]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
gdb: new AndesTech NDS32 port
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2662 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2663 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2664 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2665 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2666 information on convenience variables.
2667
2668 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2669 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2670 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2671 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2672 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2673 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2674
2675 @table @code
2676 @kindex add-inferior
2677 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2678 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2679 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2680 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2681 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2682 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2683
2684 @kindex clone-inferior
2685 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2686 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2687 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2688 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2689 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2690
2691 @smallexample
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2695 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2696 Added inferior 2.
2697 1 inferiors added.
2698 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2699 Num Description Executable
2700 2 <null> helloworld
2701 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2702 @end smallexample
2703
2704 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2705
2706 @kindex remove-inferiors
2707 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2708 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2709 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2710 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2711
2712 @end table
2713
2714 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2715 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2716 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2717 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2721 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2723 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2724 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2725 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2726
2727 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2728 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2730 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2731 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2732 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2733 @end table
2734
2735 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2736 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2737 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2738 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2739
2740
2741 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2742 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2743
2744 @table @code
2745 @kindex set print inferior-events
2746 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2747 @item set print inferior-events
2748 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2749 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2750 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2751 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2752 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2753 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2754
2755 @kindex show print inferior-events
2756 @item show print inferior-events
2757 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2758 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2759 @end table
2760
2761 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2762 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2763 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2764
2765
2766 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2767 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2768 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2769 info program-spaces}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2773 @item maint info program-spaces
2774 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2775 @value{GDBN}.
2776
2777 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2778
2779 @enumerate
2780 @item
2781 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2782
2783 @item
2784 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2785 the @code{file} command.
2786
2787 @end enumerate
2788
2789 @noindent
2790 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2791 indicates the current program space.
2792
2793 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2794 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2795 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2796
2797 @smallexample
2798 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2799 Id Executable
2800 * 1 hello
2801 2 goodbye
2802 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2803 @end smallexample
2804
2805 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2806 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2807 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2808 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2809 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2810
2811 @smallexample
2812 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2813 Id Executable
2814 * 1 vfork-test
2815 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2819 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2820 @end table
2821
2822 @node Threads
2823 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2824
2825 @cindex threads of execution
2826 @cindex multiple threads
2827 @cindex switching threads
2828 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2829 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2830 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2831 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2832 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2833 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2834 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2835
2836 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2837 programs:
2838
2839 @itemize @bullet
2840 @item automatic notification of new threads
2841 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2842 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2843 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2844 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2845 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2846 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2847 messages on thread start and exit.
2848 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2849 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2850 isn't compatible with the program.
2851 @end itemize
2852
2853 @cindex focus of debugging
2854 @cindex current thread
2855 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2856 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2857 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2858 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2859 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2860
2861 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2862 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2863 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2864 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2865 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2866 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2867 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2868 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2869 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2870 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2871
2872 @smallexample
2873 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2874 @end smallexample
2875
2876 @noindent
2877 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2878 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2879 further qualifier.
2880
2881 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2882 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2883 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2884 @c program?
2885 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2886 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2887 @c threads ab initio?
2888
2889 @anchor{thread numbers}
2890 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2891 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2892 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2893 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2894 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2895 between threads of different inferiors.
2896
2897 @cindex qualified thread ID
2898 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2899 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2900 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2901 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2902 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2903 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2904 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2905 inferior.
2906
2907 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2908 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2909 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2910 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2911
2912 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2913 @cindex thread ID lists
2914 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2915 argument. A list element can be:
2916
2917 @enumerate
2918 @item
2919 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2920 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2921 @samp{1}.
2922
2923 @item
2924 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2925 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2926 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2927
2928 @item
2929 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2930 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2931 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2932 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2933 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2934
2935 @end enumerate
2936
2937 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2938 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2939 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2940 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2941 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2942 7.1}.
2943
2944
2945 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2946 @cindex global thread number
2947 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2948 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2949 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2950 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2951 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2952 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2953
2954 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2955 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2956 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2957
2958 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2959 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2960 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2961 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2962 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2963 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2964 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2965 general information on convenience variables.
2966
2967 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2968 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2969 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2970
2971 @smallexample
2972 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2973 @end smallexample
2974
2975 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2976
2977 @smallexample
2978 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2979 @end smallexample
2980
2981 @table @code
2982 @kindex info threads
2983 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2984
2985 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2986 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2987 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2988 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2989
2990 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2991
2992 @enumerate
2993 @item
2994 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2995
2996 @item
2997 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
2998 option was specified
2999
3000 @item
3001 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3002
3003 @item
3004 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3005 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3006 program itself.
3007
3008 @item
3009 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3010 @end enumerate
3011
3012 @noindent
3013 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3014 indicates the current thread.
3015
3016 For example,
3017 @end table
3018 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3019
3020 @smallexample
3021 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3022 Id Target Id Frame
3023 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3024 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3025 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3026 at threadtest.c:68
3027 @end smallexample
3028
3029 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3030 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3031 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3032
3033 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3034 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3035
3036 @smallexample
3037 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3038 Id GId Target Id Frame
3039 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3040 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3041 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3042 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3043 @end smallexample
3044
3045 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3046 Solaris-specific command:
3047
3048 @table @code
3049 @item maint info sol-threads
3050 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3051 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3052 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3053 @end table
3054
3055 @table @code
3056 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3057 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3058 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3059 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3060 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3061 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3062
3063 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3064 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3065
3066 @smallexample
3067 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3068 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3069 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3070 8 printf ("hello\n");
3071 @end smallexample
3072
3073 @noindent
3074 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3075 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3076 threads.
3077
3078 @kindex thread apply
3079 @cindex apply command to several threads
3080 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3081 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3082 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3083 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3084 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3085 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3086 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3087 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3088
3089
3090 @kindex thread name
3091 @cindex name a thread
3092 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3093 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3094 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3095 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3096
3097 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3098 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3099 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3100 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3101 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3102
3103 @kindex thread find
3104 @cindex search for a thread
3105 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3106 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3107 matches the supplied regular expression.
3108
3109 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3110 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3111 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3112 is the LWP id.
3113
3114 @smallexample
3115 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3116 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3117 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3120 @end smallexample
3121
3122 @kindex set print thread-events
3123 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3124 @item set print thread-events
3125 @itemx set print thread-events on
3126 @itemx set print thread-events off
3127 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3128 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3129 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3130 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3131 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3132
3133 @kindex show print thread-events
3134 @item show print thread-events
3135 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3136 have started and exited.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3140 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3141 programs with multiple threads.
3142
3143 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3144 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3145
3146 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3149 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3150 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3151 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3152 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3153 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3154 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3155 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3156 macro.
3157
3158 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3159 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3160 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3161 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3162 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3163 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3164
3165 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3166 refers to the default system directories that are
3167 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3168 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3169 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3170
3171 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3172 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3173 was loaded in the inferior process.
3174
3175 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3176 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3177 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3178 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3179 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3180 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3181 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3182
3183 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3184 only on some platforms.
3185
3186 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3187 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3188 Display current libthread_db search path.
3189
3190 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3191 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3192 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3193 @item set debug libthread-db
3194 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3195 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3196 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3197 @end table
3198
3199 @node Forks
3200 @section Debugging Forks
3201
3202 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3203 @cindex multiple processes
3204 @cindex processes, multiple
3205 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3206 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3207 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3208 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3209 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3210 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3211 will cause it to terminate.
3212
3213 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3214 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3215 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3216 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3217 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3218 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3219 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3220 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3221 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3222 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3223
3224 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3225 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3226 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3227 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3228
3229 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3230 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3231 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3232
3233 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3234 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3235
3236 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3237 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3238
3239 @table @code
3240 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3241 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3242 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3243 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3244 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3245
3246 @table @code
3247 @item parent
3248 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3249 unimpeded. This is the default.
3250
3251 @item child
3252 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3253 unimpeded.
3254
3255 @end table
3256
3257 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3258 @item show follow-fork-mode
3259 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3260 @end table
3261
3262 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3263 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3264 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3265
3266 @table @code
3267 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3268 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3269 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3270 retain debugger control over them both.
3271
3272 @table @code
3273 @item on
3274 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3275 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3276 independently. This is the default.
3277
3278 @item off
3279 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3280 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3281 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3282 is held suspended.
3283
3284 @end table
3285
3286 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3287 @item show detach-on-fork
3288 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3289 @end table
3290
3291 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3292 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3293 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3294 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3295 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3296 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3297
3298 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3299 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3300 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3301 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3302 and Programs}.
3303
3304 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3305 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3306 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3307 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3308 the child process's @code{main}.
3309
3310 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3311 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3312
3313 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3314 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3315 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3316 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3317 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3318 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3319 command.
3320
3321 @table @code
3322 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3323 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3324
3325 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3326 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3327
3328 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3329
3330 @table @code
3331 @item new
3332 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3333 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3334 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3335 original inferior.
3336
3337 For example:
3338
3339 @smallexample
3340 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3341 (gdb) info inferior
3342 Id Description Executable
3343 * 1 <null> prog1
3344 (@value{GDBP}) run
3345 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3346 Program exited normally.
3347 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3348 Id Description Executable
3349 1 <null> prog1
3350 * 2 <null> prog2
3351 @end smallexample
3352
3353 @item same
3354 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3355 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3356 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3357 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3358 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3359
3360 For example:
3361
3362 @smallexample
3363 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3364 Id Description Executable
3365 * 1 <null> prog1
3366 (@value{GDBP}) run
3367 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3368 Program exited normally.
3369 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3370 Id Description Executable
3371 * 1 <null> prog2
3372 @end smallexample
3373
3374 @end table
3375 @end table
3376
3377 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3378 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3379
3380 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3381 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3382 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3383
3384 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3385 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3386
3387 @cindex checkpoint
3388 @cindex restart
3389 @cindex bookmark
3390 @cindex snapshot of a process
3391 @cindex rewind program state
3392
3393 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3394 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3395 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3396 later.
3397
3398 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3399 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3400 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3401 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3402 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3403
3404 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3405 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3406 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3407 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3408 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3409 start again from there.
3410
3411 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3412 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3413
3414 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3415
3416 @table @code
3417 @kindex checkpoint
3418 @item checkpoint
3419 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3420 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3421 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3422
3423 @kindex info checkpoints
3424 @item info checkpoints
3425 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3426 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3427 listed:
3428
3429 @table @code
3430 @item Checkpoint ID
3431 @item Process ID
3432 @item Code Address
3433 @item Source line, or label
3434 @end table
3435
3436 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3437 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3438 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3439 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3440 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3441 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3442 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3443
3444 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3445 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3446 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3447 the debugger.
3448
3449 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3450 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3451 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3452
3453 @end table
3454
3455 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3456 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3457 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3458 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3459 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3460 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3461 previously read data can be read again.
3462
3463 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3464 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3465 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3466 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3467 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3468 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3469
3470 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3471 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3472 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3473 different execution path this time.
3474
3475 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3476 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3477 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3478 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3479 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3480 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3481 potentially pose a problem.
3482
3483 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3484
3485 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3486 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3487 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3488 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3489 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3490 next.
3491
3492 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3493 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3494 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3495 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3496 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3497
3498 @node Stopping
3499 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3500
3501 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3502 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3503 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3504
3505 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3506 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3507 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3508 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3509 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3510 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3511 explicitly request this information at any time.
3512
3513 @table @code
3514 @kindex info program
3515 @item info program
3516 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3517 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3518 @end table
3519
3520 @menu
3521 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3522 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3523 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3524 Skipping over functions and files
3525 * Signals:: Signals
3526 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3527 @end menu
3528
3529 @node Breakpoints
3530 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3531
3532 @cindex breakpoints
3533 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3534 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3535 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3536 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3537 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3538 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3539 program.
3540
3541 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3542 the executable is run.
3543
3544 @cindex watchpoints
3545 @cindex data breakpoints
3546 @cindex memory tracing
3547 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3548 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3549 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3550 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3551 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3552 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3553 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3554 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3555 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3556 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3557 same commands.
3558
3559 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3560 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3561 Automatic Display}.
3562
3563 @cindex catchpoints
3564 @cindex breakpoint on events
3565 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3566 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3567 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3568 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3569 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3570 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3571 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3572
3573 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3574 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3575 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3576 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3577 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3578 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3579 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3580 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3581 enable it again.
3582
3583 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3584 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3585 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3586 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3587 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3588 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3589 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3590
3591 @menu
3592 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3593 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3594 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3595 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3596 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3597 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3598 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3599 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3600 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3601 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3602 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3603 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3604 @end menu
3605
3606 @node Set Breaks
3607 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3608
3609 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3610 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3611 @c
3612 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3613
3614 @kindex break
3615 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3616 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3617 @cindex latest breakpoint
3618 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3619 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3620 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3621 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3622 convenience variables.
3623
3624 @table @code
3625 @item break @var{location}
3626 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3627 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3628 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3629 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3630 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3631
3632 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3633 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3634 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3635 that situation.
3636
3637 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3638 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3639 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3640
3641 @item break
3642 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3643 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3644 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3645 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3646 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3647 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3648 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3649 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3650 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3651 inside loops.
3652
3653 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3654 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3655 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3656 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3657 existed when your program stopped.
3658
3659 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3660 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3661 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3662 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3663 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3664 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3665 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3666
3667 @kindex tbreak
3668 @item tbreak @var{args}
3669 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3670 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3671 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3672 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3673
3674 @kindex hbreak
3675 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3676 @item hbreak @var{args}
3677 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3678 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3679 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3680 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3681 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3682 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3683 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3684 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3685 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3686 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3687 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3688 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3689 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3690 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3691 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3692 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3693 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3694 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3695
3696 @kindex thbreak
3697 @item thbreak @var{args}
3698 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3699 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3700 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3701 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3702 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3703 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3704 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3705 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3706
3707 @kindex rbreak
3708 @cindex regular expression
3709 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3710 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3711 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3712 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3713 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3714 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3715 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3716 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3717 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3718
3719 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3720 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3721 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3722 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3723 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3724 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3725
3726 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3727 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3728 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3729 classes.
3730
3731 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3732 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3733 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3734
3735 @smallexample
3736 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3737 @end smallexample
3738
3739 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3740 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3741 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3742 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3743 every function in a given file:
3744
3745 @smallexample
3746 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3747 @end smallexample
3748
3749 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3750 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3751
3752 @kindex info breakpoints
3753 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3754 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3755 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3756 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3757 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3758 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3759 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3760
3761 @table @emph
3762 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3763 @item Type
3764 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3765 @item Disposition
3766 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3767 @item Enabled or Disabled
3768 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3769 that are not enabled.
3770 @item Address
3771 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3772 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3773 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3774 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3775 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3776 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3777 @item What
3778 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3779 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3780 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3781 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3782 @end table
3783
3784 @noindent
3785 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3786 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3787 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3788 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3789 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3790 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3791
3792 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3793 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3794 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3795 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3796
3797 @noindent
3798 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3799 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3800 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3801 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3802 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3803
3804 @noindent
3805 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3806 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3807 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3808 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3809 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3810 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3811
3812 @noindent
3813 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3814 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3815
3816 @end table
3817
3818 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3819 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3820 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3821 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3822
3823 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3824 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3825 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3826 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3827
3828 @itemize @bullet
3829 @item
3830 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3831
3832 @item
3833 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3834 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3835
3836 @item
3837 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3838 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3839
3840 @item
3841 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3842 several places where that function is inlined.
3843 @end itemize
3844
3845 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3846 the relevant locations.
3847
3848 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3849 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3850 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3851 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3852 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3853 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3854 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3855
3856 For example:
3857
3858 @smallexample
3859 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3860 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3861 stop only if i==1
3862 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3863 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3864 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3865 @end smallexample
3866
3867 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3868 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3869 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3870 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3871 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3872 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3873 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3874 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3875 that belong to that breakpoint.
3876
3877 @cindex pending breakpoints
3878 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3879 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3880 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3881 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3882 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3883 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3884 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3885 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3886 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3887 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3888 is not yet resolved.
3889
3890 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3891 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3892 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3893 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3894 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3895 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3896
3897 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3898 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3899 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3900 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3901
3902 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3903 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3904 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3905
3906 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3907 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3908 address specification to an address:
3909
3910 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3911 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3912 @table @code
3913 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3914 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3915 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3916
3917 @item set breakpoint pending on
3918 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3919 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3920
3921 @item set breakpoint pending off
3922 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3923 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3924 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3925
3926 @item show breakpoint pending
3927 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3928 @end table
3929
3930 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3931 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3932 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3933
3934 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3935 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3936 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3937 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3938 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3939 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3940 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3941 breakpoints.
3942
3943 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3944
3945 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3946 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3947 @table @code
3948 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3949 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3950 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3951 breakpoint must be used.
3952
3953 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3954 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3955 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3956 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3957 @end table
3958
3959 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3960 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3961 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3962 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3963 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3964 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3965 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3966 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3967 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3968
3969 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3970 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3971 @table @code
3972 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3973 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3974 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3975 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3976
3977 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3978 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3979 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3980 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3981 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3982 @end table
3983
3984 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3985 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3986 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3987
3988 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3989 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3990
3991 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3992
3993 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3994 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3995 @table @code
3996 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3997 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3998 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3999 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4000 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4001
4002 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4003 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4004 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4005 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4006 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4007 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4008 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4009 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4010 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4011 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4012 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4013 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4014 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4015
4016 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4017 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4018 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4019 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4020 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4021 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4022 @end table
4023
4024
4025 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4026 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4027 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4028 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4029 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4030 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4031 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4032 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4033
4034
4035 @node Set Watchpoints
4036 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4037
4038 @cindex setting watchpoints
4039 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4040 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4041 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4042 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4043 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4044
4045 @itemize @bullet
4046 @item
4047 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4048
4049 @item
4050 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4051 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4052 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4053
4054 @item
4055 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4056 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4057 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4058 @end itemize
4059
4060 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4061 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4062 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4063 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4064 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4065 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4066 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4067 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4068 the expression changes.
4069
4070 @cindex software watchpoints
4071 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4072 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4073 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4074 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4075 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4076 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4077 culprit.)
4078
4079 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4080 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4081 slow down the running of your program.
4082
4083 @table @code
4084 @kindex watch
4085 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4086 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4087 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4088 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4089 to watch the value of a single variable:
4090
4091 @smallexample
4092 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4093 @end smallexample
4094
4095 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4096 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4097 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4098 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4099 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4100 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4101
4102 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4103 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4104 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4105 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4106 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4107 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4108 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4109 error.
4110
4111 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4112 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4113 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4114 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4115 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4116 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4117 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4118 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4119 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4120 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4121 Examples:
4122
4123 @smallexample
4124 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4125 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4126 @end smallexample
4127
4128 @kindex rwatch
4129 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4130 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4131 by the program.
4132
4133 @kindex awatch
4134 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4135 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4136 or written into by the program.
4137
4138 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4139 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4140 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4141 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4142 @end table
4143
4144 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4145 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4146 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4147 a never-changing value:
4148
4149 @smallexample
4150 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4151 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4152 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4153 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4154 @end smallexample
4155
4156 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4157 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4158 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4159 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4160 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4161 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4162
4163 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4164 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4165 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4166 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4167 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4168 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4169 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4170 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4171
4172 @table @code
4173 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4174 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4175 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4176
4177 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4178 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4179 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4180 @end table
4181
4182 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4183 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4184 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4185
4186 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4187
4188 @smallexample
4189 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4190 @end smallexample
4191
4192 @noindent
4193 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4194
4195 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4196 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4197 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4198 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4199 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4200 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4201 will print a message like this:
4202
4203 @smallexample
4204 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4205 @end smallexample
4206
4207 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4208 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4209 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4210 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4211 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4212 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4213 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4214 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4215
4216 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4217 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4218 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4219 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4220 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4221 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4222
4223 @smallexample
4224 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4225 @end smallexample
4226
4227 @noindent
4228 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4229
4230 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4231 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4232 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4233 expression with separately allocated resources.
4234
4235 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4236 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4237 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4238
4239 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4240 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4241 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4242 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4243 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4244 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4245 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4246 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4247 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4248
4249 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4250 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4251 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4252 watched expression from every thread.
4253
4254 @quotation
4255 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4256 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4257 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4258 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4259 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4260 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4261 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4262 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4263 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4264 @end quotation
4265
4266 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4267
4268 @node Set Catchpoints
4269 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4270 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4271 @cindex exception handlers
4272 @cindex event handling
4273
4274 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4275 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4276 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4277
4278 @table @code
4279 @kindex catch
4280 @item catch @var{event}
4281 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4282
4283 @table @code
4284 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4285 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4286 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4287 @kindex catch throw
4288 @kindex catch rethrow
4289 @kindex catch catch
4290 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4291 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4292
4293 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4294 regular expression will be caught.
4295
4296 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4297 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4298 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4299 exception being thrown.
4300
4301 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4302 @value{GDBN}:
4303
4304 @itemize @bullet
4305 @item
4306 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4307 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4308 supported.
4309
4310 @item
4311 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4312 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4313 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4314 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4315 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4316 built.
4317
4318 @item
4319 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4320 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4321
4322 @item
4323 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4324 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4325 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4326 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4327
4328 @item
4329 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4330 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4331 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4332 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4333 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4334 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4335 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4336 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4337 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4338
4339 @item
4340 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4341
4342 @item
4343 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4344 @end itemize
4345
4346 @item exception
4347 @kindex catch exception
4348 @cindex Ada exception catching
4349 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4350 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4351 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4352 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4353 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4354
4355 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4356 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4357 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4358 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4359 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4360 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4361 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4362 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4363
4364 @item exception unhandled
4365 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4366 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4367
4368 @item assert
4369 @kindex catch assert
4370 A failed Ada assertion.
4371
4372 @item exec
4373 @kindex catch exec
4374 @cindex break on fork/exec
4375 A call to @code{exec}.
4376
4377 @item syscall
4378 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4379 @kindex catch syscall
4380 @cindex break on a system call.
4381 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4382 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4383 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4384 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4385 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4386 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4387 will be caught.
4388
4389 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4390 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4391 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4392 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4393
4394 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4395 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4396 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4397 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4398
4399 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4400 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4401 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4402 available choices.
4403
4404 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4405 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4406 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4407 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4408 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4409 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4410 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4411 behind the OS upgrades).
4412
4413 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4414 arguments to it:
4415
4416 @smallexample
4417 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4418 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4419 (@value{GDBP}) r
4420 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4421
4422 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4423 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4424 (@value{GDBP}) c
4425 Continuing.
4426
4427 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4428 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4429 (@value{GDBP})
4430 @end smallexample
4431
4432 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4433
4434 @smallexample
4435 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4436 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4437 (@value{GDBP}) r
4438 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4439
4440 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4441 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4442 (@value{GDBP}) c
4443 Continuing.
4444
4445 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4446 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4447 (@value{GDBP})
4448 @end smallexample
4449
4450 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4451 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4452 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4453
4454 @smallexample
4455 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4456 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4457 (@value{GDBP}) r
4458 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4459
4460 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4461 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4462 (@value{GDBP}) c
4463 Continuing.
4464
4465 Program exited normally.
4466 (@value{GDBP})
4467 @end smallexample
4468
4469 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4470 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4471 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4472 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4473
4474 @smallexample
4475 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4476 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4477 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4478 (@value{GDBP})
4479 @end smallexample
4480
4481 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4482 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4483 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4484 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4485 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4486 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4487
4488 @smallexample
4489 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4490 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4491 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4492 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4493 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4494 (@value{GDBP})
4495 @end smallexample
4496
4497 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4498
4499 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4500 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4501
4502 @smallexample
4503 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4504 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4505 @end smallexample
4506
4507 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4508
4509 @item fork
4510 @kindex catch fork
4511 A call to @code{fork}.
4512
4513 @item vfork
4514 @kindex catch vfork
4515 A call to @code{vfork}.
4516
4517 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4518 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4519 @kindex catch load
4520 @kindex catch unload
4521 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4522 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4523 matches one of the affected libraries.
4524
4525 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4526 @kindex catch signal
4527 The delivery of a signal.
4528
4529 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4530 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4531 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4532
4533 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4534 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4535 signal names.
4536
4537 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4538 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4539 will be caught.
4540
4541 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4542 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4543 catchpoint.
4544
4545 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4546 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4547 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4548 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4549 commands.
4550
4551 @end table
4552
4553 @item tcatch @var{event}
4554 @kindex tcatch
4555 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4556 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4557
4558 @end table
4559
4560 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4561
4562
4563 @node Delete Breaks
4564 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4565
4566 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4567 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4568 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4569 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4570 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4571 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4572
4573 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4574 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4575 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4576 their breakpoint numbers.
4577
4578 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4579 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4580 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4581
4582 @table @code
4583 @kindex clear
4584 @item clear
4585 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4586 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4587 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4588 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4589
4590 @item clear @var{location}
4591 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4592 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4593 most useful ones are listed below:
4594
4595 @table @code
4596 @item clear @var{function}
4597 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4598 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4599
4600 @item clear @var{linenum}
4601 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4602 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4603 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4604 @end table
4605
4606 @cindex delete breakpoints
4607 @kindex delete
4608 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4609 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4610 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4611 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4612 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4613 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4614 @end table
4615
4616 @node Disabling
4617 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4618
4619 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4620 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4621 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4622 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4623 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4624
4625 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4626 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4627 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4628 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4629 do not know which numbers to use.
4630
4631 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4632 affects all of its locations.
4633
4634 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4635 different states of enablement:
4636
4637 @itemize @bullet
4638 @item
4639 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4640 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4641 @item
4642 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4643 @item
4644 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4645 disabled.
4646 @item
4647 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4648 N times, then becomes disabled.
4649 @item
4650 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4651 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4652 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4653 @end itemize
4654
4655 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4656 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4657
4658 @table @code
4659 @kindex disable
4660 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4661 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4662 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4663 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4664 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4665 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4666 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4667
4668 @kindex enable
4669 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4670 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4671 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4672
4673 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4674 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4675 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4676
4677 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4678 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4679 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4680 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4681 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4682 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4683 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4684
4685 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4686 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4687 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4688 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4689 @end table
4690
4691 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4692 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4693 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4694 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4695 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4696 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4697 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4698 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4699 Stepping}.)
4700
4701 @node Conditions
4702 @subsection Break Conditions
4703 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4704 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4705
4706 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4707 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4708 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4709 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4710 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4711 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4712 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4713 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4714
4715 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4716 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4717 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4718 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4719 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4720
4721 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4722 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4723 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4724 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4725 one.
4726
4727 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4728 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4729 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4730 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4731 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4732 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4733 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4734 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4735 conditions for the
4736 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4737 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4738
4739 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4740 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4741 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4742 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4743 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4744 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4745
4746 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4747 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4748 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4749 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4750 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4751
4752 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4753 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4754 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4755 with the @code{condition} command.
4756
4757 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4758 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4759 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4760 catchpoint.
4761
4762 @table @code
4763 @kindex condition
4764 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4765 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4766 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4767 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4768 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4769 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4770 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4771 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4772 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4773 prints an error message:
4774
4775 @smallexample
4776 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4777 @end smallexample
4778
4779 @noindent
4780 @value{GDBN} does
4781 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4782 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4783 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4784
4785 @item condition @var{bnum}
4786 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4787 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4788 @end table
4789
4790 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4791 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4792 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4793 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4794 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4795 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4796 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4797 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4798 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4799 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4800 your program reaches it.
4801
4802 @table @code
4803 @kindex ignore
4804 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4805 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4806 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4807 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4808 takes no action.
4809
4810 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4811 a count of zero.
4812
4813 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4814 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4815 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4816 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4817
4818 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4819 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4820 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4821
4822 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4823 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4824 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4825 Variables}.
4826 @end table
4827
4828 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4829
4830
4831 @node Break Commands
4832 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4833
4834 @cindex breakpoint commands
4835 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4836 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4837 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4838 enable other breakpoints.
4839
4840 @table @code
4841 @kindex commands
4842 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4843 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4844 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4845 @itemx end
4846 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4847 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4848 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4849
4850 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4851 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4852
4853 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4854 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4855 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4856 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4857 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4858 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4859 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4860 Expressions}).
4861 @end table
4862
4863 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4864 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4865
4866 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4867 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4868 that resumes execution.
4869
4870 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4871 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4872 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4873 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4874 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4875
4876 @kindex silent
4877 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4878 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4879 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4880 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4881 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4882 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4883
4884 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4885 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4886 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4887
4888 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4889 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4890
4891 @smallexample
4892 break foo if x>0
4893 commands
4894 silent
4895 printf "x is %d\n",x
4896 cont
4897 end
4898 @end smallexample
4899
4900 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4901 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4902 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4903 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4904 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4905 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4906 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4907
4908 @smallexample
4909 break 403
4910 commands
4911 silent
4912 set x = y + 4
4913 cont
4914 end
4915 @end smallexample
4916
4917 @node Dynamic Printf
4918 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4919
4920 @cindex dynamic printf
4921 @cindex dprintf
4922 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4923 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4924 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4925 having to recompile it.
4926
4927 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4928 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4929 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4930 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4931 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4932 redirects to files and so forth.
4933
4934 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4935 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4936 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4937 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4938 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4939 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4940 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4941
4942 @table @code
4943 @kindex dprintf
4944 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4945 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4946 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4947 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4948
4949 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4950 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4951 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4952 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4953 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4954 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4955
4956 @item gdb
4957 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4958 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4959
4960 @item call
4961 @kindex dprintf-style call
4962 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4963 @code{printf}).
4964
4965 @item agent
4966 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4967 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4968 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4969 support running commands on the target.
4970
4971 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4972 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4973 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4974 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4975 command.
4976
4977 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4978 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4979 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4980 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4981 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4982 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4983
4984 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4985 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4986 you could do the following:
4987
4988 @example
4989 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4990 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4991 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4992 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4993 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4994 (gdb) info break
4995 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4996 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4997 continue
4998 (gdb)
4999 @end example
5000
5001 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5002 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5003 the variable settings.
5004
5005 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5006 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5007 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5008 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5009 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5010 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5011
5012 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5013 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5014 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5015
5016 @end table
5017
5018 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5019 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5020 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5021 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5022 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5023 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5024
5025 @node Save Breakpoints
5026 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5027
5028 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5029 breakpoints}} command.
5030
5031 @table @code
5032 @kindex save breakpoints
5033 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5034 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5035 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5036 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5037 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5038 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5039 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5040 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5041 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5042 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5043 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5044 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5045 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5046 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5047 that can no longer be recreated.
5048 @end table
5049
5050 @node Static Probe Points
5051 @subsection Static Probe Points
5052
5053 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5054 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5055 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5056 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5057 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5058
5059 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5060 ELF-compatible systems:
5061
5062 @itemize @bullet
5063
5064 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5065 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5066 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5067 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5068 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5069 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5070 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5071 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5072
5073 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5074 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5075 C@t{++} languages.
5076 @end itemize
5077
5078 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5079 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5080 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5081 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5082 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5083 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5084 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5085 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5086 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5087
5088 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5089 probes}, with optional arguments:
5090
5091 @table @code
5092 @kindex info probes
5093 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5094 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5095 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5096 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5097
5098 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5099 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5100 probes from all providers are listed.
5101
5102 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5103 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5104 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5105
5106 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5107 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5108 given, all object files are considered.
5109
5110 @item info probes all
5111 List the available static probes, from all types.
5112 @end table
5113
5114 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5115 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5116 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5117 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5118 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5119
5120 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5121 commands, with optional arguments:
5122
5123 @table @code
5124 @kindex enable probes
5125 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5126 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5127 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5128 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5129
5130 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5131 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5132 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5133
5134 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5135 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5136 given, all object files are considered.
5137
5138 @kindex disable probes
5139 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5140 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5141 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5142 @end table
5143
5144 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5145 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5146 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5147 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5148 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5149 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5150 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5151 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5152 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5153 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5154 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5155 at the current probe point.
5156
5157 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5158 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5159 an error message.
5160
5161
5162 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5163 @node Error in Breakpoints
5164 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5165
5166 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5167 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5168
5169 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5170 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5171 @smallexample
5172 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5173 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5174 @end smallexample
5175
5176 @noindent
5177 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5178 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5179 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5180
5181 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5182 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5183
5184 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5185 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5186 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5187
5188 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5189 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5190 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5191 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5192
5193 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5194 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5195 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5196 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5197 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5198 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5199 first in the bundle.
5200
5201 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5202 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5203 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5204 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5205 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5206 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5207 is hit.
5208
5209 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5210 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5211
5212 @smallexample
5213 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5214 @end smallexample
5215
5216 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5217 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5218 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5219 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5220 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5221 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5222 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5223 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5224
5225 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5226 adjusted breakpoints:
5227
5228 @smallexample
5229 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5230 to 0x00010410.
5231 @end smallexample
5232
5233 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5234 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5235 frequently than expected.
5236
5237 @node Continuing and Stepping
5238 @section Continuing and Stepping
5239
5240 @cindex stepping
5241 @cindex continuing
5242 @cindex resuming execution
5243 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5244 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5245 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5246 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5247 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5248 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5249 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5250 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5251 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5252 handlers}).)
5253
5254 @table @code
5255 @kindex continue
5256 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5257 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5258 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5259 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5260 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5261 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5262 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5263 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5264 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5265 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5266
5267 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5268 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5269 @code{continue} is ignored.
5270
5271 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5272 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5273 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5274 @code{continue}.
5275 @end table
5276
5277 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5278 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5279 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5280 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5281
5282 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5283 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5284 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5285 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5286 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5287 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5288
5289 @table @code
5290 @kindex step
5291 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5292 @item step
5293 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5294 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5295 abbreviated @code{s}.
5296
5297 @quotation
5298 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5299 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5300 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5301 @c distinction here.
5302 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5303 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5304 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5305 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5306 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5307 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5308 below.
5309 @end quotation
5310
5311 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5312 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5313 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5314 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5315 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5316 called within the line.
5317
5318 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5319 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5320 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5321 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5322 was any debugging information about the routine.
5323
5324 @item step @var{count}
5325 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5326 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5327 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5328
5329 @kindex next
5330 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5331 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5332 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5333 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5334 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5335 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5336 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5337 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5338
5339 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5340
5341
5342 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5343 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5344 @c
5345 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5346 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5347 @c function are executed without stopping.
5348
5349 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5350 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5351 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5352
5353 @kindex set step-mode
5354 @item set step-mode
5355 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5356 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5357 @itemx set step-mode on
5358 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5359 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5360 information rather than stepping over it.
5361
5362 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5363 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5364 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5365
5366 @item set step-mode off
5367 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5368 debug information. This is the default.
5369
5370 @item show step-mode
5371 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5372 source line debug information.
5373
5374 @kindex finish
5375 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5376 @item finish
5377 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5378 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5379 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5380
5381 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5382 ,Returning from a Function}).
5383
5384 @kindex until
5385 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5386 @cindex run until specified location
5387 @item until
5388 @itemx u
5389 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5390 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5391 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5392 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5393 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5394 than the address of the jump.
5395
5396 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5397 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5398 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5399 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5400 through the next iteration.
5401
5402 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5403 stack frame.
5404
5405 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5406 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5407 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5408 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5409 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5410
5411 @smallexample
5412 (@value{GDBP}) f
5413 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5414 206 expand_input();
5415 (@value{GDBP}) until
5416 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5417 @end smallexample
5418
5419 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5420 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5421 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5422 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5423 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5424 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5425 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5426
5427 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5428 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5429 argument.
5430
5431 @item until @var{location}
5432 @itemx u @var{location}
5433 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5434 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5435 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5436 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5437 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5438 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5439 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5440 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5441 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5442 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5443 invocations have returned.
5444
5445 @smallexample
5446 94 int factorial (int value)
5447 95 @{
5448 96 if (value > 1) @{
5449 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5450 98 @}
5451 99 return (value);
5452 100 @}
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455
5456 @kindex advance @var{location}
5457 @item advance @var{location}
5458 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5459 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5460 @ref{Specify Location}.
5461 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5462 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5463 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5464 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5465
5466
5467 @kindex stepi
5468 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5469 @item stepi
5470 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5471 @itemx si
5472 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5473
5474 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5475 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5476 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5477 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5478
5479 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5480
5481 @need 750
5482 @kindex nexti
5483 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5484 @item nexti
5485 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5486 @itemx ni
5487 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5488 proceed until the function returns.
5489
5490 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5491
5492 @end table
5493
5494 @anchor{range stepping}
5495 @cindex range stepping
5496 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5497 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5498 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5499 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5500 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5501 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5502 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5503 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5504 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5505 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5506 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5507 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5508 if necessary:
5509
5510 @table @code
5511 @kindex set range-stepping
5512 @kindex show range-stepping
5513 @item set range-stepping
5514 @itemx show range-stepping
5515 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5516
5517 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5518 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5519 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5520 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5521 default is @code{on}.
5522
5523 @end table
5524
5525 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5526 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5527 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5528
5529 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5530 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5531 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5532 a particular file when stepping.
5533
5534 For example, consider the following C function:
5535
5536 @smallexample
5537 101 int func()
5538 102 @{
5539 103 foo(boring());
5540 104 bar(boring());
5541 105 @}
5542 @end smallexample
5543
5544 @noindent
5545 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5546 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5547 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5548 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5549
5550 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5551 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5552 is called from many places.
5553
5554 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5555 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5556 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5557 @code{foo}.
5558
5559 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5560 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5561 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5562
5563 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5564 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5565 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5566 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5567 the underlying system.
5568 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5569 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5570
5571 @table @code
5572 @kindex skip
5573 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5574 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5575 that specify what to skip.
5576 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5577
5578 @table @code
5579 @item -file @var{file}
5580 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5581 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5582
5583 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5584 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5585 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5586 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5587 over when stepping.
5588
5589 @smallexample
5590 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5591 @end smallexample
5592
5593 @item -function @var{linespec}
5594 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5595 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5596 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5597 @xref{Specify Location}.
5598
5599 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5600 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5601 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5602 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5603
5604 This form is useful for complex function names.
5605 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5606 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5607 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5608 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5609 regular expression makes this easier.
5610
5611 @smallexample
5612 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5613 @end smallexample
5614
5615 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5616 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5617
5618 @smallexample
5619 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5620 @end smallexample
5621 @end table
5622
5623 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5624 will be skipped.
5625
5626 @kindex skip function
5627 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5628 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5629 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5630 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5631
5632 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5633 will be skipped.
5634
5635 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5636 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5637
5638 @kindex skip file
5639 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5640 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5641 will be skipped over when stepping.
5642
5643 @smallexample
5644 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5645 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5646 @end smallexample
5647
5648 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5649 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5650 @end table
5651
5652 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5653 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5654
5655 @table @code
5656 @kindex info skip
5657 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5658 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5659 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5660 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5661
5662 @table @emph
5663 @item Identifier
5664 A number identifying this skip.
5665 @item Enabled or Disabled
5666 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5667 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5668 @item Glob
5669 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5670 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5671 @item File
5672 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5673 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5674 @item RE
5675 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5676 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5677 @item Function
5678 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5679 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5680 @end table
5681
5682 @kindex skip delete
5683 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5684 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5685 skips.
5686
5687 @kindex skip enable
5688 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5689 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5690 skips.
5691
5692 @kindex skip disable
5693 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5694 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5695 skips.
5696
5697 @end table
5698
5699 @node Signals
5700 @section Signals
5701 @cindex signals
5702
5703 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5704 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5705 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5706 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5707 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5708 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5709 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5710 requested an alarm).
5711
5712 @cindex fatal signals
5713 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5714 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5715 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5716 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5717 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5718 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5719
5720 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5721 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5722 signal.
5723
5724 @cindex handling signals
5725 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5726 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5727 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5728 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5729 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5730
5731 @table @code
5732 @kindex info signals
5733 @kindex info handle
5734 @item info signals
5735 @itemx info handle
5736 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5737 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5738 the defined types of signals.
5739
5740 @item info signals @var{sig}
5741 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5742
5743 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5744
5745 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5746 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5747 for details about this command.
5748
5749 @kindex handle
5750 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5751 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5752 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5753 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5754 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5755 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5756 say what change to make.
5757 @end table
5758
5759 @c @group
5760 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5761 Their full names are:
5762
5763 @table @code
5764 @item nostop
5765 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5766 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5767
5768 @item stop
5769 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5770 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5771
5772 @item print
5773 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5774
5775 @item noprint
5776 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5777 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5778
5779 @item pass
5780 @itemx noignore
5781 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5782 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5783 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5784
5785 @item nopass
5786 @itemx ignore
5787 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5788 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5789 @end table
5790 @c @end group
5791
5792 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5793 program until you
5794 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5795 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5796 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5797 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5798 program sees that signal when you continue.
5799
5800 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5801 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5802 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5803 erroneous signals.
5804
5805 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5806 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5807 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5808 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5809 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5810 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5811 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5812 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5813 Program a Signal}.
5814
5815 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5816 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5817
5818 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5819 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5820 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5821 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5822 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5823 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5824 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5825 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5826 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5827 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5828 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5829 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5830 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5831
5832 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5833
5834 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5835 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5836 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5837 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5838
5839 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5840 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5841 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5842 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5843
5844 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5845 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5846
5847 @smallexample
5848 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5849 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5850 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5851 (@value{GDBP}) c
5852 Continuing.
5853
5854 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5855 main () sigusr1.c:28
5856 28 p = 0;
5857 (@value{GDBP}) si
5858 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5859 9 @{
5860 @end smallexample
5861
5862 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5863 program to receive the signal first:
5864
5865 @smallexample
5866 (@value{GDBP}) n
5867 28 p = 0;
5868 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5869 (@value{GDBP}) si
5870 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5871 9 @{
5872 (@value{GDBP})
5873 @end smallexample
5874
5875 @cindex extra signal information
5876 @anchor{extra signal information}
5877
5878 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5879 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5880 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5881 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5882 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5883 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5884 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5885 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5886 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5887 system header.
5888
5889 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5890 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5891
5892 @smallexample
5893 @group
5894 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5895 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5896 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5897 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5898 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5899 type = struct @{
5900 int si_signo;
5901 int si_errno;
5902 int si_code;
5903 union @{
5904 int _pad[28];
5905 struct @{...@} _kill;
5906 struct @{...@} _timer;
5907 struct @{...@} _rt;
5908 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5909 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5910 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5911 @} _sifields;
5912 @}
5913 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5914 type = struct @{
5915 void *si_addr;
5916 @}
5917 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5918 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5919 @end group
5920 @end smallexample
5921
5922 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5923
5924 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5925 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5926 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5927 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5928 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5929 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5930 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5931 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5932 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5933 information is displayed.
5934
5935 The usual output of a segfault is:
5936 @smallexample
5937 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5938 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5939 68 value = *(p + len);
5940 @end smallexample
5941
5942 While a bound violation is presented as:
5943 @smallexample
5944 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5945 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5946 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5947 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5948 68 value = *(p + len);
5949 @end smallexample
5950
5951 @node Thread Stops
5952 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5953
5954 @cindex stopped threads
5955 @cindex threads, stopped
5956
5957 @cindex continuing threads
5958 @cindex threads, continuing
5959
5960 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5961 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5962 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5963 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5964 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5965 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5966 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5967 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5968 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5969
5970 @menu
5971 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5972 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5973 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5974 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5975 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5976 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5977 @end menu
5978
5979 @node All-Stop Mode
5980 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5981
5982 @cindex all-stop mode
5983
5984 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5985 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5986 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5987 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5988 underfoot.
5989
5990 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5991 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5992 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5993
5994 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5995 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5996 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5997 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5998 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5999 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6000 stops.
6001
6002 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6003 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6004 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6005 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6006
6007 @cindex automatic thread selection
6008 @cindex switching threads automatically
6009 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6010 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6011 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6012 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6013 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6014 thread.
6015
6016 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6017 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6018
6019 @table @code
6020 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6021 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6022 @cindex lock scheduler
6023 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6024 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6025 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6026 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6027 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6028 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6029 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6030 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6031 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6032 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6033 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6034 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6035 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6036 @code{on} in replay mode.
6037
6038 @item show scheduler-locking
6039 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6040 @end table
6041
6042 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6043 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6044 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6045 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6046 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6047 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6048 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6049 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6050 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6051 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6052 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6053 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6054 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6055 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6056
6057 @table @code
6058 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6059 @item set schedule-multiple
6060 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6061 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6062 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6063 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6064 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6065 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6066
6067 @item show schedule-multiple
6068 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6069 multiple processes.
6070 @end table
6071
6072 @node Non-Stop Mode
6073 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6074
6075 @cindex non-stop mode
6076
6077 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6078 @c with more details.
6079
6080 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6081 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6082 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6083 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6084 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6085 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6086
6087 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6088 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6089 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6090 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6091 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6092 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6093 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6094 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6095 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6096 independently and simultaneously.
6097
6098 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6099 or attach to your program:
6100
6101 @smallexample
6102 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6103 set pagination off
6104
6105 # Finally, turn it on!
6106 set non-stop on
6107 @end smallexample
6108
6109 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6110
6111 @table @code
6112 @kindex set non-stop
6113 @item set non-stop on
6114 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6115 @item set non-stop off
6116 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6117 @kindex show non-stop
6118 @item show non-stop
6119 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6120 @end table
6121
6122 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6123 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6124 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6125 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6126 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6127 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6128 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6129 default.
6130
6131 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6132 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6133 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6134
6135 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6136 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6137 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6138 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6139 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6140
6141 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6142 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6143 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6144 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6145 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6146
6147 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6148
6149 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6150 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6151 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6152 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6153 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6154 previously current thread.
6155
6156 @node Background Execution
6157 @subsection Background Execution
6158
6159 @cindex foreground execution
6160 @cindex background execution
6161 @cindex asynchronous execution
6162 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6163
6164 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6165 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6166 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6167 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6168 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6169 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6170
6171 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6172 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6173
6174 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6175 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6176 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6177 are:
6178
6179 @table @code
6180 @kindex run&
6181 @item run
6182 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6183
6184 @item attach
6185 @kindex attach&
6186 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6187
6188 @item step
6189 @kindex step&
6190 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6191
6192 @item stepi
6193 @kindex stepi&
6194 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6195
6196 @item next
6197 @kindex next&
6198 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6199
6200 @item nexti
6201 @kindex nexti&
6202 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6203
6204 @item continue
6205 @kindex continue&
6206 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6207
6208 @item finish
6209 @kindex finish&
6210 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6211
6212 @item until
6213 @kindex until&
6214 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6215
6216 @end table
6217
6218 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6219 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6220 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6221 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6222 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6223 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6224
6225 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6226 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6227
6228 @table @code
6229 @kindex interrupt
6230 @item interrupt
6231 @itemx interrupt -a
6232
6233 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6234 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6235 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6236 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6237 @end table
6238
6239 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6240 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6241
6242 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6243 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6244 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6245
6246 @table @code
6247 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6248 @cindex thread breakpoints
6249 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6250 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6251 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6252 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6253 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6254 specify some source line.
6255
6256 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6257 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6258 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6259 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6260 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6261
6262 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6263 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6264 program.
6265
6266 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6267 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6268 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6269
6270 @smallexample
6271 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6272 @end smallexample
6273
6274 @end table
6275
6276 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6277 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6278 thread list. For example:
6279
6280 @smallexample
6281 (@value{GDBP}) c
6282 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6283 @end smallexample
6284
6285 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6286 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6287 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6288 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6289 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6290 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6291 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6292 command.
6293
6294 @node Interrupted System Calls
6295 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6296
6297 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6298 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6299 @cindex premature return from system calls
6300 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6301 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6302 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6303 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6304 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6305 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6306 stop execution.
6307
6308 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6309 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6310 style anyways.
6311
6312 For example, do not write code like this:
6313
6314 @smallexample
6315 sleep (10);
6316 @end smallexample
6317
6318 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6319 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6320
6321 Instead, write this:
6322
6323 @smallexample
6324 int unslept = 10;
6325 while (unslept > 0)
6326 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6327 @end smallexample
6328
6329 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6330 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6331 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6332 @value{GDBN}.
6333
6334 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6335 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6336 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6337 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6338
6339 @node Observer Mode
6340 @subsection Observer Mode
6341
6342 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6343 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6344 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6345 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6346 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6347
6348 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6349 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6350 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6351 mode.
6352
6353 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6354 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6355 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6356 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6357 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6358
6359 @table @code
6360
6361 @kindex observer
6362 @item set observer on
6363 @itemx set observer off
6364 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6365 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6366 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6367 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6368
6369 @item show observer
6370 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6371
6372 @kindex may-write-registers
6373 @item set may-write-registers on
6374 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6375 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6376 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6377 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6378
6379 @item show may-write-registers
6380 Show the current permission to write registers.
6381
6382 @kindex may-write-memory
6383 @item set may-write-memory on
6384 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6385 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6386 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6387 defaults to @code{on}.
6388
6389 @item show may-write-memory
6390 Show the current permission to write memory.
6391
6392 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6393 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6394 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6395 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6396 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6397 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6398
6399 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6400 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6401
6402 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6403 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6404 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6405 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6406 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6407 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6408 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6409
6410 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6411 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6412
6413 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6414 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6415 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6416 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6417 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6418 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6419 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6420
6421 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6422 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6423
6424 @kindex may-interrupt
6425 @item set may-interrupt on
6426 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6427 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6428 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6429 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6430 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6431
6432 @item show may-interrupt
6433 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6434
6435 @end table
6436
6437 @node Reverse Execution
6438 @chapter Running programs backward
6439 @cindex reverse execution
6440 @cindex running programs backward
6441
6442 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6443 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6444 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6445 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6446
6447 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6448 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6449 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6450 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6451 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6452 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6453
6454 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6455 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6456 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6457 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6458 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6459 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6460 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6461 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6462 prior values@footnote{
6463 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6464 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6465 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6466
6467 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6468 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6469 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6470 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6471 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6472 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6473 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6474 }.
6475
6476 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6477 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6478
6479 @table @code
6480 @kindex reverse-continue
6481 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6482 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6483 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6484 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6485 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6486 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6487 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6488
6489 @kindex reverse-step
6490 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6491 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6492 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6493 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6494
6495 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6496 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6497 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6498 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6499 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6500 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6501
6502 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6503 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6504
6505 @kindex reverse-stepi
6506 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6507 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6508 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6509 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6510 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6511 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6512 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6513
6514 @kindex reverse-next
6515 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6516 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6517 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6518 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6519 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6520 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6521 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6522 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6523 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6524 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6525
6526 @kindex reverse-nexti
6527 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6528 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6529 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6530 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6531 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6532 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6533 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6534 frame) is reached.
6535
6536 @kindex reverse-finish
6537 @item reverse-finish
6538 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6539 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6540 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6541 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6542
6543 @kindex set exec-direction
6544 @item set exec-direction
6545 Set the direction of target execution.
6546 @item set exec-direction reverse
6547 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6548 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6549 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6550 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6551 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6552 @item set exec-direction forward
6553 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6554 This is the default.
6555 @end table
6556
6557
6558 @node Process Record and Replay
6559 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6560 @cindex process record and replay
6561 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6562
6563 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6564 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6565 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6566
6567 @cindex replay mode
6568 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6569 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6570 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6571 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6572 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6573 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6574 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6575 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6576 execution log.
6577
6578 @cindex record mode
6579 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6580 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6581 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6582 for future replay.
6583
6584 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6585 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6586 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6587 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6588 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6589 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6590
6591 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6592 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6593 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6594 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6595
6596 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6597 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6598
6599 @table @code
6600 @kindex target record
6601 @kindex target record-full
6602 @kindex target record-btrace
6603 @kindex record
6604 @kindex record full
6605 @kindex record btrace
6606 @kindex record btrace bts
6607 @kindex record btrace pt
6608 @kindex record bts
6609 @kindex record pt
6610 @kindex rec
6611 @kindex rec full
6612 @kindex rec btrace
6613 @kindex rec btrace bts
6614 @kindex rec btrace pt
6615 @kindex rec bts
6616 @kindex rec pt
6617 @item record @var{method}
6618 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6619 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6620 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6621 recording methods are available:
6622
6623 @table @code
6624 @item full
6625 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6626 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6627 execution.
6628
6629 @item btrace @var{format}
6630 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6631 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6632 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6633 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6634 execution.
6635
6636 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6637 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6638 formats are available:
6639
6640 @table @code
6641 @item bts
6642 @cindex branch trace store
6643 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6644 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6645 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6646
6647 @item pt
6648 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6649 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6650 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6651 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6652
6653 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6654 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6655 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6656
6657 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6658 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6659 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6660 buffer-size with care.
6661 @end table
6662
6663 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6664 @end table
6665
6666 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6667 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6668 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6669 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6670
6671 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6672 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6673 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6674 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6675 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6676
6677 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6678 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6679 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6680 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6681 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6682 does not support these two modes.
6683
6684 @kindex record stop
6685 @kindex rec s
6686 @item record stop
6687 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6688 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6689 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6690
6691 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6692 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6693 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6694 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6695 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6696
6697 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6698 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6699 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6700 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6701 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6702
6703 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6704 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6705
6706 @kindex record goto
6707 @item record goto
6708 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6709 ways to specify the location to go to:
6710
6711 @table @code
6712 @item record goto begin
6713 @itemx record goto start
6714 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6715
6716 @item record goto end
6717 Go to the end of the execution log.
6718
6719 @item record goto @var{n}
6720 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6721 @end table
6722
6723 @kindex record save
6724 @item record save @var{filename}
6725 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6726 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6727 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6728
6729 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6730
6731 @kindex record restore
6732 @item record restore @var{filename}
6733 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6734 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6735
6736 @kindex set record full
6737 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6738 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6739 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6740 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6741
6742 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6743 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6744 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6745 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6746 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6747 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6748 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6749 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6750
6751 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6752 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6753 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6754
6755 @kindex show record full
6756 @item show record full insn-number-max
6757 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6758 recording method.
6759
6760 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6761 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6762 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6763 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6764 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6765 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6766 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6767 oldest one to be deleted.
6768
6769 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6770 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6771
6772 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6773 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6774
6775 @item set record full memory-query
6776 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6777 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6778 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6779 case.
6780
6781 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6782 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6783 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6784 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6785 results.
6786
6787 @item show record full memory-query
6788 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6789
6790 @kindex set record btrace
6791 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6792 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6793 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6794 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6795 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6796 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6797 You can use the following command for that:
6798
6799 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6800 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6801 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6802 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6803 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6804 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6805 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6806 position.
6807
6808 @kindex show record btrace
6809 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6810 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6811
6812 @kindex set record btrace bts
6813 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6814 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6815 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6816 format. Default is 64KB.
6817
6818 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6819 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6820 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6821 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6822 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6823 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6824 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6825
6826 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6827 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6828
6829 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6830 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6831
6832 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6833 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6834 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6835
6836 @kindex set record btrace pt
6837 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6838 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6839 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6840 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6841
6842 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6843 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6844 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6845 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6846 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6847 actual buffer size for each thread.
6848
6849 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6850 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6851
6852 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6853 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6854
6855 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6856 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6857 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6858
6859 @kindex info record
6860 @item info record
6861 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6862 method:
6863
6864 @table @code
6865 @item full
6866 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6867 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6868
6869 @itemize @bullet
6870 @item
6871 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6872 @item
6873 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6874 @item
6875 Highest recorded instruction number.
6876 @item
6877 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6878 @item
6879 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6880 @item
6881 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6882 @end itemize
6883
6884 @item btrace
6885 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6886
6887 @itemize @bullet
6888 @item
6889 Recording format.
6890 @item
6891 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6892 @item
6893 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6894 instructions.
6895 @item
6896 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6897 @end itemize
6898
6899 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6900 @itemize @bullet
6901 @item
6902 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6903 @end itemize
6904
6905 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6906 @itemize @bullet
6907 @item
6908 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6909 @end itemize
6910 @end table
6911
6912 @kindex record delete
6913 @kindex rec del
6914 @item record delete
6915 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6916 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6917 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6918 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6919
6920 @kindex record instruction-history
6921 @kindex rec instruction-history
6922 @item record instruction-history
6923 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6924 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6925 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6926 are printed in execution order.
6927
6928 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6929 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6930 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6931
6932 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6933 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6934 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6935 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6936 @code{/p} modifier.
6937
6938 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6939 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6940 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6941
6942 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6943 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6944
6945 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6946 disassemble:
6947
6948 @table @code
6949 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6950 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6951 @var{insn}.
6952
6953 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6954 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6955 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6956 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6957 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6958 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6959
6960 @item record instruction-history
6961 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6962
6963 @item record instruction-history -
6964 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6965
6966 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6967 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6968 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6969 number @var{end} is included.
6970 @end table
6971
6972 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6973
6974 @kindex set record
6975 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6976 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6977 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6978 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6979 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6980
6981 @kindex show record
6982 @item show record instruction-history-size
6983 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6984 instruction-history} command.
6985
6986 @kindex record function-call-history
6987 @kindex rec function-call-history
6988 @item record function-call-history
6989 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6990 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6991 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6992 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6993 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6994 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6995 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6996 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6997 given together.
6998
6999 @smallexample
7000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7001 1 void foo (void)
7002 2 @{
7003 3 @}
7004 4
7005 5 void bar (void)
7006 6 @{
7007 7 ...
7008 8 foo ();
7009 9 ...
7010 10 @}
7011 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7012 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7013 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7014 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7015 @end smallexample
7016
7017 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7018 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7019 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7020 to print:
7021
7022 @table @code
7023 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7024 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7025
7026 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7027 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7028 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7029 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7030 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7031
7032 @item record function-call-history
7033 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7034
7035 @item record function-call-history -
7036 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7037
7038 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7039 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7040 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7041 @end table
7042
7043 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7044
7045 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7046 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7047 Define how many lines to print in the
7048 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7049 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7050
7051 @item show record function-call-history-size
7052 Show how many lines to print in the
7053 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7054 @end table
7055
7056
7057 @node Stack
7058 @chapter Examining the Stack
7059
7060 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7061 stopped and how it got there.
7062
7063 @cindex call stack
7064 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7065 is generated.
7066 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7067 the arguments of the call,
7068 and the local variables of the function being called.
7069 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7070 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7071 stack}.
7072
7073 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7074 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7075
7076 @cindex selected frame
7077 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7078 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7079 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7080 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7081 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7082 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7083
7084 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7085 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7086 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7087
7088 @menu
7089 * Frames:: Stack frames
7090 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7091 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7092 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7093 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7094
7095 @end menu
7096
7097 @node Frames
7098 @section Stack Frames
7099
7100 @cindex frame, definition
7101 @cindex stack frame
7102 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7103 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7104 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7105 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7106 which the function is executing.
7107
7108 @cindex initial frame
7109 @cindex outermost frame
7110 @cindex innermost frame
7111 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7112 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7113 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7114 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7115 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7116 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7117 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7118 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7119
7120 @cindex frame pointer
7121 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7122 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7123 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7124 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7125 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7126 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7127
7128 @cindex frame number
7129 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7130 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7131 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7132 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7133 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7134
7135 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7136 @c underflow problems.
7137 @cindex frameless execution
7138 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7139 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7140 @smallexample
7141 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7142 @end smallexample
7143 generates functions without a frame.)
7144 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7145 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7146 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7147 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7148 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7149 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7150 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7151
7152 @node Backtrace
7153 @section Backtraces
7154
7155 @cindex traceback
7156 @cindex call stack traces
7157 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7158 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7159 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7160 stack.
7161
7162 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7163 @table @code
7164 @kindex backtrace
7165 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7166 @item backtrace
7167 @itemx bt
7168 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7169 frames in the stack.
7170
7171 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7172 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7173
7174 @item backtrace @var{n}
7175 @itemx bt @var{n}
7176 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7177
7178 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7179 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7180 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7181
7182 @item backtrace full
7183 @itemx bt full
7184 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7185 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7186 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7187 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7188
7189 @item backtrace no-filters
7190 @itemx bt no-filters
7191 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7192 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7193 @itemx bt no-filters full
7194 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7195 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7196 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7197 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7198 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7199 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7200 support.
7201 @end table
7202
7203 @kindex where
7204 @kindex info stack
7205 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7206 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7207
7208 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7209 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7210 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7211 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7212 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7213 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7214 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7215 multi-threaded program.
7216
7217 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7218 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7219 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7220 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7221 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7222 line number.
7223
7224 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7225 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7226
7227 @smallexample
7228 @group
7229 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7230 at builtin.c:993
7231 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7232 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7233 at macro.c:71
7234 (More stack frames follow...)
7235 @end group
7236 @end smallexample
7237
7238 @noindent
7239 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7240 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7241 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7242
7243 @noindent
7244 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7245 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7246 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7247 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7248 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7249
7250 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7251 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7252 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7253 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7254 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7255 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7256 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7257 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7258 such a backtrace might look like:
7259
7260 @smallexample
7261 @group
7262 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7263 at builtin.c:993
7264 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7265 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7266 at macro.c:71
7267 (More stack frames follow...)
7268 @end group
7269 @end smallexample
7270
7271 @noindent
7272 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7273 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7274
7275 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7276 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7277 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7278
7279 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7280 @cindex program entry point
7281 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7282 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7283 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7284 @code{main}@footnote{
7285 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7286 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7287 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7288 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7289 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7290 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7291
7292 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7293 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7294
7295 @table @code
7296 @item set backtrace past-main
7297 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7298 @kindex set backtrace
7299 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7300
7301 @item set backtrace past-main off
7302 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7303 default.
7304
7305 @item show backtrace past-main
7306 @kindex show backtrace
7307 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7308
7309 @item set backtrace past-entry
7310 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7311 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7312 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7313 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7314
7315 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7316 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7317 application. This is the default.
7318
7319 @item show backtrace past-entry
7320 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7321
7322 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7323 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7324 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7325 @cindex backtrace limit
7326 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7327 or zero means unlimited levels.
7328
7329 @item show backtrace limit
7330 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7331 @end table
7332
7333 You can control how file names are displayed.
7334
7335 @table @code
7336 @item set filename-display
7337 @itemx set filename-display relative
7338 @cindex filename-display
7339 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7340
7341 @item set filename-display basename
7342 Display only basename of a filename.
7343
7344 @item set filename-display absolute
7345 Display an absolute filename.
7346
7347 @item show filename-display
7348 Show the current way to display filenames.
7349 @end table
7350
7351 @node Selection
7352 @section Selecting a Frame
7353
7354 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7355 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7356 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7357 of the stack frame just selected.
7358
7359 @table @code
7360 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7361 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7362 @item frame @var{n}
7363 @itemx f @var{n}
7364 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7365 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7366 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7367 @code{main}.
7368
7369 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7370 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7371 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7372 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7373 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7374 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7375 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7376 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7377
7378 @kindex up
7379 @item up @var{n}
7380 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7381 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7382 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7383
7384 @kindex down
7385 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7386 @item down @var{n}
7387 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7388 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7389 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7390 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7391 @end table
7392
7393 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7394 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7395 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7396 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7397
7398 @need 1000
7399 For example:
7400
7401 @smallexample
7402 @group
7403 (@value{GDBP}) up
7404 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7405 at env.c:10
7406 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7407 @end group
7408 @end smallexample
7409
7410 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7411 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7412 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7413 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7414 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7415 for details.
7416
7417 @table @code
7418 @kindex select-frame
7419 @item select-frame
7420 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7421 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7422 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7423 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7424
7425 @kindex down-silently
7426 @kindex up-silently
7427 @item up-silently @var{n}
7428 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7429 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7430 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7431 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7432 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7433 distracting.
7434 @end table
7435
7436 @node Frame Info
7437 @section Information About a Frame
7438
7439 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7440 stack frame.
7441
7442 @table @code
7443 @item frame
7444 @itemx f
7445 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7446 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7447 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7448 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7449 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7450
7451 @kindex info frame
7452 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7453 @item info frame
7454 @itemx info f
7455 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7456 including:
7457
7458 @itemize @bullet
7459 @item
7460 the address of the frame
7461 @item
7462 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7463 @item
7464 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7465 @item
7466 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7467 @item
7468 the address of the frame's arguments
7469 @item
7470 the address of the frame's local variables
7471 @item
7472 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7473 @item
7474 which registers were saved in the frame
7475 @end itemize
7476
7477 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7478 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7479 the usual conventions.
7480
7481 @item info frame @var{addr}
7482 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7483 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7484 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7485 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7486 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7487 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7488
7489 @kindex info args
7490 @item info args
7491 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7492
7493 @item info locals
7494 @kindex info locals
7495 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7496 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7497 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7498
7499 @end table
7500
7501 @node Frame Filter Management
7502 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7503 @cindex managing frame filters
7504
7505 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7506 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7507
7508 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7509 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7510
7511 @table @code
7512 @kindex info frame-filter
7513 @item info frame-filter
7514 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7515 their name, priority and enabled status.
7516
7517 @kindex disable frame-filter
7518 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7519 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7520 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7521 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7522 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7523 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7524 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7525 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7526 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7527 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7528 may be enabled again later.
7529
7530 @kindex enable frame-filter
7531 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7532 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7533 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7534 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7535 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7536 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7537 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7538 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7539 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7540
7541 Example:
7542
7543 @smallexample
7544 (gdb) info frame-filter
7545
7546 global frame-filters:
7547 Priority Enabled Name
7548 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7549 100 Yes Reverse
7550
7551 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7552 Priority Enabled Name
7553 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7554
7555 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7556 Priority Enabled Name
7557 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7558
7559 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7560 (gdb) info frame-filter
7561
7562 global frame-filters:
7563 Priority Enabled Name
7564 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7565 100 Yes Reverse
7566
7567 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7568 Priority Enabled Name
7569 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7570
7571 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7572 Priority Enabled Name
7573 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7574
7575 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7576 (gdb) info frame-filter
7577
7578 global frame-filters:
7579 Priority Enabled Name
7580 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7581 100 Yes Reverse
7582
7583 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7584 Priority Enabled Name
7585 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7586
7587 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7588 Priority Enabled Name
7589 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7590 @end smallexample
7591
7592 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7593 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7594 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7595 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7596 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7597 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7598 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7599
7600 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7601 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7602 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7603 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7604 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7605 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7606 dictionary resides.
7607
7608 Example:
7609
7610 @smallexample
7611 (gdb) info frame-filter
7612
7613 global frame-filters:
7614 Priority Enabled Name
7615 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7616 100 Yes Reverse
7617
7618 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7619 Priority Enabled Name
7620 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7621
7622 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7623 Priority Enabled Name
7624 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7625
7626 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7627 (gdb) info frame-filter
7628
7629 global frame-filters:
7630 Priority Enabled Name
7631 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7632 50 Yes Reverse
7633
7634 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7635 Priority Enabled Name
7636 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7637
7638 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7639 Priority Enabled Name
7640 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7641 @end smallexample
7642 @end table
7643
7644 @node Source
7645 @chapter Examining Source Files
7646
7647 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7648 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7649 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7650 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7651 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7652 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7653 source files by explicit command.
7654
7655 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7656 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7657 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7658
7659 @menu
7660 * List:: Printing source lines
7661 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7662 * Edit:: Editing source files
7663 * Search:: Searching source files
7664 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7665 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7666 @end menu
7667
7668 @node List
7669 @section Printing Source Lines
7670
7671 @kindex list
7672 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7673 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7674 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7675 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7676 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7677
7678 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7679
7680 @table @code
7681 @item list @var{linenum}
7682 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7683 current source file.
7684
7685 @item list @var{function}
7686 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7687 @var{function}.
7688
7689 @item list
7690 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7691 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7692 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7693 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7694 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7695
7696 @item list -
7697 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7698 @end table
7699
7700 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7701 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7702 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7703
7704 @table @code
7705 @kindex set listsize
7706 @item set listsize @var{count}
7707 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7708 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7709 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7710 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7711
7712 @kindex show listsize
7713 @item show listsize
7714 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7715 @end table
7716
7717 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7718 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7719 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7720 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7721 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7722
7723 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7724 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7725 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7726 to specify some source line.
7727
7728 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7729
7730 @table @code
7731 @item list @var{location}
7732 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7733
7734 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7735 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7736 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7737 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7738 the same source file as the first location.
7739
7740 @item list ,@var{last}
7741 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7742
7743 @item list @var{first},
7744 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7745
7746 @item list +
7747 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7748
7749 @item list -
7750 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7751
7752 @item list
7753 As described in the preceding table.
7754 @end table
7755
7756 @node Specify Location
7757 @section Specifying a Location
7758 @cindex specifying location
7759 @cindex location
7760 @cindex source location
7761
7762 @menu
7763 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7764 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7765 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7766 @end menu
7767
7768 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7769 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7770 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7771 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7772 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7773
7774 @node Linespec Locations
7775 @subsection Linespec Locations
7776 @cindex linespec locations
7777
7778 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7779 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7780 specifying a linespec:
7781
7782 @table @code
7783 @item @var{linenum}
7784 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7785
7786 @item -@var{offset}
7787 @itemx +@var{offset}
7788 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7789 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7790 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7791 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7792 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7793 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7794 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7795 linespec.
7796
7797 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7798 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7799 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7800 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7801 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7802 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7803 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7804
7805 @item @var{function}
7806 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7807 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7808
7809 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7810 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7811
7812 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7813 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7814 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7815 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7816 functions in different source files.
7817
7818 @item @var{label}
7819 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7820 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7821 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7822 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7823
7824 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7825 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7826 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7827 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7828 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7829 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7830
7831 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7832 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7833 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7834 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7835 each one of those probes.
7836 @end table
7837
7838 @node Explicit Locations
7839 @subsection Explicit Locations
7840 @cindex explicit locations
7841
7842 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7843 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7844
7845 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7846 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7847 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7848 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7849 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7850
7851 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7852 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7853 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7854 the symbol table to know.
7855
7856 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7857 following table:
7858
7859 @table @code
7860 @item -source @var{filename}
7861 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7862 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7863 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7864 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7865 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7866
7867 @item -function @var{function}
7868 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7869 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7870 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7871 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7872
7873 @item -label @var{label}
7874 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7875 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7876 selected stack frame.
7877
7878 @item -line @var{number}
7879 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7880 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7881 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7882 relative to the current line.
7883 @end table
7884
7885 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7886 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7887
7888 @node Address Locations
7889 @subsection Address Locations
7890 @cindex address locations
7891
7892 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7893 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7894
7895 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7896 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7897 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7898 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7899 source files.
7900
7901 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7902 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7903 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7904 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7905 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7906 of @var{address}:
7907
7908 @table @code
7909 @item @var{expression}
7910 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7911
7912 @item @var{funcaddr}
7913 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7914 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7915 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7916 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7917 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7918 (although the Pascal form also works).
7919
7920 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7921 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7922
7923 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7924 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7925 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7926 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7927 functions with identical names in different source files.
7928 @end table
7929
7930 @node Edit
7931 @section Editing Source Files
7932 @cindex editing source files
7933
7934 @kindex edit
7935 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7936 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7937 The editing program of your choice
7938 is invoked with the current line set to
7939 the active line in the program.
7940 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7941 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7942
7943 @table @code
7944 @item edit @var{location}
7945 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7946 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7947 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7948 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7949 command most commonly used:
7950
7951 @table @code
7952 @item edit @var{number}
7953 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7954
7955 @item edit @var{function}
7956 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7957 @end table
7958
7959 @end table
7960
7961 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7962 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7963 @footnote{
7964 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7965 following command-line syntax:
7966 @smallexample
7967 ex +@var{number} file
7968 @end smallexample
7969 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7970 the file where to start editing.}.
7971 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7972 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7973 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7974 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7975 @smallexample
7976 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7977 export EDITOR
7978 gdb @dots{}
7979 @end smallexample
7980 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7981 @smallexample
7982 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7983 gdb @dots{}
7984 @end smallexample
7985
7986 @node Search
7987 @section Searching Source Files
7988 @cindex searching source files
7989
7990 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7991 regular expression.
7992
7993 @table @code
7994 @kindex search
7995 @kindex forward-search
7996 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7997 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7998 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7999 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8000 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8001 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8002 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8003 @code{fo}.
8004
8005 @kindex reverse-search
8006 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8007 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8008 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8009 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8010 this command as @code{rev}.
8011 @end table
8012
8013 @node Source Path
8014 @section Specifying Source Directories
8015
8016 @cindex source path
8017 @cindex directories for source files
8018 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8019 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8020 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8021 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8022 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8023 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8024 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8025
8026 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8027 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8028 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8029 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8030 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8031 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8032 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8033 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8034 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8035 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8036 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8037
8038 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8039 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8040 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8041 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8042 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8043 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8044
8045 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8046 source files.
8047
8048 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8049 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8050 each line is in the file.
8051
8052 @kindex directory
8053 @kindex dir
8054 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8055 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8056 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8057
8058 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8059 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8060
8061 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8062 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8063 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8064 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8065 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8066 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8067 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8068 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8069 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8070 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8071 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8072 name to look up the sources.
8073
8074 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8075 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8076 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8077 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8078 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8079 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8080 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8081 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8082
8083 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8084 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8085 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8086 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8087 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8088 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8089 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8090
8091 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8092 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8093 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8094 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8095 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8096 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8097 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8098 command.
8099
8100 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8101 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8102 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8103 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8104 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8105 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8106 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8107
8108 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8109 @cindex default source path substitution
8110 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8111 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8112 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8113 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8114 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8115 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8116 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8117 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8118 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8119 together.
8120
8121 @table @code
8122 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8123 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8124 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8125 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8126 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8127 part of absolute file names) or
8128 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8129 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8130
8131 @kindex cdir
8132 @kindex cwd
8133 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8134 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8135 @cindex compilation directory
8136 @cindex current directory
8137 @cindex working directory
8138 @cindex directory, current
8139 @cindex directory, compilation
8140 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8141 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8142 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8143 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8144 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8145 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8146
8147 @item directory
8148 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8149
8150 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8151 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8152
8153 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8154 @kindex set directories
8155 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8156 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8157
8158 @item show directories
8159 @kindex show directories
8160 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8161
8162 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8163 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8164 @kindex set substitute-path
8165 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8166 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8167 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8168
8169 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8170 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8171
8172 @smallexample
8173 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8174 @end smallexample
8175
8176 @noindent
8177 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8178 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8179 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8180
8181 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8182 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8183 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8184 the substitution.
8185
8186 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8187
8188 @smallexample
8189 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8190 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8191 @end smallexample
8192
8193 @noindent
8194 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8195 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8196 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8197 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8198
8199
8200 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8201 @kindex unset substitute-path
8202 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8203 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8204 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8205
8206 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8207
8208 @item show substitute-path [path]
8209 @kindex show substitute-path
8210 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8211 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8212
8213 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8214 rules.
8215
8216 @end table
8217
8218 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8219 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8220 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8221
8222 @enumerate
8223 @item
8224 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8225
8226 @item
8227 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8228 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8229 directories in one command.
8230 @end enumerate
8231
8232 @node Machine Code
8233 @section Source and Machine Code
8234 @cindex source line and its code address
8235
8236 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8237 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8238 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8239 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8240 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8241 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8242 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8243 well as hex.
8244
8245 @table @code
8246 @kindex info line
8247 @item info line @var{location}
8248 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8249 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8250 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8251 @end table
8252
8253 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8254 the object code for the first line of function
8255 @code{m4_changequote}:
8256
8257 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8258 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8259 @smallexample
8260 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8261 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8262 @end smallexample
8263
8264 @noindent
8265 @cindex code address and its source line
8266 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8267 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8268 @smallexample
8269 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8270 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8271 @end smallexample
8272
8273 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8274 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8275 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8276 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8277 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8278 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8279 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8280 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8281 Variables}).
8282
8283 @table @code
8284 @kindex disassemble
8285 @cindex assembly instructions
8286 @cindex instructions, assembly
8287 @cindex machine instructions
8288 @cindex listing machine instructions
8289 @item disassemble
8290 @itemx disassemble /m
8291 @itemx disassemble /s
8292 @itemx disassemble /r
8293 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8294 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8295 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8296 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8297 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8298 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8299 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8300 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8301 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8302 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8303
8304 @table @code
8305 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8306 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8307 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8308 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8309 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8310 @end table
8311
8312 @noindent
8313 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8314 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8315
8316 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8317 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8318
8319 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8320 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8321 @end table
8322
8323 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8324 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8325
8326 @smallexample
8327 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8328 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8329 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8330 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8331 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8332 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8333 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8334 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8335 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8336 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8337 End of assembler dump.
8338 @end smallexample
8339
8340 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8341 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8342 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8343
8344 @smallexample
8345 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8346 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8347 5 @{
8348 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8349 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8350 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8351 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8352 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8353
8354 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8355 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8356 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8357
8358 7 return 0;
8359 8 @}
8360 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8361 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8362 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8363
8364 End of assembler dump.
8365 @end smallexample
8366
8367 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8368 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8369 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8370 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8371 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8372 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8373 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8374 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8375 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8376
8377 @file{foo.h}:
8378
8379 @smallexample
8380 int
8381 foo (int a)
8382 @{
8383 if (a < 0)
8384 return a * 2;
8385 if (a == 0)
8386 return 1;
8387 return a + 10;
8388 @}
8389 @end smallexample
8390
8391 @file{foo.c}:
8392
8393 @smallexample
8394 #include "foo.h"
8395 volatile int x, y;
8396 int
8397 main ()
8398 @{
8399 x = foo (y);
8400 return 0;
8401 @}
8402 @end smallexample
8403
8404 @smallexample
8405 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8406 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8407 5 @{
8408
8409 6 x = foo (y);
8410 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8411 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8412
8413 7 return 0;
8414 8 @}
8415 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8416 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8417 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8418 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8419
8420 End of assembler dump.
8421 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8422 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8423 foo.c:
8424 5 @{
8425 6 x = foo (y);
8426 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8427
8428 foo.h:
8429 4 if (a < 0)
8430 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8431 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8432
8433 6 if (a == 0)
8434 7 return 1;
8435 8 return a + 10;
8436 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8437 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8438 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8439 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8440
8441 foo.c:
8442 6 x = foo (y);
8443 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8444
8445 7 return 0;
8446 8 @}
8447 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8448 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8449
8450 foo.h:
8451 5 return a * 2;
8452 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8453 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8454 End of assembler dump.
8455 @end smallexample
8456
8457 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8458
8459 @smallexample
8460 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8461 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8462 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8463 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8464 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8465 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8466 End of assembler dump.
8467 @end smallexample
8468
8469 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8470 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8471 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8472 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8473
8474 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8475 mnemonics or other syntax.
8476
8477 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8478 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8479 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8480 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8481 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8482
8483 @table @code
8484 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8485 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8486 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8487 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8488 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8489 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8490
8491 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8492 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8493 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8494 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8495
8496 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8497 @item show disassembly-flavor
8498 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8499 @end table
8500
8501 @table @code
8502 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8503 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8504 @item set disassemble-next-line
8505 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8506 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8507 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8508 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8509 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8510 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8511 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8512 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8513 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8514 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8515 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8516 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8517 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8518 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8519 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8520 instruction.
8521 @end table
8522
8523
8524 @node Data
8525 @chapter Examining Data
8526
8527 @cindex printing data
8528 @cindex examining data
8529 @kindex print
8530 @kindex inspect
8531 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8532 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8533 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8534 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8535 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8536 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8537
8538 @table @code
8539 @item print @var{expr}
8540 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8541 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8542 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8543 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8544 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8545 Formats}.
8546
8547 @item print
8548 @itemx print /@var{f}
8549 @cindex reprint the last value
8550 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8551 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8552 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8553 @end table
8554
8555 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8556 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8557 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8558
8559 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8560 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8561 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8562 Table}.
8563
8564 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8565 @kindex explore
8566 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8567 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8568 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8569 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8570 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8571 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8572 embedded in the higher level data types.
8573
8574 @table @code
8575 @item explore @var{arg}
8576 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8577 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8578 @end table
8579
8580 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8581 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8582 C program as
8583
8584 @smallexample
8585 struct SimpleStruct
8586 @{
8587 int i;
8588 double d;
8589 @};
8590
8591 struct ComplexStruct
8592 @{
8593 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8594 int arr[10];
8595 @};
8596 @end smallexample
8597
8598 @noindent
8599 followed by variable declarations as
8600
8601 @smallexample
8602 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8603 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8604 @end smallexample
8605
8606 @noindent
8607 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8608 @code{explore} command as follows.
8609
8610 @smallexample
8611 (gdb) explore cs
8612 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8613 the following fields:
8614
8615 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8616 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8617
8618 Enter the field number of choice:
8619 @end smallexample
8620
8621 @noindent
8622 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8623 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8624 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8625 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8626 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8627 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8628 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8629 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8630
8631 @smallexample
8632 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8633 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8634 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8635 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8636
8637 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8638 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8639
8640 Press enter to return to parent value:
8641 @end smallexample
8642
8643 @noindent
8644 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8645 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8646 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8647 to explore.
8648
8649 @smallexample
8650 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8651 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8652
8653 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8654
8655 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8656
8657 Press enter to return to parent value:
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8661 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8662 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8663 level data structure).
8664
8665 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8666 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8667 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8668 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8669 same example as above, your can explore the type
8670 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8671 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8672
8673 @smallexample
8674 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8675 @end smallexample
8676
8677 @noindent
8678 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8679 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8680 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8681 example.
8682
8683 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8684 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8685 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8686 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8687 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8688
8689 @table @code
8690 @item explore value @var{expr}
8691 @cindex explore value
8692 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8693 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8694 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8695 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8696 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8697
8698 @item explore type @var{arg}
8699 @cindex explore type
8700 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8701 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8702 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8703 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8704 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8705 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8706 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8707 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8708 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8709 @end table
8710
8711 @menu
8712 * Expressions:: Expressions
8713 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8714 * Variables:: Program variables
8715 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8716 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8717 * Memory:: Examining memory
8718 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8719 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8720 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8721 * Value History:: Value history
8722 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8723 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8724 * Registers:: Registers
8725 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8726 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8727 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8728 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8729 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8730 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8731 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8732 character set than GDB does
8733 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8734 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8735 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8736 @end menu
8737
8738 @node Expressions
8739 @section Expressions
8740
8741 @cindex expressions
8742 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8743 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8744 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8745 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8746 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8747 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8748 @ref{Compilation}.
8749
8750 @cindex arrays in expressions
8751 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8752 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8753 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8754 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8755 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8756 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8757
8758 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8759 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8760 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8761 languages.
8762
8763 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8764 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8765
8766 @cindex casts, in expressions
8767 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8768 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8769 at that address in memory.
8770 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8771
8772 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8773 to programming languages:
8774
8775 @table @code
8776 @item @@
8777 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8778 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8779
8780 @item ::
8781 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8782 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8783
8784 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8785 @cindex type casting memory
8786 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8787 @cindex casts, to view memory
8788 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8789 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8790 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8791 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8792 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8793 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8794 @end table
8795
8796 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8797 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8798 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8799
8800 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8801 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8802 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8803 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8804 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8805 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8806 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8807
8808 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8809 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8810 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8811 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8812 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8813 as well.
8814
8815 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8816 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8817 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8818 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8819 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8820 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8821 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8822 choices.
8823
8824 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8825 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8826 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8827
8828 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8829 @smallexample
8830 @group
8831 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8832 [0] cancel
8833 [1] all
8834 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8835 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8836 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8837 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8838 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8839 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8840 > 2 4 6
8841 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8842 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8843 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8844 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8845 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8846 breakpoints.
8847 (@value{GDBP})
8848 @end group
8849 @end smallexample
8850
8851 @table @code
8852 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8853 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8854 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8855
8856 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8857 is ambiguous.
8858
8859 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8860 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8861 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8862 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8863 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8864 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8865 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8866 in the use of the menu.
8867
8868 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8869 when an ambiguity is detected.
8870
8871 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8872 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8873
8874 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8875 @item show multiple-symbols
8876 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8877 @end table
8878
8879 @node Variables
8880 @section Program Variables
8881
8882 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8883 in your program.
8884
8885 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8886 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8887
8888 @itemize @bullet
8889 @item
8890 global (or file-static)
8891 @end itemize
8892
8893 @noindent or
8894
8895 @itemize @bullet
8896 @item
8897 visible according to the scope rules of the
8898 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8899 @end itemize
8900
8901 @noindent This means that in the function
8902
8903 @smallexample
8904 foo (a)
8905 int a;
8906 @{
8907 bar (a);
8908 @{
8909 int b = test ();
8910 bar (b);
8911 @}
8912 @}
8913 @end smallexample
8914
8915 @noindent
8916 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8917 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8918 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8919 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8920
8921 @cindex variable name conflict
8922 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8923 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8924 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8925 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8926 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8927 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8928 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8929
8930 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8931 @ifnotinfo
8932 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8933 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8934 @end ifnotinfo
8935 @smallexample
8936 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8937 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8938 @end smallexample
8939
8940 @noindent
8941 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8942 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8943 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8944 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8945
8946 @smallexample
8947 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8948 @end smallexample
8949
8950 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8951 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8952 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8953 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8954 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8955
8956 @smallexample
8957 void
8958 foo (int a)
8959 @{
8960 if (a < 10)
8961 bar (a);
8962 else
8963 process (a); /* Stop here */
8964 @}
8965
8966 int
8967 bar (int a)
8968 @{
8969 foo (a + 5);
8970 @}
8971 @end smallexample
8972
8973 @noindent
8974 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8975 here is what you might see
8976 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8977
8978 @smallexample
8979 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8980 $1 = 10
8981 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8982 $2 = 5
8983 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8984 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8985 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8986 $3 = 5
8987 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8988 $4 = 0
8989 @end smallexample
8990
8991 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8992 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8993 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8994 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8995 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8996
8997 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8998 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8999 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9000 @code{some_global}.
9001
9002 @smallexample
9003 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9004 $1 = 23
9005 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9006 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9007 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9008 $2 = 27
9009 @end smallexample
9010
9011 @cindex wrong values
9012 @cindex variable values, wrong
9013 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9014 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9015 @quotation
9016 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9017 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9018 scope, and just before exit.
9019 @end quotation
9020 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9021 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9022 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9023 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9024 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9025 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9026 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9027 variable definitions may be gone.
9028
9029 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9030 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9031 when compiling.
9032
9033 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9034 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9035 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9036 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9037 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9038 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9039 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9040
9041 @smallexample
9042 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9043 @end smallexample
9044
9045 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9046 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9047 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9048 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9049 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9050
9051 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9052 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9053 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9054 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9055
9056 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9057 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9058 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9059 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9060 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9061
9062 @smallexample
9063 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9064 29 i++;
9065 (gdb) next
9066 30 e (i);
9067 (gdb) print i
9068 $1 = 31
9069 (gdb) print i@@entry
9070 $2 = 30
9071 @end smallexample
9072
9073 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9074 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9075 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9076 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9077 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9078 For program code
9079
9080 @smallexample
9081 char var0[] = "A";
9082 signed char var1[] = "A";
9083 @end smallexample
9084
9085 You get during debugging
9086 @smallexample
9087 (gdb) print var0
9088 $1 = "A"
9089 (gdb) print var1
9090 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9091 @end smallexample
9092
9093 @node Arrays
9094 @section Artificial Arrays
9095
9096 @cindex artificial array
9097 @cindex arrays
9098 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9099 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9100 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9101 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9102 program.
9103
9104 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9105 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9106 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9107 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9108 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9109 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9110 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9111 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9112 example. If a program says
9113
9114 @smallexample
9115 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9116 @end smallexample
9117
9118 @noindent
9119 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9120
9121 @smallexample
9122 p *array@@len
9123 @end smallexample
9124
9125 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9126 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9127 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9128 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9129 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9130
9131 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9132 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9133 The value need not be in memory:
9134 @smallexample
9135 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9136 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9137 @end smallexample
9138
9139 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9140 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9141 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9142 @smallexample
9143 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9144 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9145 @end smallexample
9146
9147 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9148 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9149 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9150 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9151 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9152 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9153 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9154 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9155 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9156 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9157
9158 @smallexample
9159 set $i = 0
9160 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9161 @key{RET}
9162 @key{RET}
9163 @dots{}
9164 @end smallexample
9165
9166 @node Output Formats
9167 @section Output Formats
9168
9169 @cindex formatted output
9170 @cindex output formats
9171 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9172 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9173 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9174 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9175 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9176
9177 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9178 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9179 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9180 letters supported are:
9181
9182 @table @code
9183 @item x
9184 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9185 hexadecimal.
9186
9187 @item d
9188 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9189
9190 @item u
9191 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9192
9193 @item o
9194 Print as integer in octal.
9195
9196 @item t
9197 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9198 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9199 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9200 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9201
9202 @item a
9203 @cindex unknown address, locating
9204 @cindex locate address
9205 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9206 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9207 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9208
9209 @smallexample
9210 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9211 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9212 @end smallexample
9213
9214 @noindent
9215 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9216 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9217
9218 @item c
9219 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9220 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9221 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9222 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9223
9224 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9225 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9226 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9227 data.
9228
9229 @item f
9230 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9231 using typical floating point syntax.
9232
9233 @item s
9234 @cindex printing strings
9235 @cindex printing byte arrays
9236 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9237 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9238 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9239 natural types.
9240
9241 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9242 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9243 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9244 array.
9245
9246 @item z
9247 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9248 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9249 to the size of the integer type.
9250
9251 @item r
9252 @cindex raw printing
9253 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9254 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9255 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9256 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9257 pretty-printer which might exist.
9258 @end table
9259
9260 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9261
9262 @smallexample
9263 p/x $pc
9264 @end smallexample
9265
9266 @noindent
9267 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9268 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9269
9270 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9271 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9272 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9273
9274 @node Memory
9275 @section Examining Memory
9276
9277 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9278 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9279
9280 @cindex examining memory
9281 @table @code
9282 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9283 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9284 @itemx x @var{addr}
9285 @itemx x
9286 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9287 @end table
9288
9289 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9290 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9291 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9292 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9293 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9294
9295 @table @r
9296 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9297 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9298 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9299 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9300 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9301 @c 4.1.2.
9302
9303 @item @var{f}, the display format
9304 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9305 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9306 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9307 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9308 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9309
9310 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9311 The unit size is any of
9312
9313 @table @code
9314 @item b
9315 Bytes.
9316 @item h
9317 Halfwords (two bytes).
9318 @item w
9319 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9320 @item g
9321 Giant words (eight bytes).
9322 @end table
9323
9324 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9325 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9326 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9327 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9328 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9329 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9330 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9331 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9332 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9333 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9334 be altered.
9335
9336 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9337 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9338 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9339 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9340 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9341 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9342 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9343 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9344 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9345 a value from memory).
9346 @end table
9347
9348 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9349 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9350 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9351 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9352 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9353
9354 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9355 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9356 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9357
9358 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9359 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9360 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9361 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9362 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9363
9364 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9365 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9366 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9367 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9368 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9369 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9370 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9371 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9372 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9373
9374 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9375 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9376 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9377 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9378 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9379 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9380
9381 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9382 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9383 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9384 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9385 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9386 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9387 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9388
9389 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9390 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9391
9392 @smallexample
9393 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9394 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9395 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9396 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9397 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9398 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9399 @end smallexample
9400
9401 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9402 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9403 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9404 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9405 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9406 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9407 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9408 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9409 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9410
9411 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9412 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9413 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9414
9415 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9416 @cindex addressable memory unit
9417 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9418 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9419 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9420 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9421 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9422 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9423 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9424 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9425 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9426
9427 @cindex remote memory comparison
9428 @cindex target memory comparison
9429 @cindex verify remote memory image
9430 @cindex verify target memory image
9431 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9432 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9433 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9434 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9435 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9436 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9437
9438 @table @code
9439 @kindex compare-sections
9440 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9441 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9442 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9443 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9444 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9445 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9446
9447 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9448 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9449 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9450 @end table
9451
9452 @node Auto Display
9453 @section Automatic Display
9454 @cindex automatic display
9455 @cindex display of expressions
9456
9457 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9458 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9459 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9460 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9461 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9462 The automatic display looks like this:
9463
9464 @smallexample
9465 2: foo = 38
9466 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9467 @end smallexample
9468
9469 @noindent
9470 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9471 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9472 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9473 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9474 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9475 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9476
9477 @table @code
9478 @kindex display
9479 @item display @var{expr}
9480 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9481 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9482
9483 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9484
9485 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9486 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9487 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9488 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9489 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9490
9491 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9492 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9493 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9494 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9495 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9496 @end table
9497
9498 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9499 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9500 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9501
9502 @table @code
9503 @kindex delete display
9504 @kindex undisplay
9505 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9506 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9507 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9508 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9509 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9510 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9511 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9512
9513 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9514 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9515
9516 @kindex disable display
9517 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9518 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9519 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9520 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9521 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9522 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9523 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9524 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9525
9526 @kindex enable display
9527 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9528 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9529 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9530 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9531 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9532 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9533 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9534
9535 @item display
9536 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9537 done when your program stops.
9538
9539 @kindex info display
9540 @item info display
9541 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9542 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9543 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9544 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9545 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9546 @end table
9547
9548 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9549 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9550 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9551 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9552 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9553 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9554 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9555 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9556 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9557 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9558 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9559
9560 @node Print Settings
9561 @section Print Settings
9562
9563 @cindex format options
9564 @cindex print settings
9565 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9566 and symbols are printed.
9567
9568 @noindent
9569 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9570
9571 @table @code
9572 @kindex set print
9573 @item set print address
9574 @itemx set print address on
9575 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9576 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9577 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9578 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9579 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9580 @code{set print address on}:
9581
9582 @smallexample
9583 @group
9584 (@value{GDBP}) f
9585 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9586 at input.c:530
9587 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9588 @end group
9589 @end smallexample
9590
9591 @item set print address off
9592 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9593 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9594
9595 @smallexample
9596 @group
9597 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9598 (@value{GDBP}) f
9599 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9600 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9601 @end group
9602 @end smallexample
9603
9604 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9605 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9606 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9607 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9608
9609 @kindex show print
9610 @item show print address
9611 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9612 @end table
9613
9614 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9615 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9616 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9617 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9618 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9619 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9620 it prints a symbolic address:
9621
9622 @table @code
9623 @item set print symbol-filename on
9624 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9625 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9626 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9627 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9628
9629 @item set print symbol-filename off
9630 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9631 default.
9632
9633 @item show print symbol-filename
9634 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9635 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9636 @end table
9637
9638 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9639 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9640 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9641
9642 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9643 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9644
9645 @table @code
9646 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9647 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9648 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9649 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9650 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9651 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9652 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9653 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9654
9655 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9656 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9657 symbolic address.
9658 @end table
9659
9660 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9661 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9662 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9663 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9664 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9665 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9666 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9667 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9668
9669 @smallexample
9670 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9671 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9672 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9673 @end smallexample
9674
9675 @quotation
9676 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9677 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9678 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9679 @end quotation
9680
9681 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9682 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9683
9684 @table @code
9685 @item set print symbol on
9686 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9687 one exists.
9688
9689 @item set print symbol off
9690 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9691 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9692 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9693
9694 @item show print symbol
9695 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9696 address.
9697 @end table
9698
9699 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9700
9701 @table @code
9702 @item set print array
9703 @itemx set print array on
9704 @cindex pretty print arrays
9705 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9706 but uses more space. The default is off.
9707
9708 @item set print array off
9709 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9710
9711 @item show print array
9712 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9713 arrays.
9714
9715 @cindex print array indexes
9716 @item set print array-indexes
9717 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9718 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9719 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9720 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9721
9722 @item set print array-indexes off
9723 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9724
9725 @item show print array-indexes
9726 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9727 arrays.
9728
9729 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9730 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9731 @cindex number of array elements to print
9732 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9733 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9734 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9735 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9736 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9737 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9738 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9739 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9740
9741 @item show print elements
9742 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9743 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9744
9745 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9746 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9747 @cindex printing frame argument values
9748 @cindex print all frame argument values
9749 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9750 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9751 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9752 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9753 values are:
9754
9755 @table @code
9756 @item all
9757 The values of all arguments are printed.
9758
9759 @item scalars
9760 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9761 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9762 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9763 only scalar arguments are shown:
9764
9765 @smallexample
9766 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9767 at frame-args.c:23
9768 @end smallexample
9769
9770 @item none
9771 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9772 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9773
9774 @smallexample
9775 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9776 at frame-args.c:23
9777 @end smallexample
9778 @end table
9779
9780 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9781 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9782 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9783 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9784 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9785 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9786 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9787 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9788 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9789 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9790
9791 @item show print frame-arguments
9792 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9793
9794 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9795 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9796
9797 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9798 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9799 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9800 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9801 This is the default.
9802
9803 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9804 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9805
9806 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9807 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9808 @kindex set print entry-values
9809 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9810 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9811 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9812 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9813 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9814
9815 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9816 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9817 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9818 @code{no} setting.
9819
9820 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9821 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9822 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9823 this information.
9824
9825 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9826
9827 @table @code
9828 @item no
9829 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9830 point.
9831 @smallexample
9832 #0 equal (val=5)
9833 #0 different (val=6)
9834 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9835 #0 born (val=10)
9836 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9837 @end smallexample
9838
9839 @item only
9840 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9841 values are never printed.
9842 @smallexample
9843 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9844 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9845 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9846 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9847 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9848 @end smallexample
9849
9850 @item preferred
9851 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9852 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9853 value for such parameter.
9854 @smallexample
9855 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9856 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9857 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9858 #0 born (val=10)
9859 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9860 @end smallexample
9861
9862 @item if-needed
9863 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9864 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9865 parameter.
9866 @smallexample
9867 #0 equal (val=5)
9868 #0 different (val=6)
9869 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9870 #0 born (val=10)
9871 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9872 @end smallexample
9873
9874 @item both
9875 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9876 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9877 optimizations.
9878 @smallexample
9879 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9880 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9881 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9882 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9883 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9884 @end smallexample
9885
9886 @item compact
9887 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9888 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9889 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9890 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9891 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9892 @smallexample
9893 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9894 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9895 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9896 #0 born (val=10)
9897 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9898 @end smallexample
9899
9900 @item default
9901 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9902 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9903 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9904 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9905 @smallexample
9906 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9907 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9908 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9909 #0 born (val=10)
9910 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9911 @end smallexample
9912 @end table
9913
9914 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9915 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9916
9917 @item show print entry-values
9918 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9919 entry.
9920
9921 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9922 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9923 @cindex repeated array elements
9924 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9925 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9926 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9927 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9928 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9929 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9930 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9931 is 10.
9932
9933 @item show print repeats
9934 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9935 elements.
9936
9937 @item set print null-stop
9938 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9939 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9940 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9941 contain only short strings.
9942 The default is off.
9943
9944 @item show print null-stop
9945 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9946 @sc{null} character.
9947
9948 @item set print pretty on
9949 @cindex print structures in indented form
9950 @cindex indentation in structure display
9951 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9952 per line, like this:
9953
9954 @smallexample
9955 @group
9956 $1 = @{
9957 next = 0x0,
9958 flags = @{
9959 sweet = 1,
9960 sour = 1
9961 @},
9962 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9963 @}
9964 @end group
9965 @end smallexample
9966
9967 @item set print pretty off
9968 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9969
9970 @smallexample
9971 @group
9972 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9973 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9974 @end group
9975 @end smallexample
9976
9977 @noindent
9978 This is the default format.
9979
9980 @item show print pretty
9981 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9982
9983 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9984 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9985 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9986 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9987 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9988 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9989 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9990 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9991
9992 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9993 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9994 international character sets, and is the default.
9995
9996 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9997 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9998
9999 @item set print union on
10000 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10001 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10002 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10003
10004 @item set print union off
10005 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10006 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10007 instead.
10008
10009 @item show print union
10010 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10011 structures and other unions.
10012
10013 For example, given the declarations
10014
10015 @smallexample
10016 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10017 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10018 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10019 Bug_forms;
10020
10021 struct thing @{
10022 Species it;
10023 union @{
10024 Tree_forms tree;
10025 Bug_forms bug;
10026 @} form;
10027 @};
10028
10029 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10030 @end smallexample
10031
10032 @noindent
10033 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10034
10035 @smallexample
10036 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10037 @end smallexample
10038
10039 @noindent
10040 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10041
10042 @smallexample
10043 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10044 @end smallexample
10045
10046 @noindent
10047 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10048 and in Pascal.
10049 @end table
10050
10051 @need 1000
10052 @noindent
10053 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10054
10055 @table @code
10056 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10057 @item set print demangle
10058 @itemx set print demangle on
10059 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10060 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10061 linkage. The default is on.
10062
10063 @item show print demangle
10064 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10065
10066 @item set print asm-demangle
10067 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10068 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10069 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10070 The default is off.
10071
10072 @item show print asm-demangle
10073 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10074 or demangled form.
10075
10076 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10077 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10078 @kindex set demangle-style
10079 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10080 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10081 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10082
10083 @table @code
10084 @item auto
10085 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10086 This is the default.
10087
10088 @item gnu
10089 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10090
10091 @item hp
10092 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10093
10094 @item lucid
10095 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10096
10097 @item arm
10098 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10099 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10100 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10101 require further enhancement to permit that.
10102
10103 @end table
10104 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10105
10106 @item show demangle-style
10107 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10108
10109 @item set print object
10110 @itemx set print object on
10111 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10112 @cindex display derived types
10113 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10114 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10115 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10116 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10117 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10118 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10119 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10120
10121 @item set print object off
10122 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10123 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10124
10125 @item show print object
10126 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10127
10128 @item set print static-members
10129 @itemx set print static-members on
10130 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10131 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10132
10133 @item set print static-members off
10134 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10135
10136 @item show print static-members
10137 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10138
10139 @item set print pascal_static-members
10140 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10141 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10142 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10143 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10144
10145 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10146 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10147
10148 @item show print pascal_static-members
10149 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10150
10151 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10152 @item set print vtbl
10153 @itemx set print vtbl on
10154 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10155 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10156 @cindex VTBL display
10157 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10158 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10159 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10160
10161 @item set print vtbl off
10162 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10163
10164 @item show print vtbl
10165 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10166 @end table
10167
10168 @node Pretty Printing
10169 @section Pretty Printing
10170
10171 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10172 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10173 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10174
10175 @menu
10176 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10177 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10178 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10179 @end menu
10180
10181 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10182 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10183
10184 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10185 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10186 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10187
10188 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10189 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10190 pretty-printers with their names.
10191 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10192 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10193 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10194 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10195
10196 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10197 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10198 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10199 do anything special.
10200
10201 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10202
10203 @itemize @bullet
10204 @item
10205 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10206 all inferiors.
10207
10208 @item
10209 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10210 when debugging that program.
10211 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10212
10213 @item
10214 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10215 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10216 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10217 @end itemize
10218
10219 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10220 pretty-printers are selected,
10221
10222 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10223 for new types.
10224
10225 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10226 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10227
10228 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10229
10230 @smallexample
10231 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10232 $1 = @{
10233 static npos = 4294967295,
10234 _M_dataplus = @{
10235 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10236 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10237 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10238 @},
10239 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10240 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10241 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10242 @}
10243 @}
10244 @end smallexample
10245
10246 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10247
10248 @smallexample
10249 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10250 $2 = "abcd"
10251 @end smallexample
10252
10253 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10254 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10255 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10256
10257 @table @code
10258 @kindex info pretty-printer
10259 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10260 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10261 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10262
10263 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10264 whose pretty-printers to list.
10265 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10266 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10267 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10268 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10269 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10270
10271 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10272 to list.
10273
10274 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10275 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10276 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10277 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10278
10279 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10280 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10281 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10282 @end table
10283
10284 Example:
10285
10286 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10287 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10288 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10289 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10290
10291 @smallexample
10292 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10293 library1.so:
10294 foo
10295 library2.so:
10296 bar
10297 bar1
10298 bar2
10299 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10300 library2.so:
10301 bar
10302 bar1
10303 bar2
10304 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10305 1 printer disabled
10306 2 of 3 printers enabled
10307 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10308 library1.so:
10309 foo [disabled]
10310 library2.so:
10311 bar
10312 bar1
10313 bar2
10314 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10315 1 printer disabled
10316 1 of 3 printers enabled
10317 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10318 library1.so:
10319 foo [disabled]
10320 library2.so:
10321 bar
10322 bar1 [disabled]
10323 bar2
10324 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10325 1 printer disabled
10326 0 of 3 printers enabled
10327 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10328 library1.so:
10329 foo [disabled]
10330 library2.so:
10331 bar [disabled]
10332 bar1 [disabled]
10333 bar2
10334 @end smallexample
10335
10336 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10337 as can each individual subprinter.
10338
10339 @node Value History
10340 @section Value History
10341
10342 @cindex value history
10343 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10344 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10345 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10346 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10347 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10348 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10349 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10350 symbol table.
10351
10352 @cindex @code{$}
10353 @cindex @code{$$}
10354 @cindex history number
10355 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10356 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10357 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10358 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10359 history number.
10360
10361 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10362 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10363 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10364 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10365 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10366 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10367 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10368
10369 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10370 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10371
10372 @smallexample
10373 p *$
10374 @end smallexample
10375
10376 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10377 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10378
10379 @smallexample
10380 p *$.next
10381 @end smallexample
10382
10383 @noindent
10384 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10385 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10386
10387 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10388 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10389
10390 @smallexample
10391 print x
10392 set x=5
10393 @end smallexample
10394
10395 @noindent
10396 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10397 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10398
10399 @table @code
10400 @kindex show values
10401 @item show values
10402 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10403 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10404 values} does not change the history.
10405
10406 @item show values @var{n}
10407 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10408
10409 @item show values +
10410 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10411 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10412 @end table
10413
10414 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10415 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10416
10417 @node Convenience Vars
10418 @section Convenience Variables
10419
10420 @cindex convenience variables
10421 @cindex user-defined variables
10422 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10423 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10424 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10425 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10426 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10427
10428 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10429 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10430 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10431 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10432 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10433
10434 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10435 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10436 For example:
10437
10438 @smallexample
10439 set $foo = *object_ptr
10440 @end smallexample
10441
10442 @noindent
10443 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10444 @code{object_ptr}.
10445
10446 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10447 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10448 value with another assignment at any time.
10449
10450 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10451 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10452 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10453 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10454
10455 @table @code
10456 @kindex show convenience
10457 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10458 @item show convenience
10459 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10460 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10461 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10462
10463 @kindex init-if-undefined
10464 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10465 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10466 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10467 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10468 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10469 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10470 override default values used in a command script.
10471
10472 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10473 any side-effects do not occur.
10474 @end table
10475
10476 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10477 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10478 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10479
10480 @smallexample
10481 set $i = 0
10482 print bar[$i++]->contents
10483 @end smallexample
10484
10485 @noindent
10486 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10487
10488 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10489 values likely to be useful.
10490
10491 @table @code
10492 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10493 @item $_
10494 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10495 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10496 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10497 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10498 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10499 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10500 to the type of @code{$__}.
10501
10502 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10503 @item $__
10504 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10505 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10506 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10507
10508 @item $_exitcode
10509 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10510 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10511 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10512 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10513
10514 @item $_exitsignal
10515 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10516 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10517 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10518 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10519
10520 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10521 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10522 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10523 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10524 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10525
10526 @smallexample
10527 #include <signal.h>
10528
10529 int
10530 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10531 @{
10532 raise (SIGALRM);
10533 return 0;
10534 @}
10535 @end smallexample
10536
10537 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10538 or signalled would be:
10539
10540 @smallexample
10541 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10542 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10543 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10544 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10545 >echo The program has exited\n
10546 >else
10547 >echo The program has signalled\n
10548 >end
10549 >end
10550 (@value{GDBP}) run
10551 Starting program:
10552
10553 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10554 The program no longer exists.
10555 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10556 The program has signalled
10557 @end smallexample
10558
10559 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10560 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10561 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10562 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10563
10564 @smallexample
10565 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10566 The program has exited
10567 @end smallexample
10568
10569 @item $_exception
10570 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10571 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10572
10573 @item $_probe_argc
10574 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10575 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10576
10577 @item $_sdata
10578 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10579 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10580 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10581 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10582 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10583
10584 @item $_siginfo
10585 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10586 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10587 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10588 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10589 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10590
10591 @item $_tlb
10592 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10593 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10594 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10595 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10596 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10597 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10598
10599 @item $_inferior
10600 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10601 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10602
10603 @item $_thread
10604 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10605
10606 @item $_gthread
10607 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10608
10609 @end table
10610
10611 @node Convenience Funs
10612 @section Convenience Functions
10613
10614 @cindex convenience functions
10615 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10616 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10617 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10618 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10619 @value{GDBN}.
10620
10621 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10622 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10623
10624 @table @code
10625
10626 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10627 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10628 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10629 returns zero.
10630
10631 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10632 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10633 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10634 it is @code{void}:
10635
10636 @smallexample
10637 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10638 $1 = void
10639 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10640 $2 = 1
10641 (@value{GDBP}) run
10642 Starting program: ./a.out
10643 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10644 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10645 $3 = 0
10646 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10647 $4 = 0
10648 @end smallexample
10649
10650 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10651 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10652 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10653 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10654 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10655 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10656 anymore.
10657
10658 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10659 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10660
10661 @smallexample
10662 void
10663 foo (void)
10664 @{
10665 @}
10666 @end smallexample
10667
10668 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10669
10670 @smallexample
10671 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10672 $1 = void
10673 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10674 $2 = 1
10675 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10676 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10677 $3 = void
10678 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10679 $4 = 1
10680 @end smallexample
10681
10682 @end table
10683
10684 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10685 @code{Python} support.
10686
10687 @table @code
10688
10689 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10690 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10691 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10692 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10693 Otherwise it returns zero.
10694
10695 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10696 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10697 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10698 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10699 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10700 regular expression support.
10701
10702 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10703 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10704 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10705 Otherwise it returns zero.
10706
10707 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10708 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10709 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10710
10711 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10712 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10713 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10714 Otherwise it returns zero.
10715
10716 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10717 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10718 The default is 1.
10719
10720 Example:
10721
10722 @smallexample
10723 (gdb) backtrace
10724 #0 bottom_func ()
10725 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10726 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10727 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10728 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10729 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10730 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10731 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10732 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10733 $1 = 1
10734 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10735 $1 = 1
10736 @end smallexample
10737
10738 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10739 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10740 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10741 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10742
10743 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10744 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10745 The default is 1.
10746
10747 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10748 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10749 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10750 Otherwise it returns zero.
10751
10752 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10753 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10754 The default is 1.
10755
10756 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10757 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10758 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10759 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10760
10761 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10762 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10763 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10764 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10765
10766 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10767 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10768 The default is 1.
10769
10770 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10771 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10772 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10773 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10774
10775 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10776 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10777 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10778
10779 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10780 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10781 an enumerated type:
10782
10783 @smallexample
10784 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10785 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10786 @end smallexample
10787
10788 @end table
10789
10790 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10791 convenience functions.
10792
10793 @table @code
10794 @item help function
10795 @kindex help function
10796 @cindex show all convenience functions
10797 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10798 @end table
10799
10800 @node Registers
10801 @section Registers
10802
10803 @cindex registers
10804 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10805 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10806 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10807 your machine.
10808
10809 @table @code
10810 @kindex info registers
10811 @item info registers
10812 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10813 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10814
10815 @kindex info all-registers
10816 @cindex floating point registers
10817 @item info all-registers
10818 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10819 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10820
10821 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10822 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10823 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10824 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10825 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10826 @end table
10827
10828 @anchor{standard registers}
10829 @cindex stack pointer register
10830 @cindex program counter register
10831 @cindex process status register
10832 @cindex frame pointer register
10833 @cindex standard registers
10834 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10835 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10836 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10837 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10838 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10839 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10840 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10841 you could print the program counter in hex with
10842
10843 @smallexample
10844 p/x $pc
10845 @end smallexample
10846
10847 @noindent
10848 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10849
10850 @smallexample
10851 x/i $pc
10852 @end smallexample
10853
10854 @noindent
10855 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10856 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10857 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10858 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10859 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10860 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10861 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10862
10863 @smallexample
10864 set $sp += 4
10865 @end smallexample
10866
10867 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10868 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10869 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10870 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10871 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10872 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10873 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10874
10875 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10876 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10877 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10878 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10879 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10880 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10881 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10882
10883 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10884 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10885 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10886 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10887 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10888 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10889 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10890 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10891 prints the data in both formats.
10892
10893 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10894 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10895 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10896 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10897 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10898 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10899 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10900
10901 @smallexample
10902 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10903 $1 = @{
10904 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10905 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10906 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10907 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10908 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10909 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10910 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10911 @}
10912 @end smallexample
10913
10914 @noindent
10915 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10916 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10917 value to a @code{struct} member:
10918
10919 @smallexample
10920 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10921 @end smallexample
10922
10923 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10924 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10925 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10926 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10927 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10928 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10929
10930 @cindex caller-saved registers
10931 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10932 @cindex volatile registers
10933 @cindex <not saved> values
10934 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10935 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10936 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10937 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10938 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10939 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10940 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10941 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10942 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10943 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10944 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10945 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10946 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10947 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10948 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10949 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10950 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10951 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10952 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10953 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10954 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10955 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10956 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10957
10958 @node Floating Point Hardware
10959 @section Floating Point Hardware
10960 @cindex floating point
10961
10962 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10963 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10964
10965 @table @code
10966 @kindex info float
10967 @item info float
10968 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10969 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10970 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10971 the ARM and x86 machines.
10972 @end table
10973
10974 @node Vector Unit
10975 @section Vector Unit
10976 @cindex vector unit
10977
10978 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10979 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10980
10981 @table @code
10982 @kindex info vector
10983 @item info vector
10984 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10985 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10986 @end table
10987
10988 @node OS Information
10989 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10990 @cindex OS information
10991
10992 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10993 you debug your program.
10994
10995 @cindex auxiliary vector
10996 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10997 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10998 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10999 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11000 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11001 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11002 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11003 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11004 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11005 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11006 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11007 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11008
11009 @table @code
11010 @kindex info auxv
11011 @item info auxv
11012 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11013 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11014 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11015 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11016 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11017 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11018 an unrecognized tag.
11019 @end table
11020
11021 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11022 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11023 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11024 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11025 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11026 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11027 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11028
11029 @table @code
11030 @kindex info os
11031 @item info os @var{infotype}
11032
11033 Display OS information of the requested type.
11034
11035 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11036
11037 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11038 @table @code
11039 @kindex info os cpus
11040 @item cpus
11041 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11042 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11043 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11044 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11045 kernel initialization.
11046
11047 @kindex info os files
11048 @item files
11049 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11050 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11051 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11052 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11053
11054 @kindex info os modules
11055 @item modules
11056 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11057 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11058 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11059 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11060 in memory.
11061
11062 @kindex info os msg
11063 @item msg
11064 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11065 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11066 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11067 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11068 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11069 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11070 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11071 the message queue was last changed.
11072
11073 @kindex info os processes
11074 @item processes
11075 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11076 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11077 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11078 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11079 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11080 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11081
11082 @kindex info os procgroups
11083 @item procgroups
11084 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11085 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11086 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11087 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11088 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11089 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11090 and the process group leader is listed first.
11091
11092 @kindex info os semaphores
11093 @item semaphores
11094 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11095 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11096 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11097 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11098 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11099
11100 @kindex info os shm
11101 @item shm
11102 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11103 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11104 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11105 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11106 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11107 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11108 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11109
11110 @kindex info os sockets
11111 @item sockets
11112 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11113 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11114 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11115 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11116 connection.
11117
11118 @kindex info os threads
11119 @item threads
11120 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11121 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11122 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11123 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11124 process is not listed.
11125 @end table
11126
11127 @item info os
11128 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11129 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11130 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11131 types, this command will report an error.
11132 @end table
11133
11134 @node Memory Region Attributes
11135 @section Memory Region Attributes
11136 @cindex memory region attributes
11137
11138 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11139 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11140 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11141 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11142 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11143 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11144 user can override the fetched regions.
11145
11146 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11147 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11148 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11149 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11150 all memory.
11151
11152 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11153 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11154
11155 @table @code
11156 @kindex mem
11157 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11158 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11159 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11160 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11161 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11162 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11163
11164 @item mem auto
11165 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11166 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11167
11168 @kindex delete mem
11169 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11170 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11171 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11172
11173 @kindex disable mem
11174 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11175 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11176 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11177 It may be enabled again later.
11178
11179 @kindex enable mem
11180 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11181 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11182
11183 @kindex info mem
11184 @item info mem
11185 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11186 for each region:
11187
11188 @table @emph
11189 @item Memory Region Number
11190 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11191 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11192 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11193
11194 @item Lo Address
11195 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11196
11197 @item Hi Address
11198 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11199
11200 @item Attributes
11201 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11202 @end table
11203 @end table
11204
11205
11206 @subsection Attributes
11207
11208 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11209 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11210 write accesses to a memory region.
11211
11212 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11213 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11214 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11215
11216 @table @code
11217 @item ro
11218 Memory is read only.
11219 @item wo
11220 Memory is write only.
11221 @item rw
11222 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11223 @end table
11224
11225 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11226 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11227 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11228 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11229 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11230
11231 @table @code
11232 @item 8
11233 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11234 @item 16
11235 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11236 @item 32
11237 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11238 @item 64
11239 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11240 @end table
11241
11242 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11243 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11244 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11245 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11246 @c
11247 @c @table @code
11248 @c @item hwbreak
11249 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11250 @c @item swbreak (default)
11251 @c @end table
11252
11253 @subsubsection Data Cache
11254 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11255 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11256 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11257 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11258 registers.
11259
11260 @table @code
11261 @item cache
11262 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11263 @item nocache
11264 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11265 @end table
11266
11267 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11268 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11269 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11270 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11271 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11272
11273 @table @code
11274 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11275 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11276 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11277 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11278 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11279 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11280 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11281 The default value is @code{on}.
11282 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11283 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11284 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11285 @end table
11286
11287
11288 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11289 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11290 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11291 @c
11292 @c @table @code
11293 @c @item verify
11294 @c @item noverify (default)
11295 @c @end table
11296
11297 @node Dump/Restore Files
11298 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11299 @cindex dump/restore files
11300 @cindex append data to a file
11301 @cindex dump data to a file
11302 @cindex restore data from a file
11303
11304 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11305 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11306 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11307 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11308 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11309 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11310 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11311
11312 @table @code
11313
11314 @kindex dump
11315 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11316 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11317 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11318 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11319
11320 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11321 @table @code
11322 @item binary
11323 Raw binary form.
11324 @item ihex
11325 Intel hex format.
11326 @item srec
11327 Motorola S-record format.
11328 @item tekhex
11329 Tektronix Hex format.
11330 @item verilog
11331 Verilog Hex format.
11332 @end table
11333
11334 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11335 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11336 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11337 form.
11338
11339 @kindex append
11340 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11341 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11342 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11343 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11344 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11345
11346 @kindex restore
11347 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11348 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11349 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11350 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11351 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11352
11353 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11354 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11355 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11356 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11357 from that location.
11358
11359 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11360 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11361 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11362 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11363
11364 @end table
11365
11366 @node Core File Generation
11367 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11368 @cindex dump core from inferior
11369
11370 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11371 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11372 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11373 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11374 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11375 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11376 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11377
11378 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11379 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11380 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11381
11382 @table @code
11383 @kindex gcore
11384 @kindex generate-core-file
11385 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11386 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11387 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11388 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11389 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11390 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11391
11392 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11393 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11394
11395 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11396 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11397 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11398
11399 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11400 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11401 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11402 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11403 Enable or disable the use of the file
11404 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11405 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11406 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11407 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11408
11409 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11410 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11411 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11412 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11413 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11414 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11415 about the bits that can be set in the
11416 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11417 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11418
11419 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11420 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11421 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11422 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11423 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11424 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11425 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11426 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11427 @end table
11428
11429 @node Character Sets
11430 @section Character Sets
11431 @cindex character sets
11432 @cindex charset
11433 @cindex translating between character sets
11434 @cindex host character set
11435 @cindex target character set
11436
11437 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11438 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11439 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11440 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11441 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11442 @dfn{target character set}.
11443
11444 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11445 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11446 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11447 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11448 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11449 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11450 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11451 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11452 character and string literals in expressions.
11453
11454 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11455 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11456 target-charset} command, described below.
11457
11458 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11459 support:
11460
11461 @table @code
11462 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11463 @kindex set target-charset
11464 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11465 list of supported target character sets, type
11466 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11467
11468 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11469 @kindex set host-charset
11470 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11471
11472 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11473 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11474 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11475 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11476 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11477
11478 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11479 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11480 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11481
11482 @item set charset @var{charset}
11483 @kindex set charset
11484 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11485 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11486 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11487 for both host and target.
11488
11489 @item show charset
11490 @kindex show charset
11491 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11492
11493 @item show host-charset
11494 @kindex show host-charset
11495 Show the name of the current host character set.
11496
11497 @item show target-charset
11498 @kindex show target-charset
11499 Show the name of the current target character set.
11500
11501 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11502 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11503 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11504 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11505 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11506 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11507
11508 @item show target-wide-charset
11509 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11510 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11511 @end table
11512
11513 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11514 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11515 @file{charset-test.c}:
11516
11517 @smallexample
11518 #include <stdio.h>
11519
11520 char ascii_hello[]
11521 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11522 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11523 char ibm1047_hello[]
11524 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11525 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11526
11527 main ()
11528 @{
11529 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11530 @}
11531 @end smallexample
11532
11533 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11534 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11535 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11536
11537 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11538
11539 @smallexample
11540 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11541 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11542 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11543 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11544 @dots{}
11545 (@value{GDBP})
11546 @end smallexample
11547
11548 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11549 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11550 strings:
11551
11552 @smallexample
11553 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11554 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11555 (@value{GDBP})
11556 @end smallexample
11557
11558 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11559 initial character set:
11560 @smallexample
11561 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11562 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11563 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11564 (@value{GDBP})
11565 @end smallexample
11566
11567 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11568 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11569 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11570 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11571 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11572
11573 @smallexample
11574 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11575 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11576 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11577 $2 = 72 'H'
11578 (@value{GDBP})
11579 @end smallexample
11580
11581 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11582 literals you use in expressions:
11583
11584 @smallexample
11585 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11586 $3 = 43 '+'
11587 (@value{GDBP})
11588 @end smallexample
11589
11590 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11591 character.
11592
11593 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11594 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11595 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11596
11597 @smallexample
11598 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11599 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11600 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11601 $5 = 200 '\310'
11602 (@value{GDBP})
11603 @end smallexample
11604
11605 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11606 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11607
11608 @smallexample
11609 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11610 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11611 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11612 @end smallexample
11613
11614 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11615 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11616 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11617 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11618 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11619
11620 @smallexample
11621 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11622 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11623 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11624 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11625 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11626 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11627 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11628 $7 = 72 '\110'
11629 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11630 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11631 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11632 $9 = 200 'H'
11633 (@value{GDBP})
11634 @end smallexample
11635
11636 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11637 string literals you use in expressions:
11638
11639 @smallexample
11640 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11641 $10 = 78 '+'
11642 (@value{GDBP})
11643 @end smallexample
11644
11645 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11646 character.
11647
11648 @node Caching Target Data
11649 @section Caching Data of Targets
11650 @cindex caching data of targets
11651
11652 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11653 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11654 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11655 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11656 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11657 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11658 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11659 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11660 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11661 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11662 is executing.
11663 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11664 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11665 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11666 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11667 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11668 in the code segment.
11669 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11670 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11671
11672 @table @code
11673 @kindex set remotecache
11674 @item set remotecache on
11675 @itemx set remotecache off
11676 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11677 with old scripts.
11678
11679 @kindex show remotecache
11680 @item show remotecache
11681 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11682
11683 @kindex set stack-cache
11684 @item set stack-cache on
11685 @itemx set stack-cache off
11686 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11687 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11688
11689 @kindex show stack-cache
11690 @item show stack-cache
11691 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11692
11693 @kindex set code-cache
11694 @item set code-cache on
11695 @itemx set code-cache off
11696 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11697 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11698 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11699
11700 @kindex show code-cache
11701 @item show code-cache
11702 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11703 accesses.
11704
11705 @kindex info dcache
11706 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11707 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11708 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11709 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11710 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11711 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11712
11713 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11714 printed in hex.
11715
11716 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11717 @cindex dcache size
11718 @kindex set dcache size
11719 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11720
11721 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11722 @cindex dcache line-size
11723 @kindex set dcache line-size
11724 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11725 Must be a power of 2.
11726
11727 @item show dcache size
11728 @kindex show dcache size
11729 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11730
11731 @item show dcache line-size
11732 @kindex show dcache line-size
11733 Show default size of dcache lines.
11734
11735 @end table
11736
11737 @node Searching Memory
11738 @section Search Memory
11739 @cindex searching memory
11740
11741 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11742 @code{find} command.
11743
11744 @table @code
11745 @kindex find
11746 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11747 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11748 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11749 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11750 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11751 @end table
11752
11753 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11754 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11755
11756 @table @r
11757 @item @var{s}, search query size
11758 The size of each search query value.
11759
11760 @table @code
11761 @item b
11762 bytes
11763 @item h
11764 halfwords (two bytes)
11765 @item w
11766 words (four bytes)
11767 @item g
11768 giant words (eight bytes)
11769 @end table
11770
11771 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11772 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11773 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11774
11775 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11776 value's type in the current language.
11777 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11778 pattern as a mixture of types.
11779 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11780 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11781 which is typically four bytes.
11782
11783 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11784 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11785 @end table
11786
11787 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11788 (@code{"}).
11789 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11790 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11791
11792 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11793 number of matches found.
11794
11795 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11796 @samp{$_}.
11797 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11798
11799 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11800
11801 @smallexample
11802 void
11803 hello ()
11804 @{
11805 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11806 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11807 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11808 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11809 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11810 @}
11811 @end smallexample
11812
11813 @noindent
11814 you get during debugging:
11815
11816 @smallexample
11817 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11818 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11819 1 pattern found
11820 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11821 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11822 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11823 2 patterns found
11824 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11825 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11826 1 pattern found
11827 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11828 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11829 1 pattern found
11830 (gdb) print $numfound
11831 $1 = 1
11832 (gdb) print $_
11833 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11834 @end smallexample
11835
11836 @node Value Sizes
11837 @section Value Sizes
11838
11839 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11840 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11841 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11842 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11843 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11844
11845 @table @code
11846 @kindex set max-value-size
11847 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11848 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11849 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11850 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11851 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11852
11853 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11854 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11855
11856 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11857 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11858 currently 16 bytes.
11859
11860 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11861 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11862 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11863 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11864 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11865 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11866 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11867 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11868
11869 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11870
11871 @kindex show max-value-size
11872 @item show max-value-size
11873 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11874 allocate for the contents of a value.
11875 @end table
11876
11877 @node Optimized Code
11878 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11879 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11880 @cindex debugging optimized code
11881
11882 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11883 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11884 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11885 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11886 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11887 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11888 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11889
11890 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11891 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11892 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11893 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11894
11895 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11896 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11897 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11898 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11899 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11900 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11901
11902 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11903 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11904 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11905 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11906 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11907
11908 @menu
11909 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11910 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11911 @end menu
11912
11913 @node Inline Functions
11914 @section Inline Functions
11915 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11916
11917 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11918 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11919 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11920 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11921 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11922 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11923 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11924 @code{info frame} command.
11925
11926 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11927 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11928 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11929 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11930 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11931 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11932 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11933 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11934 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11935 local variables in the caller.
11936
11937 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11938 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11939 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11940 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11941 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11942 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11943 instructions are executed.
11944
11945 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11946 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11947 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11948 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11949
11950 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11951 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11952
11953 @itemize @bullet
11954 @item
11955 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11956 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11957 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11958 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11959 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11960 or inside the inlined function instead.
11961
11962 @item
11963 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11964 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11965 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11966 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11967
11968 @end itemize
11969
11970 @node Tail Call Frames
11971 @section Tail Call Frames
11972 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11973
11974 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11975 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11976 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11977 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11978 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11979
11980 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11981 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11982 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11983 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11984 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11985 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11986 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11987
11988 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11989 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11990 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11991 this information.
11992
11993 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11994 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11995
11996 @smallexample
11997 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11998 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11999 (gdb) info frame
12000 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12001 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12002 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12003 source language c++.
12004 Arglist at unknown address.
12005 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12006 @end smallexample
12007
12008 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12009 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12010 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12011 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12012 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12013 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12014
12015 @table @code
12016 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12017 @item set debug entry-values
12018 @kindex set debug entry-values
12019 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12020 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12021 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12022 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12023 result.
12024
12025 @item show debug entry-values
12026 @kindex show debug entry-values
12027 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12028 values at function entry and tail calls.
12029 @end table
12030
12031 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12032 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12033 reference by variable @code{x}):
12034
12035 @smallexample
12036 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12037 void (*x) (void) = c;
12038 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12039 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12040 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12041
12042 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
12043 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
12044 a () at t.c:3
12045 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12046 (gdb) bt
12047 #0 a () at t.c:3
12048 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12049 @end smallexample
12050
12051 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12052
12053 @smallexample
12054 int i;
12055 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12056 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12057 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12058 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12059 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12060 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12061 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12062 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12063
12064 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12065 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12066 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12067 (gdb) bt
12068 #0 f () at t.c:2
12069 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12070 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12071 @end smallexample
12072
12073 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12074 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12075
12076 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12077 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12078 @set ARROW @click{}
12079 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12080 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12081 @end ifset
12082 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12083 @set ARROW ->
12084 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12085 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12086 @end ifclear
12087
12088 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12089 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12090 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12091
12092 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12093 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12094 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12095 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12096 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12097 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12098
12099 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12100 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12101 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12102 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12103 omitted.
12104
12105 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12106 entry may fail:
12107
12108 @smallexample
12109 int v;
12110 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12111 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12112 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12113 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12114 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12115 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12116
12117 (gdb) bt
12118 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12119 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
12120 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12121 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12122 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12123 @end smallexample
12124
12125 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12126 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12127 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12128 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12129 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12130
12131 @node Macros
12132 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12133
12134 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12135 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12136 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12137 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12138 where it was defined.
12139
12140 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12141 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12142 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12143 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12144
12145 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12146 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12147 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12148 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12149 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12150 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12151 see @ref{List}.
12152
12153 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12154 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12155 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12156
12157 @table @code
12158
12159 @kindex macro expand
12160 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12161 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12162 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12163 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12164 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12165 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12166 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12167 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12168 it can be any string of tokens.
12169
12170 @kindex macro exp1
12171 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12172 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12173 @cindex expand macro once
12174 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12175 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12176 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12177 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12178 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12179 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12180 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12181 can be any string of tokens.
12182
12183 @kindex info macro
12184 @cindex macro definition, showing
12185 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12186 @cindex macros, from debug info
12187 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12188 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12189 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12190 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12191 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12192 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12193
12194 @kindex info macros
12195 @item info macros @var{location}
12196 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12197 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12198 command-line where those definitions were established.
12199
12200 @kindex macro define
12201 @cindex user-defined macros
12202 @cindex defining macros interactively
12203 @cindex macros, user-defined
12204 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12205 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12206 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12207 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12208 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12209 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12210 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12211 @var{arglist}.
12212
12213 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12214 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12215 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12216 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12217 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12218
12219 @kindex macro undef
12220 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12221 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12222 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12223 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12224 in the program being debugged.
12225
12226 @kindex macro list
12227 @item macro list
12228 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12229 @end table
12230
12231 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12232 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12233 show our source files:
12234
12235 @smallexample
12236 $ cat sample.c
12237 #include <stdio.h>
12238 #include "sample.h"
12239
12240 #define M 42
12241 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12242
12243 main ()
12244 @{
12245 #define N 28
12246 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12247 #undef N
12248 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12249 #define N 1729
12250 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12251 @}
12252 $ cat sample.h
12253 #define Q <
12254 $
12255 @end smallexample
12256
12257 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12258 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12259 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12260 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12261 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12262 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12263 information.
12264
12265 @smallexample
12266 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12267 $
12268 @end smallexample
12269
12270 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12271
12272 @smallexample
12273 $ gdb -nw sample
12274 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12275 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12276 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12277 (@value{GDBP})
12278 @end smallexample
12279
12280 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12281 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12282 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12283
12284 @smallexample
12285 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12286 3
12287 4 #define M 42
12288 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12289 6
12290 7 main ()
12291 8 @{
12292 9 #define N 28
12293 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12294 11 #undef N
12295 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12296 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12297 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12298 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12299 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12300 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12301 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12302 #define Q <
12303 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12304 expands to: (42 + 1)
12305 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12306 expands to: once (M + 1)
12307 (@value{GDBP})
12308 @end smallexample
12309
12310 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12311 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12312 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12313 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12314
12315 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12316 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12317
12318 @smallexample
12319 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12320 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12321 (@value{GDBP}) run
12322 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12323
12324 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12325 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12326 (@value{GDBP})
12327 @end smallexample
12328
12329 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12330
12331 @smallexample
12332 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12333 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12334 #define N 28
12335 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12336 expands to: 28 < 42
12337 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12338 $1 = 1
12339 (@value{GDBP})
12340 @end smallexample
12341
12342 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12343 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12344 thereof) in force at each point:
12345
12346 @smallexample
12347 (@value{GDBP}) next
12348 Hello, world!
12349 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12350 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12351 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12352 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12353 (@value{GDBP}) next
12354 We're so creative.
12355 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12356 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12357 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12358 #define N 1729
12359 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12360 expands to: 1729 < 42
12361 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12362 $2 = 0
12363 (@value{GDBP})
12364 @end smallexample
12365
12366 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12367 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12368 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12369 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12370
12371 @smallexample
12372 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12373 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12374 -D__STDC__=1
12375 (@value{GDBP})
12376 @end smallexample
12377
12378
12379 @node Tracepoints
12380 @chapter Tracepoints
12381 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12382 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12383
12384 @cindex tracepoints
12385 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12386 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12387 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12388 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12389 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12390 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12391 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12392
12393 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12394 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12395 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12396 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12397 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12398 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12399 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12400 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12401 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12402 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12403 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12404
12405 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12406 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12407 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12408 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12409 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12410 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12411 Packets}.
12412
12413 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12414 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12415 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12416
12417 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12418
12419 @menu
12420 * Set Tracepoints::
12421 * Analyze Collected Data::
12422 * Tracepoint Variables::
12423 * Trace Files::
12424 @end menu
12425
12426 @node Set Tracepoints
12427 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12428
12429 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12430 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12431 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12432 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12433 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12434 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12435 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12436
12437 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12438 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12439 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12440 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12441 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12442 tracepoint was hit.
12443
12444 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12445 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12446 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12447 either.
12448
12449 @cindex fast tracepoints
12450 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12451 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12452 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12453
12454 @cindex static tracepoints
12455 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12456 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12457 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12458 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12459 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12460 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12461 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12462 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12463 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12464 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12465 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12466 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12467 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12468 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12469 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12470 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12471 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12472 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12473 static tracepoint marker.
12474
12475 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12476 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12477
12478 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12479 conditions and actions.
12480
12481 @menu
12482 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12483 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12484 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12485 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12486 * Trace State Variables::
12487 * Tracepoint Actions::
12488 * Listing Tracepoints::
12489 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12490 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12491 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12492 @end menu
12493
12494 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12495 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12496
12497 @table @code
12498 @cindex set tracepoint
12499 @kindex trace
12500 @item trace @var{location}
12501 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12502 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12503 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12504 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12505 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12506 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12507 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12508 in tracing}).
12509 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12510 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12511 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12512 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12513 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12514 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12515 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12516 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12517 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12518 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12519 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12520 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12521
12522 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12523
12524 @smallexample
12525 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12526
12527 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12528
12529 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12530
12531 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12532
12533 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12534 @end smallexample
12535
12536 @noindent
12537 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12538
12539 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12540 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12541 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12542 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12543 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12544 information on tracepoint conditions.
12545
12546 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12547 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12548 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12549 @kindex ftrace
12550 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12551 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12552 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12553 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12554 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12555 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12556 message.
12557
12558 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12559 @code{trace}.
12560
12561 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12562 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12563 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12564 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12565 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12566 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12567 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12568 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12569
12570 @example
12571 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12572 @end example
12573
12574 @noindent
12575 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12576 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12577
12578 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12579 @cindex set static tracepoint
12580 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12581 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12582 @kindex strace
12583 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12584 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12585 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12586 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12587 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12588
12589 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12590 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12591 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12592 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12593 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12594 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12595 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12596 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12597 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12598 tracing engine:
12599
12600 @smallexample
12601 main ()
12602 @{
12603 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12604 @}
12605 @end smallexample
12606
12607 @noindent
12608 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12609 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12610
12611 @smallexample
12612 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12613 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12614 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12615 Data: "str %s"
12616 [etc...]
12617 @end smallexample
12618
12619 @noindent
12620 so you may probe the marker above with:
12621
12622 @smallexample
12623 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12624 @end smallexample
12625
12626 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12627 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12628 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12629 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12630 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12631 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12632 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12633 the @samp{Data:} field.
12634
12635 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12636 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12637 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12638
12639 @vindex $tpnum
12640 @cindex last tracepoint number
12641 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12642 @cindex tracepoint number
12643 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12644 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12645
12646 @kindex delete tracepoint
12647 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12648 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12649 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12650 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12651 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12652
12653 Examples:
12654
12655 @smallexample
12656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12657
12658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12659 @end smallexample
12660
12661 @noindent
12662 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12663 @end table
12664
12665 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12666 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12667
12668 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12669
12670 @table @code
12671 @kindex disable tracepoint
12672 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12673 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12674 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12675 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12676 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12677 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12678 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12679 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12680 next trace experiment.
12681
12682 @kindex enable tracepoint
12683 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12684 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12685 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12686 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12687 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12688 next time a trace experiment is run.
12689 @end table
12690
12691 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12692 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12693
12694 @table @code
12695 @kindex passcount
12696 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12697 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12698 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12699 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12700 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12701 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12702 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12703 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12704 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12705 user.
12706
12707 Examples:
12708
12709 @smallexample
12710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12711 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12712
12713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12714 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12720 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12721 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12722 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12723 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12724 @end smallexample
12725 @end table
12726
12727 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12728 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12729 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12730 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12731
12732 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12733 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12734 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12735 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12736 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12737 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12738 is true.
12739
12740 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12741 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12742 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12743 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12744 just as with breakpoints.
12745
12746 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12747 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12748 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12749 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12750 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12751 accesses, and so forth.
12752
12753 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12754 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12755 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12756 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12757 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12758 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12759 search through.
12760
12761 @smallexample
12762 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12763 @end smallexample
12764
12765 @node Trace State Variables
12766 @subsection Trace State Variables
12767 @cindex trace state variables
12768
12769 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12770 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12771 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12772 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12773 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12774 integers.
12775
12776 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12777 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12778 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12779 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12780
12781 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12782 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12783 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12784 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12785 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12786 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12787 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12788 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12789 variable with the same name.
12790
12791 @table @code
12792
12793 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12794 @kindex tvariable
12795 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12796 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12797 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12798 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12799 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12800 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12801 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12802 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12803 value. The default initial value is 0.
12804
12805 @item info tvariables
12806 @kindex info tvariables
12807 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12808 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12809 currently running.
12810
12811 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12812 @kindex delete tvariable
12813 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12814 are specified.
12815
12816 @end table
12817
12818 @node Tracepoint Actions
12819 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12820
12821 @table @code
12822 @kindex actions
12823 @cindex tracepoint actions
12824 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12825 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12826 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12827 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12828 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12829 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12830 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12831 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12832 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12833 @code{while-stepping}.
12834
12835 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12836 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12837 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12838
12839 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12840 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12841 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12842
12843 @smallexample
12844 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12845
12846 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12847
12848 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12849 @end smallexample
12850
12851 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12852 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12853 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12854 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12855 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12856 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12857 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12858 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12859
12860 @smallexample
12861 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12862 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12863 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12864 > collect bar,baz
12865 > collect $regs
12866 > while-stepping 12
12867 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12868 > end
12869 end
12870 @end smallexample
12871
12872 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12873 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12874 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12875 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12876 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12877 special arguments are supported:
12878
12879 @table @code
12880 @item $regs
12881 Collect all registers.
12882
12883 @item $args
12884 Collect all function arguments.
12885
12886 @item $locals
12887 Collect all local variables.
12888
12889 @item $_ret
12890 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12891 of a backtrace.
12892
12893 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12894 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12895 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12896 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12897 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12898 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12899
12900 @item $_probe_argc
12901 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12902 tracepoint is located.
12903 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12904
12905 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12906 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12907 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12908 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12909
12910 @item $_sdata
12911 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12912 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12913 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12914 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12915 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12916 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12917 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12918 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12919 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12920
12921 @smallexample
12922 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12923 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12924 @end smallexample
12925
12926 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12927 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12928 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12929 @value{GDBN}.
12930 @end table
12931
12932 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12933 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12934 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12935
12936 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12937 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12938 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12939 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12940 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12941 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12942 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12943 @samp{mystr}.
12944
12945 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12946 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12947
12948 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12949 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12950 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12951 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12952 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12953 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12954 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12955 action were used.
12956
12957 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12958 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12959 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12960 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12961 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12962 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12963
12964 @smallexample
12965 > while-stepping 12
12966 > collect $regs, myglobal
12967 > end
12968 >
12969 @end smallexample
12970
12971 @noindent
12972 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12973 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12974 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12975 @code{stepping}.
12976
12977 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12978 @kindex set default-collect
12979 @cindex default collection action
12980 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12981 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12982 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12983 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12984 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12985 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12986
12987 @item show default-collect
12988 @kindex show default-collect
12989 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12990 tracepoint hit.
12991
12992 @end table
12993
12994 @node Listing Tracepoints
12995 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12996
12997 @table @code
12998 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12999 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13000 @cindex information about tracepoints
13001 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13002 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13003 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13004 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13005 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13006 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13007
13008 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13009 tracing:
13010
13011 @itemize @bullet
13012 @item
13013 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13014
13015 @item
13016 the state about installed on target of each location
13017 @end itemize
13018
13019 @smallexample
13020 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13021 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13022 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13023 while-stepping 20
13024 collect globfoo, $regs
13025 end
13026 collect globfoo2
13027 end
13028 pass count 1200
13029 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13030 collect $eip
13031 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13032 installed on target
13033 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13034 installed on target
13035 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13036 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13037 not installed on target
13038 (@value{GDBP})
13039 @end smallexample
13040
13041 @noindent
13042 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13043 @end table
13044
13045 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13046 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13047
13048 @table @code
13049 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13050 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13051 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13052 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13053 program.
13054
13055 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13056
13057 @table @emph
13058 @item Count
13059 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13060 stable identifier.
13061 @item ID
13062 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13063 @item Enabled or Disabled
13064 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13065 that are not enabled.
13066 @item Address
13067 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13068 @item What
13069 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13070 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13071 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13072 will be left blank.
13073 @end table
13074
13075 @noindent
13076 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13077
13078 @table @emph
13079 @item Data
13080 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13081 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13082 marker call.
13083 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13084 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13085 @end table
13086
13087 @smallexample
13088 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13089 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13090 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13091 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13092 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13093 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13094 Data: str %s
13095 (@value{GDBP})
13096 @end smallexample
13097 @end table
13098
13099 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13100 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13101
13102 @table @code
13103 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13104 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13105 @cindex collected data discarded
13106 @item tstart
13107 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13108 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13109 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13110 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13111 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13112 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13113 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13114 information, and so forth.
13115
13116 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13117 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13118 @item tstop
13119 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13120 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13121 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13122 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13123 needs to be stopped quickly.
13124
13125 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13126 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13127 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13128
13129 @kindex tstatus
13130 @cindex status of trace data collection
13131 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13132 @item tstatus
13133 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13134 collection.
13135 @end table
13136
13137 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13138
13139 @smallexample
13140 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13141 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13142 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13143 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13144 > while-stepping 11
13145 > collect $regs
13146 > end
13147 > end
13148 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13149 [time passes @dots{}]
13150 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13151 @end smallexample
13152
13153 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13154 @cindex disconnected tracing
13155 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13156 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13157 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13158 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13159 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13160 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13161 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13162 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13163
13164 @table @code
13165 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13166 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13167 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13168 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13169 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13170 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13171 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13172 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13173
13174 @item show disconnected-tracing
13175 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13176 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13177
13178 @end table
13179
13180 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13181 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13182 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13183 it will continue after reconnection.
13184
13185 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13186 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13187 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13188 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13189 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13190 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13191 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13192 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13193 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13194 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13195
13196 @cindex circular trace buffer
13197 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13198 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13199 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13200 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13201 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13202 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13203 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13204 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13205 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13206 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13207 the next run.
13208
13209 @table @code
13210 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13211 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13212 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13213 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13214 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13215 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13216 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13217
13218 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13219 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13220 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13221 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13222 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13223 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13224
13225 @end table
13226
13227 @table @code
13228 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13229 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13230 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13231 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13232 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13233 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13234 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13235 likes. This is also the default.
13236
13237 @item show trace-buffer-size
13238 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13239 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13240 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13241 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13242 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13243 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13244 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13245 @end table
13246
13247 @table @code
13248 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13249 @kindex set trace-user
13250
13251 @item show trace-user
13252 @kindex show trace-user
13253
13254 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13255 @kindex set trace-notes
13256 Set the trace run's notes.
13257
13258 @item show trace-notes
13259 @kindex show trace-notes
13260 Show the trace run's notes.
13261
13262 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13263 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13264 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13265 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13266 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13267
13268 @item show trace-stop-notes
13269 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13270 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13271
13272 @end table
13273
13274 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13275 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13276
13277 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13278 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13279 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13280 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13281 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13282 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13283 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13284 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13285 mentioned here.
13286
13287 @itemize @bullet
13288
13289 @item
13290 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13291 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13292 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13293 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13294 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13295 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13296 cannot be collected either.
13297
13298 @item
13299 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13300 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13301 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13302 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13303 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13304 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13305 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13306 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13307 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13308 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13309
13310 @item
13311 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13312 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13313 in a misleading way.
13314
13315 @item
13316 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13317 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13318 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13319 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13320 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13321 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13322 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13323 by @code{ptr}.
13324
13325 @item
13326 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13327 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13328 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13329 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13330 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13331 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13332 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13333 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13334 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13335 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13336 invalid address.
13337
13338 @item
13339 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13340 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13341 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13342 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13343 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13344 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13345 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13346 it to zero.
13347
13348 @end itemize
13349
13350 @node Analyze Collected Data
13351 @section Using the Collected Data
13352
13353 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13354 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13355 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13356 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13357 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13358 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13359 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13360 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13361 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13362 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13363 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13364 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13365 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13366 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13367 the buffer will fail.
13368
13369 @menu
13370 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13371 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13372 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13373 @end menu
13374
13375 @node tfind
13376 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13377
13378 @kindex tfind
13379 @cindex select trace snapshot
13380 @cindex find trace snapshot
13381 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13382 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13383 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13384 snapshot is selected.
13385
13386 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13387
13388 @table @code
13389 @item tfind start
13390 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13391 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13392
13393 @item tfind none
13394 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13395
13396 @item tfind end
13397 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13398
13399 @item tfind
13400 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13401 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13402
13403 @item tfind -
13404 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13405 retracing earlier steps.
13406
13407 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13408 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13409 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13410 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13411 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13412
13413 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13414 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13415 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13416 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13417 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13418
13419 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13420 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13421 addresses (exclusive).
13422
13423 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13424 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13425 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13426
13427 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13428 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13429 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13430 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13431 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13432 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13433 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13434 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13435 @end table
13436
13437 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13438 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13439 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13440 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13441 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13442 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13443 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13444 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13445 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13446 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13447 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13448 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13449 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13450 tracepoint as the current one.
13451
13452 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13453 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13454 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13455 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13456 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13457
13458 @smallexample
13459 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13460 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13461 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13462 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13463 > tfind
13464 > end
13465
13466 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13467 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13468 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13469 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13470 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13471 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13472 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13473 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13474 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13475 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13476 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13477 @end smallexample
13478
13479 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13480 the buffer:
13481
13482 @smallexample
13483 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13484 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13485 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13486 > tfind line
13487 > end
13488
13489 Frame 0, X = 1
13490 Frame 7, X = 2
13491 Frame 13, X = 255
13492 @end smallexample
13493
13494 @node tdump
13495 @subsection @code{tdump}
13496 @kindex tdump
13497 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13498 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13499
13500 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13501 the current trace snapshot.
13502
13503 @smallexample
13504 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13505 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13506 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13507 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13508 > end
13509
13510 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13511
13512 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13513 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13514 at gdb_test.c:444
13515 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13516
13517 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13518 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13519 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13520 d1 0x18 24
13521 d2 0x80 128
13522 d3 0x33 51
13523 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13524 d5 0x22 34
13525 d6 0xe0 224
13526 d7 0x380035 3670069
13527 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13528 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13529 a2 0x100 256
13530 a3 0x322000 3284992
13531 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13532 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13533 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13534 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13535 ps 0x0 0
13536 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13537 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13538 fpstatus 0x0 0
13539 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13540 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13541 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13542 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13543 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13544 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13545 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13546 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13547 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13548
13549 (@value{GDBP})
13550 @end smallexample
13551
13552 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13553 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13554 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13555 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13556
13557 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13558 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13559 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13560 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13561 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13562 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13563 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13564 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13565 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13566 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13567
13568 @node save tracepoints
13569 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13570 @kindex save tracepoints
13571 @kindex save-tracepoints
13572 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13573
13574 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13575 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13576 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13577 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13578 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13579 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13580
13581 @node Tracepoint Variables
13582 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13583 @cindex tracepoint variables
13584 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13585
13586 @table @code
13587 @vindex $trace_frame
13588 @item (int) $trace_frame
13589 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13590 snapshot is selected.
13591
13592 @vindex $tracepoint
13593 @item (int) $tracepoint
13594 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13595
13596 @vindex $trace_line
13597 @item (int) $trace_line
13598 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13599
13600 @vindex $trace_file
13601 @item (char []) $trace_file
13602 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13603
13604 @vindex $trace_func
13605 @item (char []) $trace_func
13606 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13607 @end table
13608
13609 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13610 use @code{output} instead.
13611
13612 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13613 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13614 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13615 which are managed by the target.
13616
13617 @smallexample
13618 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13619
13620 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13621 > output $trace_file
13622 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13623 > tfind
13624 > end
13625 @end smallexample
13626
13627 @node Trace Files
13628 @section Using Trace Files
13629 @cindex trace files
13630
13631 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13632 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13633 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13634 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13635 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13636
13637 @table @code
13638
13639 @kindex tsave
13640 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13641 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13642 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13643 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13644 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13645 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13646 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13647 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13648 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13649 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13650 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13651 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13652 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13653 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13654 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13655
13656 @kindex target tfile
13657 @kindex tfile
13658 @kindex target ctf
13659 @kindex ctf
13660 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13661 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13662 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13663 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13664 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13665 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13666 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13667 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13668 the host.
13669
13670 @smallexample
13671 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13672 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13673 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13674 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13675 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13676 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13677 i = 0
13678 a = 0
13679 b = 1 '\001'
13680 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13681 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13682 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13683 $1 = 1
13684 @end smallexample
13685
13686 @end table
13687
13688 @node Overlays
13689 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13690 @cindex overlays
13691
13692 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13693 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13694 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13695 use overlays.
13696
13697 @menu
13698 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13699 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13700 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13701 mapped by asking the inferior.
13702 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13703 @end menu
13704
13705 @node How Overlays Work
13706 @section How Overlays Work
13707 @cindex mapped overlays
13708 @cindex unmapped overlays
13709 @cindex load address, overlay's
13710 @cindex mapped address
13711 @cindex overlay area
13712
13713 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13714 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13715 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13716 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13717 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13718
13719 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13720 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13721 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13722 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13723 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13724 largest overlay as well.
13725
13726 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13727 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13728 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13729 there.
13730
13731 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13732 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13733 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13734
13735 @smallexample
13736 @group
13737 Data Instruction Larger
13738 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13739 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13740 | | | | | |
13741 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13742 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13743 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13744 | and heap | | | | | |
13745 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13746 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13747 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13748 | | | | | |
13749 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13750 address | | | | | |
13751 | overlay | <-' | | |
13752 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13753 | | <---. | | load address
13754 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13755 | | | |
13756 +-----------+ | |
13757 +-----------+
13758 | |
13759 +-----------+
13760
13761 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13762 @end group
13763 @end smallexample
13764
13765 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13766 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13767 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13768 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13769 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13770 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13771 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13772 program and the overlay area.
13773
13774 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13775 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13776 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13777 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13778 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13779 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13780 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13781
13782 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13783 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13784 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13785
13786 @itemize @bullet
13787
13788 @item
13789 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13790 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13791 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13792 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13793
13794 @item
13795 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13796 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13797 your program's performance.
13798
13799 @item
13800 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13801 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13802 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13803 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13804 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13805 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13806 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13807
13808 @item
13809 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13810 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13811 instruction and data spaces.
13812
13813 @end itemize
13814
13815 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13816 improved in many ways:
13817
13818 @itemize @bullet
13819
13820 @item
13821 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13822 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13823 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13824 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13825 area in the usual way.
13826
13827 @item
13828 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13829 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13830
13831 @item
13832 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13833 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13834 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13835 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13836 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13837 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13838 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13839
13840 @end itemize
13841
13842
13843 @node Overlay Commands
13844 @section Overlay Commands
13845
13846 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13847 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13848 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13849 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13850 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13851 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13852
13853 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13854 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13855
13856 @table @code
13857 @item overlay off
13858 @kindex overlay
13859 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13860 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13861 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13862 overlay support is disabled.
13863
13864 @item overlay manual
13865 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13866 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13867 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13868 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13869 commands described below.
13870
13871 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13872 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13873 @cindex map an overlay
13874 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13875 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13876 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13877 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13878 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13879 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13880
13881 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13882 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13883 @cindex unmap an overlay
13884 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13885 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13886 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13887 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13888
13889 @item overlay auto
13890 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13891 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13892 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13893 Overlay Debugging}.
13894
13895 @item overlay load-target
13896 @itemx overlay load
13897 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13898 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13899 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13900 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13901 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13902 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13903
13904 @item overlay list-overlays
13905 @itemx overlay list
13906 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13907 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13908 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13909
13910 @end table
13911
13912 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13913 of the function the address falls in:
13914
13915 @smallexample
13916 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13917 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13918 @end smallexample
13919 @noindent
13920 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13921 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13922 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13923 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13924
13925 @smallexample
13926 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13927 No sections are mapped.
13928 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13929 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13930 @end smallexample
13931 @noindent
13932 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13933 name normally:
13934
13935 @smallexample
13936 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13937 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13938 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13939 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13940 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13941 @end smallexample
13942
13943 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13944 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13945 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13946 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13947 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13948
13949 @itemize @bullet
13950 @item
13951 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13952 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13953 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13954 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13955 @item
13956 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13957 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13958 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13959 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13960 breakpoints properly.
13961 @end itemize
13962
13963
13964 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13965 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13966 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13967
13968 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13969 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13970 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13971 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13972 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13973 current state of the overlays.
13974
13975 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13976 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13977
13978 @table @asis
13979
13980 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13981 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13982
13983 @smallexample
13984 struct
13985 @{
13986 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13987 unsigned long vma;
13988
13989 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13990 unsigned long size;
13991
13992 /* The overlay's load address. */
13993 unsigned long lma;
13994
13995 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13996 zero otherwise. */
13997 unsigned long mapped;
13998 @}
13999 @end smallexample
14000
14001 @item @code{_novlys}:
14002 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14003 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14004
14005 @end table
14006
14007 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14008 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14009 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14010 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14011 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14012 currently mapped.
14013
14014 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14015 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14016 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14017 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14018 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14019 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14020 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14021 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14022 are not being executed.
14023
14024 @node Overlay Sample Program
14025 @section Overlay Sample Program
14026 @cindex overlay example program
14027
14028 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14029 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14030 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14031 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14032 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14033 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14034 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14035
14036 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14037 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14038 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14039 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14040
14041 @table @file
14042 @item overlays.c
14043 The main program file.
14044 @item ovlymgr.c
14045 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14046 @item foo.c
14047 @itemx bar.c
14048 @itemx baz.c
14049 @itemx grbx.c
14050 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14051 @item d10v.ld
14052 @itemx m32r.ld
14053 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14054 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14055 @end table
14056
14057 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14058 cross-compiler like this:
14059
14060 @smallexample
14061 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14062 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14063 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14064 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14065 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14066 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14067 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14068 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14069 @end smallexample
14070
14071 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14072 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14073 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14074
14075
14076 @node Languages
14077 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14078 @cindex languages
14079
14080 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14081 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14082 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14083 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14084 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14085 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14086
14087 @cindex working language
14088 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14089 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14090 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14091 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14092 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14093 language}.
14094
14095 @menu
14096 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14097 * Show:: Displaying the language
14098 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14099 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14100 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14101 @end menu
14102
14103 @node Setting
14104 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14105
14106 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14107 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14108 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14109 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14110 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14111 are printed, etc.
14112
14113 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14114 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14115 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14116 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14117 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14118 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14119 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14120 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14121 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14122 Displaying the Language}.
14123
14124 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14125 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14126 another language. In that case, make the
14127 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14128 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14129 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14130
14131 @menu
14132 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14133 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14134 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14135 @end menu
14136
14137 @node Filenames
14138 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14139
14140 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14141 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14142
14143 @table @file
14144 @item .ada
14145 @itemx .ads
14146 @itemx .adb
14147 @itemx .a
14148 Ada source file.
14149
14150 @item .c
14151 C source file
14152
14153 @item .C
14154 @itemx .cc
14155 @itemx .cp
14156 @itemx .cpp
14157 @itemx .cxx
14158 @itemx .c++
14159 C@t{++} source file
14160
14161 @item .d
14162 D source file
14163
14164 @item .m
14165 Objective-C source file
14166
14167 @item .f
14168 @itemx .F
14169 Fortran source file
14170
14171 @item .mod
14172 Modula-2 source file
14173
14174 @item .s
14175 @itemx .S
14176 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14177 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14178 @end table
14179
14180 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14181 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14182
14183 @node Manually
14184 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14185
14186 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14187 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14188 your program.
14189
14190 @kindex set language
14191 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14192 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14193 a language, such as
14194 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14195 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14196
14197 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14198 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14199 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14200 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14201 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14202 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14203 command such as:
14204
14205 @smallexample
14206 print a = b + c
14207 @end smallexample
14208
14209 @noindent
14210 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14211 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14212 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14213 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14214
14215 @node Automatically
14216 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14217
14218 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14219 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14220 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14221 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14222 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14223 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14224 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14225 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14226 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14227
14228 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14229 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14230 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14231 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14232 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14233
14234 @node Show
14235 @section Displaying the Language
14236
14237 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14238 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14239
14240 @table @code
14241 @item show language
14242 @anchor{show language}
14243 @kindex show language
14244 Display the current working language. This is the
14245 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14246 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14247
14248 @item info frame
14249 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14250 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14251 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14252 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14253 information listed here.
14254
14255 @item info source
14256 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14257 Display the source language of this source file.
14258 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14259 information listed here.
14260 @end table
14261
14262 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14263 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14264 with a language explicitly:
14265
14266 @table @code
14267 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14268 @kindex set extension-language
14269 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14270 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14271
14272 @item info extensions
14273 @kindex info extensions
14274 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14275 @end table
14276
14277 @node Checks
14278 @section Type and Range Checking
14279
14280 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14281 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14282 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14283 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14284 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14285 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14286 errors when your program is running.
14287
14288 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14289 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14290 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14291 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14292
14293 @menu
14294 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14295 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14296 @end menu
14297
14298 @cindex type checking
14299 @cindex checks, type
14300 @node Type Checking
14301 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14302
14303 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14304 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14305 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14306 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14307
14308 @smallexample
14309 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14310
14311 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14312 $1 = 2
14313 @exdent but
14314 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14315 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14316 @end smallexample
14317
14318 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14319 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14320
14321 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14322 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14323 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14324 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14325 expressions like the second example above.
14326
14327 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14328 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14329 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14330 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14331 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14332 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14333
14334 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14335
14336 @kindex set check type
14337 @kindex show check type
14338 @table @code
14339 @item set check type on
14340 @itemx set check type off
14341 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14342 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14343 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14344
14345 @item show check type
14346 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14347 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14348 @end table
14349
14350 @cindex range checking
14351 @cindex checks, range
14352 @node Range Checking
14353 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14354
14355 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14356 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14357 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14358 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14359 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14360
14361 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14362 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14363 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14364 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14365
14366 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14367 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14368 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14369 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14370 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14371 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14372
14373 @smallexample
14374 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14375 @end smallexample
14376
14377 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14378 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14379 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14380
14381 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14382
14383 @kindex set check range
14384 @kindex show check range
14385 @table @code
14386 @item set check range auto
14387 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14388 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14389 each language.
14390
14391 @item set check range on
14392 @itemx set check range off
14393 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14394 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14395 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14396 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14397
14398 @item set check range warn
14399 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14400 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14401 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14402 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14403 systems).
14404
14405 @item show range
14406 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14407 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14408 @end table
14409
14410 @node Supported Languages
14411 @section Supported Languages
14412
14413 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14414 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14415 @c This is false ...
14416 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14417 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14418 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14419 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14420 language.
14421
14422 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14423 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14424 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14425 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14426 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14427 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14428 language reference or tutorial.
14429
14430 @menu
14431 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14432 * D:: D
14433 * Go:: Go
14434 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14435 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14436 * Fortran:: Fortran
14437 * Pascal:: Pascal
14438 * Rust:: Rust
14439 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14440 * Ada:: Ada
14441 @end menu
14442
14443 @node C
14444 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14445
14446 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14447 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14448
14449 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14450 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14451 together.
14452
14453 @cindex C@t{++}
14454 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14455 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14456 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14457 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14458 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14459 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14460 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14461
14462 @menu
14463 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14464 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14465 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14466 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14467 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14468 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14469 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14470 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14471 @end menu
14472
14473 @node C Operators
14474 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14475
14476 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14477
14478 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14479 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14480 often defined on groups of types.
14481
14482 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14483
14484 @itemize @bullet
14485
14486 @item
14487 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14488 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14489
14490 @item
14491 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14492 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14493
14494 @item
14495 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14496
14497 @item
14498 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14499
14500 @end itemize
14501
14502 @noindent
14503 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14504 in order of increasing precedence:
14505
14506 @table @code
14507 @item ,
14508 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14509 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14510 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14511
14512 @item =
14513 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14514 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14515
14516 @item @var{op}=
14517 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14518 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14519 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14520 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14521 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14522
14523 @item ?:
14524 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14525 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14526 should be of an integral type.
14527
14528 @item ||
14529 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14530
14531 @item &&
14532 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14533
14534 @item |
14535 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14536
14537 @item ^
14538 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14539
14540 @item &
14541 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14542
14543 @item ==@r{, }!=
14544 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14545 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14546
14547 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14548 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14549 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14550 and non-zero for true.
14551
14552 @item <<@r{, }>>
14553 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14554
14555 @item @@
14556 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14557
14558 @item +@r{, }-
14559 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14560 pointer types.
14561
14562 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14563 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14564 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14565 integral types.
14566
14567 @item ++@r{, }--
14568 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14569 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14570 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14571 operation takes place.
14572
14573 @item *
14574 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14575 @code{++}.
14576
14577 @item &
14578 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14579
14580 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14581 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14582 to examine the address
14583 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14584 stored.
14585
14586 @item -
14587 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14588 precedence as @code{++}.
14589
14590 @item !
14591 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14592 @code{++}.
14593
14594 @item ~
14595 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14596 @code{++}.
14597
14598
14599 @item .@r{, }->
14600 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14601 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14602 pointer based on the stored type information.
14603 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14604
14605 @item .*@r{, }->*
14606 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14607
14608 @item []
14609 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14610 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14611
14612 @item ()
14613 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14614
14615 @item ::
14616 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14617 and @code{class} types.
14618
14619 @item ::
14620 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14621 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14622 above.
14623 @end table
14624
14625 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14626 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14627 predefined meaning.
14628
14629 @node C Constants
14630 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14631
14632 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14633
14634 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14635 following ways:
14636
14637 @itemize @bullet
14638 @item
14639 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14640 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14641 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14642 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14643 @code{long} value.
14644
14645 @item
14646 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14647 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14648 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14649 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14650 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14651 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14652 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14653 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14654 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14655 constant.
14656
14657 @item
14658 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14659 integral equivalents.
14660
14661 @item
14662 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14663 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14664 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14665 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14666 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14667 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14668 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14669 @samp{\n} for newline.
14670
14671 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14672 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14673 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14674 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14675
14676 @item
14677 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14678 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14679 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14680 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14681 characters.
14682
14683 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14684 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14685 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14686
14687 @item
14688 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14689 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14690
14691 @item
14692 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14693 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14694 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14695 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14696 @end itemize
14697
14698 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14699 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14700
14701 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14702 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14703
14704 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14705 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14706 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14707 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14708 @quotation
14709 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14710 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14711 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14712 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14713 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14714 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14715 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14716 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14717 @end quotation
14718
14719 @enumerate
14720
14721 @cindex member functions
14722 @item
14723 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14724
14725 @smallexample
14726 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14727 @end smallexample
14728
14729 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14730 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14731 @item
14732 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14733 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14734 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14735 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14736 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14737
14738 @cindex call overloaded functions
14739 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14740 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14741 @item
14742 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14743 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14744 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14745 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14746 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14747 default arguments.
14748
14749 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14750 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14751 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14752 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14753 number of function arguments.
14754
14755 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14756 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14757 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14758
14759 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14760 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14761 @smallexample
14762 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14763 @end smallexample
14764
14765 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14766 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14767
14768 @cindex reference declarations
14769 @item
14770 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14771 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14772 dereferenced.
14773
14774 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14775 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14776 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14777 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14778 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14779
14780 @item
14781 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14782 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14783 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14784 necessary, for example in an expression like
14785 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14786 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14787 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14788
14789 @item
14790 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14791 specification.
14792 @end enumerate
14793
14794 @node C Defaults
14795 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14796
14797 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14798
14799 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14800 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14801 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14802 selects the working language.
14803
14804 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14805 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14806 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14807 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14808 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14809 for further details.
14810
14811 @node C Checks
14812 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14813
14814 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14815
14816 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14817 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14818 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14819 constants to pointers.
14820
14821 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14822 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14823 that is not itself an array.
14824
14825 @node Debugging C
14826 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14827
14828 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14829 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14830 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14831 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14832
14833 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14834 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14835 ,Expressions}.
14836
14837 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14838 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14839
14840 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14841
14842 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14843 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14844
14845 @table @code
14846 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14847 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14848 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14849 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14850 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14851 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14852
14853 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14854 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14855 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14856 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14857 classes.
14858 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14859
14860 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14861 @item catch throw
14862 @itemx catch rethrow
14863 @itemx catch catch
14864 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14865 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14866
14867 @cindex inheritance
14868 @item ptype @var{typename}
14869 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14870 @var{typename}.
14871 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14872
14873 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14874 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14875 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14876 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14877 multiple inheritance is in use.
14878
14879 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14880 @item demangle @var{name}
14881 Demangle @var{name}.
14882 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14883
14884 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14885 @item set print demangle
14886 @itemx show print demangle
14887 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14888 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14889 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14890 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14891 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14892
14893 @item set print object
14894 @itemx show print object
14895 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14896 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14897
14898 @item set print vtbl
14899 @itemx show print vtbl
14900 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14901 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14902 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14903 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14904
14905 @kindex set overload-resolution
14906 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14907 @item set overload-resolution on
14908 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14909 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14910 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14911 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14912 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14913 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14914
14915 @item set overload-resolution off
14916 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14917 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14918 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14919 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14920 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14921 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14922 argument types.
14923
14924 @kindex show overload-resolution
14925 @item show overload-resolution
14926 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14927
14928 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14929 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14930 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14931 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14932 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14933 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14934 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14935 @end table
14936
14937 @node Decimal Floating Point
14938 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14939 @cindex decimal floating point format
14940
14941 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14942 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14943 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14944 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14945
14946 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14947 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14948 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14949 configured target.
14950
14951 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14952 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14953 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14954
14955 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14956 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14957 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14958
14959 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14960 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14961 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14962
14963 @node D
14964 @subsection D
14965
14966 @cindex D
14967 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14968 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14969 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14970
14971 @node Go
14972 @subsection Go
14973
14974 @cindex Go (programming language)
14975 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14976 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14977
14978 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14979
14980 @table @code
14981 @cindex current Go package
14982 @item The current Go package
14983 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14984 specifying global variables and functions.
14985
14986 For example, given the program:
14987
14988 @example
14989 package main
14990 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14991 func main () @{
14992 // ...
14993 @}
14994 @end example
14995
14996 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14997
14998 @example
14999 (gdb) p myglob
15000 (gdb) p main.myglob
15001 @end example
15002
15003 @cindex builtin Go types
15004 @item Builtin Go types
15005 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15006 as a string.
15007
15008 @cindex builtin Go functions
15009 @item Builtin Go functions
15010 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15011 function and handles it internally.
15012
15013 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15014 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15015 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15016 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15017 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15018 @end table
15019
15020 @node Objective-C
15021 @subsection Objective-C
15022
15023 @cindex Objective-C
15024 This section provides information about some commands and command
15025 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15026 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15027 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15028
15029 @menu
15030 * Method Names in Commands::
15031 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15032 @end menu
15033
15034 @node Method Names in Commands
15035 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15036
15037 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15038 names as line specifications:
15039
15040 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15041 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15042 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15043 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15044 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15045 @itemize
15046 @item @code{clear}
15047 @item @code{break}
15048 @item @code{info line}
15049 @item @code{jump}
15050 @item @code{list}
15051 @end itemize
15052
15053 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15054
15055 @smallexample
15056 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15057 @end smallexample
15058
15059 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15060 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15061 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15062 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15063 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15064 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15065 debugged, enter:
15066
15067 @smallexample
15068 break -[Fruit create]
15069 @end smallexample
15070
15071 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15072 enter:
15073
15074 @smallexample
15075 list +[NSText initialize]
15076 @end smallexample
15077
15078 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15079 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15080 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15081 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15082
15083 @smallexample
15084 break create
15085 @end smallexample
15086
15087 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15088 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15089 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15090 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15091 none apply.
15092
15093 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15094 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15095
15096 @smallexample
15097 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15098 @end smallexample
15099
15100 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15101 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15102 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15103 @kindex print-object
15104 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15105
15106 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15107
15108 @smallexample
15109 print -[@var{object} hash]
15110 @end smallexample
15111
15112 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15113 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15114 @noindent
15115 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15116 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15117 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15118 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15119 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15120 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15121
15122 @node OpenCL C
15123 @subsection OpenCL C
15124
15125 @cindex OpenCL C
15126 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15127
15128 @menu
15129 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15130 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15131 * OpenCL C Operators::
15132 @end menu
15133
15134 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15135 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15136
15137 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15138 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15139 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15140 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15141 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15142
15143 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15144 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15145
15146 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15147 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15148 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15149 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15150
15151 @node OpenCL C Operators
15152 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15153
15154 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15155 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15156 vector data types.
15157
15158 @node Fortran
15159 @subsection Fortran
15160 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15161
15162 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15163 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15164
15165 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15166 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15167 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15168 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15169 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15170 underscore.
15171
15172 @menu
15173 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15174 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15175 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15176 @end menu
15177
15178 @node Fortran Operators
15179 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15180
15181 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15182
15183 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15184 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15185 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15186
15187 @table @code
15188 @item **
15189 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15190 of the second one.
15191
15192 @item :
15193 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15194 represent a section of array.
15195
15196 @item %
15197 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15198 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15199 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15200 union type.
15201 @end table
15202
15203 @node Fortran Defaults
15204 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15205
15206 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15207
15208 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15209 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15210 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15211 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15212
15213 @node Special Fortran Commands
15214 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15215
15216 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15217
15218 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15219 such as displaying common blocks.
15220
15221 @table @code
15222 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15223 @kindex info common
15224 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15225 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15226 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15227 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15228 printed.
15229 @end table
15230
15231 @node Pascal
15232 @subsection Pascal
15233
15234 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15235 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15236 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15237 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15238 syntax.
15239
15240 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15241 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15242 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15243
15244 @node Rust
15245 @subsection Rust
15246
15247 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15248 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15249 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15250 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15251
15252 @itemize @bullet
15253 @item
15254 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15255 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15256 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15257
15258 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15259 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15260 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15261 @samp{B}.
15262
15263 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15264 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15265
15266 @item
15267 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15268 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15269 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15270 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15271 @samp{K::x::y}.
15272
15273 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15274 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15275 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15276 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15277 scope.
15278
15279 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15280 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15281
15282 @item
15283 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15284 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15285
15286 @item
15287 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15288
15289 @item
15290 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15291 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15292 never be destroyed.
15293
15294 @item
15295 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15296 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15297 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15298
15299 @item
15300 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15301 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15302 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15303 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15304 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15305 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15306 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15307 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15308
15309 @item
15310 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15311 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15312 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15313 @itemize @bullet
15314
15315 @item
15316 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15317
15318 @item
15319 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15320
15321 @item
15322 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15323
15324 @item
15325 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15326 type names.
15327
15328 @item
15329 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15330
15331 @item
15332 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15333 available in the crate.
15334 @end itemize
15335 @end itemize
15336
15337 @node Modula-2
15338 @subsection Modula-2
15339
15340 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15341
15342 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15343 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15344 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15345 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15346 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15347 table.
15348
15349 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15350 @menu
15351 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15352 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15353 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15354 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15355 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15356 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15357 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15358 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15359 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15360 @end menu
15361
15362 @node M2 Operators
15363 @subsubsection Operators
15364 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15365
15366 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15367 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15368 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15369 following definitions hold:
15370
15371 @itemize @bullet
15372
15373 @item
15374 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15375 their subranges.
15376
15377 @item
15378 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15379
15380 @item
15381 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15382
15383 @item
15384 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15385 @var{type}}.
15386
15387 @item
15388 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15389
15390 @item
15391 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15392
15393 @item
15394 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15395 @end itemize
15396
15397 @noindent
15398 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15399 increasing precedence:
15400
15401 @table @code
15402 @item ,
15403 Function argument or array index separator.
15404
15405 @item :=
15406 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15407 @var{value}.
15408
15409 @item <@r{, }>
15410 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15411 types.
15412
15413 @item <=@r{, }>=
15414 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15415 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15416 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15417
15418 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15419 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15420 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15421 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15422 comment character.
15423
15424 @item IN
15425 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15426 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15427
15428 @item OR
15429 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15430
15431 @item AND@r{, }&
15432 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15433
15434 @item @@
15435 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15436
15437 @item +@r{, }-
15438 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15439 and difference on set types.
15440
15441 @item *
15442 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15443 on set types.
15444
15445 @item /
15446 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15447 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15448
15449 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15450 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15451 precedence as @code{*}.
15452
15453 @item -
15454 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15455
15456 @item ^
15457 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15458
15459 @item NOT
15460 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15461 @code{^}.
15462
15463 @item .
15464 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15465 precedence as @code{^}.
15466
15467 @item []
15468 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15469
15470 @item ()
15471 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15472 as @code{^}.
15473
15474 @item ::@r{, }.
15475 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15476 @end table
15477
15478 @quotation
15479 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15480 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15481 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15482 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15483 @end quotation
15484
15485
15486 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15487 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15488 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15489
15490 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15491 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15492
15493 @table @var
15494
15495 @item a
15496 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15497
15498 @item c
15499 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15500
15501 @item i
15502 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15503
15504 @item m
15505 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15506 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15507 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15508
15509 @item n
15510 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15511
15512 @item r
15513 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15514
15515 @item t
15516 represents a type.
15517
15518 @item v
15519 represents a variable.
15520
15521 @item x
15522 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15523 explanation of the function for details.
15524 @end table
15525
15526 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15527
15528 @table @code
15529 @item ABS(@var{n})
15530 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15531
15532 @item CAP(@var{c})
15533 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15534 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15535
15536 @item CHR(@var{i})
15537 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15538
15539 @item DEC(@var{v})
15540 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15541
15542 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15543 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15544 new value.
15545
15546 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15547 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15548 set.
15549
15550 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15551 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15552
15553 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15554 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15555
15556 @item INC(@var{v})
15557 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15558
15559 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15560 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15561 new value.
15562
15563 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15564 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15565 there. Returns the new set.
15566
15567 @item MAX(@var{t})
15568 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15569
15570 @item MIN(@var{t})
15571 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15572
15573 @item ODD(@var{i})
15574 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15575
15576 @item ORD(@var{x})
15577 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15578 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15579 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15580 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15581
15582 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15583 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15584 variable or a type.
15585
15586 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15587 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15588
15589 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15590 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15591 variable or a type.
15592
15593 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15594 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15595 @end table
15596
15597 @quotation
15598 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15599 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15600 an error.
15601 @end quotation
15602
15603 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15604 @node M2 Constants
15605 @subsubsection Constants
15606
15607 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15608 ways:
15609
15610 @itemize @bullet
15611
15612 @item
15613 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15614 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15615 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15616 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15617
15618 @item
15619 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15620 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15621 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15622 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15623 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15624 digits.
15625
15626 @item
15627 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15628 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15629 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15630 followed by a @samp{C}.
15631
15632 @item
15633 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15634 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15635 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15636 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15637 sequences.
15638
15639 @item
15640 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15641
15642 @item
15643 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15644 @code{FALSE}.
15645
15646 @item
15647 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15648
15649 @item
15650 Set constants are not yet supported.
15651 @end itemize
15652
15653 @node M2 Types
15654 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15655 @cindex Modula-2 types
15656
15657 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15658 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15659 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15660 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15661 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15662 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15663
15664 The first example contains the following section of code:
15665
15666 @smallexample
15667 VAR
15668 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15669 r: [20..40] ;
15670 @end smallexample
15671
15672 @noindent
15673 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15674 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15675
15676 @smallexample
15677 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15678 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15679 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15680 SET OF CHAR
15681 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15682 21
15683 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15684 [20..40]
15685 @end smallexample
15686
15687 @noindent
15688 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15689
15690 @smallexample
15691 VAR
15692 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15693 @end smallexample
15694
15695 @noindent
15696 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15697
15698 @smallexample
15699 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15700 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15701 @end smallexample
15702
15703 @noindent
15704 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15705 expressions using the debugger.
15706
15707 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15708 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15709
15710 @smallexample
15711 VAR
15712 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15713 @end smallexample
15714
15715 @smallexample
15716 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15717 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15718 @end smallexample
15719
15720 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15721 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15722 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15723 above.
15724
15725 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15726
15727 @smallexample
15728 TYPE
15729 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15730 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15731 VAR
15732 s: t ;
15733 BEGIN
15734 s := blue ;
15735 @end smallexample
15736
15737 @noindent
15738 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15739 and value of a variable.
15740
15741 @smallexample
15742 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15743 $1 = blue
15744 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15745 type = [blue..yellow]
15746 @end smallexample
15747
15748 @noindent
15749 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15750 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15751 their @code{C} counterparts.
15752
15753 @smallexample
15754 VAR
15755 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15756 BEGIN
15757 s[1] := 1 ;
15758 @end smallexample
15759
15760 @smallexample
15761 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15762 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15763 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15764 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15765 @end smallexample
15766
15767 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15768 pointer types as shown in this example:
15769
15770 @smallexample
15771 VAR
15772 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15773 BEGIN
15774 NEW(s) ;
15775 s^[1] := 1 ;
15776 @end smallexample
15777
15778 @noindent
15779 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15780
15781 @smallexample
15782 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15783 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15784 @end smallexample
15785
15786 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15787 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15788 types:
15789
15790 @smallexample
15791 TYPE
15792 foo = RECORD
15793 f1: CARDINAL ;
15794 f2: CHAR ;
15795 f3: myarray ;
15796 END ;
15797
15798 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15799 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15800 VAR
15801 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15802 @end smallexample
15803
15804 @noindent
15805 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15806 below.
15807
15808 @smallexample
15809 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15810 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15811 f1 : CARDINAL;
15812 f2 : CHAR;
15813 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15814 END
15815 @end smallexample
15816
15817 @node M2 Defaults
15818 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15819 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15820
15821 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15822 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15823 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15824 selected the working language.
15825
15826 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15827 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15828 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15829 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15830
15831 @node Deviations
15832 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15833 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15834
15835 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15836 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15837
15838 @itemize @bullet
15839 @item
15840 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15841 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15842 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15843 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15844 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15845 returned a pointer.)
15846
15847 @item
15848 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15849 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15850 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15851 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15852
15853 @item
15854 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15855 argument.
15856
15857 @item
15858 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15859 @end itemize
15860
15861 @node M2 Checks
15862 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15863 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15864
15865 @quotation
15866 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15867 range checking.
15868 @end quotation
15869 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15870
15871 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15872
15873 @itemize @bullet
15874 @item
15875 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15876 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15877
15878 @item
15879 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15880 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15881 @end itemize
15882
15883 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15884 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15885
15886 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15887 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15888
15889 @node M2 Scope
15890 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15891 @cindex scope
15892 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15893 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15894 @ifinfo
15895 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15896 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15897 @end ifinfo
15898 @ifnotinfo
15899 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15900 @end ifnotinfo
15901
15902 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15903 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15904 similar syntax:
15905
15906 @smallexample
15907
15908 @var{module} . @var{id}
15909 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15910 @end smallexample
15911
15912 @noindent
15913 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15914 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15915 identifier within your program, except another module.
15916
15917 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15918 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15919 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15920 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15921
15922 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15923 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15924 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15925 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15926 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15927 @var{module}.
15928
15929 @node GDB/M2
15930 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15931
15932 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15933 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15934 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15935 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15936 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15937 analogue in Modula-2.
15938
15939 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15940 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15941 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15942 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15943 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15944 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15945
15946 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15947 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15948 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15949
15950 @node Ada
15951 @subsection Ada
15952 @cindex Ada
15953
15954 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15955 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15956 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15957 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15958 to be difficult.
15959
15960
15961 @cindex expressions in Ada
15962 @menu
15963 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15964 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15965 in @value{GDBN}.
15966 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15967 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15968 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15969 subprograms.
15970 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15971 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15972 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15973 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15974 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15975 Profile
15976 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15977 @end menu
15978
15979 @node Ada Mode Intro
15980 @subsubsection Introduction
15981 @cindex Ada mode, general
15982
15983 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15984 syntax, with some extensions.
15985 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15986
15987 @itemize @bullet
15988 @item
15989 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15990 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15991 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15992 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15993
15994 @item
15995 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15996 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15997
15998 @item
15999 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16000 @end itemize
16001
16002 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16003 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16004 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16005 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16006 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16007
16008 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16009 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16010 was translated from an Ada source file.
16011
16012 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16013 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16014 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16015 middle (to allow based literals).
16016
16017 @node Omissions from Ada
16018 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16019 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16020
16021 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16022
16023 @itemize @bullet
16024 @item
16025 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16026
16027 @itemize @minus
16028 @item
16029 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16030 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16031
16032 @item
16033 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16034
16035 @item
16036 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16037
16038 @item
16039 @t{'Tag}.
16040
16041 @item
16042 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16043 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16044
16045 @item
16046 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16047 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16048
16049 @item
16050 @t{'Address}.
16051 @end itemize
16052
16053 @item
16054 The names in
16055 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16056 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16057 not currently available.
16058
16059 @item
16060 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16061 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16062 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16063 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16064 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16065 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16066 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16067 indeterminate values.
16068
16069 @item
16070 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16071 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16072 are not implemented.
16073
16074 @item
16075 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16076 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16077 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16078 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16079 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16080
16081 @smallexample
16082 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16083 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16084 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16085 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16086 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16087 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16088 @end smallexample
16089
16090 Changing a
16091 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16092 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16093 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16094 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16095 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16096 declared to have a type such as:
16097
16098 @smallexample
16099 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16100 Id : Integer;
16101 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16102 end record;
16103 @end smallexample
16104
16105 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16106 assignments:
16107
16108 @smallexample
16109 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16110 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16111 @end smallexample
16112
16113 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16114 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16115 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16116 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16117 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16118 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16119 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16120 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16121
16122 @item
16123 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16124
16125 @item
16126 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16127 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16128 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16129 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16130 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16131 the proper resolution.
16132
16133 @item
16134 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16135
16136 @item
16137 Entry calls are not implemented.
16138
16139 @item
16140 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16141 formats are not supported.
16142
16143 @item
16144 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16145
16146 @item
16147 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16148 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16149 context.
16150 Should your program
16151 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16152 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16153 @end itemize
16154
16155 @node Additions to Ada
16156 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16157 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16158
16159 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16160 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16161
16162 @itemize @bullet
16163 @item
16164 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16165 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16166 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16167 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16168 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16169 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16170 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16171 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16172
16173 @item
16174 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16175 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16176 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16177
16178 @item
16179 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16180 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16181
16182 @item
16183 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16184 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16185 @end itemize
16186
16187 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16188 additions specific to Ada:
16189
16190 @itemize @bullet
16191 @item
16192 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16193 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16194
16195 @smallexample
16196 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16197 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16198 @end smallexample
16199
16200 @item
16201 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16202 the value of its right-hand operand.
16203 This allows, for example,
16204 complex conditional breaks:
16205
16206 @smallexample
16207 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16208 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16209 @end smallexample
16210
16211 @item
16212 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16213 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16214 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16215 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16216 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16217 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16218 in strings. For example,
16219 @smallexample
16220 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16221 @end smallexample
16222 @noindent
16223 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16224 after each period.
16225
16226 @item
16227 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16228 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16229 to write
16230
16231 @smallexample
16232 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16233 @end smallexample
16234
16235 @item
16236 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16237 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16238 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16239 of 3 might print as
16240
16241 @smallexample
16242 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16243 @end smallexample
16244
16245 @noindent
16246 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16247 clause.
16248
16249 @item
16250 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16251 multi-character subsequence of
16252 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16253 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16254 in place of @t{a'length}.
16255
16256 @item
16257 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16258 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16259 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16260 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16261 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16262 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16263 For example,
16264 @smallexample
16265 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16266 @end smallexample
16267
16268 @item
16269 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16270 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16271 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16272 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16273 object.
16274
16275 @end itemize
16276
16277 @node Overloading support for Ada
16278 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16279 @cindex overloading, Ada
16280
16281 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16282 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16283 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16284 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16285 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16286 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16287
16288 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16289 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16290 use, for instance:
16291
16292 @smallexample
16293 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16294 Multiple matches for f
16295 [0] cancel
16296 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16297 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16298 >
16299 @end smallexample
16300
16301 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16302 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16303 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16304
16305 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16306 case:
16307
16308 @table @code
16309
16310 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16311 @item set ada print-signatures
16312 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16313 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16314 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16315
16316 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16317 @item show ada print-signatures
16318 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16319 overloads selection menu.
16320 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16321
16322 @end table
16323
16324 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16325 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16326
16327 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16328 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16329 before reaching the main procedure.
16330 As defined in the Ada Reference
16331 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16332 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16333 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16334 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16335
16336 @node Ada Exceptions
16337 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16338
16339 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16340
16341 @table @code
16342 @kindex info exceptions
16343 @item info exceptions
16344 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16345 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16346 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16347 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16348 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16349 @end table
16350
16351 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16352 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16353 argument.
16354
16355 @smallexample
16356 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16357 All defined Ada exceptions:
16358 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16359 program_error: 0x613d20
16360 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16361 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16362 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16363 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16364 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16365 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16366 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16367 @end smallexample
16368
16369 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16370 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16371
16372 @node Ada Tasks
16373 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16374 @cindex Ada, tasking
16375
16376 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16377 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16378
16379 @table @code
16380 @kindex info tasks
16381 @item info tasks
16382 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16383
16384
16385 @smallexample
16386 @iftex
16387 @leftskip=0.5cm
16388 @end iftex
16389 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16390 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16391 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16392 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16393 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16394 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16395
16396 @end smallexample
16397
16398 @noindent
16399 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16400 task currently being inspected.
16401
16402 @table @asis
16403 @item ID
16404 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16405
16406 @item TID
16407 The Ada task ID.
16408
16409 @item P-ID
16410 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16411
16412 @item Pri
16413 The base priority of the task.
16414
16415 @item State
16416 Current state of the task.
16417
16418 @table @code
16419 @item Unactivated
16420 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16421 executing.
16422
16423 @item Runnable
16424 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16425 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16426
16427 @item Terminated
16428 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16429 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16430 terminated themselves.
16431
16432 @item Child Activation Wait
16433 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16434
16435 @item Accept Statement
16436 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16437
16438 @item Waiting on entry call
16439 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16440
16441 @item Async Select Wait
16442 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16443 select statement.
16444
16445 @item Delay Sleep
16446 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16447 alternative open.
16448
16449 @item Child Termination Wait
16450 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16451 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16452 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16453
16454 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16455 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16456 finish terminating.
16457
16458 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16459 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16460 @end table
16461
16462 @item Name
16463 Name of the task in the program.
16464
16465 @end table
16466
16467 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16468 @item info task @var{taskno}
16469 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16470 the following example:
16471 @smallexample
16472 @iftex
16473 @leftskip=0.5cm
16474 @end iftex
16475 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16476 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16477 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16478 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16479 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16480 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16481 Name: task_1
16482 Thread: 0x807f378
16483 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16484 Base Priority: 15
16485 State: Runnable
16486 @end smallexample
16487
16488 @item task
16489 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16490 @cindex current Ada task ID
16491 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16492
16493 @smallexample
16494 @iftex
16495 @leftskip=0.5cm
16496 @end iftex
16497 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16498 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16499 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16500 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16501 (@value{GDBP}) task
16502 [Current task is 2]
16503 @end smallexample
16504
16505 @item task @var{taskno}
16506 @cindex Ada task switching
16507 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16508 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16509 from the current task to the given task.
16510
16511 @smallexample
16512 @iftex
16513 @leftskip=0.5cm
16514 @end iftex
16515 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16516 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16517 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16518 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16519 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16520 [Switching to task 1]
16521 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16522 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16523 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16524 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16525 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16526 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16527 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16528 @end smallexample
16529
16530 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16531 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16532 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16533 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16534 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16535 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16536 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16537 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16538 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16539
16540 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16541 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16542 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16543 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16544 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16545
16546 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16547 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16548 program.
16549
16550 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16551 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16552 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16553
16554 For example,
16555
16556 @smallexample
16557 @iftex
16558 @leftskip=0.5cm
16559 @end iftex
16560 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16561 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16562 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16563 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16564 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16565 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16566 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16567 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16568 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16569 Continuing.
16570 task # 1 running
16571 task # 2 running
16572
16573 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16574 15 flush;
16575 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16576 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16577 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16578 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16579 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16580 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16581 @end smallexample
16582 @end table
16583
16584 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16585 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16586 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16587
16588 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16589 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16590 the platform being used.
16591 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16592 switching is not supported.
16593
16594 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16595 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16596 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16597 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16598 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16599 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16600
16601 @node Ravenscar Profile
16602 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16603 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16604
16605 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16606 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16607 requirements.
16608
16609 @table @code
16610 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16611 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16612 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16613 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16614 Profile. This is the default.
16615
16616 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16617 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16618 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16619 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16620 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16621 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16622 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16623
16624 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16625 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16626 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16627 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16628
16629 @end table
16630
16631 @node Ada Glitches
16632 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16633 @cindex Ada, problems
16634
16635 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16636 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16637 @value{GDBN},
16638 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16639 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16640
16641 @itemize @bullet
16642 @item
16643 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16644 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16645
16646 @item
16647 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16648 argument lists are treated as positional).
16649
16650 @item
16651 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16652
16653 @item
16654 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16655 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16656 the host machine.
16657
16658 @item
16659 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16660 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16661 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16662 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16663 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16664 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16665 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16666 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16667 you can usually resolve the confusion
16668 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16669 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16670 @end itemize
16671
16672 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16673 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16674 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16675 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16676 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16677 enabled.
16678
16679 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16680 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16681 @table @code
16682
16683 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16684 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16685 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16686 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16687 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16688 This is the default.
16689
16690 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16691 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16692 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16693 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16694 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16695 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16696 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16697
16698 @end table
16699
16700 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16701 @cindex GNAT encoding
16702 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16703 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16704 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16705 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16706 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16707 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16708
16709 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16710 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16711 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16712 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16713 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16714 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16715 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16716 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16717
16718 @table @code
16719
16720 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16721 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16722 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16723 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16724
16725 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16726 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16727 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16728
16729 @end table
16730
16731 @node Unsupported Languages
16732 @section Unsupported Languages
16733
16734 @cindex unsupported languages
16735 @cindex minimal language
16736 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16737 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16738 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16739 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16740 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16741 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16742
16743 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16744 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16745 language.
16746
16747 @node Symbols
16748 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16749
16750 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16751 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16752 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16753 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16754 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16755 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16756 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16757
16758 @cindex symbol names
16759 @cindex names of symbols
16760 @cindex quoting names
16761 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16762 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16763 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16764 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16765 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16766 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16767 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16768 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16769
16770 @smallexample
16771 p 'foo.c'::x
16772 @end smallexample
16773
16774 @noindent
16775 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16776
16777 @table @code
16778 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16779 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16780 @kindex set case-sensitive
16781 @item set case-sensitive on
16782 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16783 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16784 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16785 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16786 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16787 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16788 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16789 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16790 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16791 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16792 case-insensitive matches.
16793
16794 @kindex show case-sensitive
16795 @item show case-sensitive
16796 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16797 lookups.
16798
16799 @kindex set print type methods
16800 @item set print type methods
16801 @itemx set print type methods on
16802 @itemx set print type methods off
16803 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16804 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16805 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16806 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16807 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16808 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16809
16810 @kindex show print type methods
16811 @item show print type methods
16812 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16813 classes.
16814
16815 @kindex set print type typedefs
16816 @item set print type typedefs
16817 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16818 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16819
16820 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16821 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16822 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16823 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16824 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16825 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16826 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16827 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16828 types.
16829
16830 @kindex show print type typedefs
16831 @item show print type typedefs
16832 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16833 printing classes.
16834
16835 @kindex info address
16836 @cindex address of a symbol
16837 @item info address @var{symbol}
16838 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16839 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16840 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16841 is always stored.
16842
16843 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16844 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16845 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16846
16847 @kindex info symbol
16848 @cindex symbol from address
16849 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16850 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16851 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16852 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16853 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16854
16855 @smallexample
16856 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16857 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16858 @end smallexample
16859
16860 @noindent
16861 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16862 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16863
16864 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16865 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16866
16867 @smallexample
16868 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16869 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16870 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16871 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16872 @end smallexample
16873
16874 @kindex demangle
16875 @cindex demangle
16876 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16877 Demangle @var{name}.
16878 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16879 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16880
16881 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16882 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16883
16884 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16885 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16886
16887 @kindex whatis
16888 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16889 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16890 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16891 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16892
16893 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16894 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16895 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16896
16897 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16898 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16899 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16900 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16901 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16902 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16903 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16904 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16905 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16906
16907 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16908 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16909 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16910 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16911 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16912 unroll it.
16913
16914 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16915 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16916 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16917
16918 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16919 Available flags are:
16920
16921 @table @code
16922 @item r
16923 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16924 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16925 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16926
16927 @item m
16928 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16929
16930 @item M
16931 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16932 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16933
16934 @item t
16935 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16936 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16937 names are substituted when printing other types.
16938
16939 @item T
16940 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16941 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16942 @end table
16943
16944 @kindex ptype
16945 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16946 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16947 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16948 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16949
16950 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16951 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16952 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16953 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16954 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16955 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16956 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16957 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16958
16959 For example, for this variable declaration:
16960
16961 @smallexample
16962 typedef double real_t;
16963 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16964 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16965 complex_t var;
16966 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16967 @end smallexample
16968
16969 @noindent
16970 the two commands give this output:
16971
16972 @smallexample
16973 @group
16974 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16975 type = complex_t
16976 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16977 type = struct complex @{
16978 real_t real;
16979 double imag;
16980 @}
16981 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16982 type = struct complex
16983 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16984 type = struct complex
16985 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16986 type = struct complex @{
16987 real_t real;
16988 double imag;
16989 @}
16990 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16991 type = real_t *
16992 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16993 type = double *
16994 @end group
16995 @end smallexample
16996
16997 @noindent
16998 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16999 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17000
17001 @cindex incomplete type
17002 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17003 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17004 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17005 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17006 given these declarations:
17007
17008 @smallexample
17009 struct foo;
17010 struct foo *fooptr;
17011 @end smallexample
17012
17013 @noindent
17014 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17015
17016 @smallexample
17017 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17018 $1 = <incomplete type>
17019 @end smallexample
17020
17021 @noindent
17022 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17023 completely specified.
17024
17025 @kindex info types
17026 @item info types @var{regexp}
17027 @itemx info types
17028 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17029 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17030 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17031 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17032 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17033 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17034 name is @code{value}.
17035
17036 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17037 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17038 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17039
17040 @kindex info type-printers
17041 @item info type-printers
17042 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17043 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17044 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17045 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17046 type printers.
17047
17048 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17049
17050 @kindex enable type-printer
17051 @kindex disable type-printer
17052 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17053 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17054 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17055
17056 @kindex info scope
17057 @cindex local variables
17058 @item info scope @var{location}
17059 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17060 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17061 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17062 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17063 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17064
17065 @smallexample
17066 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17067 Scope for command_line_handler:
17068 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17069 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17070 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17071 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17072 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17073 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17074 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17075 @end smallexample
17076
17077 @noindent
17078 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17079 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17080 collect}.
17081
17082 @kindex info source
17083 @item info source
17084 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17085 the function containing the current point of execution:
17086 @itemize @bullet
17087 @item
17088 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17089 @item
17090 the directory it was compiled in,
17091 @item
17092 its length, in lines,
17093 @item
17094 which programming language it is written in,
17095 @item
17096 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17097 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17098 @item
17099 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17100 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17101 @item
17102 whether the debugging information includes information about
17103 preprocessor macros.
17104 @end itemize
17105
17106
17107 @kindex info sources
17108 @item info sources
17109 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17110 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17111 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17112
17113 @kindex info functions
17114 @item info functions
17115 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17116
17117 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17118 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17119 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17120 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17121 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17122 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17123 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17124 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17125
17126 @kindex info variables
17127 @item info variables
17128 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17129 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17130
17131 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17132 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17133 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17134 @var{regexp}.
17135
17136 @kindex info classes
17137 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17138 @item info classes
17139 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17140 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17141 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17142 expression.
17143
17144 @kindex info selectors
17145 @item info selectors
17146 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17147 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17148 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17149 expression.
17150
17151 @ignore
17152 This was never implemented.
17153 @kindex info methods
17154 @item info methods
17155 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17156 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17157 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17158 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17159 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17160 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17161 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17162 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17163 @end ignore
17164
17165 @cindex opaque data types
17166 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17167 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17168 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17169 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17170 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17171 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17172 another source file. The default is on.
17173
17174 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17175 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17176
17177 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17178 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17179 is printed as follows:
17180 @smallexample
17181 @{<no data fields>@}
17182 @end smallexample
17183
17184 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17185 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17186 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17187
17188 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17189 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17190 @item set print symbol-loading
17191 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17192 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17193 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17194 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17195 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17196 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17197 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17198 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17199 can be annoying.
17200 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17201 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17202 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17203 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17204
17205 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17206 @item show print symbol-loading
17207 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17208 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17209
17210 @kindex maint print symbols
17211 @cindex symbol dump
17212 @kindex maint print psymbols
17213 @cindex partial symbol dump
17214 @kindex maint print msymbols
17215 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17216 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
17217 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
17218 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
17219 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
17220 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
17221 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
17222 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
17223 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
17224 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
17225 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
17226 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
17227 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
17228 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
17229 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
17230 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
17231 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17232 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17233
17234 @kindex maint info symtabs
17235 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17236 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17237 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17238 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17239 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17240 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17241 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17242
17243 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17244 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17245 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17246 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17247 structure in more detail. For example:
17248
17249 @smallexample
17250 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17251 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17252 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17253 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17254 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17255 readin no
17256 fullname (null)
17257 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17258 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17259 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17260 dependencies (none)
17261 @}
17262 @}
17263 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17264 (@value{GDBP})
17265 @end smallexample
17266 @noindent
17267 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17268 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17269 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17270 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17271 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17272
17273 @smallexample
17274 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17275 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17276 line 1574.
17277 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17278 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17279 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17280 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17281 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17282 dirname (null)
17283 fullname (null)
17284 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17285 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17286 debugformat DWARF 2
17287 @}
17288 @}
17289 (@value{GDBP})
17290 @end smallexample
17291
17292 @kindex maint info line-table
17293 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17294 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17295 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17296
17297 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17298 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17299 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17300
17301 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17302 @cindex symbol cache size
17303 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17304 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17305 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17306 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17307 with different sizes.
17308
17309 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17310 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17311 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17312
17313 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17314 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17315 @item maint print symbol-cache
17316 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17317 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17318
17319 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17320 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17321 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17322 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17323 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17324
17325 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17326 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17327 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17328 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17329 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17330 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17331
17332 @end table
17333
17334 @node Altering
17335 @chapter Altering Execution
17336
17337 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17338 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17339 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17340 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17341 program.
17342
17343 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17344 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17345 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17346
17347 @menu
17348 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17349 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17350 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17351 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17352 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17353 * Patching:: Patching your program
17354 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17355 @end menu
17356
17357 @node Assignment
17358 @section Assignment to Variables
17359
17360 @cindex assignment
17361 @cindex setting variables
17362 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17363 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17364
17365 @smallexample
17366 print x=4
17367 @end smallexample
17368
17369 @noindent
17370 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17371 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17372 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17373 information on operators in supported languages.
17374
17375 @kindex set variable
17376 @cindex variables, setting
17377 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17378 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17379 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17380 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17381 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17382
17383 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17384 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17385 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17386 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17387 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17388 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17389 command @code{set width}:
17390
17391 @smallexample
17392 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17393 type = double
17394 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17395 $4 = 13
17396 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17397 Invalid syntax in expression.
17398 @end smallexample
17399
17400 @noindent
17401 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17402 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17403
17404 @smallexample
17405 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17406 @end smallexample
17407
17408 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17409 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17410 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17411 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17412 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17413 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17414
17415 @smallexample
17416 @group
17417 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17418 type = double
17419 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17420 $1 = 1
17421 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17422 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17423 $2 = 1
17424 (@value{GDBP}) r
17425 The program being debugged has been started already.
17426 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17427 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17428 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17429 Invalid bfd target.
17430 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17431 The current BFD target is "=4".
17432 @end group
17433 @end smallexample
17434
17435 @noindent
17436 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17437 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17438 @code{g}, use
17439
17440 @smallexample
17441 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17442 @end smallexample
17443
17444 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17445 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17446 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17447 same length or shorter.
17448 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17449 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17450
17451 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17452 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17453 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17454 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17455 and representation in memory), and
17456
17457 @smallexample
17458 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17459 @end smallexample
17460
17461 @noindent
17462 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17463
17464 @node Jumping
17465 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17466
17467 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17468 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17469 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17470
17471 @table @code
17472 @kindex jump
17473 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17474 @item jump @var{location}
17475 @itemx j @var{location}
17476 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17477 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17478 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17479 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17480 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17481
17482 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17483 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17484 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17485 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17486 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17487 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17488 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17489 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17490 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17491 @end table
17492
17493 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17494 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17495 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17496 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17497 example,
17498
17499 @smallexample
17500 set $pc = 0x485
17501 @end smallexample
17502
17503 @noindent
17504 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17505 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17506 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17507
17508 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17509 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17510 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17511 detail.
17512
17513 @c @group
17514 @node Signaling
17515 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17516 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17517
17518 @table @code
17519 @kindex signal
17520 @item signal @var{signal}
17521 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17522 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17523 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17524 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17525
17526 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17527 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17528 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17529 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17530 signal.
17531
17532 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17533 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17534 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17535 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17536 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17537 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17538 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17539 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17540
17541 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17542 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17543 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17544 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17545 passes the signal directly to your program.
17546
17547 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17548 after executing the command.
17549
17550 @kindex queue-signal
17551 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17552 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17553 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17554 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17555 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17556 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17557 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17558 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17559 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17560
17561 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17562 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17563 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17564 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17565 @code{continue} command.
17566
17567 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17568 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17569 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17570 (@pxref{Signals}).
17571 @end table
17572 @c @end group
17573
17574 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17575 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17576
17577 @node Returning
17578 @section Returning from a Function
17579
17580 @table @code
17581 @cindex returning from a function
17582 @kindex return
17583 @item return
17584 @itemx return @var{expression}
17585 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17586 command. If you give an
17587 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17588 value.
17589 @end table
17590
17591 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17592 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17593 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17594 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17595
17596 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17597 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17598 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17599 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17600 of functions.
17601
17602 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17603 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17604 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17605 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17606 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17607
17608 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17609 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17610 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17611 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17612 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17613 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17614 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17615 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17616 assignment into the right register(s).
17617
17618 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17619 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17620 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17621 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17622 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17623 into a @code{long long int}:
17624
17625 @smallexample
17626 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17627 29 return 31;
17628 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17629 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17630 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17631 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17632 (@value{GDBP})
17633 @end smallexample
17634
17635 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17636 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17637 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17638 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17639 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17640 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17641 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17642 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17643
17644 @smallexample
17645 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17646 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17647 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17648 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17649 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17650 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17651 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17652 (@value{GDBP})
17653 @end smallexample
17654
17655 @node Calling
17656 @section Calling Program Functions
17657
17658 @table @code
17659 @cindex calling functions
17660 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17661 @item print @var{expr}
17662 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17663 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17664 debugged.
17665
17666 @kindex call
17667 @item call @var{expr}
17668 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17669 returned values.
17670
17671 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17672 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17673 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17674 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17675 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17676 value history.
17677 @end table
17678
17679 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17680 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17681 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17682 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17683
17684 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17685 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17686 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17687 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17688 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17689 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17690 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17691 in that case is controlled by the
17692 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17693
17694 @table @code
17695 @item set unwindonsignal
17696 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17697 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17698 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17699 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17700 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17701 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17702 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17703 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17704 received.
17705
17706 @item show unwindonsignal
17707 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17708 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17709 @value{GDBN}.
17710
17711 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17712 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17713 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17714 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17715 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17716 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17717 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17718 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17719 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17720 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17721
17722 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17723 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17724 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17725 @value{GDBN}.
17726
17727 @end table
17728
17729 @cindex weak alias functions
17730 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17731 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17732 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17733 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17734 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17735 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17736 function instead.
17737
17738 @node Patching
17739 @section Patching Programs
17740
17741 @cindex patching binaries
17742 @cindex writing into executables
17743 @cindex writing into corefiles
17744
17745 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17746 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17747 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17748 patching your program's binary.
17749
17750 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17751 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17752 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17753 repairs.
17754
17755 @table @code
17756 @kindex set write
17757 @item set write on
17758 @itemx set write off
17759 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17760 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17761 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17762
17763 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17764 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17765 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17766
17767 @item show write
17768 @kindex show write
17769 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17770 as well as reading.
17771 @end table
17772
17773 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17774 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17775 @cindex injecting code
17776 @cindex writing into executables
17777 @cindex compiling code
17778
17779 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17780 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17781 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17782 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17783
17784 @table @code
17785 @kindex compile code
17786 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17787 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17788 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17789 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17790 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17791 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17792 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17793 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17794 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17795 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17796 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17797 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17798
17799 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17800 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17801 E.g.:
17802
17803 @smallexample
17804 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17805 @end smallexample
17806
17807 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17808 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17809 from actual source code. E.g.:
17810
17811 @smallexample
17812 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17813 @end smallexample
17814
17815 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17816 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17817 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17818 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17819 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17820 editor.
17821
17822 @smallexample
17823 compile code
17824 >printf ("hello\n");
17825 >printf ("world\n");
17826 >end
17827 @end smallexample
17828
17829 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17830 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17831 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17832 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17833 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17834 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17835 inferior symbols otherwise.
17836
17837 @kindex compile file
17838 @item compile file @var{filename}
17839 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17840 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17841
17842 @smallexample
17843 compile file /home/user/example.c
17844 @end smallexample
17845 @end table
17846
17847 @table @code
17848 @item compile print @var{expr}
17849 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17850 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17851 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17852 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17853 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17854 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17855 Formats}.
17856
17857 @item compile print
17858 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17859 @cindex reprint the last value
17860 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17861 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17862 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17863 multiple-line editor.
17864 @end table
17865
17866 @noindent
17867 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17868
17869 @table @code
17870 @anchor{set debug compile}
17871 @item set debug compile
17872 @cindex compile command debugging info
17873 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17874 injecting the code. The default is off.
17875
17876 @item show debug compile
17877 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17878 compiling and injecting the code.
17879 @end table
17880
17881 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17882
17883 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17884 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17885 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17886 injecting process.
17887
17888 @noindent
17889 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17890
17891 @table @asis
17892 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17893 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17894 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17895 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17896
17897 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17898 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17899 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17900 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17901 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17902 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17903 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17904 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17905
17906 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17907 @end table
17908
17909 @noindent
17910 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17911
17912 @table @code
17913 @item set compile-args
17914 @cindex compile command options override
17915 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17916 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17917 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17918 compilation.
17919
17920 @item show compile-args
17921 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17922 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17923 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17924 @end table
17925
17926 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17927
17928 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17929 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17930 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17931
17932 @table @asis
17933 @item C code examples and caveats
17934 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17935 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17936 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17937 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17938 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17939
17940 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17941 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17942 much like any other normal debugging session.
17943
17944 @smallexample
17945 void function1 (void)
17946 @{
17947 int i = 42;
17948 printf ("function 1\n");
17949 @}
17950
17951 void function2 (void)
17952 @{
17953 int j = 12;
17954 function1 ();
17955 @}
17956
17957 int main(void)
17958 @{
17959 int k = 6;
17960 int *p;
17961 function2 ();
17962 return 0;
17963 @}
17964 @end smallexample
17965
17966 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17967 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17968 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17969
17970 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17971 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17972 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17973 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17974 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17975
17976 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17977 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17978 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17979 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17980 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17981 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17982 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17983 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17984 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17985 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17986
17987 @smallexample
17988 compile code k = 3;
17989 @end smallexample
17990
17991 @noindent
17992 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17993 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17994 @code{compile} command changes it.
17995
17996 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17997 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17998 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17999 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18000 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18001
18002 @smallexample
18003 compile code j = 3;
18004 @end smallexample
18005
18006 @noindent
18007 will result in a compilation error message.
18008
18009 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18010 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18011 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18012
18013 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18014 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18015 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18016 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18017
18018 @smallexample
18019 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18020 @end smallexample
18021
18022 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18023 command has completed:
18024
18025 @smallexample
18026 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18027 @end smallexample
18028
18029 @noindent
18030 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18031 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18032 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18033 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18034 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18035
18036 @smallexample
18037 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18038 @end smallexample
18039
18040 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18041 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18042 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18043 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18044 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18045 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18046 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18047 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18048
18049 @smallexample
18050 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18051 @end smallexample
18052
18053 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18054 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18055 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18056 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18057 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18058 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18059 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18060
18061 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18062 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18063 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18064 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18065 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18066 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18067
18068 @smallexample
18069 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18070 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18071 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18072 Compilation failed.
18073 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18074 42
18075 @end smallexample
18076
18077 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18078 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18079 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18080 will print to the console.
18081 @end table
18082
18083 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18084
18085 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
18086 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
18087 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
18088 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
18089 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
18090 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18091 target architecture and operating system.
18092
18093 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18094 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18095 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18096 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18097 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18098 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18099 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18100
18101 @node GDB Files
18102 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18103
18104 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18105 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18106 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18107 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18108
18109 @menu
18110 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18111 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18112 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18113 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18114 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18115 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18116 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18117 @end menu
18118
18119 @node Files
18120 @section Commands to Specify Files
18121
18122 @cindex symbol table
18123 @cindex core dump file
18124
18125 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18126 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18127 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18128 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18129
18130 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18131 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18132 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18133 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18134 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18135 new files are useful.
18136
18137 @table @code
18138 @cindex executable file
18139 @kindex file
18140 @item file @var{filename}
18141 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18142 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18143 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18144 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18145 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18146 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18147 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18148 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18149
18150 @cindex unlinked object files
18151 @cindex patching object files
18152 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18153 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18154 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18155 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18156 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18157 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18158 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18159 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18160
18161 @item file
18162 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18163 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18164
18165 @kindex exec-file
18166 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18167 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18168 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18169 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18170 discard information on the executable file.
18171
18172 @kindex symbol-file
18173 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18174 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18175 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18176 table and program to run from the same file.
18177
18178 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18179 program's symbol table.
18180
18181 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18182 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18183 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18184 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18185 @value{GDBN}.
18186
18187 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18188 executing it once.
18189
18190 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18191 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18192 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18193 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18194 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18195 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18196 optimized code.
18197
18198 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18199 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18200 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18201 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18202 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18203
18204 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18205 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18206 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18207 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18208 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18209 Warnings and Messages}.)
18210
18211 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18212 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18213 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18214 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18215 in stabs format.
18216
18217 @kindex readnow
18218 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18219 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18220 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18221 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18222 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18223 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18224 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18225 entire symbol table available.
18226
18227 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18228 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18229 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18230 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18231 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18232 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18233 @c files.
18234
18235 @kindex core-file
18236 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18237 @itemx core
18238 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18239 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18240 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18241 executable file itself for other parts.
18242
18243 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18244 to be used.
18245
18246 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18247 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18248 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18249 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18250 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18251
18252 @kindex add-symbol-file
18253 @cindex dynamic linking
18254 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18255 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18256 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18257 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18258 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18259 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18260 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18261 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18262 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18263 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18264 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18265 @var{address} as an expression.
18266
18267 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18268 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18269 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18270 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18271
18272 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18273
18274 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18275 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18276 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18277 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18278 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18279 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18280 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18281 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18282 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18283
18284 @itemize @bullet
18285 @item
18286 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18287 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18288 @item
18289 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18290 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18291 @item
18292 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18293 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18294 @end itemize
18295
18296 @noindent
18297 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18298 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18299 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18300 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18301 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18302 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18303 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18304 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18305 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18306 way.
18307
18308 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18309
18310 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18311 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18312 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18313 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18314 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18315 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18316
18317 @smallexample
18318 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18319 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18320 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18321 (y or n) y
18322 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18323 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18324 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18325 (gdb)
18326 @end smallexample
18327
18328
18329 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18330
18331 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18332 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18333 @cindex load symbols from memory
18334 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18335 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18336 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18337 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18338 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18339 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18340 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18341 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18342 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18343
18344 @kindex section
18345 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18346 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18347 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18348 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18349 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18350 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18351 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18352 their addresses.
18353
18354 @kindex info files
18355 @kindex info target
18356 @item info files
18357 @itemx info target
18358 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18359 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18360 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18361 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18362 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18363 current ones.
18364
18365 @kindex maint info sections
18366 @item maint info sections
18367 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18368 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18369 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18370 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18371 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18372 may be arbitrarily combined):
18373
18374 @table @code
18375 @item ALLOBJ
18376 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18377 @item @var{sections}
18378 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18379 @item @var{section-flags}
18380 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18381 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18382 @table @code
18383 @item ALLOC
18384 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18385 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18386 @item LOAD
18387 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18388 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18389 @item RELOC
18390 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18391 @item READONLY
18392 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18393 @item CODE
18394 Section contains executable code only.
18395 @item DATA
18396 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18397 @item ROM
18398 Section will reside in ROM.
18399 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18400 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18401 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18402 Section is not empty.
18403 @item NEVER_LOAD
18404 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18405 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18406 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18407 COFF shared library information.
18408 @item IS_COMMON
18409 Section contains common symbols.
18410 @end table
18411 @end table
18412 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18413 @cindex read-only sections
18414 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18415 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18416 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18417 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18418 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18419 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18420 enhancement to debugging performance.
18421
18422 The default is off.
18423
18424 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18425 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18426 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18427 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18428
18429 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18430 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18431 @end table
18432
18433 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18434 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18435 name and remembers it that way.
18436
18437 @cindex shared libraries
18438 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18439 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18440 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18441 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18442
18443 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18444 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18445
18446 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18447 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18448 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18449 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18450 debugging a core file).
18451
18452 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18453 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18454 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18455
18456 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18457 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18458 particularly large or there are many of them.
18459
18460 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18461 commands:
18462
18463 @table @code
18464 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18465 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18466 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18467 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18468 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18469 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18470 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18471 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18472
18473 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18474 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18475 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18476 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18477 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18478 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18479 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18480 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18481 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18482
18483 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18484 @item show auto-solib-add
18485 Display the current autoloading mode.
18486 @end table
18487
18488 @cindex load shared library
18489 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18490 command:
18491
18492 @table @code
18493 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18494 @kindex info share
18495 @item info share @var{regex}
18496 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18497 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18498 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18499 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18500
18501 @kindex info dll
18502 @item info dll @var{regex}
18503 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18504
18505 @kindex sharedlibrary
18506 @kindex share
18507 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18508 @itemx share @var{regex}
18509 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18510 Unix regular expression.
18511 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18512 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18513 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18514 loaded.
18515
18516 @item nosharedlibrary
18517 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18518 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18519 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18520 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18521 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18522 discarded.
18523 @end table
18524
18525 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18526 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18527 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18528 Catchpoints}).
18529
18530 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18531 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18532 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18533 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18534
18535 @table @code
18536 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18537 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18538 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18539 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18540 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18541 shared library.
18542
18543 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18544 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18545 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18546 library events happen.
18547 @end table
18548
18549 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18550 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18551 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18552 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18553 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18554 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18555 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18556 not.
18557
18558 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18559 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18560 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18561 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18562 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18563
18564 @table @code
18565 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18566 @cindex system root, alternate
18567 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18568 @kindex set sysroot
18569 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18570 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18571 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18572 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18573 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18574 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18575 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18576 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18577 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18578 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18579 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18580 @var{path}.
18581
18582 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18583 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18584 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18585 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18586 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18587 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18588 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18589 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18590 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18591 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18592 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18593 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18594 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18595 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18596
18597 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18598 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18599 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18600 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18601 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18602
18603 @smallexample
18604 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18605 @end smallexample
18606
18607 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18608 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18609 system:
18610
18611 @smallexample
18612 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18613 @end smallexample
18614
18615 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18616 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18617 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18618 colons:
18619
18620 @smallexample
18621 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18622 @end smallexample
18623
18624 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18625 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18626 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18627 @samp{z}):
18628
18629 @smallexample
18630 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18631 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18632 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18633 @end smallexample
18634
18635 @noindent
18636 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18637 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18638 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18639
18640 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18641 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18642
18643 @smallexample
18644 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18645 @end smallexample
18646
18647 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18648 if you don't want or need to.
18649
18650 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18651 sysroot}.
18652
18653 @cindex default system root
18654 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18655 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18656 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18657 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18658 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18659 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18660 location.
18661
18662 @kindex show sysroot
18663 @item show sysroot
18664 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18665
18666 @kindex set solib-search-path
18667 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18668 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18669 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18670 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18671 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18672 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18673 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18674 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18675 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18676 of shared library symbols.
18677
18678 @kindex show solib-search-path
18679 @item show solib-search-path
18680 Display the current shared library search path.
18681
18682 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18683 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18684 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18685 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18686 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18687
18688 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18689 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18690 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18691 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18692 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18693 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18694 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18695 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18696 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18697 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18698 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18699 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18700 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18701 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18702 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18703 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18704 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18705 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18706 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18707 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18708 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18709 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18710
18711 @table @code
18712 @item unix
18713 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18714 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18715 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18716 the forward slash.
18717
18718 @item dos-based
18719 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18720 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18721 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18722 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18723 considered directory separators.
18724
18725 @item auto
18726 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18727 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18728 This is the default.
18729 @end table
18730 @end table
18731
18732 @cindex file name canonicalization
18733 @cindex base name differences
18734 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18735 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18736 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18737 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18738 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18739 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18740 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18741 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18742 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18743 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18744 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18745 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18746 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18747 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18748 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18749
18750 @table @code
18751 @item set basenames-may-differ
18752 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18753 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18754
18755 @item show basenames-may-differ
18756 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18757 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18758 @end table
18759
18760 @node File Caching
18761 @section File Caching
18762 @cindex caching of opened files
18763 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18764
18765 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18766 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18767 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18768 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18769
18770 @table @code
18771 @kindex maint info bfds
18772 @item maint info bfds
18773 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18774 @value{GDBN}.
18775
18776 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18777 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18778 @kindex bfd caching
18779 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18780 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18781 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18782 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18783 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18784 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18785 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18786 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18787 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18788
18789 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18790 @kindex bfd caching
18791 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18792 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18793
18794 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18795 @kindex bfd caching
18796 @item show debug bfd-cache
18797 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18798 @end table
18799
18800 @node Separate Debug Files
18801 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18802 @cindex separate debugging information files
18803 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18804 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18805 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18806 @cindex global debugging information directories
18807 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18808 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18809
18810 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18811 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18812 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18813 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18814 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18815 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18816 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18817
18818 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18819 file:
18820
18821 @itemize @bullet
18822 @item
18823 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18824 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18825 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18826 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18827 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18828 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18829 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18830 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18831
18832 @item
18833 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18834 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18835 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18836 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18837 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18838 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18839 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18840 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18841 below.
18842 @end itemize
18843
18844 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18845 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18846
18847 @itemize @bullet
18848 @item
18849 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18850 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18851 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18852 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18853 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18854
18855 @item
18856 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18857 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18858 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18859 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18860 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18861 hex characters, not 10.)
18862 @end itemize
18863
18864 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18865 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18866 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18867 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18868 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18869 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18870
18871 @itemize @minus
18872 @item
18873 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18874 @item
18875 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18876 @item
18877 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18878 @item
18879 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18880 @end itemize
18881
18882 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18883 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18884 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18885 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18886 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18887
18888 @table @code
18889
18890 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18891 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18892 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18893 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18894 concatenating them by a path separator.
18895
18896 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18897 @item show debug-file-directory
18898 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18899 information files.
18900
18901 @end table
18902
18903 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18904 @cindex debug link sections
18905 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18906 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18907
18908 @itemize
18909 @item
18910 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18911 a zero byte,
18912 @item
18913 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18914 boundary within the section, and
18915 @item
18916 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18917 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18918 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18919 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18920 @end itemize
18921
18922 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18923 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18924 described above.
18925
18926 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18927 @cindex build ID sections
18928 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18929 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18930 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18931 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18932 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18933 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18934 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18935 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18936 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18937
18938 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18939 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18940 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18941 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18942 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18943 in an ordinary executable.
18944
18945 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18946 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18947 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18948 following commands:
18949
18950 @smallexample
18951 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18952 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18953 @end smallexample
18954
18955 @noindent
18956 These commands remove the debugging
18957 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18958 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18959 two files:
18960
18961 @itemize @bullet
18962 @item
18963 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18964 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18965
18966 @smallexample
18967 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18968 @end smallexample
18969
18970 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18971 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18972 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18973 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18974
18975 @item
18976 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18977 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18978 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18979 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18980 @end itemize
18981
18982 @noindent
18983
18984 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18985 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18986 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18987
18988 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18989 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18990 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18991 @c different ways!
18992 @ifhtml
18993 @display
18994 @html
18995 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18996 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18997 @end html
18998 @end display
18999 @end ifhtml
19000 @ifnothtml
19001 @display
19002 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19003 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19004 @end display
19005 @end ifnothtml
19006
19007 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19008 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19009 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19010 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19011 CRC.
19012
19013 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19014 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19015 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19016 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19017 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19018
19019 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19020 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19021 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19022 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19023 @code{0xffffffff}.
19024
19025 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19026 @smallexample
19027 unsigned long
19028 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19029 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19030 @{
19031 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19032 @{
19033 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19034 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19035 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19036 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19037 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19038 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19039 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19040 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19041 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19042 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19043 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19044 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19045 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19046 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19047 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19048 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19049 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19050 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19051 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19052 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19053 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19054 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19055 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19056 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19057 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19058 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19059 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19060 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19061 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19062 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19063 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19064 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19065 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19066 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19067 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19068 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19069 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19070 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19071 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19072 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19073 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19074 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19075 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19076 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19077 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19078 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19079 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19080 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19081 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19082 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19083 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19084 0x2d02ef8d
19085 @};
19086 unsigned char *end;
19087
19088 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19089 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19090 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19091 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19092 @}
19093 @end smallexample
19094
19095 @noindent
19096 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19097
19098 @node MiniDebugInfo
19099 @section Debugging information in a special section
19100 @cindex separate debug sections
19101 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19102
19103 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19104 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19105 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19106 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19107
19108 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19109 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19110 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19111 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19112 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19113 debugging information might be included in the section.
19114
19115 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19116 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19117 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19118
19119 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19120 standard utilities:
19121
19122 @smallexample
19123 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19124 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19125 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19126 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19127
19128 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19129 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19130 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19131 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19132 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19133 | sort > funcsyms
19134
19135 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19136 # table.
19137 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19138
19139 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19140 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19141
19142 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19143 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19144 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19145 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19146
19147 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19148 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19149
19150 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19151 # original binary.
19152 xz mini_debuginfo
19153 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19154 @end smallexample
19155
19156 @node Index Files
19157 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19158 @cindex index files
19159 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19160
19161 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19162 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19163 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19164 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19165 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19166 startup.
19167
19168 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19169 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19170 using @command{objcopy}.
19171
19172 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19173
19174 @table @code
19175 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19176 @kindex save gdb-index
19177 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19178 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19179 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19180 @var{directory}.
19181 @end table
19182
19183 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19184 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19185
19186 @smallexample
19187 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19188 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19189 @end smallexample
19190
19191 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19192 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19193 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19194 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19195 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19196 The default is @code{off}.
19197 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19198 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19199
19200 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19201 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19202
19203 @smallexample
19204 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19205 @end smallexample
19206
19207 Instead you must do, for example,
19208
19209 @smallexample
19210 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19211 @end smallexample
19212
19213 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19214 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19215 currently work for programs using Ada.
19216
19217 @node Symbol Errors
19218 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19219
19220 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19221 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19222 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19223 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19224 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19225 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19226 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19227 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19228 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19229 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19230 Messages}).
19231
19232 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19233
19234 @table @code
19235 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19236
19237 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19238 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19239 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19240 in its outer scope blocks.
19241
19242 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19243 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19244 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19245 function.
19246
19247 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19248
19249 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19250 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19251 do so.
19252
19253 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19254 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19255 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19256 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19257 Messages}.)
19258
19259 @item bad block start address patched
19260
19261 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19262 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19263 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19264
19265 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19266 starting on the previous source line.
19267
19268 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19269
19270 @cindex foo
19271 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19272 larger than the size of the string table.
19273
19274 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19275 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19276 with this name.
19277
19278 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19279
19280 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19281 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19282 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19283
19284 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19285 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19286 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19287 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19288 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19289 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19290
19291 @item stub type has NULL name
19292
19293 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19294
19295 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19296 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19297 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19298 it.
19299
19300 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19301
19302 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19303
19304 @end table
19305
19306 @node Data Files
19307 @section GDB Data Files
19308
19309 @cindex prefix for data files
19310 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19311 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19312
19313 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19314 is currently using.
19315
19316 @table @code
19317 @kindex set data-directory
19318 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19319 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19320 to @var{directory}.
19321
19322 @kindex show data-directory
19323 @item show data-directory
19324 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19325 @end table
19326
19327 @cindex default data directory
19328 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19329 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19330 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19331 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19332 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19333 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19334 location.
19335
19336 The data directory may also be specified with the
19337 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19338 @xref{Mode Options}.
19339
19340 @node Targets
19341 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19342
19343 @cindex debugging target
19344 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19345
19346 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19347 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19348 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19349 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19350 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19351 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19352 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19353 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19354
19355 @cindex target architecture
19356 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19357 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19358 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19359 command.
19360
19361 @table @code
19362 @kindex set architecture
19363 @kindex show architecture
19364 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19365 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19366 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19367 supported architectures.
19368
19369 @item show architecture
19370 Show the current target architecture.
19371
19372 @item set processor
19373 @itemx processor
19374 @kindex set processor
19375 @kindex show processor
19376 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19377 and @code{show architecture}.
19378 @end table
19379
19380 @menu
19381 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19382 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19383 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19384 @end menu
19385
19386 @node Active Targets
19387 @section Active Targets
19388
19389 @cindex stacking targets
19390 @cindex active targets
19391 @cindex multiple targets
19392
19393 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19394 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19395 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19396 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19397 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19398 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19399 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19400 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19401 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19402
19403 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19404 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19405 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19406 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19407
19408 @node Target Commands
19409 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19410
19411 @table @code
19412 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19413 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19414 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19415 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19416 protocol of the target machine.
19417
19418 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19419 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19420 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19421
19422 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19423 after executing the command.
19424
19425 @kindex help target
19426 @item help target
19427 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19428 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19429 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19430
19431 @item help target @var{name}
19432 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19433 select it.
19434
19435 @kindex set gnutarget
19436 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19437 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19438 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19439 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19440 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19441 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19442
19443 @quotation
19444 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19445 you must know the actual BFD name.
19446 @end quotation
19447
19448 @noindent
19449 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19450
19451 @kindex show gnutarget
19452 @item show gnutarget
19453 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19454 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19455 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19456 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19457 @end table
19458
19459 @cindex common targets
19460 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19461 configuration):
19462
19463 @table @code
19464 @kindex target
19465 @item target exec @var{program}
19466 @cindex executable file target
19467 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19468 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19469
19470 @item target core @var{filename}
19471 @cindex core dump file target
19472 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19473 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19474
19475 @item target remote @var{medium}
19476 @cindex remote target
19477 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19478 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19479 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19480
19481 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19482 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19483
19484 @smallexample
19485 target remote /dev/ttya
19486 @end smallexample
19487
19488 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19489 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19490 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19491 clobbered by the download.
19492
19493 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19494 @cindex built-in simulator target
19495 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19496 In general,
19497 @smallexample
19498 target sim
19499 load
19500 run
19501 @end smallexample
19502 @noindent
19503 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19504 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19505 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19506 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19507 Processors}.
19508
19509 @item target native
19510 @cindex native target
19511 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19512 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19513 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19514 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19515
19516 @end table
19517
19518 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19519 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19520
19521 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19522 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19523 various aspects of this process.
19524
19525 @table @code
19526
19527 @item set hash
19528 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19529 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19530 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19531 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19532 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19533 monitor.
19534
19535 @item show hash
19536 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19537 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19538
19539 @item set debug monitor
19540 @kindex set debug monitor
19541 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19542 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19543 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19544
19545 @item show debug monitor
19546 @kindex show debug monitor
19547 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19548 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19549 @end table
19550
19551 @table @code
19552
19553 @kindex load @var{filename}
19554 @item load @var{filename}
19555 @anchor{load}
19556 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19557 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19558 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19559 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19560 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19561 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19562
19563 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19564 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19565 target is @dots{}}''
19566
19567 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19568 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19569 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19570 specifies a fixed address.
19571 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19572
19573 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19574 load programs into flash memory.
19575
19576 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19577 @end table
19578
19579 @node Byte Order
19580 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19581
19582 @cindex choosing target byte order
19583 @cindex target byte order
19584
19585 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19586 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19587 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19588 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19589 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19590 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19591
19592 @table @code
19593 @kindex set endian
19594 @item set endian big
19595 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19596
19597 @item set endian little
19598 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19599
19600 @item set endian auto
19601 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19602 executable.
19603
19604 @item show endian
19605 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19606
19607 @end table
19608
19609 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19610 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19611 target system.
19612
19613
19614 @node Remote Debugging
19615 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19616 @cindex remote debugging
19617
19618 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19619 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19620 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19621 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19622 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19623
19624 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19625 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19626 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19627 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19628 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19629 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19630
19631 Other remote targets may be available in your
19632 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19633
19634 @menu
19635 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19636 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19637 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19638 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19639 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19640 @end menu
19641
19642 @node Connecting
19643 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19644 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19645 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19646 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19647 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19648 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19649 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19650
19651 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19652 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19653 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19654 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19655
19656 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19657
19658 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19659 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19660 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19661 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19662
19663 @table @asis
19664
19665 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19666 @item Result of detach or program exit
19667 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19668 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19669 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19670
19671 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19672 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19673 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19674 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19675
19676 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19677 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19678 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19679 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19680
19681 @item Specifying the program to debug
19682 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19683 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19684 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19685 target.
19686
19687 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19688 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19689 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19690
19691 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19692 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19693 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19694 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19695
19696 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19697 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19698 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19699 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19700 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19701 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19702 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19703 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19704 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19705
19706 @item The @code{run} command
19707 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19708 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19709 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19710 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19711 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19712
19713 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19714 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19715 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19716 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19717 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19718
19719 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19720 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19721 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19722 @code{target remote} mode.
19723
19724 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19725 @item Attaching
19726 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19727 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19728 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19729
19730 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19731 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19732 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19733 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19734 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19735
19736 @end table
19737
19738 @anchor{Host and target files}
19739 @subsection Host and Target Files
19740 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19741 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19742
19743 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19744 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19745 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19746 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19747 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19748
19749 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19750 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19751 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19752 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19753 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19754
19755 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19756 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19757 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19758 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19759 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19760 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19761 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19762 target libraries.
19763
19764 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19765 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19766 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19767 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19768 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19769 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19770 programs.
19771
19772 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19773 @cindex remote connection commands
19774 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19775 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19776 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19777 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19778 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19779 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19780 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19781
19782 @table @code
19783
19784 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19785 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19786 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19787 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19788 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19789
19790 @smallexample
19791 target remote /dev/ttyb
19792 @end smallexample
19793
19794 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19795 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19796 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19797 @code{target} command.
19798
19799 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19800 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19801 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19802 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19803 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19804 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19805 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19806 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19807 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19808 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19809 target.
19810
19811 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19812 @code{manyfarms}:
19813
19814 @smallexample
19815 target remote manyfarms:2828
19816 @end smallexample
19817
19818 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19819 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19820 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19821 port 1234 on your local machine:
19822
19823 @smallexample
19824 target remote :1234
19825 @end smallexample
19826 @noindent
19827
19828 Note that the colon is still required here.
19829
19830 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19831 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19832 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19833 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19834 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19835
19836 @smallexample
19837 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19838 @end smallexample
19839
19840 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19841 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19842 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19843 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19844
19845 @item target remote | @var{command}
19846 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19847 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19848 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19849 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19850 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19851 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19852 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19853 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19854 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19855
19856 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19857 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19858 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19859
19860 @end table
19861
19862 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19863 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19864 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19865 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19866 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19867 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19868 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19869
19870 @smallexample
19871 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19872 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19873 @end smallexample
19874
19875 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19876 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19877 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19878 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19879
19880 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19881 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19882
19883 @table @code
19884 @kindex detach (remote)
19885 @item detach
19886 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19887 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19888 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19889 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19890 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19891 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19892 still connected to the target.
19893
19894 @kindex disconnect
19895 @item disconnect
19896 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19897 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19898 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19899 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19900 another target.
19901
19902 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19903 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19904 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19905 @kindex monitor
19906 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19907 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19908 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19909 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19910 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19911 and implement.
19912 @end table
19913
19914 @node File Transfer
19915 @section Sending files to a remote system
19916 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19917 @cindex file transfer
19918 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19919
19920 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19921 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19922 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19923 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19924 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19925 the only way to upload or download files.
19926
19927 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19928
19929 @table @code
19930 @kindex remote put
19931 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19932 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19933 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19934
19935 @kindex remote get
19936 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19937 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19938 on the host system.
19939
19940 @kindex remote delete
19941 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19942 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19943
19944 @end table
19945
19946 @node Server
19947 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19948
19949 @kindex gdbserver
19950 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19951 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19952 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19953 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19954 linking in the usual debugging stub.
19955
19956 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19957 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19958 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19959 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19960 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19961 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19962 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19963 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19964 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19965 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19966 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19967 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19968 choice for debugging.
19969
19970 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19971 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19972 protocol.
19973
19974 @quotation
19975 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19976 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19977 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19978 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19979 @code{gdbserver}.
19980 @end quotation
19981
19982 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
19983 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19984 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19985 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19986
19987 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19988 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19989 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19990 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19991 system does all the symbol handling.
19992
19993 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19994 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19995 syntax is:
19996
19997 @smallexample
19998 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19999 @end smallexample
20000
20001 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20002 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20003 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20004 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20005 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20006 @file{/dev/com1}:
20007
20008 @smallexample
20009 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20010 @end smallexample
20011
20012 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20013 with it.
20014
20015 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20016
20017 @smallexample
20018 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20019 @end smallexample
20020
20021 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20022 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20023 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20024 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20025 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20026 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20027 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20028 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20029 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20030 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20031 @code{target remote} command.
20032
20033 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20034 with ssh:
20035
20036 @smallexample
20037 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20038 @end smallexample
20039
20040 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20041 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20042 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20043 You could elide it if you want to.
20044
20045 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20046 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20047 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20048 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20049
20050 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20051 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20052 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20053 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20054
20055 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20056 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20057
20058 @smallexample
20059 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20060 @end smallexample
20061
20062 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20063 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20064
20065 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20066 @value{GDBN} attach command
20067 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20068
20069 @pindex pidof
20070 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20071 @code{pidof} utility:
20072
20073 @smallexample
20074 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20075 @end smallexample
20076
20077 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20078 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20079 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20080
20081 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20082
20083 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20084 port.
20085
20086 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20087 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20088 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20089 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20090 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20091 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20092 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20093 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20094
20095 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20096 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20097 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20098
20099 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20100 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20101 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20102 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20103 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20104 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20105 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20106 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20107 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20108 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20109 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20110 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20111
20112 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20113 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20114
20115 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20116 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20117 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20118 program. For more information,
20119 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20120
20121 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20122 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20123 status information about the debugging process.
20124 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20125 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20126 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20127 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20128
20129 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20130 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20131 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20132 Possible options are:
20133
20134 @table @code
20135 @item none
20136 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20137 @item all
20138 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20139 @item timestamps
20140 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20141 @end table
20142
20143 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20144 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20145
20146 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20147 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20148 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20149 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20150 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20151
20152 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20153 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20154 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20155 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20156
20157 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20158 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20159 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20160 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20161
20162 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20163 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20164 environment:
20165
20166 @smallexample
20167 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20168 @end smallexample
20169
20170 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20171
20172 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20173 @itemize
20174
20175 @item
20176 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20177
20178 @item
20179 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20180 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20181 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20182 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20183 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20184 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20185
20186 @item
20187 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20188 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20189 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20190 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20191 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20192 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20193 program is already on the target.
20194
20195 @end itemize
20196
20197 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20198 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20199 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20200
20201 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20202 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20203 Here are the available commands.
20204
20205 @table @code
20206 @item monitor help
20207 List the available monitor commands.
20208
20209 @item monitor set debug 0
20210 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20211 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20212
20213 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20214 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20215 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20216 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20217
20218 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20219 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20220 Possible options are:
20221
20222 @table @code
20223 @item none
20224 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20225 @item all
20226 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20227 @item timestamps
20228 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20229 @end table
20230
20231 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20232 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20233
20234 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20235 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20236 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20237 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20238 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20239 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20240
20241 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20242 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20243
20244 @item monitor exit
20245 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20246 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20247 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20248 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20249 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20250
20251 @end table
20252
20253 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20254 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20255
20256 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20257 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20258
20259 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20260 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20261 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20262 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20263 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20264 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20265 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20266 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20267 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20268 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20269 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20270 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20271
20272 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20273
20274 @table @code
20275 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20276
20277 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20278 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20279 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20280
20281 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20282
20283 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20284 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20285 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20286 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20287 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20288 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20289
20290 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20291
20292 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20293 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20294 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20295 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20296 command for that. For example:
20297
20298 @smallexample
20299 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20300 @end smallexample
20301
20302 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20303 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20304 @end table
20305
20306 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20307 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20308 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20309 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20310 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20311 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20312 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20313 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20314 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20315 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20316
20317 @smallexample
20318 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20319 @end smallexample
20320
20321 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20322
20323 @smallexample
20324 $ gdb myprogram
20325 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20326 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20327 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20328 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20329 @end smallexample
20330
20331 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20332 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20333 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20334 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20335 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20336 tracing.
20337
20338 @node Remote Configuration
20339 @section Remote Configuration
20340
20341 @kindex set remote
20342 @kindex show remote
20343 This section documents the configuration options available when
20344 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20345 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20346 system-call-allowed}.
20347
20348 @table @code
20349 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20350 @cindex address size for remote targets
20351 @cindex bits in remote address
20352 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20353 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20354 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20355 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20356
20357 @item show remoteaddresssize
20358 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20359
20360 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20361 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20362 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20363 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20364 remote targets.
20365
20366 @item show serial baud
20367 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20368
20369 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20370 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20371 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20372
20373 @item show serial parity
20374 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20375
20376 @item set remotebreak
20377 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20378 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20379 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20380 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20381 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20382 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20383 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20384 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20385
20386 @item show remotebreak
20387 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20388 interrupt the remote program.
20389
20390 @item set remoteflow on
20391 @itemx set remoteflow off
20392 @kindex set remoteflow
20393 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20394 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20395
20396 @item show remoteflow
20397 @kindex show remoteflow
20398 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20399
20400 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20401 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20402 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20403 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20404 @code{ascii}.
20405
20406 @item show remotelogbase
20407 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20408 protocol.
20409
20410 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20411 @cindex record serial communications on file
20412 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20413 default is not to record at all.
20414
20415 @item show remotelogfile.
20416 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20417 serial communications.
20418
20419 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20420 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20421 @cindex remote timeout
20422 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20423 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20424
20425 @item show remotetimeout
20426 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20427 responses.
20428
20429 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20430 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20431 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20432 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20433 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20434 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20435 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20436 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20437
20438 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20439 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20440 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20441 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20442 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20443 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20444 as unlimited.
20445
20446 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20447 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20448 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20449
20450 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20451 @itemx show remote exec-file
20452 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20453 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20454 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20455 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20456 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20457 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20458
20459 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20460 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20461 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20462 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20463 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20464 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20465 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20466 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20467 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20468 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20469
20470 @item show interrupt-sequence
20471 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20472 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20473 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20474 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20475
20476 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20477 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20478 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20479 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20480 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20481 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20482
20483 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20484 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20485 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20486
20487 @kindex set tcp
20488 @kindex show tcp
20489 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20490 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20491 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20492 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20493 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20494 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20495 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20496 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20497 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20498
20499 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20500 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20501
20502 @item show tcp auto-retry
20503 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20504
20505 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20506 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20507 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20508 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20509 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20510 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20511 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20512 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20513 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20514 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20515 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20516
20517 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20518 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20519 @end table
20520
20521 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20522 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20523 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20524 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20525 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20526 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20527 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20528 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20529 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20530
20531 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20532 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20533 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20534 @value{GDBN} developers.
20535
20536 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20537 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20538 are:
20539
20540 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20541 @item Command Name
20542 @tab Remote Packet
20543 @tab Related Features
20544
20545 @item @code{fetch-register}
20546 @tab @code{p}
20547 @tab @code{info registers}
20548
20549 @item @code{set-register}
20550 @tab @code{P}
20551 @tab @code{set}
20552
20553 @item @code{binary-download}
20554 @tab @code{X}
20555 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20556
20557 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20558 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20559 @tab @code{info auxv}
20560
20561 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20562 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20563 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20564
20565 @item @code{attach}
20566 @tab @code{vAttach}
20567 @tab @code{attach}
20568
20569 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20570 @tab @code{vCont}
20571 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20572
20573 @item @code{run}
20574 @tab @code{vRun}
20575 @tab @code{run}
20576
20577 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20578 @tab @code{Z0}
20579 @tab @code{break}
20580
20581 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20582 @tab @code{Z1}
20583 @tab @code{hbreak}
20584
20585 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20586 @tab @code{Z2}
20587 @tab @code{watch}
20588
20589 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20590 @tab @code{Z3}
20591 @tab @code{rwatch}
20592
20593 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20594 @tab @code{Z4}
20595 @tab @code{awatch}
20596
20597 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20598 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20599 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20600
20601 @item @code{target-features}
20602 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20603 @tab @code{set architecture}
20604
20605 @item @code{library-info}
20606 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20607 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20608
20609 @item @code{memory-map}
20610 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20611 @tab @code{info mem}
20612
20613 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20614 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20615 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20616
20617 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20618 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20619 @tab @code{info spu}
20620
20621 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20622 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20623 @tab @code{info spu}
20624
20625 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20626 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20627 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20628
20629 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20630 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20631 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20632
20633 @item @code{threads}
20634 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20635 @tab @code{info threads}
20636
20637 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20638 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20639 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20640
20641 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20642 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20643 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20644
20645 @item @code{search-memory}
20646 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20647 @tab @code{find}
20648
20649 @item @code{supported-packets}
20650 @tab @code{qSupported}
20651 @tab Remote communications parameters
20652
20653 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20654 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20655 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20656
20657 @item @code{pass-signals}
20658 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20659 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20660
20661 @item @code{program-signals}
20662 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20663 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20664
20665 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20666 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20667 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20668
20669 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20670 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20671 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20672
20673 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20674 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20675 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20676
20677 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20678 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20679 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20680
20681 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20682 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20683 @tab @code{remote delete}
20684
20685 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20686 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20687 @tab Host I/O
20688
20689 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20690 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20691 @tab Host I/O
20692
20693 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20694 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20695 @tab Host I/O
20696
20697 @item @code{noack-packet}
20698 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20699 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20700
20701 @item @code{osdata}
20702 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20703 @tab @code{info os}
20704
20705 @item @code{query-attached}
20706 @tab @code{qAttached}
20707 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20708
20709 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20710 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20711 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20712
20713 @item @code{trace-status}
20714 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20715 @tab @code{tstatus}
20716
20717 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20718 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20719 @tab Traceframe info
20720
20721 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20722 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20723 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20724
20725 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20726 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20727 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20728
20729 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20730 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20731 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20732
20733 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20734 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20735 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20736
20737 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20738 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20739 @tab @code{break}
20740
20741 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20742 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20743 @tab @code{hbreak}
20744
20745 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20746 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20747 @tab @code{fork}
20748
20749 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20750 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20751 @tab @code{vfork}
20752
20753 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20754 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20755 @tab @code{exec}
20756
20757 @item @code{thread-events}
20758 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20759 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20760
20761 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20762 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20763 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20764
20765 @end multitable
20766
20767 @node Remote Stub
20768 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20769
20770 @cindex debugging stub, example
20771 @cindex remote stub, example
20772 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20773 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20774 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20775 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20776 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20777 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20778 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20779 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20780
20781 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20782 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20783 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20784 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20785 program, you need:
20786
20787 @enumerate
20788 @item
20789 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20790 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20791 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20792
20793 @item
20794 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20795 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20796
20797 @item
20798 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20799 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20800 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20801 documentation.
20802 @end enumerate
20803
20804 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20805 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20806 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20807
20808 @table @emph
20809 @item On the host,
20810 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20811 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20812 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20813
20814 @item On the target,
20815 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20816 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20817 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20818
20819 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20820 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20821 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20822 @end table
20823
20824 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20825 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20826 @sc{sparc} boards.
20827
20828 @cindex remote serial stub list
20829 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20830
20831 @table @code
20832
20833 @item i386-stub.c
20834 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20835 @cindex Intel
20836 @cindex i386
20837 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20838
20839 @item m68k-stub.c
20840 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20841 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20842 @cindex m680x0
20843 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20844
20845 @item sh-stub.c
20846 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20847 @cindex Renesas
20848 @cindex SH
20849 For Renesas SH architectures.
20850
20851 @item sparc-stub.c
20852 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20853 @cindex Sparc
20854 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20855
20856 @item sparcl-stub.c
20857 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20858 @cindex Fujitsu
20859 @cindex SparcLite
20860 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20861
20862 @end table
20863
20864 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20865 recently added stubs.
20866
20867 @menu
20868 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20869 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20870 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20871 @end menu
20872
20873 @node Stub Contents
20874 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20875
20876 @cindex remote serial stub
20877 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20878 subroutines:
20879
20880 @table @code
20881 @item set_debug_traps
20882 @findex set_debug_traps
20883 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20884 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20885 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20886 program's startup code.
20887
20888 @item handle_exception
20889 @findex handle_exception
20890 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20891 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20892 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20893 run when a trap is triggered.
20894
20895 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20896 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20897 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20898 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20899 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20900 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20901 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20902 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20903 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20904 machine.
20905
20906 @item breakpoint
20907 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20908 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20909 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20910 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20911 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20912 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20913 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20914 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20915 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20916 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20917 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20918
20919 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20920 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20921 start of your debugging session.
20922 @end table
20923
20924 @node Bootstrapping
20925 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20926
20927 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20928 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20929 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20930 debugging target machine.
20931
20932 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20933 serial port.
20934
20935 @table @code
20936 @item int getDebugChar()
20937 @findex getDebugChar
20938 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20939 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20940 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20941
20942 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20943 @findex putDebugChar
20944 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20945 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20946 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20947 @end table
20948
20949 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20950 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20951 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20952 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20953 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20954 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20955 remote system to stop.
20956
20957 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20958 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20959 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20960 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20961
20962 Other routines you need to supply are:
20963
20964 @table @code
20965 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20966 @findex exceptionHandler
20967 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20968 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20969 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20970 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20971 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20972 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20973 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20974 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20975 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20976 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20977 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20978 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20979 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20980
20981 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20982 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20983 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20984 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20985 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20986
20987 @item void flush_i_cache()
20988 @findex flush_i_cache
20989 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20990 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20991 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20992
20993 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20994 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20995 @end table
20996
20997 @noindent
20998 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20999
21000 @table @code
21001 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21002 @findex memset
21003 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21004 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21005 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21006 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21007 @end table
21008
21009 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21010 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21011 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21012 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21013
21014
21015 @node Debug Session
21016 @subsection Putting it All Together
21017
21018 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21019 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21020 steps.
21021
21022 @enumerate
21023 @item
21024 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21025 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21026 @display
21027 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21028 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21029 @end display
21030
21031 @item
21032 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21033 procedure is called:
21034
21035 @smallexample
21036 set_debug_traps();
21037 breakpoint();
21038 @end smallexample
21039
21040 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21041 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21042 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21043 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21044 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21045 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21046 progress.
21047
21048 @item
21049 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21050 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21051
21052 @smallexample
21053 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21054 @end smallexample
21055
21056 @noindent
21057 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21058 function in your program, that function is called when
21059 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21060 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21061 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21062
21063 @item
21064 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21065 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21066
21067 @item
21068 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21069 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21070
21071 @item
21072 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21073 @c document that. FIXME.
21074 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21075 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21076
21077 @item
21078 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21079 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21080
21081 @end enumerate
21082
21083 @node Configurations
21084 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21085
21086 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21087 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21088 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21089
21090 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21091 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21092 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21093 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21094 are quite different from each other.
21095
21096 @menu
21097 * Native::
21098 * Embedded OS::
21099 * Embedded Processors::
21100 * Architectures::
21101 @end menu
21102
21103 @node Native
21104 @section Native
21105
21106 This section describes details specific to particular native
21107 configurations.
21108
21109 @menu
21110 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21111 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21112 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21113 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21114 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21115 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21116 @end menu
21117
21118 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21119 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21120
21121 @cindex libkvm
21122 @cindex kernel memory image
21123 @cindex kernel crash dump
21124
21125 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21126 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21127 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21128 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21129 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21130 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21131 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21132 @code{kvm} target:
21133
21134 @smallexample
21135 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21136 @end smallexample
21137
21138 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21139 argument:
21140
21141 @smallexample
21142 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21143 @end smallexample
21144
21145 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21146 available:
21147
21148 @table @code
21149 @kindex kvm
21150 @item kvm pcb
21151 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21152
21153 @item kvm proc
21154 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21155 modern FreeBSD systems.
21156 @end table
21157
21158 @node SVR4 Process Information
21159 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21160 @cindex /proc
21161 @cindex examine process image
21162 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21163
21164 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21165 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21166 process using file-system subroutines.
21167
21168 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21169 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21170 information about the process running your program, or about any
21171 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21172 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21173
21174 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21175 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21176
21177 @table @code
21178 @kindex info proc
21179 @cindex process ID
21180 @item info proc
21181 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21182 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21183 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21184 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21185 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21186 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21187 executable file's absolute file name.
21188
21189 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21190 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21191 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21192 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21193 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21194 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21195
21196 @item info proc cmdline
21197 @cindex info proc cmdline
21198 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21199 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21200
21201 @item info proc cwd
21202 @cindex info proc cwd
21203 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21204 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21205
21206 @item info proc exe
21207 @cindex info proc exe
21208 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21209 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21210
21211 @item info proc mappings
21212 @cindex memory address space mappings
21213 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21214 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21215 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21216 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21217 memory access rights to that range.
21218
21219 @item info proc stat
21220 @itemx info proc status
21221 @cindex process detailed status information
21222 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21223 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21224 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21225 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21226 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21227 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21228 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21229
21230 @item info proc all
21231 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21232 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21233
21234 @ignore
21235 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21236 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21237 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21238 @kindex info proc times
21239 @item info proc times
21240 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21241 its children.
21242
21243 @kindex info proc id
21244 @item info proc id
21245 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21246 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21247 @end ignore
21248
21249 @item set procfs-trace
21250 @kindex set procfs-trace
21251 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21252 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21253
21254 @item show procfs-trace
21255 @kindex show procfs-trace
21256 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21257
21258 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21259 @kindex set procfs-file
21260 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21261 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21262 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21263 standard output.
21264
21265 @item show procfs-file
21266 @kindex show procfs-file
21267 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21268
21269 @item proc-trace-entry
21270 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21271 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21272 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21273 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21274 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21275 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21276 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21277 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21278 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21279
21280 @item info pidlist
21281 @kindex info pidlist
21282 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21283 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21284 processes and all the threads within each process.
21285
21286 @item info meminfo
21287 @kindex info meminfo
21288 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21289 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21290 @end table
21291
21292 @node DJGPP Native
21293 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21294 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21295 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21296 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21297
21298 @cindex DPMI
21299 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21300 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21301 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21302 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21303
21304 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21305 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21306 subsection describes those commands.
21307
21308 @table @code
21309 @kindex info dos
21310 @item info dos
21311 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21312 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21313
21314 @kindex sysinfo
21315 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21316 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21317 @item info dos sysinfo
21318 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21319 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21320 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21321
21322 @cindex GDT
21323 @cindex LDT
21324 @cindex IDT
21325 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21326 @cindex descriptor tables display
21327 @item info dos gdt
21328 @itemx info dos ldt
21329 @itemx info dos idt
21330 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21331 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21332 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21333 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21334 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21335 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21336 rights.
21337
21338 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21339 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21340 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21341 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21342 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21343
21344 @cindex garbled pointers
21345 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21346 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21347 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21348 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21349 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21350 debugged program's data segment:
21351
21352 @smallexample
21353 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21354 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21355 @end smallexample
21356
21357 @noindent
21358 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21359 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21360
21361 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21362 @item info dos pde
21363 @itemx info dos pte
21364 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21365 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21366 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21367 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21368 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21369 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21370 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21371 that is currently in use.
21372
21373 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21374 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21375 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21376 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21377 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21378 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21379 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21380
21381 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21382 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21383 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21384 controller.
21385
21386 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21387
21388 @cindex physical address from linear address
21389 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21390 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21391 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21392 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21393 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21394 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21395 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21396
21397 @smallexample
21398 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21399 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21400 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21401 @end smallexample
21402
21403 @noindent
21404 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21405 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21406 attributes of that page.
21407
21408 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21409 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21410 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21411 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21412 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21413 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21414
21415 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21416 transfer buffer:
21417
21418 @smallexample
21419 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21420 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21421 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21422 @end smallexample
21423
21424 @noindent
21425 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21426 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21427 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21428 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21429 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21430
21431 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21432 @end table
21433
21434 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21435 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21436 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21437 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21438
21439 @table @code
21440 @kindex set com1base
21441 @kindex set com1irq
21442 @kindex set com2base
21443 @kindex set com2irq
21444 @kindex set com3base
21445 @kindex set com3irq
21446 @kindex set com4base
21447 @kindex set com4irq
21448 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21449 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21450 port.
21451
21452 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21453 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21454 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21455
21456 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21457 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21458 other 3 COM ports.
21459
21460 @kindex show com1base
21461 @kindex show com1irq
21462 @kindex show com2base
21463 @kindex show com2irq
21464 @kindex show com3base
21465 @kindex show com3irq
21466 @kindex show com4base
21467 @kindex show com4irq
21468 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21469 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21470 lines used by the COM ports.
21471
21472 @item info serial
21473 @kindex info serial
21474 @cindex DOS serial port status
21475 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21476 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21477 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21478 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21479 @end table
21480
21481
21482 @node Cygwin Native
21483 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21484 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21485 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21486 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21487
21488 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21489 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21490
21491 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21492 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21493 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21494 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21495 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21496 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21497 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21498 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21499
21500 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21501 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21502 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21503
21504 @table @code
21505 @kindex info w32
21506 @item info w32
21507 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21508 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21509
21510 @item info w32 selector
21511 This command displays information returned by
21512 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21513 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21514 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21515 Without argument, this command displays information
21516 about the six segment registers.
21517
21518 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21519 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21520 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21521 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21522
21523 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21524 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21525 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21526 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21527 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21528 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21529 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21530 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21531 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21532 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21533 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21534
21535 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21536 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21537 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21538 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21539
21540 @kindex set new-console
21541 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21542 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21543 be started in a new console on next start.
21544 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21545 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21546
21547 @kindex show new-console
21548 @item show new-console
21549 Displays whether a new console is used
21550 when the debuggee is started.
21551
21552 @kindex set new-group
21553 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21554 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21555 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21556 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21557 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21558
21559 @kindex show new-group
21560 @item show new-group
21561 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21562
21563 @kindex set debugevents
21564 @item set debugevents
21565 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21566 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21567 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21568 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21569 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21570
21571 @kindex set debugexec
21572 @item set debugexec
21573 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21574 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21575
21576 @kindex set debugexceptions
21577 @item set debugexceptions
21578 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21579 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21580
21581 @kindex set debugmemory
21582 @item set debugmemory
21583 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21584 and writes by the debugger.
21585
21586 @kindex set shell
21587 @item set shell
21588 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21589 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21590
21591 @kindex show shell
21592 @item show shell
21593 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21594
21595 @end table
21596
21597 @menu
21598 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21599 @end menu
21600
21601 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21602 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21603 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21604 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21605
21606 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21607 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21608 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21609 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21610 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21611 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21612 ``minimal symbols''.
21613
21614 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21615 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21616 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21617 program run once to completion.
21618
21619 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21620
21621 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21622 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21623 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21624 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21625 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21626 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21627 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21628 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21629 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21630
21631 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21632 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21633 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21634 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21635 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21636 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21637
21638 @smallexample
21639 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21640 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21641
21642 Non-debugging symbols:
21643 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21644 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21645 @end smallexample
21646
21647 @smallexample
21648 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21649 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21650
21651 Non-debugging symbols:
21652 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21653 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21654 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21655 [etc...]
21656 @end smallexample
21657
21658 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21659
21660 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21661 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21662 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21663 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21664 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21665 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21666 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21667
21668 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21669 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21670 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21671 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21672 problem:
21673
21674 @smallexample
21675 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21676 $1 = 268572168
21677 @end smallexample
21678
21679 @smallexample
21680 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21681 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21682 @end smallexample
21683
21684 And two possible solutions:
21685
21686 @smallexample
21687 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21688 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21689 @end smallexample
21690
21691 @smallexample
21692 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21693 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21694 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21695 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21696 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21697 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21698 @end smallexample
21699
21700 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21701 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21702 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21703 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21704 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21705
21706 @smallexample
21707 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21708 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21709 @end smallexample
21710
21711 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21712 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21713 safe.
21714
21715 @node Hurd Native
21716 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21717 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21718
21719 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21720 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21721
21722 @table @code
21723 @item set signals
21724 @itemx set sigs
21725 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21726 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21727 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21728 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21729 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21730 @code{signals}.
21731
21732 @item show signals
21733 @itemx show sigs
21734 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21735 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21736 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21737
21738 @item set signal-thread
21739 @itemx set sigthread
21740 @kindex set signal-thread
21741 @kindex set sigthread
21742 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21743 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21744 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21745 signal-thread}.
21746
21747 @item show signal-thread
21748 @itemx show sigthread
21749 @kindex show signal-thread
21750 @kindex show sigthread
21751 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21752 delivered a signal.
21753
21754 @item set stopped
21755 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21756 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21757 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21758 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21759
21760 @item show stopped
21761 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21762 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21763 stopped.
21764
21765 @item set exceptions
21766 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21767 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21768 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21769 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21770 trapping on.
21771
21772 @item show exceptions
21773 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21774 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21775
21776 @item set task pause
21777 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21778 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21779 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21780 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21781 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21782 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21783 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21784 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21785 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21786
21787 @item show task pause
21788 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21789 Show the current state of task suspension.
21790
21791 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21792 @cindex task suspend count
21793 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21794 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21795 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21796
21797 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21798 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21799
21800 @item set task exception-port
21801 @itemx set task excp
21802 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21803 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21804 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21805 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21806
21807 @item set noninvasive
21808 @cindex noninvasive task options
21809 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21810 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21811 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21812 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21813
21814 @item info send-rights
21815 @itemx info receive-rights
21816 @itemx info port-rights
21817 @itemx info port-sets
21818 @itemx info dead-names
21819 @itemx info ports
21820 @itemx info psets
21821 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21822 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21823 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21824 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21825 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21826 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21827 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21828 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21829 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21830
21831 @item set thread pause
21832 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21833 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21834 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21835 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21836 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21837 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21838 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21839 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21840 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21841 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21842 only the current thread.
21843
21844 @item show thread pause
21845 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21846 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21847
21848 @item set thread run
21849 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21850
21851 @item show thread run
21852 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21853
21854 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21855 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21856 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21857 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21858 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21859 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21860 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21861
21862 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21863 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21864 detaching.
21865
21866 @item set thread exception-port
21867 @itemx set thread excp
21868 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21869 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21870 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21871
21872 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21873 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21874 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21875 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21876
21877 @item set thread default
21878 @itemx show thread default
21879 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21880 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21881 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21882 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21883 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21884 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21885 the non-default commands.
21886 @end table
21887
21888 @node Darwin
21889 @subsection Darwin
21890 @cindex Darwin
21891
21892 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21893
21894 @table @code
21895 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21896 @kindex set debug darwin
21897 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21898 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21899
21900 @item show debug darwin
21901 @kindex show debug darwin
21902 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21903
21904 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21905 @kindex set debug mach-o
21906 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21907 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21908 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21909 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21910 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21911 usage.
21912
21913 @item show debug mach-o
21914 @kindex show debug mach-o
21915 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21916
21917 @item set mach-exceptions on
21918 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21919 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21920 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21921 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21922 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21923 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21924
21925 @item show mach-exceptions
21926 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21927 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21928 @end table
21929
21930
21931 @node Embedded OS
21932 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21933
21934 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21935 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21936 architectures.
21937
21938 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21939 various real-time operating systems.
21940
21941 @node Embedded Processors
21942 @section Embedded Processors
21943
21944 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21945 configurations.
21946
21947 @cindex send command to simulator
21948 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21949 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21950
21951 @table @code
21952 @item sim @var{command}
21953 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21954 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21955 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21956 acceptable commands.
21957 @end table
21958
21959
21960 @menu
21961 * ARM:: ARM
21962 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21963 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21964 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21965 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21966 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21967 * CRIS:: CRIS
21968 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21969 @end menu
21970
21971 @node ARM
21972 @subsection ARM
21973
21974 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21975
21976 @table @code
21977 @item set arm disassembler
21978 @kindex set arm
21979 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21980 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21981
21982 @item show arm disassembler
21983 @kindex show arm
21984 Show the current disassembly style.
21985
21986 @item set arm apcs32
21987 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21988 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21989
21990 @item show arm apcs32
21991 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21992
21993 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21994 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21995 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21996
21997 @table @code
21998 @item auto
21999 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22000 @item softfpa
22001 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22002 processors.
22003 @item fpa
22004 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22005 @item softvfp
22006 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22007 @item vfp
22008 VFP co-processor.
22009 @end table
22010
22011 @item show arm fpu
22012 Show the current type of the FPU.
22013
22014 @item set arm abi
22015 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22016
22017 @item show arm abi
22018 Show the currently used ABI.
22019
22020 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22021 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22022 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22023 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22024 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22025 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22026 register).
22027
22028 @item show arm fallback-mode
22029 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22030
22031 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22032 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22033 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22034 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22035 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22036
22037 @item show arm force-mode
22038 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22039
22040 @item set debug arm
22041 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22042 target support subsystem.
22043
22044 @item show debug arm
22045 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22046 @end table
22047
22048 @table @code
22049 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22050 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22051
22052 @table @code
22053 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22054 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22055 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22056 The default value is @code{all}.
22057
22058 @table @code
22059 @item none
22060 @item demon
22061 @item angel
22062 @item redboot
22063 @item all
22064 @end table
22065 @end table
22066 @end table
22067
22068 @node M68K
22069 @subsection M68k
22070
22071 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22072
22073 @node MicroBlaze
22074 @subsection MicroBlaze
22075 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22076 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22077
22078 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22079 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22080 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22081 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22082 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22083 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22084 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22085 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22086 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22087 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22088 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22089
22090 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22091
22092 @table @code
22093 @item target remote :1234
22094 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22095 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22096
22097 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22098 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22099 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22100
22101 @item load
22102 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22103
22104 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22105 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22106
22107 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22108 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22109 @end table
22110
22111 @node MIPS Embedded
22112 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22113
22114 @noindent
22115 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22116
22117 @table @code
22118 @item set mipsfpu double
22119 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22120 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22121 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22122 @itemx show mipsfpu
22123 @kindex set mipsfpu
22124 @kindex show mipsfpu
22125 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22126 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22127 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22128 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22129 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22130 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22131 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22132 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22133 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22134 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22135 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22136 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22137 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22138
22139 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22140 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22141 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22142
22143 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22144 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22145 @end table
22146
22147 @node PowerPC Embedded
22148 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22149
22150 @cindex DVC register
22151 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22152 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22153
22154 @smallexample
22155 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22156 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22157 @end smallexample
22158
22159 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22160 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22161 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22162 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22163 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22164 or newer.
22165
22166 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22167 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22168 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22169 watching variables of scalar types.
22170
22171 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22172 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22173
22174 @smallexample
22175 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22176 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22177 @end smallexample
22178
22179 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22180 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22181
22182 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22183 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22184 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22185 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22186 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22187 use the @code{break-range} command.
22188
22189 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22190
22191 @table @code
22192 @kindex break-range
22193 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22194 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22195 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22196 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22197 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22198 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22199 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22200 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22201 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22202
22203 @kindex set powerpc
22204 @item set powerpc soft-float
22205 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22206 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22207 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22208 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22209
22210 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22211 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22212 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22213 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22214 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22215 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22216 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22217 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22218
22219 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22220 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22221 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22222 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22223 address of its first byte.
22224
22225 @end table
22226
22227 @node AVR
22228 @subsection Atmel AVR
22229 @cindex AVR
22230
22231 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22232 following AVR-specific commands:
22233
22234 @table @code
22235 @item info io_registers
22236 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22237 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22238 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22239 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22240 @end table
22241
22242 @node CRIS
22243 @subsection CRIS
22244 @cindex CRIS
22245
22246 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22247 following CRIS-specific commands:
22248
22249 @table @code
22250 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22251 @cindex CRIS version
22252 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22253 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22254 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22255
22256 @item show cris-version
22257 Show the current CRIS version.
22258
22259 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22260 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22261 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22262 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22263 @code{R59}.
22264
22265 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22266 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22267
22268 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22269 @cindex CRIS mode
22270 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22271 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22272 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22273
22274 @item show cris-mode
22275 Show the current CRIS mode.
22276 @end table
22277
22278 @node Super-H
22279 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22280 @cindex Super-H
22281
22282 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22283 commands:
22284
22285 @table @code
22286 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22287 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22288 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22289 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22290 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22291 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22292 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22293 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22294 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22295 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22296 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22297 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22298
22299 @item show sh calling-convention
22300 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22301 Show the current calling convention setting.
22302
22303 @end table
22304
22305
22306 @node Architectures
22307 @section Architectures
22308
22309 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22310 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22311
22312 @menu
22313 * AArch64::
22314 * i386::
22315 * Alpha::
22316 * MIPS::
22317 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22318 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22319 * PowerPC::
22320 * Nios II::
22321 @end menu
22322
22323 @node AArch64
22324 @subsection AArch64
22325 @cindex AArch64 support
22326
22327 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22328 following special commands:
22329
22330 @table @code
22331 @item set debug aarch64
22332 @kindex set debug aarch64
22333 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22334 messages are to be displayed.
22335
22336 @item show debug aarch64
22337 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22338
22339 @end table
22340
22341 @node i386
22342 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22343
22344 @table @code
22345 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22346 @kindex set struct-convention
22347 @cindex struct return convention
22348 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22349 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22350 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22351 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22352 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22353 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22354 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22355 be returned in a register.
22356
22357 @item show struct-convention
22358 @kindex show struct-convention
22359 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22360 from functions.
22361 @end table
22362
22363
22364 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22365 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22366
22367 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22368 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22369 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22370 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22371 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22372 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22373 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22374
22375 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22376 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22377 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22378 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22379 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22380 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22381
22382 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22383 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22384 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22385
22386 @smallexample
22387 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22388 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22389 @end smallexample
22390
22391 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22392 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22393 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22394 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22395 the pointer.
22396
22397 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22398 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22399 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22400 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22401 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22402
22403 @table @code
22404 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22405 @kindex show mpx bound
22406 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22407
22408 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22409 @kindex set mpx bound
22410 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22411 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22412 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22413 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22414 @end table
22415
22416 @node Alpha
22417 @subsection Alpha
22418
22419 See the following section.
22420
22421 @node MIPS
22422 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22423
22424 @cindex stack on Alpha
22425 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22426 @cindex Alpha stack
22427 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22428 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22429 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22430 find the beginning of a function.
22431
22432 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22433 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22434 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22435 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22436 commands:
22437
22438 @table @code
22439 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22440 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22441 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22442 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22443 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22444 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22445 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22446 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22447
22448 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22449 Display the current limit.
22450 @end table
22451
22452 @noindent
22453 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22454 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22455
22456 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22457 programs:
22458
22459 @table @code
22460 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22461 @kindex set mips abi
22462 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22463 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22464 values of @var{arg} are:
22465
22466 @table @samp
22467 @item auto
22468 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22469 default).
22470 @item o32
22471 @item o64
22472 @item n32
22473 @item n64
22474 @item eabi32
22475 @item eabi64
22476 @end table
22477
22478 @item show mips abi
22479 @kindex show mips abi
22480 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22481
22482 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22483 @kindex set mips compression
22484 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22485 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22486 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22487 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22488 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22489 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22490 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22491 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22492 provided by the executable.
22493
22494 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22495 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22496 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22497 identified as such.
22498
22499 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22500 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22501 implicitly from an executable.
22502
22503 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22504 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22505 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22506 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22507 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22508
22509 @item show mips compression
22510 @kindex show mips compression
22511 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22512 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22513
22514 @item set mipsfpu
22515 @itemx show mipsfpu
22516 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22517
22518 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22519 @kindex set mips mask-address
22520 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22521 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22522 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22523 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22524 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22525
22526 @item show mips mask-address
22527 @kindex show mips mask-address
22528 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22529 not.
22530
22531 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22532 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22533 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22534 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22535 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22536 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22537
22538 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22539 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22540 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22541
22542 @item set debug mips
22543 @kindex set debug mips
22544 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22545 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22546
22547 @item show debug mips
22548 @kindex show debug mips
22549 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22550 @end table
22551
22552
22553 @node HPPA
22554 @subsection HPPA
22555 @cindex HPPA support
22556
22557 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22558 following special commands:
22559
22560 @table @code
22561 @item set debug hppa
22562 @kindex set debug hppa
22563 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22564 messages are to be displayed.
22565
22566 @item show debug hppa
22567 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22568
22569 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22570 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22571 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22572 given @var{address}.
22573
22574 @end table
22575
22576
22577 @node SPU
22578 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22579 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22580 @cindex SPU
22581
22582 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22583 it provides the following special commands:
22584
22585 @table @code
22586 @item info spu event
22587 @kindex info spu
22588 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22589 and pending event status.
22590
22591 @item info spu signal
22592 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22593 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22594 notification channels.
22595
22596 @item info spu mailbox
22597 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22598 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22599 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22600
22601 @item info spu dma
22602 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22603 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22604 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22605
22606 @item info spu proxydma
22607 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22608 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22609 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22610
22611 @end table
22612
22613 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22614 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22615 special commands:
22616
22617 @table @code
22618 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22619 @kindex set spu
22620 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22621 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22622 function. The default is @code{off}.
22623
22624 @item show spu stop-on-load
22625 @kindex show spu
22626 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22627
22628 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22629 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22630 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22631 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22632 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22633 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22634
22635 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22636 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22637
22638 @end table
22639
22640 @node PowerPC
22641 @subsection PowerPC
22642 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22643
22644 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22645 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22646 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22647 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22648 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22649
22650 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22651 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22652 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22653
22654 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22655 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22656
22657 @node Nios II
22658 @subsection Nios II
22659 @cindex Nios II architecture
22660
22661 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22662 it provides the following special commands:
22663
22664 @table @code
22665
22666 @item set debug nios2
22667 @kindex set debug nios2
22668 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22669 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22670
22671 @item show debug nios2
22672 @kindex show debug nios2
22673 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22674 @end table
22675
22676 @node Controlling GDB
22677 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22678
22679 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22680 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22681 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22682 described here.
22683
22684 @menu
22685 * Prompt:: Prompt
22686 * Editing:: Command editing
22687 * Command History:: Command history
22688 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22689 * Numbers:: Numbers
22690 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22691 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22692 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22693 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22694 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22695 @end menu
22696
22697 @node Prompt
22698 @section Prompt
22699
22700 @cindex prompt
22701
22702 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22703 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22704 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22705 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22706 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22707 which one you are talking to.
22708
22709 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22710 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22711 or a prompt that does not.
22712
22713 @table @code
22714 @kindex set prompt
22715 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22716 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22717
22718 @kindex show prompt
22719 @item show prompt
22720 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22721 @end table
22722
22723 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22724 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22725 are:
22726
22727 @table @code
22728 @kindex set extended-prompt
22729 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22730 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22731 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22732 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22733 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22734 is displayed.
22735
22736 For example:
22737
22738 @smallexample
22739 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22740 @end smallexample
22741
22742 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22743 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22744
22745 @kindex show extended-prompt
22746 @item show extended-prompt
22747 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22748 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22749 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22750 @end table
22751
22752 @node Editing
22753 @section Command Editing
22754 @cindex readline
22755 @cindex command line editing
22756
22757 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22758 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22759 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22760 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22761 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22762 debugging sessions.
22763
22764 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22765 command @code{set}.
22766
22767 @table @code
22768 @kindex set editing
22769 @cindex editing
22770 @item set editing
22771 @itemx set editing on
22772 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22773
22774 @item set editing off
22775 Disable command line editing.
22776
22777 @kindex show editing
22778 @item show editing
22779 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22780 @end table
22781
22782 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22783 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22784 @end ifset
22785 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22786 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22787 @end ifclear
22788 for more details about the Readline
22789 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22790 encouraged to read that chapter.
22791
22792 @node Command History
22793 @section Command History
22794 @cindex command history
22795
22796 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22797 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22798 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22799 history facility.
22800
22801 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22802 package, to provide the history facility.
22803 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22804 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22805 @end ifset
22806 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22807 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22808 @end ifclear
22809 for the detailed description of the History library.
22810
22811 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22812 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22813 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22814 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22815 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22816 pressed on a line by itself.
22817
22818 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22819 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22820 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22821 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22822
22823 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22824 history.
22825
22826 @table @code
22827 @cindex history substitution
22828 @cindex history file
22829 @kindex set history filename
22830 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22831 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22832 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22833 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22834 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22835 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22836 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22837 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22838 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22839 is not set.
22840
22841 @cindex save command history
22842 @kindex set history save
22843 @item set history save
22844 @itemx set history save on
22845 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22846 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22847
22848 @item set history save off
22849 Stop recording command history in a file.
22850
22851 @cindex history size
22852 @kindex set history size
22853 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22854 @item set history size @var{size}
22855 @itemx set history size unlimited
22856 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22857 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22858 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22859 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22860 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22861 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22862
22863 @cindex remove duplicate history
22864 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22865 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22866 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22867 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22868 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22869 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22870 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22871 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22872 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22873
22874 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22875 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22876
22877 @end table
22878
22879 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22880 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22881 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22882 @end ifset
22883 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22884 @xref{Event Designators},
22885 @end ifclear
22886 for more details.
22887
22888 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22889 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22890 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22891 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22892 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22893 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22894 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22895 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22896
22897 The commands to control history expansion are:
22898
22899 @table @code
22900 @item set history expansion on
22901 @itemx set history expansion
22902 @kindex set history expansion
22903 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22904
22905 @item set history expansion off
22906 Disable history expansion.
22907
22908 @c @group
22909 @kindex show history
22910 @item show history
22911 @itemx show history filename
22912 @itemx show history save
22913 @itemx show history size
22914 @itemx show history expansion
22915 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22916 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22917 @c @end group
22918 @end table
22919
22920 @table @code
22921 @kindex show commands
22922 @cindex show last commands
22923 @cindex display command history
22924 @item show commands
22925 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22926
22927 @item show commands @var{n}
22928 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22929
22930 @item show commands +
22931 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22932 @end table
22933
22934 @node Screen Size
22935 @section Screen Size
22936 @cindex size of screen
22937 @cindex screen size
22938 @cindex pagination
22939 @cindex page size
22940 @cindex pauses in output
22941
22942 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22943 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22944 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22945 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22946 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22947 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22948 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22949 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22950
22951 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22952 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22953 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22954 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22955 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22956 width} commands:
22957
22958 @table @code
22959 @kindex set height
22960 @kindex set width
22961 @kindex show width
22962 @kindex show height
22963 @item set height @var{lpp}
22964 @itemx set height unlimited
22965 @itemx show height
22966 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22967 @itemx set width unlimited
22968 @itemx show width
22969 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22970 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22971 commands display the current settings.
22972
22973 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22974 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22975 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22976 buffer.
22977
22978 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22979 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22980
22981 @item set pagination on
22982 @itemx set pagination off
22983 @kindex set pagination
22984 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22985 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22986 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22987 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22988
22989 @item show pagination
22990 @kindex show pagination
22991 Show the current pagination mode.
22992 @end table
22993
22994 @node Numbers
22995 @section Numbers
22996 @cindex number representation
22997 @cindex entering numbers
22998
22999 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23000 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23001 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23002 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23003 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23004 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23005 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23006 both input and output with the commands described below.
23007
23008 @table @code
23009 @kindex set input-radix
23010 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23011 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23012 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23013 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23014 example, any of
23015
23016 @smallexample
23017 set input-radix 012
23018 set input-radix 10.
23019 set input-radix 0xa
23020 @end smallexample
23021
23022 @noindent
23023 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23024 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23025 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23026 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23027 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23028 change the radix.
23029
23030 @kindex set output-radix
23031 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23032 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23033 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23034 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23035
23036 @kindex show input-radix
23037 @item show input-radix
23038 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23039
23040 @kindex show output-radix
23041 @item show output-radix
23042 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23043
23044 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23045 @itemx show radix
23046 @kindex set radix
23047 @kindex show radix
23048 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23049 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23050 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23051 default value of 10.
23052
23053 @end table
23054
23055 @node ABI
23056 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23057
23058 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23059 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23060 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23061 current ABI.
23062
23063 @cindex OS ABI
23064 @kindex set osabi
23065 @kindex show osabi
23066 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23067
23068 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23069 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23070 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23071 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23072 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23073 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23074 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23075 platform provides.
23076
23077 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23078 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23079 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23080 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23081
23082 @table @code
23083 @item show osabi
23084 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23085
23086 @item set osabi
23087 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23088
23089 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23090 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23091 @end table
23092
23093 @cindex float promotion
23094
23095 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23096 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23097 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23098 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23099 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23100 @code{double} and then passed.
23101
23102 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23103 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23104 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23105
23106 @table @code
23107 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23108 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23109 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23110 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23111 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23112
23113 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23114 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23115 functions.
23116
23117 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23118 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23119 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23120 @end table
23121
23122 @kindex set cp-abi
23123 @kindex show cp-abi
23124 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23125 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23126 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23127 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23128 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23129 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23130 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23131 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23132 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23133 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23134 ``auto''.
23135
23136 @table @code
23137 @item show cp-abi
23138 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23139
23140 @item set cp-abi
23141 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23142
23143 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23144 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23145 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23146 @end table
23147
23148 @node Auto-loading
23149 @section Automatically loading associated files
23150 @cindex auto-loading
23151
23152 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23153 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23154 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23155 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23156 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23157 sources).
23158
23159 @menu
23160 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23161 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23162
23163 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23164 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23165 @end menu
23166
23167 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23168 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23169 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23170
23171 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23172 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23173 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23174
23175 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23176 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23177
23178 @table @code
23179 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23180 @kindex set auto-load off
23181 @item set auto-load off
23182 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23183 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23184 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23185 @smallexample
23186 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23187 @end smallexample
23188
23189 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23190 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23191 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23192 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23193 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23194 @code{set auto-load no}.
23195
23196 @anchor{show auto-load}
23197 @kindex show auto-load
23198 @item show auto-load
23199 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23200 or disabled.
23201
23202 @smallexample
23203 (gdb) show auto-load
23204 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23205 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23206 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23207 is on.
23208 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23209 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23210 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23211 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23212 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23213 @end smallexample
23214
23215 @anchor{info auto-load}
23216 @kindex info auto-load
23217 @item info auto-load
23218 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23219 not.
23220
23221 @smallexample
23222 (gdb) info auto-load
23223 gdb-scripts:
23224 Loaded Script
23225 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23226 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23227 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23228 loaded.
23229 python-scripts:
23230 Loaded Script
23231 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23232 @end smallexample
23233 @end table
23234
23235 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23236
23237 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23238 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23239 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23240 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23241 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23242 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23243 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23244 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23245 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23246 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23247 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23248 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23249 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23250 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23251 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23252 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23253 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23254 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23255 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23256 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23257 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23258 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23259 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23260 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23261 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23262 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23263 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23264 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23265 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23266 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23267 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23268 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23269 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23270 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23271 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23272 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23273 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23274 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23275 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23276 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23277 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23278 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23279 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23280 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23281 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23282 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23283 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23284 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23285 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23286 @end multitable
23287
23288 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23289 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23290 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23291
23292 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23293 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23294 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23295
23296 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23297 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23298
23299 @table @code
23300 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23301 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23302 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23303 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23304 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23305
23306 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23307 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23308 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23309 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23310 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23311
23312 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23313 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23314 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23315 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23316 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23317 @end table
23318
23319 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23320 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23321 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23322
23323 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23324
23325 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23326 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23327
23328 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23329 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23330 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23331 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23332 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23333 library.
23334
23335 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23336 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23337
23338 @table @code
23339 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23340 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23341 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23342 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23343
23344 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23345 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23346 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23347 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23348 enabled or disabled.
23349
23350 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23351 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23352 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23353 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23354 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23355 @end table
23356
23357 @node Auto-loading safe path
23358 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23359 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23360
23361 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23362 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23363 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23364 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23365 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23366
23367 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23368 get loaded:
23369
23370 @smallexample
23371 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23372 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23373 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23374 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23375 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23376 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23377 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23378 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23379 @end smallexample
23380
23381 @noindent
23382 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23383 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23384
23385 @smallexample
23386 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23387 @end smallexample
23388
23389 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23390
23391 @table @code
23392 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23393 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23394 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23395 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23396 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23397 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23398 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23399 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23400 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23401 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23402
23403 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23404 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23405 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23406
23407 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23408 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23409 @item show auto-load safe-path
23410 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23411 scripts.
23412
23413 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23414 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23415 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23416 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23417 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23418 by the host platform path separator in use.
23419 @end table
23420
23421 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23422 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23423 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23424 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23425 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23426
23427 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23428 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23429 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23430 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23431 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23432 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23433 init file in the current directory
23434 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23435
23436 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23437 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23438
23439 @table @asis
23440 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23441 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23442 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23443 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23444
23445 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23446 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23447 @value{GDBN} session.
23448
23449 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23450 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23451 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23452 from trusted sources.
23453
23454 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23455 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23456 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23457 trusted sources.
23458 @end table
23459
23460 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23461 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23462
23463 @table @asis
23464 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23465 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23466
23467 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23468 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23469 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23470 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23471 @end table
23472
23473 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23474 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23475 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23476 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23477 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23478 recommended to be entered.
23479
23480 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23481 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23482 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23483
23484 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23485 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23486 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23487 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23488 be printed.
23489
23490 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23491 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23492 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23493
23494 @smallexample
23495 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23496 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23497 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23498 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23499 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23500 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23501 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23502 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23503 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23504 @end smallexample
23505
23506 @table @code
23507 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23508 @kindex set debug auto-load
23509 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23510 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23511
23512 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23513 @kindex show debug auto-load
23514 @item show debug auto-load
23515 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23516 on or off.
23517 @end table
23518
23519 @node Messages/Warnings
23520 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23521
23522 @cindex verbose operation
23523 @cindex optional warnings
23524 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23525 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23526 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23527 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23528
23529 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23530 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23531 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23532
23533 @table @code
23534 @kindex set verbose
23535 @item set verbose on
23536 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23537
23538 @item set verbose off
23539 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23540
23541 @kindex show verbose
23542 @item show verbose
23543 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23544 @end table
23545
23546 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23547 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23548 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23549 Symbol Files}).
23550
23551 @table @code
23552
23553 @kindex set complaints
23554 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23555 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23556 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23557 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23558 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23559
23560 @kindex show complaints
23561 @item show complaints
23562 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23563
23564 @end table
23565
23566 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23567 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23568 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23569 you try to run a program which is already running:
23570
23571 @smallexample
23572 (@value{GDBP}) run
23573 The program being debugged has been started already.
23574 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23575 @end smallexample
23576
23577 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23578 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23579
23580 @table @code
23581
23582 @kindex set confirm
23583 @cindex flinching
23584 @cindex confirmation
23585 @cindex stupid questions
23586 @item set confirm off
23587 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23588 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23589 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23590
23591 @item set confirm on
23592 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23593
23594 @kindex show confirm
23595 @item show confirm
23596 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23597
23598 @end table
23599
23600 @cindex command tracing
23601 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23602 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23603 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23604 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23605
23606 @table @code
23607 @kindex set trace-commands
23608 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23609 @item set trace-commands on
23610 Enable command tracing.
23611 @item set trace-commands off
23612 Disable command tracing.
23613 @item show trace-commands
23614 Display the current state of command tracing.
23615 @end table
23616
23617 @node Debugging Output
23618 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23619 @cindex optional debugging messages
23620
23621 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23622 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23623 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23624 section documents those commands.
23625
23626 @table @code
23627 @kindex set exec-done-display
23628 @item set exec-done-display
23629 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23630 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23631 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23632 @kindex show exec-done-display
23633 @item show exec-done-display
23634 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23635 notification.
23636 @kindex set debug
23637 @cindex ARM AArch64
23638 @item set debug aarch64
23639 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23640 The default is off.
23641 @kindex show debug
23642 @item show debug aarch64
23643 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23644 ARM AArch64.
23645 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23646 @cindex architecture debugging info
23647 @item set debug arch
23648 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23649 @item show debug arch
23650 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23651 @item set debug aix-solib
23652 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23653 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23654 support module. The default is off.
23655 @item show debug aix-thread
23656 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23657 @item set debug aix-thread
23658 @cindex AIX threads
23659 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23660 module.
23661 @item show debug aix-thread
23662 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23663 @item set debug check-physname
23664 @cindex physname
23665 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23666 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23667 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23668 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23669 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23670 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23671 @item show debug check-physname
23672 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23673 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23674 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23675 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23676 exported symbols. The default is off.
23677 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23678 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23679 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23680 @item set debug dwarf-die
23681 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23682 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23683 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23684 A value of zero turns off the display.
23685 @item show debug dwarf-die
23686 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23687 @item set debug dwarf-line
23688 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23689 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23690 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23691 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23692 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23693 @item show debug dwarf-line
23694 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23695 @item set debug dwarf-read
23696 @cindex DWARF Reading
23697 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23698 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23699 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23700 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23701 @item show debug dwarf-read
23702 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23703 @item set debug displaced
23704 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23705 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23706 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23707 @item show debug displaced
23708 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23709 related to displaced stepping.
23710 @item set debug event
23711 @cindex event debugging info
23712 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23713 default is off.
23714 @item show debug event
23715 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23716 info.
23717 @item set debug expression
23718 @cindex expression debugging info
23719 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23720 expression parsing. The default is off.
23721 @item show debug expression
23722 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23723 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23724 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23725 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23726 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23727 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23728 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23729 @item set debug frame
23730 @cindex frame debugging info
23731 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23732 default is off.
23733 @item show debug frame
23734 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23735 info.
23736 @item set debug gnu-nat
23737 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23738 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23739 @item show debug gnu-nat
23740 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23741 @item set debug infrun
23742 @cindex inferior debugging info
23743 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23744 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23745 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23746 @item show debug infrun
23747 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23748 @item set debug jit
23749 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23750 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23751 @item show debug jit
23752 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23753 @item set debug lin-lwp
23754 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23755 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23756 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23757 @item show debug lin-lwp
23758 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23759 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23760 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23761 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23762 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23763 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23764 @item set debug mach-o
23765 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23766 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23767 processing. The default is off.
23768 @item show debug mach-o
23769 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23770 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23771 @item set debug notification
23772 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23773 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23774 The default is off.
23775 @item show debug notification
23776 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23777 @item set debug observer
23778 @cindex observer debugging info
23779 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23780 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23781 @item show debug observer
23782 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23783 @item set debug overload
23784 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23785 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23786 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23787 is off.
23788 @item show debug overload
23789 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23790 debugging info.
23791 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23792 @cindex debug expression parser
23793 @item set debug parser
23794 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23795 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23796 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23797 details. The default is off.
23798 @item show debug parser
23799 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23800 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23801 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23802 @cindex debug remote protocol
23803 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23804 @cindex display remote packets
23805 @item set debug remote
23806 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23807 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23808 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23809 @item show debug remote
23810 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23811 @item set debug serial
23812 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23813 default is off.
23814 @item show debug serial
23815 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23816 info.
23817 @item set debug solib-frv
23818 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23819 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23820 @item show debug solib-frv
23821 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23822 messages.
23823 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23824 @cindex symbol lookup
23825 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23826 The default is 0 (off).
23827 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23828 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23829 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23830 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23831 @item set debug symfile
23832 @cindex symbol file functions
23833 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23834 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23835 @item show debug symfile
23836 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23837 @item set debug symtab-create
23838 @cindex symbol table creation
23839 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23840 The default is 0 (off).
23841 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23842 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23843 @item show debug symtab-create
23844 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23845 @item set debug target
23846 @cindex target debugging info
23847 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23848 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23849 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23850 value of large memory transfers.
23851 @item show debug target
23852 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23853 info.
23854 @item set debug timestamp
23855 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23856 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23857 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23858 message.
23859 @item show debug timestamp
23860 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23861 debugging info.
23862 @item set debug varobj
23863 @cindex variable object debugging info
23864 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23865 info. The default is off.
23866 @item show debug varobj
23867 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23868 debugging info.
23869 @item set debug xml
23870 @cindex XML parser debugging
23871 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23872 @item show debug xml
23873 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23874 @end table
23875
23876 @node Other Misc Settings
23877 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23878 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23879
23880 @table @code
23881 @kindex set interactive-mode
23882 @item set interactive-mode
23883 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23884 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23885 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23886 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23887 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23888 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23889 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23890 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23891
23892 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23893 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23894 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23895 inside a cygwin window.
23896
23897 @kindex show interactive-mode
23898 @item show interactive-mode
23899 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23900 @end table
23901
23902 @node Extending GDB
23903 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23904 @cindex extending GDB
23905
23906 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23907 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23908 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23909 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23910 being debugged.
23911
23912 @menu
23913 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23914 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23915 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23916 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23917 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23918 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23919 @end menu
23920
23921 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23922 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23923 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23924 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23925 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23926 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23927
23928 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23929 setting:
23930
23931 @table @code
23932 @kindex set script-extension
23933 @kindex show script-extension
23934 @item set script-extension off
23935 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23936
23937 @item set script-extension soft
23938 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23939 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23940 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23941 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23942
23943 @item set script-extension strict
23944 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23945 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23946 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23947
23948 @item show script-extension
23949 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23950
23951 @end table
23952
23953 @node Sequences
23954 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23955
23956 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23957 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23958 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23959 files.
23960
23961 @menu
23962 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23963 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23964 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23965 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23966 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23967 @end menu
23968
23969 @node Define
23970 @subsection User-defined Commands
23971
23972 @cindex user-defined command
23973 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23974 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23975 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23976 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23977 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23978 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23979
23980 @smallexample
23981 define adder
23982 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23983 end
23984 @end smallexample
23985
23986 @noindent
23987 To execute the command use:
23988
23989 @smallexample
23990 adder 1 2 3
23991 @end smallexample
23992
23993 @noindent
23994 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23995 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23996 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23997 functions calls.
23998
23999 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24000 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24001 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24002 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
24003
24004 @smallexample
24005 define adder
24006 if $argc == 2
24007 print $arg0 + $arg1
24008 end
24009 if $argc == 3
24010 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24011 end
24012 end
24013 @end smallexample
24014
24015 @table @code
24016
24017 @kindex define
24018 @item define @var{commandname}
24019 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24020 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24021 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24022 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24023 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24024 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24025
24026 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24027 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24028 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24029
24030 @kindex document
24031 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24032 @item document @var{commandname}
24033 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24034 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24035 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24036 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24037 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24038 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24039
24040 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24041 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24042 does not change the documentation.
24043
24044 @kindex dont-repeat
24045 @cindex don't repeat command
24046 @item dont-repeat
24047 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24048 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24049 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24050
24051 @kindex help user-defined
24052 @item help user-defined
24053 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24054 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24055 included (if any).
24056
24057 @kindex show user
24058 @item show user
24059 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24060 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24061 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24062 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24063 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24064
24065 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24066 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24067 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24068 @item show max-user-call-depth
24069 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24070 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24071 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24072 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24073 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24074 @end table
24075
24076 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24077 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24078
24079 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24080 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24081 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24082
24083 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24084 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24085 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24086 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24087
24088 @node Hooks
24089 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24090 @cindex command hooks
24091 @cindex hooks, for commands
24092 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24093
24094 @kindex hook
24095 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24096 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24097 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24098 before that command.
24099
24100 @cindex hooks, post-command
24101 @kindex hookpost
24102 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24103 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24104 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24105 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24106 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24107
24108 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24109 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24110
24111 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24112 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24113
24114 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24115 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24116 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24117 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24118 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24119
24120 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24121 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24122 you could define:
24123
24124 @smallexample
24125 define hook-stop
24126 handle SIGALRM nopass
24127 end
24128
24129 define hook-run
24130 handle SIGALRM pass
24131 end
24132
24133 define hook-continue
24134 handle SIGALRM pass
24135 end
24136 @end smallexample
24137
24138 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24139 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24140 you could define:
24141
24142 @smallexample
24143 define hook-echo
24144 echo <<<---
24145 end
24146
24147 define hookpost-echo
24148 echo --->>>\n
24149 end
24150
24151 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24152 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24153 (@value{GDBP})
24154
24155 @end smallexample
24156
24157 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24158 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24159 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24160 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24161 @c or not?
24162 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24163 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24164 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24165
24166 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24167 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24168 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24169
24170 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24171 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24172
24173 @node Command Files
24174 @subsection Command Files
24175
24176 @cindex command files
24177 @cindex scripting commands
24178 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24179 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24180 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24181 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24182 terminal.
24183
24184 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24185 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24186 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24187 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24188 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24189
24190 @table @code
24191 @kindex source
24192 @cindex execute commands from a file
24193 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24194 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24195 @end table
24196
24197 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24198 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24199 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24200 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24201 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24202
24203 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24204 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24205 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24206 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24207 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24208 is not relevant to scripts.
24209
24210 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24211 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24212 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24213 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24214 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24215 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24216 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24217 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24218 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24219 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24220 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24221 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24222 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24223 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24224
24225 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24226 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24227 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24228
24229 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24230 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24231 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24232 when called from command files.
24233
24234 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24235 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24236 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24237 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24238 the next command.
24239
24240 @smallexample
24241 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24242 @end smallexample
24243
24244 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24245 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24246 would be directed to @file{log}.
24247
24248 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24249 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24250 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24251 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24252 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24253 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24254 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24255 conditionally, etc.
24256
24257 @table @code
24258 @kindex if
24259 @kindex else
24260 @item if
24261 @itemx else
24262 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24263 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24264 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24265 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24266 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24267 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24268 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24269
24270 @kindex while
24271 @item while
24272 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24273 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24274 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24275 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24276 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24277 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24278
24279 @kindex loop_break
24280 @item loop_break
24281 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24282 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24283 line.
24284
24285 @kindex loop_continue
24286 @item loop_continue
24287 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24288 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24289 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24290 the controlling expression.
24291
24292 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24293 @item end
24294 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24295 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24296 @end table
24297
24298
24299 @node Output
24300 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24301
24302 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24303 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24304 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24305 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24306 want.
24307
24308 @table @code
24309 @kindex echo
24310 @item echo @var{text}
24311 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24312 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24313 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24314 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24315 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24316 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24317 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24318 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24319 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24320 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24321 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24322
24323 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24324 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24325
24326 @smallexample
24327 echo This is some text\n\
24328 which is continued\n\
24329 onto several lines.\n
24330 @end smallexample
24331
24332 produces the same output as
24333
24334 @smallexample
24335 echo This is some text\n
24336 echo which is continued\n
24337 echo onto several lines.\n
24338 @end smallexample
24339
24340 @kindex output
24341 @item output @var{expression}
24342 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24343 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24344 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24345 on expressions.
24346
24347 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24348 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24349 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24350 Formats}, for more information.
24351
24352 @kindex printf
24353 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24354 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24355 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24356 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24357 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24358 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24359 executing the code below:
24360
24361 @smallexample
24362 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24363 @end smallexample
24364
24365 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24366 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24367 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24368 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24369 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24370 printed.
24371
24372 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24373
24374 @smallexample
24375 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24376 @end smallexample
24377
24378 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24379 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24380 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24381
24382 @itemize @bullet
24383 @item
24384 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24385
24386 @item
24387 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24388 width.
24389
24390 @item
24391 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24392 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24393
24394 @item
24395 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24396 supported.
24397
24398 @item
24399 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24400
24401 @item
24402 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24403 @end itemize
24404
24405 @noindent
24406 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24407 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24408 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24409 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24410
24411 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24412 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24413 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24414 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24415 supported.
24416
24417 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24418 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24419 together with a floating point specifier.
24420 letters:
24421
24422 @itemize @bullet
24423 @item
24424 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24425
24426 @item
24427 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24428
24429 @item
24430 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24431 @end itemize
24432
24433 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24434 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24435 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24436
24437 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24438 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24439
24440 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24441 @smallexample
24442 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24443 @end smallexample
24444
24445 @kindex eval
24446 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24447 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24448 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24449
24450 @end table
24451
24452 @node Auto-loading sequences
24453 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24454 @cindex native script auto-loading
24455
24456 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24457 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24458 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24459 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24460
24461 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24462 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24463
24464 @table @code
24465 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24466 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24467 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24468 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24469
24470 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24471 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24472 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24473 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24474 disabled.
24475
24476 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24477 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24478 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24479 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24480 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24481 auto-loaded.
24482 @end table
24483
24484 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24485 matching names are printed.
24486
24487 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24488 @include python.texi
24489
24490 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24491 @include guile.texi
24492
24493 @node Auto-loading extensions
24494 @section Auto-loading extensions
24495 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24496
24497 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24498 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24499 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24500 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24501 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24502
24503 @menu
24504 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24505 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24506 * Which flavor to choose?::
24507 @end menu
24508
24509 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24510 debugging commands and features.
24511
24512 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24513 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24514 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24515 for more information.
24516 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24517 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24518
24519 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24520 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24521
24522 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24523 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24524 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24525 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24526 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24527
24528 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24529 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24530 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24531 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24532
24533 @table @code
24534 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24535 GDB's own command language
24536 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24537 Python
24538 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24539 Guile
24540 @end table
24541
24542 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24543 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24544 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24545 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24546 script in the specified extension language.
24547
24548 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24549 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24550
24551 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24552 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24553
24554 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24555 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24556 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24557 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24558 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24559 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24560
24561 @table @code
24562 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24563 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24564 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24565 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24566 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24567 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24568
24569 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24570 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24571
24572 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24573 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24574 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24575 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24576
24577 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24578 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24579 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24580 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24581 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24582 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24583 platform.
24584
24585 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24586 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24587 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24588
24589 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24590 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24591 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24592 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24593
24594 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24595 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24596 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24597 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24598 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24599 @end table
24600
24601 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24602 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24603 @var{objfile} is opened.
24604 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24605 is evaluated more than once.
24606
24607 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24608 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24609 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24610
24611 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24612 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24613 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24614 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24615 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24616 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24617 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24618
24619 The following entries are supported:
24620
24621 @table @code
24622 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24623 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24624 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24625 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24626 @end table
24627
24628 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24629
24630 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24631 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24632 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24633 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24634 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24635
24636 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24637 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24638
24639 @example
24640 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24641 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24642 asm("\
24643 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24644 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24645 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24646 .popsection \n\
24647 ");
24648 @end example
24649
24650 @noindent
24651 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24652 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24653
24654 @example
24655 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24656 @end example
24657
24658 The script name may include directories if desired.
24659
24660 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24661 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24662
24663 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24664 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24665 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24666 will remove duplicates.
24667
24668 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24669
24670 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24671 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24672 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24673 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24674 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24675 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24676 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24677 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24678 on its name.
24679
24680 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24681 testsuite.
24682
24683 @example
24684 #include "symcat.h"
24685 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24686 asm(
24687 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24688 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24689 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24690 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24691 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24692 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24693 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24694 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24695 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24696 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24697 ".byte 0\n"
24698 ".popsection\n"
24699 );
24700 @end example
24701
24702 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24703 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24704 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24705 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24706
24707 @node Which flavor to choose?
24708 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24709
24710 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24711 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24712
24713 @noindent
24714 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24715
24716 @itemize @bullet
24717 @item
24718 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24719
24720 @item
24721 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24722
24723 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24724 in the source search path.
24725 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24726 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24727
24728 @item
24729 Doesn't require source code additions.
24730 @end itemize
24731
24732 @noindent
24733 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24734
24735 @itemize @bullet
24736 @item
24737 Works with static linking.
24738
24739 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24740 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24741 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24742 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24743 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24744
24745 @item
24746 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24747
24748 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24749 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24750
24751 @item
24752 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24753
24754 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24755 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24756 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24757 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24758 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24759 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24760 @end itemize
24761
24762 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24763 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24764
24765 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24766 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24767 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24768
24769 @subsection Python comes first
24770
24771 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24772 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24773 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24774 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24775 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24776 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24777 pretty-printed form of a value).
24778 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24779 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24780 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24781
24782 @node Aliases
24783 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24784 @cindex aliases for commands
24785
24786 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24787 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24788 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24789 that involves less typing.
24790
24791 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24792 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24793 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24794
24795 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24796 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24797 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24798
24799 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24800
24801 @table @code
24802
24803 @kindex alias
24804 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24805
24806 @end table
24807
24808 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24809 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24810 underscores.
24811
24812 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24813 that is being aliased.
24814
24815 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24816 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24817 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24818
24819 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24820 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24821
24822 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24823 of a command so that there is less to type.
24824 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24825 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24826 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24827 The following will accomplish this.
24828
24829 @smallexample
24830 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24831 @end smallexample
24832
24833 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24834 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24835 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24836 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24837
24838 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24839 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24840 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24841 of a command.
24842
24843 @smallexample
24844 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24845 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24846 (gdb) set p elms 20
24847 (gdb) show p elms
24848 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24849 @end smallexample
24850
24851 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24852 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24853 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24854
24855 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24856 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24857
24858 @smallexample
24859 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24860 @end smallexample
24861
24862 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24863 alias for a more complex command.
24864 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24865
24866 @smallexample
24867 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24868 (gdb) spe 20
24869 @end smallexample
24870
24871 @node Interpreters
24872 @chapter Command Interpreters
24873 @cindex command interpreters
24874
24875 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24876 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24877 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24878
24879 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24880 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24881 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24882 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24883
24884 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24885 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24886 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24887 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24888
24889 @table @code
24890 @item console
24891 @cindex console interpreter
24892 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24893 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24894 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24895
24896 @item mi
24897 @cindex mi interpreter
24898 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24899 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24900 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24901 Interface}.
24902
24903 @item mi2
24904 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24905 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24906
24907 @item mi1
24908 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24909 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24910
24911 @end table
24912
24913 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24914 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24915 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24916 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24917 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24918 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24919 the IDE inoperable!
24920
24921 @kindex interpreter-exec
24922 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24923 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24924 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24925 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24926
24927 @smallexample
24928 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24929 @end smallexample
24930
24931 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24932 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24933
24934 @node TUI
24935 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24936 @cindex TUI
24937 @cindex Text User Interface
24938
24939 @menu
24940 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24941 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24942 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24943 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24944 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24945 @end menu
24946
24947 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24948 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24949 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24950 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24951 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24952 is available.
24953
24954 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24955 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24956 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24957 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
24958 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
24959 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24960
24961 @node TUI Overview
24962 @section TUI Overview
24963
24964 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24965
24966 @table @emph
24967 @item command
24968 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24969 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24970 managed using readline.
24971
24972 @item source
24973 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24974 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24975
24976 @item assembly
24977 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24978
24979 @item register
24980 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24981 when their values change.
24982 @end table
24983
24984 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24985 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24986 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24987 indicates the breakpoint type:
24988
24989 @table @code
24990 @item B
24991 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24992
24993 @item b
24994 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24995
24996 @item H
24997 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24998
24999 @item h
25000 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25001 @end table
25002
25003 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25004
25005 @table @code
25006 @item +
25007 Breakpoint is enabled.
25008
25009 @item -
25010 Breakpoint is disabled.
25011 @end table
25012
25013 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25014 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25015 changes.
25016
25017 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25018 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25019 layouts:
25020
25021 @itemize @bullet
25022 @item
25023 source only,
25024
25025 @item
25026 assembly only,
25027
25028 @item
25029 source and assembly,
25030
25031 @item
25032 source and registers, or
25033
25034 @item
25035 assembly and registers.
25036 @end itemize
25037
25038 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25039
25040 @table @emph
25041 @item target
25042 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25043 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25044
25045 @item process
25046 Gives the current process or thread number.
25047 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25048
25049 @item function
25050 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25051 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25052 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25053 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25054
25055 @item line
25056 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25057 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25058
25059 @item pc
25060 Indicates the current program counter address.
25061 @end table
25062
25063 @node TUI Keys
25064 @section TUI Key Bindings
25065 @cindex TUI key bindings
25066
25067 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25068 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25069 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25070 @end ifset
25071 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25072 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25073 @end ifclear
25074 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25075 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25076
25077 @table @kbd
25078 @kindex C-x C-a
25079 @item C-x C-a
25080 @kindex C-x a
25081 @itemx C-x a
25082 @kindex C-x A
25083 @itemx C-x A
25084 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25085 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25086 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25087 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25088 The screen is then refreshed.
25089
25090 @kindex C-x 1
25091 @item C-x 1
25092 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25093 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25094 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25095
25096 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25097
25098 @kindex C-x 2
25099 @item C-x 2
25100 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25101 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25102 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25103 previous layout and the new one.
25104
25105 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25106
25107 @kindex C-x o
25108 @item C-x o
25109 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25110 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25111 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25112
25113 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25114
25115 @kindex C-x s
25116 @item C-x s
25117 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25118 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25119 @end table
25120
25121 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25122
25123 @table @asis
25124 @kindex PgUp
25125 @item @key{PgUp}
25126 Scroll the active window one page up.
25127
25128 @kindex PgDn
25129 @item @key{PgDn}
25130 Scroll the active window one page down.
25131
25132 @kindex Up
25133 @item @key{Up}
25134 Scroll the active window one line up.
25135
25136 @kindex Down
25137 @item @key{Down}
25138 Scroll the active window one line down.
25139
25140 @kindex Left
25141 @item @key{Left}
25142 Scroll the active window one column left.
25143
25144 @kindex Right
25145 @item @key{Right}
25146 Scroll the active window one column right.
25147
25148 @kindex C-L
25149 @item @kbd{C-L}
25150 Refresh the screen.
25151 @end table
25152
25153 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25154 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25155 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25156 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25157 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25158
25159 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25160 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25161 @cindex TUI single key mode
25162
25163 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25164 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25165 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25166
25167 @table @kbd
25168 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25169 @item c
25170 continue
25171
25172 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25173 @item d
25174 down
25175
25176 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25177 @item f
25178 finish
25179
25180 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25181 @item n
25182 next
25183
25184 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25185 @item q
25186 exit the SingleKey mode.
25187
25188 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25189 @item r
25190 run
25191
25192 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25193 @item s
25194 step
25195
25196 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25197 @item u
25198 up
25199
25200 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25201 @item v
25202 info locals
25203
25204 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25205 @item w
25206 where
25207 @end table
25208
25209 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25210 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25211 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25212 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25213 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25214 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25215
25216
25217 @node TUI Commands
25218 @section TUI-specific Commands
25219 @cindex TUI commands
25220
25221 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25222 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25223 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25224 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25225
25226 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25227 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25228 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25229 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25230 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25231
25232 @table @code
25233 @item tui enable
25234 @kindex tui enable
25235 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25236 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25237 otherwise a default layout is used.
25238
25239 @item tui disable
25240 @kindex tui disable
25241 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25242
25243 @item info win
25244 @kindex info win
25245 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25246
25247 @item layout @var{name}
25248 @kindex layout
25249 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25250 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25251 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25252
25253 @table @code
25254 @item next
25255 Display the next layout.
25256
25257 @item prev
25258 Display the previous layout.
25259
25260 @item src
25261 Display the source and command windows.
25262
25263 @item asm
25264 Display the assembly and command windows.
25265
25266 @item split
25267 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25268
25269 @item regs
25270 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25271 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25272 register, assembler, and command windows.
25273 @end table
25274
25275 @item focus @var{name}
25276 @kindex focus
25277 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25278 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25279
25280 @table @code
25281 @item next
25282 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25283
25284 @item prev
25285 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25286
25287 @item src
25288 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25289
25290 @item asm
25291 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25292
25293 @item regs
25294 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25295
25296 @item cmd
25297 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25298 @end table
25299
25300 @item refresh
25301 @kindex refresh
25302 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25303
25304 @item tui reg @var{group}
25305 @kindex tui reg
25306 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25307 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25308 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25309 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25310 following groups are available on most targets:
25311 @table @code
25312 @item next
25313 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25314 through all of the available register groups.
25315
25316 @item prev
25317 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25318 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25319 @var{next}.
25320
25321 @item general
25322 Display the general registers.
25323 @item float
25324 Display the floating point registers.
25325 @item system
25326 Display the system registers.
25327 @item vector
25328 Display the vector registers.
25329 @item all
25330 Display all registers.
25331 @end table
25332
25333 @item update
25334 @kindex update
25335 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25336
25337 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25338 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25339 @kindex winheight
25340 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25341 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25342 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25343 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25344 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25345
25346 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25347 @kindex tabset
25348 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25349 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25350 assembly windows.
25351 @end table
25352
25353 @node TUI Configuration
25354 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25355 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25356
25357 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25358
25359 @table @code
25360 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25361 @kindex set tui border-kind
25362 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25363 The possible values are the following:
25364 @table @code
25365 @item space
25366 Use a space character to draw the border.
25367
25368 @item ascii
25369 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25370
25371 @item acs
25372 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25373 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25374 @end table
25375
25376 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25377 @kindex set tui border-mode
25378 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25379 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25380 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25381 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25382 @table @code
25383 @item normal
25384 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25385
25386 @item standout
25387 Use standout mode.
25388
25389 @item reverse
25390 Use reverse video mode.
25391
25392 @item half
25393 Use half bright mode.
25394
25395 @item half-standout
25396 Use half bright and standout mode.
25397
25398 @item bold
25399 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25400
25401 @item bold-standout
25402 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25403 @end table
25404 @end table
25405
25406 @node Emacs
25407 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25408
25409 @cindex Emacs
25410 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25411 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25412 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25413 @value{GDBN}.
25414
25415 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25416 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25417 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25418 created Emacs buffer.
25419 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25420
25421 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25422 things:
25423
25424 @itemize @bullet
25425 @item
25426 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25427 the GUD buffer.
25428
25429 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25430 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25431
25432 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25433 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25434 in this way.
25435
25436 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25437 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25438 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25439 stop.
25440
25441 @item
25442 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25443
25444 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25445 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25446 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25447 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25448 and the source.
25449
25450 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25451 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25452 @end itemize
25453
25454 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25455 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25456 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25457 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25458
25459 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25460 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25461 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25462 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25463 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25464 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25465 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25466 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25467 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25468
25469 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25470 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25471 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25472 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25473
25474 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25475 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25476 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25477 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25478 one you want.
25479
25480 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25481 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25482
25483 @table @kbd
25484 @item C-h m
25485 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25486
25487 @item C-c C-s
25488 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25489 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25490
25491 @item C-c C-n
25492 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25493 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25494 to show the current file and location.
25495
25496 @item C-c C-i
25497 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25498 display window accordingly.
25499
25500 @item C-c C-f
25501 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25502 @code{finish} command.
25503
25504 @item C-c C-r
25505 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25506 command.
25507
25508 @item C-c <
25509 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25510 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25511 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25512
25513 @item C-c >
25514 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25515 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25516 @end table
25517
25518 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25519 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25520
25521 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25522 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25523 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25524 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25525 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25526 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25527 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25528
25529 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25530 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25531 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25532 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25533 frame.
25534
25535 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25536 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25537 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25538 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25539 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25540 to correspond properly with the code.
25541
25542 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25543 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25544 Emacs Manual}).
25545
25546 @node GDB/MI
25547 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25548
25549 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25550
25551 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25552 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25553 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25554 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25555 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25556 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25557
25558 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25559 in the form of a reference manual.
25560
25561 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25562 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25563 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25564
25565 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25566
25567 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25568 This chapter uses the following notation:
25569
25570 @itemize @bullet
25571 @item
25572 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25573
25574 @item
25575 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25576 it may or may not be given.
25577
25578 @item
25579 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25580 may repeat zero or more times.
25581
25582 @item
25583 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25584 may repeat one or more times.
25585
25586 @item
25587 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25588 @end itemize
25589
25590 @ignore
25591 @heading Dependencies
25592 @end ignore
25593
25594 @menu
25595 * GDB/MI General Design::
25596 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25597 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25598 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25599 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25600 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25601 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25602 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25603 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25604 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25605 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25606 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25607 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25608 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25609 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25610 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25611 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25612 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25613 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25614 @ignore
25615 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25616 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25617 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25618 @end ignore
25619 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25620 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25621 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25622 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25623 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25624 @end menu
25625
25626 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25627 @node GDB/MI General Design
25628 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25629 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25630
25631 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25632 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25633 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25634 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25635 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25636 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25637 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25638 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25639 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25640 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25641
25642 The important examples of notifications are:
25643 @itemize @bullet
25644
25645 @item
25646 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25647 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25648 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25649 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25650 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25651 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25652 command itself was successfully executed.
25653
25654 @item
25655 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25656 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25657 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25658 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25659 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25660 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25661
25662 @item
25663 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25664 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25665 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25666 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25667 orthogonal frontend design.
25668
25669 @end itemize
25670
25671 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25672 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25673 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25674 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25675 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25676 the user interface.
25677
25678
25679 @menu
25680 * Context management::
25681 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25682 * Thread groups::
25683 @end menu
25684
25685 @node Context management
25686 @subsection Context management
25687
25688 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25689
25690 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25691 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25692 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25693 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25694 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25695 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25696 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25697 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25698 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25699
25700 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25701 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25702 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25703 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25704 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25705 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25706 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25707 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25708 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25709 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25710 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25711
25712 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25713 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25714 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25715 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25716 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25717 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25718 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25719 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25720 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25721 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25722
25723 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25724 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25725 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25726 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25727 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25728 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25729 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25730 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25731 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25732 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25733 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25734 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25735 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25736 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25737 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25738 @samp{--frame} options.
25739
25740 @subsubsection Language
25741
25742 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25743 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25744 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25745 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25746 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25747 For instance:
25748
25749 @smallexample
25750 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25751 ^done,value="4"
25752 (gdb)
25753 @end smallexample
25754
25755 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25756 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25757 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25758
25759 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25760 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25761
25762 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25763 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25764 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25765 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25766 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25767 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25768 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25769 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25770 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25771
25772 @table @code
25773 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25774 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25775 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25776
25777 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25778 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25779 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25780
25781 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25782 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25783 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25784 MI commands even while the target is running.
25785
25786 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25787 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25788 @end table
25789
25790 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25791 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25792 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25793 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25794 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25795 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25796
25797 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25798 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25799 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25800 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25801 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25802 are running.
25803
25804 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25805 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25806 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25807 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25808 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25809 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25810 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25811 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25812 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25813 @samp{--thread} option).
25814
25815 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25816 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25817 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25818 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25819
25820 @node Thread groups
25821 @subsection Thread groups
25822 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25823 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25824 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25825 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25826 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25827
25828 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25829 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25830 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25831 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25832 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25833 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25834 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25835 into processes.
25836
25837 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25838 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25839 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25840 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25841 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25842 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25843 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25844 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25845 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25846 the members of specific thread group.
25847
25848 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25849 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25850 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25851 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25852 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25853 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25854 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25855 after attaching to that thread group.
25856
25857 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25858 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25859 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25860 such thread groups.
25861
25862 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25863 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25864 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25865
25866 @menu
25867 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25868 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25869 @end menu
25870
25871 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25872 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25873
25874 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25875 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25876 @table @code
25877 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25878 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25879
25880 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25881 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25882 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25883
25884 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25885 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25886 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25887
25888 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25889 "any sequence of digits"
25890
25891 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25892 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25893
25894 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25895 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25896
25897 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25898 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25899
25900 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25901 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25902 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25903
25904 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25905 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25906
25907 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25908 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25909 @end table
25910
25911 @noindent
25912 Notes:
25913
25914 @itemize @bullet
25915 @item
25916 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25917 output is described below.
25918
25919 @item
25920 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25921 finishes.
25922
25923 @item
25924 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25925 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25926 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25927 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25928 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25929 @end itemize
25930
25931 Pragmatics:
25932
25933 @itemize @bullet
25934 @item
25935 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25936
25937 @item
25938 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25939 @end itemize
25940
25941 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25942 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25943
25944 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25945 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25946 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25947 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25948 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25949 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25950
25951 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25952 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25953 @var{token}.
25954
25955 @table @code
25956 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25957 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25958
25959 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25960 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25961
25962 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25963 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25964
25965 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25966 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25967
25968 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25969 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25970
25971 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25972 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25973
25974 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25975 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25976
25977 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25978 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25979
25980 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25981 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25982
25983 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25984 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25985 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25986
25987 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25988 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25989
25990 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25991 @code{ @var{string} }
25992
25993 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25994 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25995
25996 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25997 @code{@var{c-string}}
25998
25999 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26000 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26001
26002 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26003 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26004 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26005
26006 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26007 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26008
26009 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26010 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26011
26012 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26013 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26014
26015 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26016 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26017
26018 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26019 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26020
26021 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26022 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26023 @end table
26024
26025 @noindent
26026 Notes:
26027
26028 @itemize @bullet
26029 @item
26030 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26031
26032 @item
26033 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26034 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26035 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26036 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26037 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26038 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26039 prior command.
26040
26041 @item
26042 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26043 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26044 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26045 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26046
26047 @item
26048 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26049 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26050 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26051 @samp{*}.
26052
26053 @item
26054 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26055 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26056 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26057 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26058
26059 @item
26060 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26061 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26062 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26063 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26064
26065 @item
26066 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26067 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26068 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26069
26070 @item
26071 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26072 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26073 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26074 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26075
26076 @item
26077 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26078 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26079 @var{values}.
26080
26081
26082 @end itemize
26083
26084 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26085 details about the various output records.
26086
26087 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26088 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26089 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26090
26091 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26092 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26093
26094 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26095 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26096 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26097 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26098 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26099 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26100
26101 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26102 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26103 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26104
26105 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26106 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26107 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26108 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26109
26110 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26111 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26112
26113 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26114 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26115 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26116 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26117 might change.
26118
26119 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26120 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26121 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26122 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26123
26124 @itemize @bullet
26125 @item
26126 New MI commands may be added.
26127
26128 @item
26129 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26130
26131 @item
26132 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26133 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26134
26135 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26136 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26137
26138 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26139 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26140 @end itemize
26141
26142 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26143 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26144 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26145 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26146 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26147
26148 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26149 @c version?
26150
26151 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26152 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26153 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26154 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26155 @cindex mailing lists
26156
26157 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26158 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26159 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26160
26161 @menu
26162 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26163 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26164 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26165 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26166 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26167 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26168 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26169 @end menu
26170
26171 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26172 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26173
26174 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26175 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26176 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26177 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26178
26179 @table @code
26180 @findex ^done
26181 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26182 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26183 values.
26184
26185 @item "^running"
26186 @findex ^running
26187 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26188 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26189 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26190 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26191 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26192 which threads are resumed.
26193
26194 @item "^connected"
26195 @findex ^connected
26196 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26197
26198 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26199 @findex ^error
26200 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26201 the corresponding error message.
26202
26203 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26204 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26205 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26206
26207 @table @samp
26208 @item "undefined-command"
26209 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26210 @end table
26211
26212 @item "^exit"
26213 @findex ^exit
26214 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26215
26216 @end table
26217
26218 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26219 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26220
26221 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26222 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26223 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26224 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26225 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26226
26227 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26228 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26229 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26230 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26231 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26232
26233 @table @code
26234 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26235 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26236 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26237
26238 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26239 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26240 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26241 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26242
26243 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26244 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26245 internals.
26246 @end table
26247
26248 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26249 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26250
26251 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26252 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26253 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26254 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26255 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26256 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26257
26258 The following is the list of possible async records:
26259
26260 @table @code
26261
26262 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26263 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26264 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26265 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26266 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26267 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26268 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26269 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26270 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26271 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26272 it run freely.
26273
26274 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26275 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26276 following values:
26277
26278 @table @code
26279 @item breakpoint-hit
26280 A breakpoint was reached.
26281 @item watchpoint-trigger
26282 A watchpoint was triggered.
26283 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26284 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26285 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26286 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26287 @item function-finished
26288 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26289 @item location-reached
26290 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26291 @item watchpoint-scope
26292 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26293 @item end-stepping-range
26294 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26295 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26296 @item exited-signalled
26297 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26298 @item exited
26299 The inferior exited.
26300 @item exited-normally
26301 The inferior exited normally.
26302 @item signal-received
26303 A signal was received by the inferior.
26304 @item solib-event
26305 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26306 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26307 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26308 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26309 @item fork
26310 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26311 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26312 @item vfork
26313 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26314 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26315 @item syscall-entry
26316 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26317 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26318 @item syscall-return
26319 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26320 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26321 @item exec
26322 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26323 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26324 @end table
26325
26326 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26327 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26328 Depending on whether all-stop
26329 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26330 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26331 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26332 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26333 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26334 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26335 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26336 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26337 if such information is not available.
26338
26339 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26340 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26341 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26342 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26343 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26344 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26345 cannot be used in any way.
26346
26347 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26348 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26349 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26350 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26351 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26352 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26353
26354 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26355 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26356 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26357 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26358 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26359 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26360
26361 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26362 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26363 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26364 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26365 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26366
26367 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26368 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26369 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26370 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26371 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26372 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26373 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26374
26375 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26376 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26377 that thread.
26378
26379 @item =library-loaded,...
26380 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26381 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26382 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26383 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26384 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26385 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26386 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26387 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26388 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26389 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26390 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26391 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26392 thread groups.
26393
26394 @item =library-unloaded,...
26395 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26396 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26397 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26398 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26399 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26400 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26401 thread groups.
26402
26403 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26404 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26405 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26406 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26407 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26408
26409 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26410 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26411 initial value @var{initial}.
26412
26413 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26414 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26415 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26416 trace state variables are deleted.
26417
26418 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26419 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26420 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26421 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26422 value of trace state variable is known.
26423
26424 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26425 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26426 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26427 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26428 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26429 user.
26430
26431 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26432 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26433 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26434
26435 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26436 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26437
26438 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26439 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26440 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26441 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26442 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26443
26444 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26445 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26446 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay}
26447 for existing method and format values.
26448
26449 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26450 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26451 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26452 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26453 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26454 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26455
26456 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26457 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26458 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26459 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26460 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26461 executable code.
26462 @end table
26463
26464 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26465 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26466
26467 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26468 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26469 following fields:
26470
26471 @table @code
26472 @item number
26473 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26474 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26475 @samp{1.2}.
26476
26477 @item type
26478 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26479 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26480
26481 @item catch-type
26482 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26483 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26484
26485 @item disp
26486 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26487 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26488 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26489
26490 @item enabled
26491 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26492 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26493 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26494
26495 @item addr
26496 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26497 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26498 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26499 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26500 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26501
26502 @item func
26503 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26504 If not known, this field is not present.
26505
26506 @item filename
26507 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26508 If not known, this field is not present.
26509
26510 @item fullname
26511 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26512 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26513
26514 @item line
26515 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26516 If not known, this field is not present.
26517
26518 @item at
26519 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26520 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26521 by a symbol name.
26522
26523 @item pending
26524 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26525 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26526
26527 @item evaluated-by
26528 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26529 @samp{target}.
26530
26531 @item thread
26532 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26533 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26534
26535 @item task
26536 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26537 field will hold the task identifier.
26538
26539 @item cond
26540 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26541
26542 @item ignore
26543 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26544
26545 @item enable
26546 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26547
26548 @item traceframe-usage
26549 FIXME.
26550
26551 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26552 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26553
26554 @item mask
26555 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26556
26557 @item pass
26558 A tracepoint's pass count.
26559
26560 @item original-location
26561 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26562 This field is optional.
26563
26564 @item times
26565 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26566
26567 @item installed
26568 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26569 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26570 is not.
26571
26572 @item what
26573 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26574
26575 @end table
26576
26577 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26578 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26579
26580 @smallexample
26581 -> -break-insert main
26582 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26583 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26584 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26585 times="0"@}
26586 <- (gdb)
26587 @end smallexample
26588
26589 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26590 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26591
26592 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26593 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26594 fields:
26595
26596 @table @code
26597 @item level
26598 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26599 zero. This field is always present.
26600
26601 @item func
26602 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26603 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26604
26605 @item addr
26606 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26607
26608 @item file
26609 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26610 address. This field may be absent.
26611
26612 @item line
26613 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26614 may be absent.
26615
26616 @item from
26617 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26618 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26619
26620 @end table
26621
26622 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26623 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26624
26625 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26626 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26627
26628 @table @code
26629 @item id
26630 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26631 always present.
26632
26633 @item target-id
26634 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26635
26636 @item details
26637 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26638 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26639 frontend. This field is optional.
26640
26641 @item state
26642 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26643 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26644
26645 @item core
26646 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26647 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26648 @end table
26649
26650 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26651 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26652
26653 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26654 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26655 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26656 the @code{exception-name} field.
26657
26658 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26659 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26660 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26661 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26662
26663 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26664 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26665 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26666 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26667
26668 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26669 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26670
26671 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26672
26673 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26674 information of the breakpoint.
26675
26676 @smallexample
26677 -> -break-insert main
26678 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26679 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26680 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26681 times="0"@}
26682 <- (gdb)
26683 @end smallexample
26684
26685 @subheading Program Execution
26686
26687 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26688 reason that execution stopped.
26689
26690 @smallexample
26691 -> -exec-run
26692 <- ^running
26693 <- (gdb)
26694 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26695 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26696 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26697 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26698 <- (gdb)
26699 -> -exec-continue
26700 <- ^running
26701 <- (gdb)
26702 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26703 <- (gdb)
26704 @end smallexample
26705
26706 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26707
26708 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26709
26710 @smallexample
26711 -> (gdb)
26712 <- -gdb-exit
26713 <- ^exit
26714 @end smallexample
26715
26716 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26717 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26718 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26719 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26720 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26721 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26722
26723 @subheading A Bad Command
26724
26725 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26726
26727 @smallexample
26728 -> -rubbish
26729 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26730 <- (gdb)
26731 @end smallexample
26732
26733
26734 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26735 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26736 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26737
26738 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26739 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26740
26741 @subheading Motivation
26742
26743 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26744
26745 @subheading Introduction
26746
26747 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26748
26749 @subheading Commands
26750
26751 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26752
26753 @subsubheading Synopsis
26754
26755 @smallexample
26756 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26757 @end smallexample
26758
26759 @subsubheading Result
26760
26761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26762
26763 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26764
26765 @subsubheading Example
26766
26767 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26768 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26769
26770
26771 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26772 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26773 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26774
26775 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26776 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26777 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26778 breakpoints.
26779
26780 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26781 @findex -break-after
26782
26783 @subsubheading Synopsis
26784
26785 @smallexample
26786 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26787 @end smallexample
26788
26789 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26790 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26791 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26792 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26793
26794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26795
26796 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26797
26798 @subsubheading Example
26799
26800 @smallexample
26801 (gdb)
26802 -break-insert main
26803 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26804 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26805 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26806 times="0"@}
26807 (gdb)
26808 -break-after 1 3
26809 ~
26810 ^done
26811 (gdb)
26812 -break-list
26813 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26814 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26815 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26816 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26817 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26818 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26819 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26820 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26821 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26822 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26823 (gdb)
26824 @end smallexample
26825
26826 @ignore
26827 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26828 @findex -break-catch
26829 @end ignore
26830
26831 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26832 @findex -break-commands
26833
26834 @subsubheading Synopsis
26835
26836 @smallexample
26837 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26838 @end smallexample
26839
26840 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26841 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26842 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26843 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26844 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26845 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26846
26847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26848
26849 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26850
26851 @subsubheading Example
26852
26853 @smallexample
26854 (gdb)
26855 -break-insert main
26856 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26857 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26858 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26859 times="0"@}
26860 (gdb)
26861 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26862 ^done
26863 (gdb)
26864 @end smallexample
26865
26866 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26867 @findex -break-condition
26868
26869 @subsubheading Synopsis
26870
26871 @smallexample
26872 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26873 @end smallexample
26874
26875 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26876 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26877 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26878 command below).
26879
26880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26881
26882 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26883
26884 @subsubheading Example
26885
26886 @smallexample
26887 (gdb)
26888 -break-condition 1 1
26889 ^done
26890 (gdb)
26891 -break-list
26892 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26893 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26894 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26895 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26896 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26897 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26898 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26899 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26900 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26901 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26902 (gdb)
26903 @end smallexample
26904
26905 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26906 @findex -break-delete
26907
26908 @subsubheading Synopsis
26909
26910 @smallexample
26911 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26912 @end smallexample
26913
26914 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26915 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26916
26917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26918
26919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26920
26921 @subsubheading Example
26922
26923 @smallexample
26924 (gdb)
26925 -break-delete 1
26926 ^done
26927 (gdb)
26928 -break-list
26929 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26930 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26931 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26932 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26933 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26934 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26935 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26936 body=[]@}
26937 (gdb)
26938 @end smallexample
26939
26940 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26941 @findex -break-disable
26942
26943 @subsubheading Synopsis
26944
26945 @smallexample
26946 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26947 @end smallexample
26948
26949 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26950 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26951
26952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26953
26954 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26955
26956 @subsubheading Example
26957
26958 @smallexample
26959 (gdb)
26960 -break-disable 2
26961 ^done
26962 (gdb)
26963 -break-list
26964 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26965 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26966 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26967 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26968 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26969 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26970 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26971 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26972 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26973 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26974 (gdb)
26975 @end smallexample
26976
26977 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26978 @findex -break-enable
26979
26980 @subsubheading Synopsis
26981
26982 @smallexample
26983 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26984 @end smallexample
26985
26986 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26987
26988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26989
26990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26991
26992 @subsubheading Example
26993
26994 @smallexample
26995 (gdb)
26996 -break-enable 2
26997 ^done
26998 (gdb)
26999 -break-list
27000 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27001 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27002 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27003 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27004 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27005 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27006 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27007 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27008 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27009 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27010 (gdb)
27011 @end smallexample
27012
27013 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27014 @findex -break-info
27015
27016 @subsubheading Synopsis
27017
27018 @smallexample
27019 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27020 @end smallexample
27021
27022 @c REDUNDANT???
27023 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27024
27025 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27026 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27027 table.
27028
27029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27030
27031 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27032
27033 @subsubheading Example
27034 N.A.
27035
27036 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27037 @findex -break-insert
27038 @anchor{-break-insert}
27039
27040 @subsubheading Synopsis
27041
27042 @smallexample
27043 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27044 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27045 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27046 @end smallexample
27047
27048 @noindent
27049 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27050
27051 @table @var
27052 @item linespec location
27053 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27054
27055 @item explicit location
27056 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27057 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27058 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27059
27060 @table @samp
27061 @item --source @var{filename}
27062 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27063 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27064
27065 @item --function @var{function}
27066 The name of a function or method.
27067
27068 @item --label @var{label}
27069 The name of a label.
27070
27071 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27072 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27073 @end table
27074
27075 @item address location
27076 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27077 @end table
27078
27079 @noindent
27080 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27081
27082 @table @samp
27083 @item -t
27084 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27085 @item -h
27086 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27087 @item -f
27088 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27089 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27090 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27091 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27092 cannot be parsed.
27093 @item -d
27094 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27095 @item -a
27096 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27097 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27098 @item -c @var{condition}
27099 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27100 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27101 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27102 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27103 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27104 @var{thread-id}.
27105 @end table
27106
27107 @subsubheading Result
27108
27109 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27110 resulting breakpoint.
27111
27112 Note: this format is open to change.
27113 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27114
27115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27116
27117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27118 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27119
27120 @subsubheading Example
27121
27122 @smallexample
27123 (gdb)
27124 -break-insert main
27125 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27126 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27127 times="0"@}
27128 (gdb)
27129 -break-insert -t foo
27130 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27131 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27132 times="0"@}
27133 (gdb)
27134 -break-list
27135 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27136 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27137 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27138 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27139 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27140 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27141 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27142 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27143 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27144 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27145 times="0"@},
27146 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27147 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27148 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27149 times="0"@}]@}
27150 (gdb)
27151 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27152 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27153 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27154 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27155 @c times="0"@}
27156 @c (gdb)
27157 @end smallexample
27158
27159 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27160 @findex -dprintf-insert
27161
27162 @subsubheading Synopsis
27163
27164 @smallexample
27165 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27166 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27167 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27168 [ @var{argument} ]
27169 @end smallexample
27170
27171 @noindent
27172 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27173 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27174
27175 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27176
27177 @table @samp
27178 @item -t
27179 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27180 @item -f
27181 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27182 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27183 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27184 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27185 cannot be parsed.
27186 @item -d
27187 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27188 @item -c @var{condition}
27189 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27190 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27191 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27192 to @var{ignore-count}.
27193 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27194 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27195 @var{thread-id}.
27196 @end table
27197
27198 @subsubheading Result
27199
27200 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27201 resulting breakpoint.
27202
27203 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27204
27205 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27206
27207 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27208
27209 @subsubheading Example
27210
27211 @smallexample
27212 (gdb)
27213 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27214 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27215 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27216 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27217 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27218 original-location="foo"@}
27219 (gdb)
27220 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27221 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27222 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27223 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27224 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27225 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27226 (gdb)
27227 @end smallexample
27228
27229 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27230 @findex -break-list
27231
27232 @subsubheading Synopsis
27233
27234 @smallexample
27235 -break-list
27236 @end smallexample
27237
27238 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27239
27240 @table @samp
27241 @item Number
27242 number of the breakpoint
27243 @item Type
27244 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27245 @item Disposition
27246 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27247 or @samp{nokeep}
27248 @item Enabled
27249 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27250 @item Address
27251 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27252 @item What
27253 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27254 name, line number
27255 @item Thread-groups
27256 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27257 @item Times
27258 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27259 @end table
27260
27261 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27262 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27263
27264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27265
27266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27267
27268 @subsubheading Example
27269
27270 @smallexample
27271 (gdb)
27272 -break-list
27273 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27274 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27275 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27276 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27277 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27278 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27279 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27280 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27281 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27282 times="0"@},
27283 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27284 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27285 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27286 (gdb)
27287 @end smallexample
27288
27289 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27290
27291 @smallexample
27292 (gdb)
27293 -break-list
27294 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27295 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27296 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27297 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27298 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27299 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27300 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27301 body=[]@}
27302 (gdb)
27303 @end smallexample
27304
27305 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27306 @findex -break-passcount
27307
27308 @subsubheading Synopsis
27309
27310 @smallexample
27311 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27312 @end smallexample
27313
27314 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27315 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27316 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27317 command @samp{passcount}.
27318
27319 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27320 @findex -break-watch
27321
27322 @subsubheading Synopsis
27323
27324 @smallexample
27325 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27326 @end smallexample
27327
27328 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27329 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27330 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27331 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27332 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27333 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27334 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27335 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27336
27337 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27338 breakpoints inserted.
27339
27340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27341
27342 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27343 @samp{rwatch}.
27344
27345 @subsubheading Example
27346
27347 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27348
27349 @smallexample
27350 (gdb)
27351 -break-watch x
27352 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27353 (gdb)
27354 -exec-continue
27355 ^running
27356 (gdb)
27357 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27358 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27359 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27360 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27361 (gdb)
27362 @end smallexample
27363
27364 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27365 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27366 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27367
27368 @smallexample
27369 (gdb)
27370 -break-watch C
27371 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27372 (gdb)
27373 -exec-continue
27374 ^running
27375 (gdb)
27376 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27377 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27378 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27379 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27380 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27381 (gdb)
27382 -exec-continue
27383 ^running
27384 (gdb)
27385 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27386 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27387 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27388 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27389 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27390 (gdb)
27391 @end smallexample
27392
27393 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27394 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27395 deleted.
27396
27397 @smallexample
27398 (gdb)
27399 -break-watch C
27400 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27401 (gdb)
27402 -break-list
27403 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27404 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27405 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27406 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27407 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27408 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27409 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27410 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27411 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27412 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27413 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27414 times="1"@},
27415 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27416 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27417 (gdb)
27418 -exec-continue
27419 ^running
27420 (gdb)
27421 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27422 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27423 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27424 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27425 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27426 (gdb)
27427 -break-list
27428 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27429 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27430 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27431 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27432 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27433 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27434 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27435 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27436 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27437 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27438 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27439 times="1"@},
27440 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27441 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27442 (gdb)
27443 -exec-continue
27444 ^running
27445 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27446 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27447 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27448 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27449 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27450 (gdb)
27451 -break-list
27452 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27453 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27454 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27455 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27456 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27457 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27458 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27459 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27460 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27461 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27462 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27463 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27464 (gdb)
27465 @end smallexample
27466
27467
27468 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27469 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27470 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27471
27472 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27473 catchpoints.
27474
27475 @menu
27476 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27477 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27478 @end menu
27479
27480 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27481 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27482
27483 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27484 @findex -catch-load
27485
27486 @subsubheading Synopsis
27487
27488 @smallexample
27489 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27490 @end smallexample
27491
27492 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27493 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27494 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27495 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27496 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27497
27498
27499 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27500
27501 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27502
27503 @subsubheading Example
27504
27505 @smallexample
27506 -catch-load -t foo.so
27507 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27508 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27509 (gdb)
27510 @end smallexample
27511
27512
27513 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27514 @findex -catch-unload
27515
27516 @subsubheading Synopsis
27517
27518 @smallexample
27519 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27520 @end smallexample
27521
27522 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27523 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27524 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27525 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27526 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27527
27528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27529
27530 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27531
27532 @subsubheading Example
27533
27534 @smallexample
27535 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27536 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27537 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27538 (gdb)
27539 @end smallexample
27540
27541 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27542 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27543
27544 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27545 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27546
27547 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27548 @findex -catch-assert
27549
27550 @subsubheading Synopsis
27551
27552 @smallexample
27553 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27554 @end smallexample
27555
27556 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27557
27558 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27559
27560 @table @samp
27561 @item -c @var{condition}
27562 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27563 @item -d
27564 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27565 @item -t
27566 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27567 @end table
27568
27569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27570
27571 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27572
27573 @subsubheading Example
27574
27575 @smallexample
27576 -catch-assert
27577 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27578 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27579 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27580 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27581 (gdb)
27582 @end smallexample
27583
27584 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27585 @findex -catch-exception
27586
27587 @subsubheading Synopsis
27588
27589 @smallexample
27590 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27591 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27592 @end smallexample
27593
27594 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27595 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27596 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27597 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27598 catchpoints.
27599
27600 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27601
27602 @table @samp
27603 @item -c @var{condition}
27604 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27605 @item -d
27606 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27607 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27608 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27609 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27610 @item -t
27611 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27612 @item -u
27613 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27614 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27615 @end table
27616
27617 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27618
27619 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27620 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27621
27622 @subsubheading Example
27623
27624 @smallexample
27625 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27626 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27627 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27628 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27629 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27630 (gdb)
27631 @end smallexample
27632
27633 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27634 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27635 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27636
27637 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27638 @findex -exec-arguments
27639
27640
27641 @subsubheading Synopsis
27642
27643 @smallexample
27644 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27645 @end smallexample
27646
27647 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27648 @samp{-exec-run}.
27649
27650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27651
27652 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27653
27654 @subsubheading Example
27655
27656 @smallexample
27657 (gdb)
27658 -exec-arguments -v word
27659 ^done
27660 (gdb)
27661 @end smallexample
27662
27663
27664 @ignore
27665 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27666 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27667
27668 @subsubheading Synopsis
27669
27670 @smallexample
27671 -exec-show-arguments
27672 @end smallexample
27673
27674 Print the arguments of the program.
27675
27676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27677
27678 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27679
27680 @subsubheading Example
27681 N.A.
27682 @end ignore
27683
27684
27685 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27686 @findex -environment-cd
27687
27688 @subsubheading Synopsis
27689
27690 @smallexample
27691 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27692 @end smallexample
27693
27694 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27695
27696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27697
27698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27699
27700 @subsubheading Example
27701
27702 @smallexample
27703 (gdb)
27704 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27705 ^done
27706 (gdb)
27707 @end smallexample
27708
27709
27710 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27711 @findex -environment-directory
27712
27713 @subsubheading Synopsis
27714
27715 @smallexample
27716 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27717 @end smallexample
27718
27719 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27720 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27721 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27722 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27723 occurs as normal.
27724 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27725 multiple directories in a single command
27726 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27727 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27728 If blanks are needed as
27729 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27730 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27731 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27732 character must not be used
27733 in any directory name.
27734 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27735
27736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27737
27738 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27739
27740 @subsubheading Example
27741
27742 @smallexample
27743 (gdb)
27744 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27745 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27746 (gdb)
27747 -environment-directory ""
27748 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27749 (gdb)
27750 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27751 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27752 (gdb)
27753 -environment-directory -r
27754 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27755 (gdb)
27756 @end smallexample
27757
27758
27759 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27760 @findex -environment-path
27761
27762 @subsubheading Synopsis
27763
27764 @smallexample
27765 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27766 @end smallexample
27767
27768 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27769 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27770 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27771 supplied in addition to the
27772 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27773 occurs as normal.
27774 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27775 multiple directories in a single command
27776 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27777 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27778 If blanks are needed as
27779 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27780 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27781 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27782 character must not be used
27783 in any directory name.
27784 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27785
27786
27787 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27788
27789 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27790
27791 @subsubheading Example
27792
27793 @smallexample
27794 (gdb)
27795 -environment-path
27796 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27797 (gdb)
27798 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27799 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27800 (gdb)
27801 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27802 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27803 (gdb)
27804 @end smallexample
27805
27806
27807 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27808 @findex -environment-pwd
27809
27810 @subsubheading Synopsis
27811
27812 @smallexample
27813 -environment-pwd
27814 @end smallexample
27815
27816 Show the current working directory.
27817
27818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27819
27820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27821
27822 @subsubheading Example
27823
27824 @smallexample
27825 (gdb)
27826 -environment-pwd
27827 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27828 (gdb)
27829 @end smallexample
27830
27831 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27832 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27833 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27834
27835
27836 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27837 @findex -thread-info
27838
27839 @subsubheading Synopsis
27840
27841 @smallexample
27842 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27843 @end smallexample
27844
27845 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
27846 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
27847 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
27848 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
27849 current thread.
27850
27851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27852
27853 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27854 about all threads.
27855
27856 @subsubheading Result
27857
27858 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27859 defined for a given thread:
27860
27861 @table @samp
27862 @item current
27863 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27864
27865 @item id
27866 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27867
27868 @item target-id
27869 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27870
27871 @item details
27872 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27873 field is optional.
27874
27875 @item name
27876 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27877 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27878 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27879 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27880 field is omitted.
27881
27882 @item frame
27883 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27884
27885 @item state
27886 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27887 values:
27888
27889 @table @code
27890 @item stopped
27891 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27892 threads.
27893
27894 @item running
27895 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27896 threads.
27897
27898 @end table
27899
27900 @item core
27901 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27902 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27903
27904 @end table
27905
27906 @subsubheading Example
27907
27908 @smallexample
27909 -thread-info
27910 ^done,threads=[
27911 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27912 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27913 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27914 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27915 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27916 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27917 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27918 state="running"@}],
27919 current-thread-id="1"
27920 (gdb)
27921 @end smallexample
27922
27923 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27924 @findex -thread-list-ids
27925
27926 @subsubheading Synopsis
27927
27928 @smallexample
27929 -thread-list-ids
27930 @end smallexample
27931
27932 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
27933 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
27934 threads.
27935
27936 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27937 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27938
27939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27940
27941 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27942
27943 @subsubheading Example
27944
27945 @smallexample
27946 (gdb)
27947 -thread-list-ids
27948 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27949 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27950 (gdb)
27951 @end smallexample
27952
27953
27954 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27955 @findex -thread-select
27956
27957 @subsubheading Synopsis
27958
27959 @smallexample
27960 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
27961 @end smallexample
27962
27963 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
27964 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
27965 topmost frame for that thread.
27966
27967 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27968 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27969
27970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27971
27972 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27973
27974 @subsubheading Example
27975
27976 @smallexample
27977 (gdb)
27978 -exec-next
27979 ^running
27980 (gdb)
27981 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27982 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27983 (gdb)
27984 -thread-list-ids
27985 ^done,
27986 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27987 number-of-threads="3"
27988 (gdb)
27989 -thread-select 3
27990 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27991 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27992 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27993 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27994 (gdb)
27995 @end smallexample
27996
27997 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27998 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27999 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28000
28001 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28002 @findex -ada-task-info
28003
28004 @subsubheading Synopsis
28005
28006 @smallexample
28007 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28008 @end smallexample
28009
28010 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28011 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28012
28013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28014
28015 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28016 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28017
28018 @subsubheading Result
28019
28020 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28021 defined for each Ada task:
28022
28023 @table @samp
28024 @item current
28025 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28026
28027 @item id
28028 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28029
28030 @item task-id
28031 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28032
28033 @item thread-id
28034 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28035 task.
28036
28037 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28038 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28039 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28040
28041 @item parent-id
28042 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28043 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28044
28045 @item priority
28046 The base priority of the task.
28047
28048 @item state
28049 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28050 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28051
28052 @item name
28053 The name of the task.
28054
28055 @end table
28056
28057 @subsubheading Example
28058
28059 @smallexample
28060 -ada-task-info
28061 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28062 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28063 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28064 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28065 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28066 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28067 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28068 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28069 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28070 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28071 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28072 (gdb)
28073 @end smallexample
28074
28075 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28076 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28077 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28078
28079 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28080 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28081 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28082 other cases.
28083
28084 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28085 @findex -exec-continue
28086
28087 @subsubheading Synopsis
28088
28089 @smallexample
28090 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28091 @end smallexample
28092
28093 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28094 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28095 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28096 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28097 @itemize @bullet
28098 @item
28099 breakpoints or watchpoints
28100 @item
28101 signals or exceptions
28102 @item
28103 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28104 @item
28105 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28106 @end itemize
28107 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28108 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28109 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28110 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28111 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28112 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28113
28114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28115
28116 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28117
28118 @subsubheading Example
28119
28120 @smallexample
28121 -exec-continue
28122 ^running
28123 (gdb)
28124 @@Hello world
28125 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28126 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28127 line="13"@}
28128 (gdb)
28129 @end smallexample
28130
28131
28132 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28133 @findex -exec-finish
28134
28135 @subsubheading Synopsis
28136
28137 @smallexample
28138 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28139 @end smallexample
28140
28141 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28142 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28143 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28144 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28145 function was called.
28146
28147 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28148
28149 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28150
28151 @subsubheading Example
28152
28153 Function returning @code{void}.
28154
28155 @smallexample
28156 -exec-finish
28157 ^running
28158 (gdb)
28159 @@hello from foo
28160 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28161 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28162 (gdb)
28163 @end smallexample
28164
28165 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28166 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28167 value itself.
28168
28169 @smallexample
28170 -exec-finish
28171 ^running
28172 (gdb)
28173 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28174 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28175 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28176 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28177 (gdb)
28178 @end smallexample
28179
28180
28181 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28182 @findex -exec-interrupt
28183
28184 @subsubheading Synopsis
28185
28186 @smallexample
28187 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28188 @end smallexample
28189
28190 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28191 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28192 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28193 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28194 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28195
28196 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28197 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28198 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28199 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28200
28201 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28202 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28203 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28204 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28205
28206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28207
28208 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28209
28210 @subsubheading Example
28211
28212 @smallexample
28213 (gdb)
28214 111-exec-continue
28215 111^running
28216
28217 (gdb)
28218 222-exec-interrupt
28219 222^done
28220 (gdb)
28221 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28222 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28223 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28224 (gdb)
28225
28226 (gdb)
28227 -exec-interrupt
28228 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28229 (gdb)
28230 @end smallexample
28231
28232 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28233 @findex -exec-jump
28234
28235 @subsubheading Synopsis
28236
28237 @smallexample
28238 -exec-jump @var{location}
28239 @end smallexample
28240
28241 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28242 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28243 different forms of @var{location}.
28244
28245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28246
28247 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28248
28249 @subsubheading Example
28250
28251 @smallexample
28252 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28253 *running,thread-id="all"
28254 ^running
28255 @end smallexample
28256
28257
28258 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28259 @findex -exec-next
28260
28261 @subsubheading Synopsis
28262
28263 @smallexample
28264 -exec-next [--reverse]
28265 @end smallexample
28266
28267 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28268 of the next source line is reached.
28269
28270 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28271 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28272 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28273 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28274 source line where the function was called.
28275
28276
28277 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28278
28279 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28280
28281 @subsubheading Example
28282
28283 @smallexample
28284 -exec-next
28285 ^running
28286 (gdb)
28287 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28288 (gdb)
28289 @end smallexample
28290
28291
28292 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28293 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28294
28295 @subsubheading Synopsis
28296
28297 @smallexample
28298 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28299 @end smallexample
28300
28301 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28302 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28303 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28304 printed as well.
28305
28306 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28307 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28308 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28309 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28310 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28311
28312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28313
28314 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28315
28316 @subsubheading Example
28317
28318 @smallexample
28319 (gdb)
28320 -exec-next-instruction
28321 ^running
28322
28323 (gdb)
28324 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28325 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28326 (gdb)
28327 @end smallexample
28328
28329
28330 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28331 @findex -exec-return
28332
28333 @subsubheading Synopsis
28334
28335 @smallexample
28336 -exec-return
28337 @end smallexample
28338
28339 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28340 Displays the new current frame.
28341
28342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28343
28344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28345
28346 @subsubheading Example
28347
28348 @smallexample
28349 (gdb)
28350 200-break-insert callee4
28351 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28352 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28353 (gdb)
28354 000-exec-run
28355 000^running
28356 (gdb)
28357 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28358 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28359 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28360 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28361 (gdb)
28362 205-break-delete
28363 205^done
28364 (gdb)
28365 111-exec-return
28366 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28367 args=[@{name="strarg",
28368 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28369 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28370 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28371 (gdb)
28372 @end smallexample
28373
28374
28375 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28376 @findex -exec-run
28377
28378 @subsubheading Synopsis
28379
28380 @smallexample
28381 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28382 @end smallexample
28383
28384 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28385 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28386 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28387 the program has exited exceptionally.
28388
28389 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28390 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28391 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28392 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28393 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28394
28395 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28396 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28397 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28398 (@pxref{Starting}).
28399
28400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28401
28402 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28403
28404 @subsubheading Examples
28405
28406 @smallexample
28407 (gdb)
28408 -break-insert main
28409 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28410 (gdb)
28411 -exec-run
28412 ^running
28413 (gdb)
28414 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28415 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28416 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28417 (gdb)
28418 @end smallexample
28419
28420 @noindent
28421 Program exited normally:
28422
28423 @smallexample
28424 (gdb)
28425 -exec-run
28426 ^running
28427 (gdb)
28428 x = 55
28429 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28430 (gdb)
28431 @end smallexample
28432
28433 @noindent
28434 Program exited exceptionally:
28435
28436 @smallexample
28437 (gdb)
28438 -exec-run
28439 ^running
28440 (gdb)
28441 x = 55
28442 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28443 (gdb)
28444 @end smallexample
28445
28446 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28447 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28448
28449 @smallexample
28450 (gdb)
28451 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28452 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28453 @end smallexample
28454
28455
28456 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28457
28458
28459 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28460 @findex -exec-step
28461
28462 @subsubheading Synopsis
28463
28464 @smallexample
28465 -exec-step [--reverse]
28466 @end smallexample
28467
28468 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28469 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28470 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28471 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28472 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28473 previously executed source line.
28474
28475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28476
28477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28478
28479 @subsubheading Example
28480
28481 Stepping into a function:
28482
28483 @smallexample
28484 -exec-step
28485 ^running
28486 (gdb)
28487 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28488 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28489 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28490 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28491 (gdb)
28492 @end smallexample
28493
28494 Regular stepping:
28495
28496 @smallexample
28497 -exec-step
28498 ^running
28499 (gdb)
28500 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28501 (gdb)
28502 @end smallexample
28503
28504
28505 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28506 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28507
28508 @subsubheading Synopsis
28509
28510 @smallexample
28511 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28512 @end smallexample
28513
28514 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28515 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28516 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28517 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28518 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28519 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28520 as well.
28521
28522 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28523
28524 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28525
28526 @subsubheading Example
28527
28528 @smallexample
28529 (gdb)
28530 -exec-step-instruction
28531 ^running
28532
28533 (gdb)
28534 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28535 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28536 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28537 (gdb)
28538 -exec-step-instruction
28539 ^running
28540
28541 (gdb)
28542 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28543 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28544 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28545 (gdb)
28546 @end smallexample
28547
28548
28549 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28550 @findex -exec-until
28551
28552 @subsubheading Synopsis
28553
28554 @smallexample
28555 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28556 @end smallexample
28557
28558 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28559 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28560 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28561 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28562
28563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28564
28565 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28566
28567 @subsubheading Example
28568
28569 @smallexample
28570 (gdb)
28571 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28572 ^running
28573 (gdb)
28574 x = 55
28575 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28576 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28577 (gdb)
28578 @end smallexample
28579
28580 @ignore
28581 @subheading -file-clear
28582 Is this going away????
28583 @end ignore
28584
28585 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28586 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28587 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28588
28589 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28590 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28591
28592 @smallexample
28593 -enable-frame-filters
28594 @end smallexample
28595
28596 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28597 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28598 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28599 request that this functionality be enabled.
28600
28601 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28602
28603 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28604 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28605
28606 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28607 @findex -stack-info-frame
28608
28609 @subsubheading Synopsis
28610
28611 @smallexample
28612 -stack-info-frame
28613 @end smallexample
28614
28615 Get info on the selected frame.
28616
28617 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28618
28619 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28620 (without arguments).
28621
28622 @subsubheading Example
28623
28624 @smallexample
28625 (gdb)
28626 -stack-info-frame
28627 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28628 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28629 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28630 (gdb)
28631 @end smallexample
28632
28633 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28634 @findex -stack-info-depth
28635
28636 @subsubheading Synopsis
28637
28638 @smallexample
28639 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28640 @end smallexample
28641
28642 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28643 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28644
28645 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28646
28647 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28648
28649 @subsubheading Example
28650
28651 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28652
28653 @smallexample
28654 (gdb)
28655 -stack-info-depth
28656 ^done,depth="12"
28657 (gdb)
28658 -stack-info-depth 4
28659 ^done,depth="4"
28660 (gdb)
28661 -stack-info-depth 12
28662 ^done,depth="12"
28663 (gdb)
28664 -stack-info-depth 11
28665 ^done,depth="11"
28666 (gdb)
28667 -stack-info-depth 13
28668 ^done,depth="12"
28669 (gdb)
28670 @end smallexample
28671
28672 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28673 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28674 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28675
28676 @subsubheading Synopsis
28677
28678 @smallexample
28679 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28680 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28681 @end smallexample
28682
28683 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28684 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28685 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28686 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28687 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28688 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28689 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28690 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28691
28692 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28693 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28694 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28695 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28696 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28697 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28698
28699 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28700 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28701 are still displayed, however.
28702
28703 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28704 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28705
28706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28707
28708 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28709 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28710 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28711
28712 @subsubheading Example
28713
28714 @smallexample
28715 (gdb)
28716 -stack-list-frames
28717 ^done,
28718 stack=[
28719 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28720 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28721 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28722 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28723 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28724 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28725 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28726 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28727 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28728 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28729 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28730 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28731 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28732 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28733 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28734 (gdb)
28735 -stack-list-arguments 0
28736 ^done,
28737 stack-args=[
28738 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28739 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28740 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28741 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28742 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28743 (gdb)
28744 -stack-list-arguments 1
28745 ^done,
28746 stack-args=[
28747 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28748 frame=@{level="1",
28749 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28750 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28751 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28752 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28753 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28754 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28755 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28756 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28757 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28758 (gdb)
28759 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28760 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28761 (gdb)
28762 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28763 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28764 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28765 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28766 (gdb)
28767 @end smallexample
28768
28769 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28770
28771
28772 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28773 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28774 @findex -stack-list-frames
28775
28776 @subsubheading Synopsis
28777
28778 @smallexample
28779 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28780 @end smallexample
28781
28782 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28783 following info:
28784
28785 @table @samp
28786 @item @var{level}
28787 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28788 @item @var{addr}
28789 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28790 @item @var{func}
28791 Function name.
28792 @item @var{file}
28793 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28794 @item @var{fullname}
28795 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28796 @item @var{line}
28797 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28798 @item @var{from}
28799 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28800 if the frame's function is not known.
28801 @end table
28802
28803 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28804 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28805 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28806 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28807 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28808 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28809 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28810 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28811 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28812
28813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28814
28815 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28816
28817 @subsubheading Example
28818
28819 Full stack backtrace:
28820
28821 @smallexample
28822 (gdb)
28823 -stack-list-frames
28824 ^done,stack=
28825 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28826 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28827 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28828 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28829 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28830 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28831 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28832 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28833 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28834 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28835 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28836 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28837 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28838 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28839 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28840 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28841 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28842 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28843 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28844 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28845 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28846 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28847 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28848 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28849 (gdb)
28850 @end smallexample
28851
28852 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28853
28854 @smallexample
28855 (gdb)
28856 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28857 ^done,stack=
28858 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28859 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28860 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28861 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28862 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28863 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28864 (gdb)
28865 @end smallexample
28866
28867 Show a single frame:
28868
28869 @smallexample
28870 (gdb)
28871 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28872 ^done,stack=
28873 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28874 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28875 (gdb)
28876 @end smallexample
28877
28878
28879 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28880 @findex -stack-list-locals
28881 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28882
28883 @subsubheading Synopsis
28884
28885 @smallexample
28886 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28887 @end smallexample
28888
28889 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28890 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28891 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28892 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28893 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28894 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28895 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28896 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28897 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28898 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28899
28900 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28901 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28902 variables are still displayed, however.
28903
28904 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28905 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28906
28907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28908
28909 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28910
28911 @subsubheading Example
28912
28913 @smallexample
28914 (gdb)
28915 -stack-list-locals 0
28916 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28917 (gdb)
28918 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28919 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28920 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28921 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28922 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28923 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28924 (gdb)
28925 @end smallexample
28926
28927 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28928 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28929 @findex -stack-list-variables
28930
28931 @subsubheading Synopsis
28932
28933 @smallexample
28934 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28935 @end smallexample
28936
28937 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28938 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28939 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28940 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28941 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28942 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28943 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28944
28945 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28946 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28947 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28948
28949 @subsubheading Example
28950
28951 @smallexample
28952 (gdb)
28953 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28954 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28955 (gdb)
28956 @end smallexample
28957
28958
28959 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28960 @findex -stack-select-frame
28961
28962 @subsubheading Synopsis
28963
28964 @smallexample
28965 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28966 @end smallexample
28967
28968 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28969 the stack.
28970
28971 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28972 option to every command.
28973
28974 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28975
28976 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28977 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28978
28979 @subsubheading Example
28980
28981 @smallexample
28982 (gdb)
28983 -stack-select-frame 2
28984 ^done
28985 (gdb)
28986 @end smallexample
28987
28988 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28989 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28990 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28991
28992 @ignore
28993
28994 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28995
28996 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28997 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28998 used by @code{Insight}.
28999
29000 The two main reasons for that are:
29001
29002 @enumerate 1
29003 @item
29004 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29005
29006 @item
29007 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29008 now).
29009 @end enumerate
29010
29011 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29012 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29013 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29014 hints about their use.
29015
29016 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29017 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29018 least, the following operations:
29019
29020 @itemize @bullet
29021 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29022 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29023 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29024 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29025 @end itemize
29026
29027 @end ignore
29028
29029 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29030
29031 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29032
29033 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29034 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29035 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29036 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29037 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29038 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29039 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29040 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29041 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29042 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29043 object, or to change display format.
29044
29045 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29046 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29047 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29048 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29049 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29050 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29051 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29052 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29053 child will be created.
29054
29055 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29056 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29057 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29058 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29059 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29060
29061 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29062 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29063 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29064 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29065 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29066 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29067 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29068 variables that frontend has created.
29069
29070 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29071 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29072 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29073 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29074 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29075 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29076 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29077 implicitly updated.
29078
29079 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29080 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29081 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29082 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29083 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29084 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29085 frame. Consider this example:
29086
29087 @smallexample
29088 void do_work(...)
29089 @{
29090 struct work_state state;
29091
29092 if (...)
29093 do_work(...);
29094 @}
29095 @end smallexample
29096
29097 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29098 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29099 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29100 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29101 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29102
29103 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29104 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29105 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29106 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29107 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29108 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29109
29110 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29111 access this functionality:
29112
29113 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29114 @item @strong{Operation}
29115 @tab @strong{Description}
29116
29117 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29118 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29119 @item @code{-var-create}
29120 @tab create a variable object
29121 @item @code{-var-delete}
29122 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29123 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29124 @tab set the display format of this variable
29125 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29126 @tab show the display format of this variable
29127 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29128 @tab tells how many children this object has
29129 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29130 @tab return a list of the object's children
29131 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29132 @tab show the type of this variable object
29133 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29134 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29135 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29136 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29137 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29138 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29139 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29140 @tab get the value of this variable
29141 @item @code{-var-assign}
29142 @tab set the value of this variable
29143 @item @code{-var-update}
29144 @tab update the variable and its children
29145 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29146 @tab set frozeness attribute
29147 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29148 @tab set range of children to display on update
29149 @end multitable
29150
29151 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29152 how it can be used.
29153
29154 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29155
29156 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29157 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29158
29159 @smallexample
29160 -enable-pretty-printing
29161 @end smallexample
29162
29163 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29164 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29165 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29166 request that this functionality be enabled.
29167
29168 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29169
29170 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29171 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29172
29173 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29174 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29175
29176 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29177 @findex -var-create
29178
29179 @subsubheading Synopsis
29180
29181 @smallexample
29182 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29183 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29184 @end smallexample
29185
29186 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29187 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29188 register.
29189
29190 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29191 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29192 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29193 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29194 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29195
29196 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29197 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29198 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29199 object must be created.
29200
29201 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29202 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29203
29204 @itemize @bullet
29205 @item
29206 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29207
29208 @item
29209 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29210
29211 @item
29212 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29213 @end itemize
29214
29215 @cindex dynamic varobj
29216 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29217 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29218 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29219 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29220 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29221 compatibility for existing clients.
29222
29223 @subsubheading Result
29224
29225 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29226 are:
29227
29228 @table @samp
29229 @item name
29230 The name of the varobj.
29231
29232 @item numchild
29233 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29234 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29235 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29236
29237 @item value
29238 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29239 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29240 will not be interesting.
29241
29242 @item type
29243 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29244 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29245 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29246 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29247 @emph{declared} one.
29248
29249 @item thread-id
29250 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29251 thread's global identifier.
29252
29253 @item has_more
29254 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29255 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29256
29257 @item dynamic
29258 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29259 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29260 then this attribute will not be present.
29261
29262 @item displayhint
29263 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29264 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29265 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29266 @end table
29267
29268 Typical output will look like this:
29269
29270 @smallexample
29271 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29272 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29273 @end smallexample
29274
29275
29276 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29277 @findex -var-delete
29278
29279 @subsubheading Synopsis
29280
29281 @smallexample
29282 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29283 @end smallexample
29284
29285 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29286 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29287
29288 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29289
29290
29291 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29292 @findex -var-set-format
29293
29294 @subsubheading Synopsis
29295
29296 @smallexample
29297 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29298 @end smallexample
29299
29300 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29301 @var{format-spec}.
29302
29303 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29304 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29305
29306 @smallexample
29307 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29308 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29309 @end smallexample
29310
29311 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29312 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29313 for pointers, etc.).
29314
29315 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29316 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29317 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29318 zero-hexadecimal format.
29319
29320 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29321 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29322
29323 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29324 @findex -var-show-format
29325
29326 @subsubheading Synopsis
29327
29328 @smallexample
29329 -var-show-format @var{name}
29330 @end smallexample
29331
29332 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29333
29334 @smallexample
29335 @var{format} @expansion{}
29336 @var{format-spec}
29337 @end smallexample
29338
29339
29340 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29341 @findex -var-info-num-children
29342
29343 @subsubheading Synopsis
29344
29345 @smallexample
29346 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29347 @end smallexample
29348
29349 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29350
29351 @smallexample
29352 numchild=@var{n}
29353 @end smallexample
29354
29355 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29356 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29357 be available.
29358
29359
29360 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29361 @findex -var-list-children
29362
29363 @subsubheading Synopsis
29364
29365 @smallexample
29366 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29367 @end smallexample
29368 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29369
29370 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29371 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29372 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29373 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29374 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29375 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29376 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29377 and unions.
29378
29379 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29380 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29381 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29382 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29383 reported.
29384
29385 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29386 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29387 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29388 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29389 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29390 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29391 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29392 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29393 the visible items.
29394
29395 For each child the following results are returned:
29396
29397 @table @var
29398
29399 @item name
29400 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29401
29402 @item exp
29403 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29404 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29405
29406 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29407 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29408
29409 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29410 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29411 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29412 type and value are not present.
29413
29414 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29415 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29416 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29417
29418 @item numchild
29419 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29420 0.
29421
29422 @item type
29423 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29424 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29425 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29426 @emph{declared} one.
29427
29428 @item value
29429 If values were requested, this is the value.
29430
29431 @item thread-id
29432 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29433 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29434
29435 @item frozen
29436 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29437
29438 @item displayhint
29439 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29440 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29441 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29442
29443 @item dynamic
29444 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29445 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29446 then this attribute will not be present.
29447
29448 @end table
29449
29450 The result may have its own attributes:
29451
29452 @table @samp
29453 @item displayhint
29454 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29455 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29456 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29457
29458 @item has_more
29459 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29460 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29461 @end table
29462
29463 @subsubheading Example
29464
29465 @smallexample
29466 (gdb)
29467 -var-list-children n
29468 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29469 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29470 (gdb)
29471 -var-list-children --all-values n
29472 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29473 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29474 @end smallexample
29475
29476
29477 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29478 @findex -var-info-type
29479
29480 @subsubheading Synopsis
29481
29482 @smallexample
29483 -var-info-type @var{name}
29484 @end smallexample
29485
29486 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29487 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29488 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29489
29490 @smallexample
29491 type=@var{typename}
29492 @end smallexample
29493
29494
29495 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29496 @findex -var-info-expression
29497
29498 @subsubheading Synopsis
29499
29500 @smallexample
29501 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29502 @end smallexample
29503
29504 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29505 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29506 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29507
29508 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29509 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29510
29511 @smallexample
29512 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29513 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29514 @end smallexample
29515
29516 @noindent
29517 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29518 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29519
29520 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29521 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29522 is of limited use.
29523
29524 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29525 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29526
29527 @subsubheading Synopsis
29528
29529 @smallexample
29530 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29531 @end smallexample
29532
29533 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29534 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29535 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29536 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29537 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29538 watchpoint from a variable object.
29539
29540 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29541 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29542
29543 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29544 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29545 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29546 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29547 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29548 @smallexample
29549 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29550 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29551 @end smallexample
29552
29553 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29554 @findex -var-show-attributes
29555
29556 @subsubheading Synopsis
29557
29558 @smallexample
29559 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29560 @end smallexample
29561
29562 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29563
29564 @smallexample
29565 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29566 @end smallexample
29567
29568 @noindent
29569 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29570
29571 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29572 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29573
29574 @subsubheading Synopsis
29575
29576 @smallexample
29577 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29578 @end smallexample
29579
29580 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29581 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29582 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29583 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29584 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29585 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29586 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29587
29588 @smallexample
29589 value=@var{value}
29590 @end smallexample
29591
29592 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29593 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29594
29595 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29596 @findex -var-assign
29597
29598 @subsubheading Synopsis
29599
29600 @smallexample
29601 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29602 @end smallexample
29603
29604 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29605 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29606 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29607 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29608
29609 @subsubheading Example
29610
29611 @smallexample
29612 (gdb)
29613 -var-assign var1 3
29614 ^done,value="3"
29615 (gdb)
29616 -var-update *
29617 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29618 (gdb)
29619 @end smallexample
29620
29621 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29622 @findex -var-update
29623
29624 @subsubheading Synopsis
29625
29626 @smallexample
29627 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29628 @end smallexample
29629
29630 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29631 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29632 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29633 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29634 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29635 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29636 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29637 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29638 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29639 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29640 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29641 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29642 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29643
29644 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29645 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29646 diagnostic.
29647
29648 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29649 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29650
29651 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29652 @samp{changelist}.
29653
29654 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29655
29656 @table @samp
29657 @item name
29658 The name of the varobj.
29659
29660 @item value
29661 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29662 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29663
29664 @item in_scope
29665 @anchor{-var-update}
29666 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29667
29668 @table @code
29669 @item "true"
29670 The variable object's current value is valid.
29671
29672 @item "false"
29673 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29674 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29675 scope.
29676
29677 @item "invalid"
29678 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29679 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29680 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29681 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29682 objects.
29683 @end table
29684
29685 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29686 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29687
29688 @item type_changed
29689 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29690 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29691 be @samp{false}.
29692
29693 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29694 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29695 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29696 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29697 unset.
29698
29699 @item new_type
29700 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29701 hold the new type.
29702
29703 @item new_num_children
29704 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29705 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29706
29707 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29708 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29709 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29710 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29711 children which may be available.
29712
29713 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29714 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29715 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29716 only happen at the end of the update range).
29717
29718 @item displayhint
29719 The display hint, if any.
29720
29721 @item has_more
29722 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29723 available outside the varobj's update range.
29724
29725 @item dynamic
29726 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29727 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29728 then this attribute will not be present.
29729
29730 @item new_children
29731 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29732 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29733 be listed in this attribute.
29734 @end table
29735
29736 @subsubheading Example
29737
29738 @smallexample
29739 (gdb)
29740 -var-assign var1 3
29741 ^done,value="3"
29742 (gdb)
29743 -var-update --all-values var1
29744 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29745 type_changed="false"@}]
29746 (gdb)
29747 @end smallexample
29748
29749 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29750 @findex -var-set-frozen
29751 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29752
29753 @subsubheading Synopsis
29754
29755 @smallexample
29756 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29757 @end smallexample
29758
29759 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29760 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29761 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29762 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29763 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29764 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29765 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29766 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29767 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29768 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29769 @code{-var-update} does.
29770
29771 @subsubheading Example
29772
29773 @smallexample
29774 (gdb)
29775 -var-set-frozen V 1
29776 ^done
29777 (gdb)
29778 @end smallexample
29779
29780 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29781 @findex -var-set-update-range
29782 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29783
29784 @subsubheading Synopsis
29785
29786 @smallexample
29787 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29788 @end smallexample
29789
29790 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29791 @code{-var-update}.
29792
29793 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29794 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29795 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29796 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29797
29798 @subsubheading Example
29799
29800 @smallexample
29801 (gdb)
29802 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29803 ^done
29804 @end smallexample
29805
29806 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29807 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29808 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29809
29810 @subsubheading Synopsis
29811
29812 @smallexample
29813 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29814 @end smallexample
29815
29816 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29817
29818 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29819 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29820
29821 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29822 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29823 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29824 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29825 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29826 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29827 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29828
29829 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29830 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29831 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29832 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29833
29834 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29835 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29836 can be used to check this.
29837
29838 @subsubheading Example
29839
29840 Resetting the visualizer:
29841
29842 @smallexample
29843 (gdb)
29844 -var-set-visualizer V None
29845 ^done
29846 @end smallexample
29847
29848 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29849
29850 @smallexample
29851 (gdb)
29852 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29853 ^done
29854 @end smallexample
29855
29856 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29857 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29858
29859 @smallexample
29860 (gdb)
29861 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29862 ^done
29863 @end smallexample
29864
29865 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29866 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29867 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29868
29869 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29870 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29871 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29872 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29873
29874 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29875 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29876
29877 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29878 @c @subheading -data-assign
29879 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29880 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29881 @c set variable
29882 @c @subsubheading Example
29883 @c N.A.
29884
29885 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29886 @findex -data-disassemble
29887
29888 @subsubheading Synopsis
29889
29890 @smallexample
29891 -data-disassemble
29892 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29893 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29894 -- @var{mode}
29895 @end smallexample
29896
29897 @noindent
29898 Where:
29899
29900 @table @samp
29901 @item @var{start-addr}
29902 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29903 @item @var{end-addr}
29904 is the end address
29905 @item @var{filename}
29906 is the name of the file to disassemble
29907 @item @var{linenum}
29908 is the line number to disassemble around
29909 @item @var{lines}
29910 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29911 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29912 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29913 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29914 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29915 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29916 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29917 are displayed.
29918 @item @var{mode}
29919 is one of:
29920 @itemize @bullet
29921 @item 0 disassembly only
29922 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
29923 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
29924 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
29925 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
29926 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
29927 @end itemize
29928
29929 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
29930 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
29931 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
29932 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
29933 @end table
29934
29935 @subsubheading Result
29936
29937 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29938 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29939 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29940
29941 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29942 following fields:
29943
29944 @table @code
29945 @item address
29946 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29947
29948 @item func-name
29949 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29950
29951 @item offset
29952 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29953
29954 @item inst
29955 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29956
29957 @item opcodes
29958 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
29959 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29960
29961 @end table
29962
29963 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29964 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29965
29966 @table @code
29967 @item line
29968 The line number within @samp{file}.
29969
29970 @item file
29971 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29972 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29973 used.
29974
29975 @item fullname
29976 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29977 using the source file search path
29978 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29979 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29980
29981 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29982 present in the debug information.
29983
29984 @item line_asm_insn
29985 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29986 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29987 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29988 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29989 @samp{opcodes}.
29990
29991 @end table
29992
29993 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29994 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29995 adjust its format.
29996
29997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29998
29999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30000
30001 @subsubheading Example
30002
30003 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30004
30005 @smallexample
30006 (gdb)
30007 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30008 ^done,
30009 asm_insns=[
30010 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30011 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30012 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30013 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30014 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30015 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30016 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30017 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30018 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30019 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30020 (gdb)
30021 @end smallexample
30022
30023 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30024 @code{main}.
30025
30026 @smallexample
30027 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30028 ^done,asm_insns=[
30029 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30030 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30031 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30032 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30033 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30034 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30035 [@dots{}]
30036 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30037 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30038 (gdb)
30039 @end smallexample
30040
30041 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30042
30043 @smallexample
30044 (gdb)
30045 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30046 ^done,asm_insns=[
30047 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30048 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30049 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30050 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30051 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30052 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30053 (gdb)
30054 @end smallexample
30055
30056 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30057
30058 @smallexample
30059 (gdb)
30060 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30061 ^done,asm_insns=[
30062 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30063 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30064 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30065 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30066 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30067 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30068 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30069 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30070 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30071 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30072 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30073 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30074 (gdb)
30075 @end smallexample
30076
30077
30078 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30079 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30080
30081 @subsubheading Synopsis
30082
30083 @smallexample
30084 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30085 @end smallexample
30086
30087 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30088 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30089 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30090
30091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30092
30093 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30094 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30095 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30096
30097 @subsubheading Example
30098
30099 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30100 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30101 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30102 output.
30103
30104 @smallexample
30105 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30106 211^done,value="1"
30107 (gdb)
30108 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30109 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30110 (gdb)
30111 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30112 411^done,value="4"
30113 (gdb)
30114 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30115 511^done,value="4"
30116 (gdb)
30117 @end smallexample
30118
30119
30120 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30121 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30122
30123 @subsubheading Synopsis
30124
30125 @smallexample
30126 -data-list-changed-registers
30127 @end smallexample
30128
30129 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30130
30131 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30132
30133 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30134 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30135
30136 @subsubheading Example
30137
30138 On a PPC MBX board:
30139
30140 @smallexample
30141 (gdb)
30142 -exec-continue
30143 ^running
30144
30145 (gdb)
30146 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30147 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30148 line="5"@}
30149 (gdb)
30150 -data-list-changed-registers
30151 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30152 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30153 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30154 (gdb)
30155 @end smallexample
30156
30157
30158 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30159 @findex -data-list-register-names
30160
30161 @subsubheading Synopsis
30162
30163 @smallexample
30164 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30165 @end smallexample
30166
30167 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30168 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30169 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30170 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30171 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30172 include empty register names.
30173
30174 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30175
30176 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30177 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30178 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30179
30180 @subsubheading Example
30181
30182 For the PPC MBX board:
30183 @smallexample
30184 (gdb)
30185 -data-list-register-names
30186 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30187 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30188 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30189 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30190 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30191 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30192 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30193 (gdb)
30194 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30195 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30196 (gdb)
30197 @end smallexample
30198
30199 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30200 @findex -data-list-register-values
30201
30202 @subsubheading Synopsis
30203
30204 @smallexample
30205 -data-list-register-values
30206 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30207 @end smallexample
30208
30209 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30210 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30211 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30212 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30213 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30214 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30215
30216 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30217
30218 @table @code
30219 @item x
30220 Hexadecimal
30221 @item o
30222 Octal
30223 @item t
30224 Binary
30225 @item d
30226 Decimal
30227 @item r
30228 Raw
30229 @item N
30230 Natural
30231 @end table
30232
30233 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30234
30235 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30236 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30237
30238 @subsubheading Example
30239
30240 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30241 don't appear in the actual output):
30242
30243 @smallexample
30244 (gdb)
30245 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30246 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30247 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30248 (gdb)
30249 -data-list-register-values x
30250 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30251 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30252 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30253 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30254 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30255 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30256 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30257 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30258 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30259 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30260 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30261 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30262 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30263 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30264 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30265 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30266 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30267 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30268 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30269 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30270 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30271 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30272 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30273 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30274 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30275 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30276 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30277 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30278 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30279 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30280 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30281 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30282 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30283 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30284 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30285 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30286 (gdb)
30287 @end smallexample
30288
30289
30290 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30291 @findex -data-read-memory
30292
30293 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30294
30295 @subsubheading Synopsis
30296
30297 @smallexample
30298 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30299 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30300 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30301 @end smallexample
30302
30303 @noindent
30304 where:
30305
30306 @table @samp
30307 @item @var{address}
30308 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30309 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30310 quoted using the C convention.
30311
30312 @item @var{word-format}
30313 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30314 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30315 ,Output Formats}).
30316
30317 @item @var{word-size}
30318 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30319
30320 @item @var{nr-rows}
30321 The number of rows in the output table.
30322
30323 @item @var{nr-cols}
30324 The number of columns in the output table.
30325
30326 @item @var{aschar}
30327 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30328 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30329 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30330 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30331
30332 @item @var{byte-offset}
30333 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30334 @end table
30335
30336 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30337 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30338 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30339 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30340 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30341 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30342 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30343 @samp{addr}.
30344
30345 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30346 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30347 @samp{prev-page}.
30348
30349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30350
30351 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30352 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30353
30354 @subsubheading Example
30355
30356 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30357 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30358 word. Display each word in hex.
30359
30360 @smallexample
30361 (gdb)
30362 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30363 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30364 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30365 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30366 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30367 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30368 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30369 (gdb)
30370 @end smallexample
30371
30372 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30373 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30374
30375 @smallexample
30376 (gdb)
30377 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30378 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30379 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30380 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30381 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30382 (gdb)
30383 @end smallexample
30384
30385 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30386 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30387 used as the non-printable character.
30388
30389 @smallexample
30390 (gdb)
30391 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30392 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30393 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30394 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30395 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30396 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30397 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30398 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30399 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30400 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30401 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30402 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30403 (gdb)
30404 @end smallexample
30405
30406 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30407 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30408
30409 @subsubheading Synopsis
30410
30411 @smallexample
30412 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30413 @var{address} @var{count}
30414 @end smallexample
30415
30416 @noindent
30417 where:
30418
30419 @table @samp
30420 @item @var{address}
30421 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30422 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30423 quoted using the C convention.
30424
30425 @item @var{count}
30426 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30427 literal.
30428
30429 @item @var{offset}
30430 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30431 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30432 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30433 arithmetics itself.
30434
30435 @end table
30436
30437 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30438 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30439 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30440 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30441 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30442 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30443
30444 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30445 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30446 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30447 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30448 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30449 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30450 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30451 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30452
30453 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30454 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30455 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30456 and has the following fields:
30457
30458 @table @code
30459 @item begin
30460 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30461
30462 @item end
30463 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30464
30465 @item offset
30466 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30467 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30468
30469 @item contents
30470 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30471
30472 @end table
30473
30474
30475
30476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30477
30478 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30479
30480 @subsubheading Example
30481
30482 @smallexample
30483 (gdb)
30484 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30485 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30486 end="0xbffff15e",
30487 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30488 (gdb)
30489 @end smallexample
30490
30491
30492 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30493 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30494
30495 @subsubheading Synopsis
30496
30497 @smallexample
30498 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30499 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30500 @end smallexample
30501
30502 @noindent
30503 where:
30504
30505 @table @samp
30506 @item @var{address}
30507 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30508 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30509 be quoted using the C convention.
30510
30511 @item @var{contents}
30512 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30513 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30514
30515 @item @var{count}
30516 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30517 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30518 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30519 @var{count} memory units.
30520
30521 @end table
30522
30523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30524
30525 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30526
30527 @subsubheading Example
30528
30529 @smallexample
30530 (gdb)
30531 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30532 ^done
30533 (gdb)
30534 @end smallexample
30535
30536 @smallexample
30537 (gdb)
30538 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30539 ^done
30540 (gdb)
30541 @end smallexample
30542
30543 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30544 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30545 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30546
30547 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30548 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30549
30550 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30551 @findex -trace-find
30552
30553 @subsubheading Synopsis
30554
30555 @smallexample
30556 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30557 @end smallexample
30558
30559 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30560 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30561 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30562
30563 @table @samp
30564
30565 @item none
30566 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30567
30568 @item frame-number
30569 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30570 that index.
30571
30572 @item tracepoint-number
30573 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30574 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30575
30576 @item pc
30577 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30578 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30579 address.
30580
30581 @item pc-inside-range
30582 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30583 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30584 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30585
30586 @item pc-outside-range
30587 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30588 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30589 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30590
30591 @item line
30592 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30593 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30594 the specified location.
30595
30596 @end table
30597
30598 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30599 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30600
30601 @table @samp
30602 @item found
30603 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30604 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30605
30606 @item traceframe
30607 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30608 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30609
30610 @item tracepoint
30611 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30612 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30613
30614 @item frame
30615 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30616 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30617 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30618
30619 @end table
30620
30621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30622
30623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30624
30625 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30626 @findex -trace-define-variable
30627
30628 @subsubheading Synopsis
30629
30630 @smallexample
30631 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30632 @end smallexample
30633
30634 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30635 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30636 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30637 with the @samp{$} character.
30638
30639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30640
30641 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30642
30643 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30644 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30645
30646 @subsubheading Synopsis
30647
30648 @smallexample
30649 -trace-frame-collected
30650 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30651 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30652 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30653 [--memory-contents]
30654 @end smallexample
30655
30656 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30657 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30658 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30659 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30660 See the output description table below for more details.
30661
30662 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30663 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30664 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30665 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30666 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30667
30668 For instance, if the actions were
30669 @smallexample
30670 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30671 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30672 @end smallexample
30673
30674 @noindent
30675 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30676 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30677 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30678 objects would be computed expressions.
30679
30680 An example output would be:
30681
30682 @smallexample
30683 (gdb)
30684 -trace-frame-collected
30685 ^done,
30686 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30687 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30688 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30689 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30690 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30691 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30692 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30693 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30694 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30695 ...
30696 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30697 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30698 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30699 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30700 (gdb)
30701 @end smallexample
30702
30703 Where:
30704
30705 @table @code
30706 @item explicit-variables
30707 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30708 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30709 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30710 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30711 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30712 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30713 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30714 arrays, structures and unions.
30715
30716 @item computed-expressions
30717 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30718 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30719 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30720 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30721
30722 @item registers
30723 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30724 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30725 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30726 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30727 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30728
30729 @item tvars
30730 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30731 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30732 current value are returned.
30733
30734 @item memory
30735 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30736 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30737 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30738
30739 @table @code
30740 @item address
30741 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30742
30743 @item length
30744 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30745
30746 @item contents
30747 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30748 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30749
30750 @end table
30751
30752 @end table
30753
30754 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30755
30756 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30757
30758 @subsubheading Example
30759
30760 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30761 @findex -trace-list-variables
30762
30763 @subsubheading Synopsis
30764
30765 @smallexample
30766 -trace-list-variables
30767 @end smallexample
30768
30769 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30770 table has the following fields:
30771
30772 @table @samp
30773 @item name
30774 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30775
30776 @item initial
30777 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30778 field is always present.
30779
30780 @item current
30781 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30782 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30783 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30784 presently running.
30785
30786 @end table
30787
30788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30789
30790 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30791
30792 @subsubheading Example
30793
30794 @smallexample
30795 (gdb)
30796 -trace-list-variables
30797 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30798 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30799 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30800 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30801 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30802 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30803 (gdb)
30804 @end smallexample
30805
30806 @subheading -trace-save
30807 @findex -trace-save
30808
30809 @subsubheading Synopsis
30810
30811 @smallexample
30812 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30813 @end smallexample
30814
30815 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30816 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30817 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30818 to perform the save.
30819
30820 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30821
30822 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30823
30824
30825 @subheading -trace-start
30826 @findex -trace-start
30827
30828 @subsubheading Synopsis
30829
30830 @smallexample
30831 -trace-start
30832 @end smallexample
30833
30834 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30835 have any fields.
30836
30837 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30838
30839 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30840
30841 @subheading -trace-status
30842 @findex -trace-status
30843
30844 @subsubheading Synopsis
30845
30846 @smallexample
30847 -trace-status
30848 @end smallexample
30849
30850 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30851 the following fields:
30852
30853 @table @samp
30854
30855 @item supported
30856 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30857 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30858 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30859 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30860 started. This field is always present.
30861
30862 @item running
30863 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30864 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30865 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30866
30867 @item stop-reason
30868 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30869 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30870 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30871 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30872 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30873 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30874 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30875 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30876 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30877
30878 @item stopping-tracepoint
30879 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30880 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30881 @samp{passcount}.
30882
30883 @item frames
30884 @itemx frames-created
30885 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30886 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30887 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30888 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30889
30890 @item buffer-size
30891 @itemx buffer-free
30892 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30893 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30894
30895 @item circular
30896 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30897 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30898 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30899 and may fill up.
30900
30901 @item disconnected
30902 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30903 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30904 that the trace run will stop.
30905
30906 @item trace-file
30907 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30908 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30909
30910 @end table
30911
30912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30913
30914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30915
30916 @subheading -trace-stop
30917 @findex -trace-stop
30918
30919 @subsubheading Synopsis
30920
30921 @smallexample
30922 -trace-stop
30923 @end smallexample
30924
30925 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30926 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30927 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30928
30929 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30930
30931 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30932
30933
30934 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30935 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30936 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30937
30938
30939 @ignore
30940 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30941 @findex -symbol-info-address
30942
30943 @subsubheading Synopsis
30944
30945 @smallexample
30946 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30947 @end smallexample
30948
30949 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30950
30951 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30952
30953 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30954
30955 @subsubheading Example
30956 N.A.
30957
30958
30959 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30960 @findex -symbol-info-file
30961
30962 @subsubheading Synopsis
30963
30964 @smallexample
30965 -symbol-info-file
30966 @end smallexample
30967
30968 Show the file for the symbol.
30969
30970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30971
30972 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30973 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30974
30975 @subsubheading Example
30976 N.A.
30977
30978
30979 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30980 @findex -symbol-info-function
30981
30982 @subsubheading Synopsis
30983
30984 @smallexample
30985 -symbol-info-function
30986 @end smallexample
30987
30988 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30989
30990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30991
30992 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30993
30994 @subsubheading Example
30995 N.A.
30996
30997
30998 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30999 @findex -symbol-info-line
31000
31001 @subsubheading Synopsis
31002
31003 @smallexample
31004 -symbol-info-line
31005 @end smallexample
31006
31007 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31008
31009 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31010
31011 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31012 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31013
31014 @subsubheading Example
31015 N.A.
31016
31017
31018 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31019 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31020
31021 @subsubheading Synopsis
31022
31023 @smallexample
31024 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31025 @end smallexample
31026
31027 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31028
31029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31030
31031 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31032
31033 @subsubheading Example
31034 N.A.
31035
31036
31037 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31038 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31039
31040 @subsubheading Synopsis
31041
31042 @smallexample
31043 -symbol-list-functions
31044 @end smallexample
31045
31046 List the functions in the executable.
31047
31048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31049
31050 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31051 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31052
31053 @subsubheading Example
31054 N.A.
31055 @end ignore
31056
31057
31058 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31059 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31060
31061 @subsubheading Synopsis
31062
31063 @smallexample
31064 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31065 @end smallexample
31066
31067 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31068 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31069 ascending PC order.
31070
31071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31072
31073 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31074
31075 @subsubheading Example
31076 @smallexample
31077 (gdb)
31078 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31079 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31080 (gdb)
31081 @end smallexample
31082
31083
31084 @ignore
31085 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31086 @findex -symbol-list-types
31087
31088 @subsubheading Synopsis
31089
31090 @smallexample
31091 -symbol-list-types
31092 @end smallexample
31093
31094 List all the type names.
31095
31096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31097
31098 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31099 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31100
31101 @subsubheading Example
31102 N.A.
31103
31104
31105 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31106 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31107
31108 @subsubheading Synopsis
31109
31110 @smallexample
31111 -symbol-list-variables
31112 @end smallexample
31113
31114 List all the global and static variable names.
31115
31116 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31117
31118 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31119
31120 @subsubheading Example
31121 N.A.
31122
31123
31124 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31125 @findex -symbol-locate
31126
31127 @subsubheading Synopsis
31128
31129 @smallexample
31130 -symbol-locate
31131 @end smallexample
31132
31133 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31134
31135 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31136
31137 @subsubheading Example
31138 N.A.
31139
31140
31141 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31142 @findex -symbol-type
31143
31144 @subsubheading Synopsis
31145
31146 @smallexample
31147 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31148 @end smallexample
31149
31150 Show type of @var{variable}.
31151
31152 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31153
31154 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31155 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31156
31157 @subsubheading Example
31158 N.A.
31159 @end ignore
31160
31161
31162 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31163 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31164 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31165
31166 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31167 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31168
31169 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31170 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31171
31172 @subsubheading Synopsis
31173
31174 @smallexample
31175 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31176 @end smallexample
31177
31178 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31179 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31180 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31181 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31182 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31183 notification.
31184
31185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31186
31187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31188
31189 @subsubheading Example
31190
31191 @smallexample
31192 (gdb)
31193 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31194 ^done
31195 (gdb)
31196 @end smallexample
31197
31198
31199 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31200 @findex -file-exec-file
31201
31202 @subsubheading Synopsis
31203
31204 @smallexample
31205 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31206 @end smallexample
31207
31208 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31209 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31210 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31211 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31212 notification.
31213
31214 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31215
31216 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31217
31218 @subsubheading Example
31219
31220 @smallexample
31221 (gdb)
31222 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31223 ^done
31224 (gdb)
31225 @end smallexample
31226
31227
31228 @ignore
31229 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31230 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31231
31232 @subsubheading Synopsis
31233
31234 @smallexample
31235 -file-list-exec-sections
31236 @end smallexample
31237
31238 List the sections of the current executable file.
31239
31240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31241
31242 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31243 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31244 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31245
31246 @subsubheading Example
31247 N.A.
31248 @end ignore
31249
31250
31251 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31252 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31253
31254 @subsubheading Synopsis
31255
31256 @smallexample
31257 -file-list-exec-source-file
31258 @end smallexample
31259
31260 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31261 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31262 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31263 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31264
31265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31266
31267 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31268
31269 @subsubheading Example
31270
31271 @smallexample
31272 (gdb)
31273 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31274 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31275 (gdb)
31276 @end smallexample
31277
31278
31279 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31280 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31281
31282 @subsubheading Synopsis
31283
31284 @smallexample
31285 -file-list-exec-source-files
31286 @end smallexample
31287
31288 List the source files for the current executable.
31289
31290 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31291 name) of a source file.
31292
31293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31294
31295 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31296 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31297
31298 @subsubheading Example
31299 @smallexample
31300 (gdb)
31301 -file-list-exec-source-files
31302 ^done,files=[
31303 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31304 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31305 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31306 (gdb)
31307 @end smallexample
31308
31309 @ignore
31310 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31311 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31312
31313 @subsubheading Synopsis
31314
31315 @smallexample
31316 -file-list-shared-libraries
31317 @end smallexample
31318
31319 List the shared libraries in the program.
31320
31321 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31322
31323 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31324
31325 @subsubheading Example
31326 N.A.
31327
31328
31329 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31330 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31331
31332 @subsubheading Synopsis
31333
31334 @smallexample
31335 -file-list-symbol-files
31336 @end smallexample
31337
31338 List symbol files.
31339
31340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31341
31342 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31343
31344 @subsubheading Example
31345 N.A.
31346 @end ignore
31347
31348
31349 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31350 @findex -file-symbol-file
31351
31352 @subsubheading Synopsis
31353
31354 @smallexample
31355 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31356 @end smallexample
31357
31358 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31359 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31360 produced, except for a completion notification.
31361
31362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31363
31364 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31365
31366 @subsubheading Example
31367
31368 @smallexample
31369 (gdb)
31370 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31371 ^done
31372 (gdb)
31373 @end smallexample
31374
31375 @ignore
31376 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31377 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31378 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31379
31380 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31381
31382 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31383
31384 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31385
31386 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31387
31388 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31389
31390 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31391
31392 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31393
31394 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31395
31396 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31397 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31398 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31399
31400 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31401
31402 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31403
31404 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31405
31406 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31407 @end ignore
31408
31409
31410 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31411 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31412 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31413
31414
31415 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31416 @findex -target-attach
31417
31418 @subsubheading Synopsis
31419
31420 @smallexample
31421 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31422 @end smallexample
31423
31424 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31425 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31426 group, the id previously returned by
31427 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31428
31429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31430
31431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31432
31433 @subsubheading Example
31434 @smallexample
31435 (gdb)
31436 -target-attach 34
31437 =thread-created,id="1"
31438 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31439 ^done
31440 (gdb)
31441 @end smallexample
31442
31443 @ignore
31444 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31445 @findex -target-compare-sections
31446
31447 @subsubheading Synopsis
31448
31449 @smallexample
31450 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31451 @end smallexample
31452
31453 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31454 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31455
31456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31457
31458 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31459
31460 @subsubheading Example
31461 N.A.
31462 @end ignore
31463
31464
31465 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31466 @findex -target-detach
31467
31468 @subsubheading Synopsis
31469
31470 @smallexample
31471 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31472 @end smallexample
31473
31474 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31475 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31476 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31477
31478 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31479
31480 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31481
31482 @subsubheading Example
31483
31484 @smallexample
31485 (gdb)
31486 -target-detach
31487 ^done
31488 (gdb)
31489 @end smallexample
31490
31491
31492 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31493 @findex -target-disconnect
31494
31495 @subsubheading Synopsis
31496
31497 @smallexample
31498 -target-disconnect
31499 @end smallexample
31500
31501 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31502 generally not resumed.
31503
31504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31505
31506 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31507
31508 @subsubheading Example
31509
31510 @smallexample
31511 (gdb)
31512 -target-disconnect
31513 ^done
31514 (gdb)
31515 @end smallexample
31516
31517
31518 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31519 @findex -target-download
31520
31521 @subsubheading Synopsis
31522
31523 @smallexample
31524 -target-download
31525 @end smallexample
31526
31527 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31528 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31529
31530 @table @samp
31531 @item section
31532 The name of the section.
31533 @item section-sent
31534 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31535 @item section-size
31536 The size of the section.
31537 @item total-sent
31538 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31539 @item total-size
31540 The size of the overall executable to download.
31541 @end table
31542
31543 @noindent
31544 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31545 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31546
31547 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31548 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31549
31550 @table @samp
31551 @item section
31552 The name of the section.
31553 @item section-size
31554 The size of the section.
31555 @item total-size
31556 The size of the overall executable to download.
31557 @end table
31558
31559 @noindent
31560 At the end, a summary is printed.
31561
31562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31563
31564 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31565
31566 @subsubheading Example
31567
31568 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31569 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31570
31571 @smallexample
31572 (gdb)
31573 -target-download
31574 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31575 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31576 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31577 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31578 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31579 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31580 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31581 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31582 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31583 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31584 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31585 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31586 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31587 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31588 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31589 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31590 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31591 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31592 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31593 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31594 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31595 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31596 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31597 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31598 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31599 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31600 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31601 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31602 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31603 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31604 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31605 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31606 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31607 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31608 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31609 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31610 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31611 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31612 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31613 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31614 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31615 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31616 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31617 write-rate="429"
31618 (gdb)
31619 @end smallexample
31620
31621
31622 @ignore
31623 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31624 @findex -target-exec-status
31625
31626 @subsubheading Synopsis
31627
31628 @smallexample
31629 -target-exec-status
31630 @end smallexample
31631
31632 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31633 not, for instance).
31634
31635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31636
31637 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31638
31639 @subsubheading Example
31640 N.A.
31641
31642
31643 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31644 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31645
31646 @subsubheading Synopsis
31647
31648 @smallexample
31649 -target-list-available-targets
31650 @end smallexample
31651
31652 List the possible targets to connect to.
31653
31654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31655
31656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31657
31658 @subsubheading Example
31659 N.A.
31660
31661
31662 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31663 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31664
31665 @subsubheading Synopsis
31666
31667 @smallexample
31668 -target-list-current-targets
31669 @end smallexample
31670
31671 Describe the current target.
31672
31673 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31674
31675 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31676 other things).
31677
31678 @subsubheading Example
31679 N.A.
31680
31681
31682 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31683 @findex -target-list-parameters
31684
31685 @subsubheading Synopsis
31686
31687 @smallexample
31688 -target-list-parameters
31689 @end smallexample
31690
31691 @c ????
31692 @end ignore
31693
31694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31695
31696 No equivalent.
31697
31698 @subsubheading Example
31699 N.A.
31700
31701
31702 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31703 @findex -target-select
31704
31705 @subsubheading Synopsis
31706
31707 @smallexample
31708 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31709 @end smallexample
31710
31711 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31712
31713 @table @samp
31714 @item @var{type}
31715 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31716 @item @var{parameters}
31717 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31718 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31719 @end table
31720
31721 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31722 which the target program is, in the following form:
31723
31724 @smallexample
31725 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31726 args=[@var{arg list}]
31727 @end smallexample
31728
31729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31730
31731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31732
31733 @subsubheading Example
31734
31735 @smallexample
31736 (gdb)
31737 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31738 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31739 (gdb)
31740 @end smallexample
31741
31742 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31743 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31744 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31745
31746
31747 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31748 @findex -target-file-put
31749
31750 @subsubheading Synopsis
31751
31752 @smallexample
31753 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31754 @end smallexample
31755
31756 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31757 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31758
31759 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31760
31761 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31762
31763 @subsubheading Example
31764
31765 @smallexample
31766 (gdb)
31767 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31768 ^done
31769 (gdb)
31770 @end smallexample
31771
31772
31773 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31774 @findex -target-file-get
31775
31776 @subsubheading Synopsis
31777
31778 @smallexample
31779 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31780 @end smallexample
31781
31782 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31783 on the host system.
31784
31785 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31786
31787 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31788
31789 @subsubheading Example
31790
31791 @smallexample
31792 (gdb)
31793 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31794 ^done
31795 (gdb)
31796 @end smallexample
31797
31798
31799 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31800 @findex -target-file-delete
31801
31802 @subsubheading Synopsis
31803
31804 @smallexample
31805 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31806 @end smallexample
31807
31808 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31809
31810 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31811
31812 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31813
31814 @subsubheading Example
31815
31816 @smallexample
31817 (gdb)
31818 -target-file-delete remotefile
31819 ^done
31820 (gdb)
31821 @end smallexample
31822
31823
31824 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31825 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31826 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31827
31828 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31829 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31830
31831 @subsubheading Synopsis
31832
31833 @smallexample
31834 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31835 @end smallexample
31836
31837 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31838 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31839 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31840
31841 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31842
31843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31844
31845 @subsubheading Result
31846
31847 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31848 defined for each exception:
31849
31850 @table @samp
31851 @item name
31852 The name of the exception.
31853
31854 @item address
31855 The address of the exception.
31856
31857 @end table
31858
31859 @subsubheading Example
31860
31861 @smallexample
31862 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31863 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31864 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31865 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31866 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31867 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31868 @end smallexample
31869
31870 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31871
31872 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31873 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31874 Catchpoint Commands}.
31875
31876
31877 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31878 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31879 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31880
31881 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31882 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31883 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31884 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31885
31886 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31887 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31888 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31889
31890 @subsubheading Synopsis
31891
31892 @smallexample
31893 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31894 @end smallexample
31895
31896 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31897
31898 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31899 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31900 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31901 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31902 dash.
31903
31904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31905
31906 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31907
31908 @subsubheading Result
31909
31910 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31911
31912 @table @samp
31913 @item exists
31914 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31915 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31916
31917 @end table
31918
31919 @subsubheading Example
31920
31921 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31922
31923 @smallexample
31924 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31925 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31926 @end smallexample
31927
31928 @noindent
31929 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31930 to the debugger:
31931
31932 @smallexample
31933 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31934 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31935 @end smallexample
31936
31937 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31938 @findex -list-features
31939 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31940
31941 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31942 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31943 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31944 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31945 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31946 startup.
31947
31948 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31949 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31950 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31951 is given below.
31952
31953 Example output:
31954
31955 @smallexample
31956 (gdb) -list-features
31957 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31958 @end smallexample
31959
31960 The current list of features is:
31961
31962 @ftable @samp
31963 @item frozen-varobjs
31964 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31965 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31966 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31967 @item pending-breakpoints
31968 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31969 command.
31970 @item python
31971 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31972 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31973 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31974 @item thread-info
31975 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31976 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31977 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31978 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31979 @item breakpoint-notifications
31980 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31981 CLI will be announced via async records.
31982 @item ada-task-info
31983 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31984 @item language-option
31985 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31986 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31987 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31988 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31989 @item undefined-command-error-code
31990 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31991 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31992 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31993 @item exec-run-start-option
31994 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31995 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31996 @end ftable
31997
31998 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31999 @findex -list-target-features
32000
32001 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32002 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32003 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32004 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32005 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32006 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32007 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32008 Example output:
32009
32010 @smallexample
32011 (gdb) -list-target-features
32012 ^done,result=["async"]
32013 @end smallexample
32014
32015 The current list of features is:
32016
32017 @table @samp
32018 @item async
32019 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32020 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32021 while the target is running.
32022
32023 @item reverse
32024 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32025 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32026
32027 @end table
32028
32029 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32030 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32031 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32032
32033 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32034
32035 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32036 @findex -gdb-exit
32037
32038 @subsubheading Synopsis
32039
32040 @smallexample
32041 -gdb-exit
32042 @end smallexample
32043
32044 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32045
32046 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32047
32048 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32049
32050 @subsubheading Example
32051
32052 @smallexample
32053 (gdb)
32054 -gdb-exit
32055 ^exit
32056 @end smallexample
32057
32058
32059 @ignore
32060 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32061 @findex -exec-abort
32062
32063 @subsubheading Synopsis
32064
32065 @smallexample
32066 -exec-abort
32067 @end smallexample
32068
32069 Kill the inferior running program.
32070
32071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32072
32073 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32074
32075 @subsubheading Example
32076 N.A.
32077 @end ignore
32078
32079
32080 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32081 @findex -gdb-set
32082
32083 @subsubheading Synopsis
32084
32085 @smallexample
32086 -gdb-set
32087 @end smallexample
32088
32089 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32090 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32091
32092 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32093
32094 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32095
32096 @subsubheading Example
32097
32098 @smallexample
32099 (gdb)
32100 -gdb-set $foo=3
32101 ^done
32102 (gdb)
32103 @end smallexample
32104
32105
32106 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32107 @findex -gdb-show
32108
32109 @subsubheading Synopsis
32110
32111 @smallexample
32112 -gdb-show
32113 @end smallexample
32114
32115 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32116
32117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32118
32119 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32120
32121 @subsubheading Example
32122
32123 @smallexample
32124 (gdb)
32125 -gdb-show annotate
32126 ^done,value="0"
32127 (gdb)
32128 @end smallexample
32129
32130 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32131
32132
32133 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32134 @findex -gdb-version
32135
32136 @subsubheading Synopsis
32137
32138 @smallexample
32139 -gdb-version
32140 @end smallexample
32141
32142 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32143
32144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32145
32146 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32147 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32148
32149 @subsubheading Example
32150
32151 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32152 @c box in TeX.
32153 @smallexample
32154 (gdb)
32155 -gdb-version
32156 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32157 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32158 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32159 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32160 ~ certain conditions.
32161 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32162 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32163 ~ details.
32164 ~This GDB was configured as
32165 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32166 ^done
32167 (gdb)
32168 @end smallexample
32169
32170 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32171 @findex -list-thread-groups
32172
32173 @subheading Synopsis
32174
32175 @smallexample
32176 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32177 @end smallexample
32178
32179 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32180 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32181 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32182 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32183 top-level thread groups.
32184
32185 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32186 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32187 available on the target.
32188
32189 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32190 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32191 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32192 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32193 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32194 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32195 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32196 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32197
32198 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32199 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32200 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32201 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32202 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32203 @samp{threads} field.
32204
32205 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32206 the following caveats:
32207
32208 @itemize @bullet
32209 @item
32210 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32211 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32212 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32213
32214 @item
32215 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32216 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32217 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32218 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32219 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32220 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32221
32222 @end itemize
32223
32224 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32225 have the following fields:
32226
32227 @table @code
32228 @item id
32229 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32230 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32231 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32232
32233 @item type
32234 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32235 valid type.
32236
32237 @item pid
32238 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32239 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32240
32241 @item exit-code
32242 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32243 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32244 only if the process is not running.
32245
32246 @item num_children
32247 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32248 absent for an available thread group.
32249
32250 @item threads
32251 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32252 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32253 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32254
32255 @item cores
32256 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32257 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32258 such information is not available.
32259
32260 @item executable
32261 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32262 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32263 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32264
32265 @end table
32266
32267 @subheading Example
32268
32269 @smallexample
32270 @value{GDBP}
32271 -list-thread-groups
32272 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32273 -list-thread-groups 17
32274 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32275 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32276 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32277 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32278 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32279 -list-thread-groups --available
32280 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32281 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32282 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32283 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32284 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32285 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32286 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32287 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32288 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32289 @end smallexample
32290
32291 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32292 @findex -info-os
32293
32294 @subsubheading Synopsis
32295
32296 @smallexample
32297 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32298 @end smallexample
32299
32300 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32301 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32302 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32303 of data of that type.
32304
32305 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32306 system.
32307
32308 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32309
32310 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32311
32312 @subsubheading Example
32313
32314 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32315 like this:
32316
32317 @smallexample
32318 @value{GDBP}
32319 -info-os
32320 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32321 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32322 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32323 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32324 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32325 col2="CPUs"@},
32326 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32327 col2="File descriptors"@},
32328 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32329 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32330 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32331 col2="Message queues"@},
32332 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32333 col2="Processes"@},
32334 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32335 col2="Process groups"@},
32336 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32337 col2="Semaphores"@},
32338 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32339 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32340 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32341 col2="Sockets"@},
32342 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32343 col2="Threads"@}]
32344 @value{GDBP}
32345 -info-os processes
32346 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32347 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32348 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32349 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32350 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32351 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32352 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32353 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32354 ...
32355 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32356 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32357 (gdb)
32358 @end smallexample
32359
32360 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32361 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32362 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32363 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32364 @code{info os} omits it.)
32365
32366 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32367 @findex -add-inferior
32368
32369 @subheading Synopsis
32370
32371 @smallexample
32372 -add-inferior
32373 @end smallexample
32374
32375 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32376 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32377 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32378 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32379 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32380 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32381
32382 @subheading Example
32383
32384 @smallexample
32385 @value{GDBP}
32386 -add-inferior
32387 ^done,inferior="i3"
32388 @end smallexample
32389
32390 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32391 @findex -interpreter-exec
32392
32393 @subheading Synopsis
32394
32395 @smallexample
32396 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32397 @end smallexample
32398 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32399
32400 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32401
32402 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32403
32404 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32405
32406 @subheading Example
32407
32408 @smallexample
32409 (gdb)
32410 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32411 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32412 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32413 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32414 ^done
32415 (gdb)
32416 @end smallexample
32417
32418 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32419 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32420
32421 @subheading Synopsis
32422
32423 @smallexample
32424 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32425 @end smallexample
32426
32427 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32428
32429 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32430
32431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32432
32433 @subheading Example
32434
32435 @smallexample
32436 (gdb)
32437 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32438 ^done
32439 (gdb)
32440 @end smallexample
32441
32442 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32443 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32444
32445 @subheading Synopsis
32446
32447 @smallexample
32448 -inferior-tty-show
32449 @end smallexample
32450
32451 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32452
32453 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32454
32455 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32456
32457 @subheading Example
32458
32459 @smallexample
32460 (gdb)
32461 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32462 ^done
32463 (gdb)
32464 -inferior-tty-show
32465 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32466 (gdb)
32467 @end smallexample
32468
32469 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32470 @findex -enable-timings
32471
32472 @subheading Synopsis
32473
32474 @smallexample
32475 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32476 @end smallexample
32477
32478 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32479 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32480 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32481 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32482
32483 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32484
32485 No equivalent.
32486
32487 @subheading Example
32488
32489 @smallexample
32490 (gdb)
32491 -enable-timings
32492 ^done
32493 (gdb)
32494 -break-insert main
32495 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32496 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32497 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32498 times="0"@},
32499 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32500 (gdb)
32501 -enable-timings no
32502 ^done
32503 (gdb)
32504 -exec-run
32505 ^running
32506 (gdb)
32507 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32508 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32509 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32510 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32511 (gdb)
32512 @end smallexample
32513
32514 @node Annotations
32515 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32516
32517 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32518 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32519 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32520 relatively high level.
32521
32522 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32523 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32524
32525 @ignore
32526 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32527 @end ignore
32528
32529 @menu
32530 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32531 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32532 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32533 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32534 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32535 * Annotations for Running::
32536 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32537 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32538 @end menu
32539
32540 @node Annotations Overview
32541 @section What is an Annotation?
32542 @cindex annotations
32543
32544 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32545 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32546 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32547 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32548 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32549 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32550 cannot contain newline characters.
32551
32552 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32553 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32554 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32555 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32556 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32557 means those three characters as output.
32558
32559 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32560 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32561 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32562 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32563 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32564 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32565 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32566 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32567 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32568
32569 @table @code
32570 @kindex set annotate
32571 @item set annotate @var{level}
32572 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32573 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32574
32575 @item show annotate
32576 @kindex show annotate
32577 Show the current annotation level.
32578 @end table
32579
32580 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32581
32582 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32583
32584 @smallexample
32585 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32586 GNU gdb 6.0
32587 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32588 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32589 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32590 under certain conditions.
32591 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32592 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32593 for details.
32594 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32595
32596 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32597 (@value{GDBP})
32598 ^Z^Zprompt
32599 @kbd{quit}
32600
32601 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32602 $
32603 @end smallexample
32604
32605 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32606 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32607 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32608 output from @value{GDBN}.
32609
32610 @node Server Prefix
32611 @section The Server Prefix
32612 @cindex server prefix
32613
32614 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32615 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32616 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32617 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32618 a transparent manner.
32619
32620 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32621 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32622 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32623 @code{print} command.
32624
32625 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32626 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32627
32628 @node Prompting
32629 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32630
32631 @cindex annotations for prompts
32632 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32633 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32634 over, etc.
32635
32636 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32637 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32638 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32639 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32640 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32641 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32642 features the following annotations:
32643
32644 @smallexample
32645 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32646 ^Z^Zprompt
32647 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32648 @end smallexample
32649
32650 The input types are
32651
32652 @table @code
32653 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32654 @findex prompt annotation
32655 @findex post-prompt annotation
32656 @item prompt
32657 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32658
32659 @findex pre-commands annotation
32660 @findex commands annotation
32661 @findex post-commands annotation
32662 @item commands
32663 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32664 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32665
32666 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32667 @findex overload-choice annotation
32668 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32669 @item overload-choice
32670 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32671
32672 @findex pre-query annotation
32673 @findex query annotation
32674 @findex post-query annotation
32675 @item query
32676 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32677
32678 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32679 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32680 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32681 @item prompt-for-continue
32682 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32683 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32684 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32685 presence of annotations.
32686 @end table
32687
32688 @node Errors
32689 @section Errors
32690 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32691
32692 @findex quit annotation
32693 @smallexample
32694 ^Z^Zquit
32695 @end smallexample
32696
32697 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32698
32699 @findex error annotation
32700 @smallexample
32701 ^Z^Zerror
32702 @end smallexample
32703
32704 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32705
32706 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32707 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32708 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32709 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32710 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32711 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32712 to the top level.
32713
32714 @findex error-begin annotation
32715 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32716
32717 @smallexample
32718 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32719 @end smallexample
32720
32721 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32722 message.
32723
32724 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32725 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32726 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32727
32728 @node Invalidation
32729 @section Invalidation Notices
32730
32731 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32732 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32733 changed.
32734
32735 @table @code
32736 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32737 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32738
32739 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32740 have changed.
32741
32742 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32743 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32744
32745 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32746 deleted a breakpoint.
32747 @end table
32748
32749 @node Annotations for Running
32750 @section Running the Program
32751 @cindex annotations for running programs
32752
32753 @findex starting annotation
32754 @findex stopping annotation
32755 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32756 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32757
32758 @smallexample
32759 ^Z^Zstarting
32760 @end smallexample
32761
32762 is output. When the program stops,
32763
32764 @smallexample
32765 ^Z^Zstopped
32766 @end smallexample
32767
32768 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32769 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32770
32771 @table @code
32772 @findex exited annotation
32773 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32774 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32775 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32776
32777 @findex signalled annotation
32778 @findex signal-name annotation
32779 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32780 @findex signal-string annotation
32781 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32782 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32783 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32784 annotation continues:
32785
32786 @smallexample
32787 @var{intro-text}
32788 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32789 @var{name}
32790 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32791 @var{middle-text}
32792 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32793 @var{string}
32794 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32795 @var{end-text}
32796 @end smallexample
32797
32798 @noindent
32799 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32800 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32801 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32802 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32803 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32804
32805 @findex signal annotation
32806 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32807 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32808 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32809 terminated with it.
32810
32811 @findex breakpoint annotation
32812 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32813 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32814
32815 @findex watchpoint annotation
32816 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32817 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32818 @end table
32819
32820 @node Source Annotations
32821 @section Displaying Source
32822 @cindex annotations for source display
32823
32824 @findex source annotation
32825 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32826
32827 @smallexample
32828 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32829 @end smallexample
32830
32831 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32832 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32833 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32834 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32835 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32836 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32837 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32838 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32839 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32840 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32841 depend on the language).
32842
32843 @node JIT Interface
32844 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32845 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32846 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32847
32848 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32849 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32850 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32851 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32852
32853 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32854 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32855 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32856 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32857 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32858 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32859
32860 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32861 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32862 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32863 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32864 LLVM JIT.
32865
32866 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32867 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32868 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32869 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32870 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32871 out about additional code.
32872
32873 @menu
32874 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32875 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32876 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32877 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32878 @end menu
32879
32880 @node Declarations
32881 @section JIT Declarations
32882
32883 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32884 implement the interface:
32885
32886 @smallexample
32887 typedef enum
32888 @{
32889 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32890 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32891 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32892 @} jit_actions_t;
32893
32894 struct jit_code_entry
32895 @{
32896 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32897 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32898 const char *symfile_addr;
32899 uint64_t symfile_size;
32900 @};
32901
32902 struct jit_descriptor
32903 @{
32904 uint32_t version;
32905 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32906 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32907 uint32_t action_flag;
32908 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32909 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32910 @};
32911
32912 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32913 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32914
32915 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32916 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32917 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32918 @end smallexample
32919
32920 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32921 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32922 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32923
32924 @node Registering Code
32925 @section Registering Code
32926
32927 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32928
32929 @itemize @bullet
32930 @item
32931 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32932 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32933
32934 @item
32935 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32936 file.
32937
32938 @item
32939 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32940
32941 @item
32942 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32943
32944 @item
32945 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32946 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32947 @end itemize
32948
32949 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32950 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32951 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32952 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32953
32954 @node Unregistering Code
32955 @section Unregistering Code
32956
32957 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32958
32959 @itemize @bullet
32960 @item
32961 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32962
32963 @item
32964 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32965
32966 @item
32967 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32968 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32969 @end itemize
32970
32971 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32972 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32973
32974 @node Custom Debug Info
32975 @section Custom Debug Info
32976 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32977 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32978
32979 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32980 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32981 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32982 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32983 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32984 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32985 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32986 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32987 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32988
32989 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32990 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32991 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32992 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32993 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32994 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32995 compiler.
32996
32997 @menu
32998 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32999 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33000 @end menu
33001
33002 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33003 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33004 @kindex jit-reader-load
33005 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33006
33007 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33008 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33009
33010 @table @code
33011 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33012 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33013 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33014 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33015 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33016 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33017 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33018
33019 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33020 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33021 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33022 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33023 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33024
33025 @item jit-reader-unload
33026 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33027
33028 @end table
33029
33030 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33031 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33032 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33033
33034 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33035 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33036
33037 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33038 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33039 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33040 the system include directory.
33041
33042 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33043 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33044 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33045
33046 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33047 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33048
33049 @findex gdb_init_reader
33050 @smallexample
33051 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33052 @end smallexample
33053
33054 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33055
33056 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33057 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33058 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33059 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33060 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33061 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33062
33063 @smallexample
33064 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33065 @{
33066 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33067 int reader_version;
33068
33069 /* For use by the reader. */
33070 void *priv_data;
33071
33072 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33073 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33074 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33075 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33076 @};
33077 @end smallexample
33078
33079 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33080 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33081
33082 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33083 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33084 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33085 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33086 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33087 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33088 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33089 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33090 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33091 target's address space.
33092
33093 @node In-Process Agent
33094 @chapter In-Process Agent
33095 @cindex debugging agent
33096 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33097 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33098 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33099 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33100 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33101 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33102 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33103 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33104 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33105 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33106 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33107 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33108 behavior without interrupting it.
33109
33110 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33111 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33112 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33113 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33114 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33115 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33116 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33117 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33118 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33119
33120 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33121 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33122 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33123 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33124
33125 @anchor{Control Agent}
33126 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33127 debugging with the following commands:
33128
33129 @table @code
33130 @kindex set agent on
33131 @item set agent on
33132 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33133 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33134 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33135 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33136 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33137 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33138
33139 @kindex set agent off
33140 @item set agent off
33141 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33142 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33143
33144 @kindex show agent
33145 @item show agent
33146 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33147 the in-process agent.
33148 @end table
33149
33150 @menu
33151 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33152 @end menu
33153
33154 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33155 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33156 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33157
33158 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33159 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33160 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33161 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33162 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33163 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33164 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33165 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33166 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33167
33168 @menu
33169 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33170 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33171 @end menu
33172
33173 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33174 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33175 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33176
33177 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33178 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33179
33180 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33181 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33182 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33183 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33184
33185 @enumerate
33186 @item
33187 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33188 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33189 @item
33190 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33191 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33192 the other one.
33193 @end enumerate
33194
33195 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33196
33197 @enumerate
33198 @item
33199 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33200 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33201 @anchor{agent expression object}
33202 @item
33203 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33204 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33205 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33206 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33207 @item
33208 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33209 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33210
33211 @end enumerate
33212
33213 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33214 object:
33215
33216 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33217 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33218 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33219 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33220 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33221 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33222 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33223 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33224 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33225 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33226 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33227 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33228 memory address for collecting.
33229 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33230 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33231 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33232 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33233 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33234 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33235 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33236 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33237 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33238 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33239 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33240 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33241 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33242 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33243 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33244 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33245 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33246 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33247 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33248 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33249 @ref{agent expression object}
33250 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33251 @ref{agent expression object}
33252 @item actions @tab variable
33253 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33254 @end multitable
33255
33256 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33257 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33258 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33259
33260 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33261 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33262
33263 @table @samp
33264
33265 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33266 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33267 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33268 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33269 in IPA finally.
33270
33271 Replies:
33272 @table @samp
33273 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33274 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33275 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33276 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33277 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33278 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33279 @item E @var{NN}
33280 for an error
33281
33282 @end table
33283
33284 @item close
33285 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33286 is about to kill inferiors.
33287
33288 @item qTfSTM
33289 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33290 @item qTsSTM
33291 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33292 @item qTSTMat
33293 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33294 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33295 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33296
33297 Replies:
33298 @table @samp
33299 @item E @var{NN}
33300 for an error
33301 @end table
33302 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33303 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33304 @end table
33305
33306 @node GDB Bugs
33307 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33308 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33309 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33310
33311 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33312
33313 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33314 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33315 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33316 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33317
33318 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33319 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33320
33321 @menu
33322 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33323 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33324 @end menu
33325
33326 @node Bug Criteria
33327 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33328 @cindex bug criteria
33329
33330 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33331
33332 @itemize @bullet
33333 @cindex fatal signal
33334 @cindex debugger crash
33335 @cindex crash of debugger
33336 @item
33337 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33338 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33339
33340 @cindex error on valid input
33341 @item
33342 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33343 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33344 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33345
33346 @cindex invalid input
33347 @item
33348 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33349 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33350 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33351 for traditional practice''.
33352
33353 @item
33354 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33355 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33356 @end itemize
33357
33358 @node Bug Reporting
33359 @section How to Report Bugs
33360 @cindex bug reports
33361 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33362
33363 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33364 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33365 contact that organization first.
33366
33367 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33368 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33369 distribution.
33370 @c should add a web page ref...
33371
33372 @ifset BUGURL
33373 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33374 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33375 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33376 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33377 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33378 be used.
33379
33380 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33381 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33382 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33383 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33384
33385 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33386 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33387 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33388 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33389 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33390 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33391 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33392 bug reports to the mailing list.
33393 @end ifset
33394 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33395 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33396 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33397 @end ifclear
33398 @end ifset
33399
33400 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33401 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33402 fact or leave it out, state it!
33403
33404 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33405 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33406 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33407 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33408 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33409 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33410 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33411 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33412 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33413
33414 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33415 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33416 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33417 self-contained.
33418
33419 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33420 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33421 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33422 bugs properly.
33423
33424 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33425
33426 @itemize @bullet
33427 @item
33428 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33429 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33430 version}.
33431
33432 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33433 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33434
33435 @item
33436 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33437 version number.
33438
33439 @item
33440 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33441 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33442 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33443 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33444
33445 @item
33446 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33447 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33448
33449 @item
33450 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33451 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33452 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33453 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33454 those compilers.
33455
33456 @item
33457 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33458 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33459 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33460 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33461
33462 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33463 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33464
33465 @item
33466 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33467 reproduce the bug.
33468
33469 @item
33470 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33471 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33472
33473 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33474 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33475 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33476 a chance to make a mistake.
33477
33478 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33479 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33480 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33481 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33482 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33483 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33484 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33485 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33486
33487 @pindex script
33488 @cindex recording a session script
33489 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33490 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33491 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33492 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33493
33494 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33495 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33496
33497 @item
33498 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33499 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33500 it by context, not by line number.
33501
33502 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33503 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33504
33505 @end itemize
33506
33507 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33508
33509 @itemize @bullet
33510 @item
33511 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33512
33513 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33514 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33515 changes will not affect it.
33516
33517 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33518 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33519 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33520 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33521
33522 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33523 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33524 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33525 less time, and so on.
33526
33527 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33528 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33529
33530 @item
33531 A patch for the bug.
33532
33533 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33534 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33535 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33536 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33537
33538 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33539 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33540 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33541 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33542
33543 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33544 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33545 help us to understand.
33546
33547 @item
33548 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33549
33550 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33551 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33552 @end itemize
33553
33554 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33555 @c and consists of the two following files:
33556 @c rluser.texi
33557 @c hsuser.texi
33558 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33559 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33560 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33561 @include rluser.texi
33562 @include hsuser.texi
33563 @end ifclear
33564
33565 @node In Memoriam
33566 @appendix In Memoriam
33567
33568 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33569 contributors:
33570
33571 @table @code
33572 @item Fred Fish
33573 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33574 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33575 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33576
33577 @item Michael Snyder
33578 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33579 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33580 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33581 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33582 @end table
33583
33584 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33585 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33586
33587 @node Formatting Documentation
33588 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33589
33590 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33591 @cindex reference card
33592 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33593 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33594 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33595 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33596 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33597 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33598
33599 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33600 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33601
33602 @smallexample
33603 make refcard.dvi
33604 @end smallexample
33605
33606 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33607 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33608 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33609 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33610 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33611
33612 @cindex documentation
33613
33614 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33615 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33616 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33617 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33618 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33619 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33620
33621 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33622 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33623 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33624 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33625 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33626 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33627 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33628 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33629
33630 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33631 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33632 @code{makeinfo}.
33633
33634 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33635 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33636 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33637
33638 @smallexample
33639 cd gdb
33640 make gdb.info
33641 @end smallexample
33642
33643 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33644 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33645 Texinfo definitions file.
33646
33647 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33648 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33649 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33650 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33651 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33652 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33653 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33654
33655 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33656 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33657 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33658 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33659 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33660 directory.
33661
33662 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33663 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33664 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33665 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33666
33667 @smallexample
33668 make gdb.dvi
33669 @end smallexample
33670
33671 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33672
33673 @node Installing GDB
33674 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33675 @cindex installation
33676
33677 @menu
33678 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33679 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33680 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33681 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33682 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33683 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33684 @end menu
33685
33686 @node Requirements
33687 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33688 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33689
33690 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33691 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33692
33693 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33694 @table @asis
33695 @item ISO C90 compiler
33696 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33697 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33698
33699 @end table
33700
33701 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33702 @table @asis
33703 @item Expat
33704 @anchor{Expat}
33705 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33706 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33707 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33708 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33709 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33710 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33711
33712 Expat is used for:
33713
33714 @itemize @bullet
33715 @item
33716 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33717 @item
33718 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33719 @item
33720 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33721 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33722 @item
33723 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33724 @item
33725 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33726 @item
33727 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33728 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33729 @end itemize
33730
33731 @item zlib
33732 @cindex compressed debug sections
33733 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33734 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33735 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33736 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33737 information in such binaries.
33738
33739 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33740 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33741 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33742
33743 @item iconv
33744 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33745 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33746 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33747 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33748
33749 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33750 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33751 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33752 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33753
33754 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33755 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33756 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33757
33758 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33759 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33760 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33761 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33762 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33763 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33764 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33765 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33766 @end table
33767
33768 @node Running Configure
33769 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33770 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33771 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33772 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33773 build the @code{gdb} program.
33774 @iftex
33775 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33776 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33777 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33778 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33779 @end iftex
33780
33781 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33782 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33783 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33784
33785 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33786 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33787
33788 @table @code
33789 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33790 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33791
33792 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33793 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33794
33795 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33796 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33797
33798 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33799 @sc{gnu} include files
33800
33801 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33802 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33803
33804 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33805 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33806
33807 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33808 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33809
33810 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33811 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33812
33813 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33814 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33815 @end table
33816
33817 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33818 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33819 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33820
33821 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33822 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33823 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33824 argument.
33825
33826 For example:
33827
33828 @smallexample
33829 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33830 ./configure @var{host}
33831 make
33832 @end smallexample
33833
33834 @noindent
33835 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33836 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33837 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33838 correct value by examining your system.)
33839
33840 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33841 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33842 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33843 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33844
33845 @need 750
33846 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33847 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33848 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33849
33850 @smallexample
33851 sh configure @var{host}
33852 @end smallexample
33853
33854 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33855 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33856 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33857 @file{configure}
33858 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33859 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33860
33861 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33862 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33863 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33864 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33865 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33866 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33867 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33868 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33869 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33870
33871 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33872 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33873 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33874 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33875 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33876
33877 @node Separate Objdir
33878 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33879
33880 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33881 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33882 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33883 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33884 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33885 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33886 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33887 program specified there.
33888
33889 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33890 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33891 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33892 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33893 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33894 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33895
33896 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33897 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33898
33899 @smallexample
33900 @group
33901 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33902 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33903 cd ../gdb-sun4
33904 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33905 make
33906 @end group
33907 @end smallexample
33908
33909 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33910 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33911 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33912 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33913 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33914 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33915
33916 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33917 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33918 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33919 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33920 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33921
33922 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33923 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33924 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33925 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33926 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33927 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33928
33929 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33930 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33931 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33932
33933 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33934 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33935 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33936 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33937 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33938
33939 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33940 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33941 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33942 with each other.
33943
33944 @node Config Names
33945 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33946
33947 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33948 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33949 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33950 of information in the following pattern:
33951
33952 @smallexample
33953 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33954 @end smallexample
33955
33956 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33957 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33958 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33959
33960 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33961 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33962 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33963 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33964 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33965 abbreviations---for example:
33966
33967 @smallexample
33968 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33969 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33970 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33971 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33972 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33973 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33974 % sh config.sub sun4
33975 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33976 % sh config.sub sun3
33977 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33978 % sh config.sub i986v
33979 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33980 @end smallexample
33981
33982 @noindent
33983 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33984 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33985
33986 @node Configure Options
33987 @section @file{configure} Options
33988
33989 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33990 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33991 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33992 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33993
33994 @smallexample
33995 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33996 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33997 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33998 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33999 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34000 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34001 @var{host}
34002 @end smallexample
34003
34004 @noindent
34005 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34006 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34007 @samp{--}.
34008
34009 @table @code
34010 @item --help
34011 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34012
34013 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34014 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34015 @file{@var{dir}}.
34016
34017 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34018 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34019 @file{@var{dir}}.
34020
34021 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34022 @need 2000
34023 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34024 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34025 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34026 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34027 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34028 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34029 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34030 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34031 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34032 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34033 @var{dirname}.
34034
34035 @item --norecursion
34036 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34037 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34038
34039 @item --target=@var{target}
34040 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34041 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34042 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34043
34044 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34045
34046 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34047 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34048
34049 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34050 @end table
34051
34052 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34053 needed for special purposes only.
34054
34055 @node System-wide configuration
34056 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34057 @cindex system-wide init file
34058
34059 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34060 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34061 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34062
34063 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34064
34065 @table @code
34066 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34067 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34068 @var{file}.
34069 @end table
34070
34071 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34072 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34073
34074 @itemize @bullet
34075 @item
34076 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34077 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34078 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34079 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34080 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34081 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34082
34083 @item
34084 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34085 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34086 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34087 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34088 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34089 @end itemize
34090
34091 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34092 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34093 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34094 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34095 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34096 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34097 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34098 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34099 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34100 reread.
34101
34102 @menu
34103 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34104 @end menu
34105
34106 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34107 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34108 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34109
34110 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34111 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34112 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34113 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34114 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34115 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34116
34117 The following scripts are currently available:
34118 @itemize @bullet
34119
34120 @item @file{elinos.py}
34121 @pindex elinos.py
34122 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34123 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34124 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34125 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34126 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34127 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34128
34129 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34130 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34131 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34132 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34133 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34134 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34135
34136 @end itemize
34137
34138 @node Maintenance Commands
34139 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34140 @cindex maintenance commands
34141 @cindex internal commands
34142
34143 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34144 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34145 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34146 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34147 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34148
34149 @table @code
34150 @kindex maint agent
34151 @kindex maint agent-eval
34152 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34153 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34154 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34155 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34156 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34157 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34158 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34159 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34160 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34161 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34162 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34163 addition and return the sum.
34164 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34165 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34166
34167 @kindex maint agent-printf
34168 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34169 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34170 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34171 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34172 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34173
34174 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34175 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34176 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34177 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34178 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34179 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34180 is shown:
34181
34182 @table @code
34183 @item breakpoint
34184 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34185
34186 @item watchpoint
34187 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34188
34189 @item longjmp
34190 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34191 @code{longjmp} calls.
34192
34193 @item longjmp resume
34194 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34195
34196 @item until
34197 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34198
34199 @item finish
34200 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34201
34202 @item shlib events
34203 Shared library events.
34204
34205 @end table
34206
34207 @kindex maint info btrace
34208 @item maint info btrace
34209 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34210
34211 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34212 @item maint btrace packet-history
34213 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34214 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34215 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34216 recording format.
34217
34218 @table @code
34219 @item bts
34220 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34221 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34222
34223 @table @asis
34224 @item Block number
34225 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34226 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34227 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34228 @end table
34229
34230 @item pt
34231 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34232 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34233 information is printed:
34234
34235 @table @asis
34236 @item Packet number
34237 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34238 @item Trace offset
34239 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34240 @item Packet opcode and payload
34241 @end table
34242 @end table
34243
34244 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34245 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34246 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34247 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34248 needed.
34249
34250 @kindex maint btrace clear
34251 @item maint btrace clear
34252 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34253 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34254
34255 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34256 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34257 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34258 buffer.
34259
34260 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34261 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34262 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34263 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34264 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34265 packet history.
34266
34267 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34268 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34269 @cindex displaced stepping support
34270 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34271 @item set displaced-stepping
34272 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34273 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34274 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34275 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34276 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34277 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34278
34279 @table @code
34280 @item set displaced-stepping on
34281 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34282 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34283
34284 @item set displaced-stepping off
34285 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34286 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34287
34288 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34289 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34290 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34291 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34292 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34293 @end table
34294
34295 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34296 @item maint check-psymtabs
34297 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34298 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34299
34300 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34301 @item maint check-symtabs
34302 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34303
34304 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34305 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34306 Expand symbol tables.
34307 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34308 names matching @var{regexp}.
34309
34310 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34311 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34312 @cindex demangler crashes
34313 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34314 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34315 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34316 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34317 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34318 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34319 option to terminate the current session.
34320
34321 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34322 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34323 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34324
34325 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34326 @item maint cplus namespace
34327 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34328
34329 @kindex maint deprecate
34330 @kindex maint undeprecate
34331 @cindex deprecated commands
34332 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34333 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34334 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34335 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34336 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34337 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34338 the replacement as part of the warning.
34339
34340 @kindex maint dump-me
34341 @item maint dump-me
34342 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34343 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34344 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34345 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34346
34347 @kindex maint internal-error
34348 @kindex maint internal-warning
34349 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34350 @cindex demangler crashes
34351 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34352 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34353 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34354
34355 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34356 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34357 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34358 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34359 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34360 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34361 @value{GDBN} session.
34362
34363 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34364 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34365
34366 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34367
34368 @smallexample
34369 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34370 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34371 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34372 debugging may prove unreliable.
34373 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34374 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34375 (@value{GDBP})
34376 @end smallexample
34377
34378 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34379 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34380 @cindex demangler crashes
34381
34382 @kindex maint set internal-error
34383 @kindex maint show internal-error
34384 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34385 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34386 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34387 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34388 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34389 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34390 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34391 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34392 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34393 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34394 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34395 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34396 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34397 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34398 described in the table below.
34399
34400 @table @samp
34401 @item quit
34402 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34403 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34404
34405 @item corefile
34406 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34407 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34408 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34409 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34410 disabled.
34411 @end table
34412
34413 @kindex maint packet
34414 @item maint packet @var{text}
34415 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34416 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34417 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34418 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34419 checksum.
34420
34421 @kindex maint print architecture
34422 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34423 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34424 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34425
34426 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34427 @item maint print c-tdesc
34428 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34429 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34430 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34431
34432 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34433 @item maint print dummy-frames
34434 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34435
34436 @smallexample
34437 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34438 @dots{}
34439 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34440 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34441 58 return (a + b);
34442 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34443 @dots{}
34444 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34445 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34446 (@value{GDBP})
34447 @end smallexample
34448
34449 Takes an optional file parameter.
34450
34451 @kindex maint print registers
34452 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34453 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34454 @kindex maint print register-groups
34455 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34456 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34457 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34458 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34459 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34460 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34461 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34462
34463 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34464 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34465 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34466 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34467 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34468 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34469 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34470 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34471
34472 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34473 write the information.
34474
34475 @kindex maint print reggroups
34476 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34477 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34478 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34479 information.
34480
34481 The register groups info looks like this:
34482
34483 @smallexample
34484 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34485 Group Type
34486 general user
34487 float user
34488 all user
34489 vector user
34490 system user
34491 save internal
34492 restore internal
34493 @end smallexample
34494
34495 @kindex flushregs
34496 @item flushregs
34497 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34498
34499 @kindex maint print objfiles
34500 @cindex info for known object files
34501 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34502 Print a dump of all known object files.
34503 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34504 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34505 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34506
34507 @kindex maint print user-registers
34508 @cindex user registers
34509 @item maint print user-registers
34510 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34511 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34512 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34513 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34514 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34515 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34516 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34517
34518 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34519 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34520 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34521 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34522 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34523 matching @var{regexp}.
34524 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34525 and the full path if known.
34526 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34527
34528 @kindex maint print statistics
34529 @cindex bcache statistics
34530 @item maint print statistics
34531 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34532 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34533 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34534 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34535 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34536 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34537 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34538 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34539 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34540 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34541 lengths.
34542
34543 @kindex maint print target-stack
34544 @cindex target stack description
34545 @item maint print target-stack
34546 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34547 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34548 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34549 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34550 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34551 address.
34552
34553 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34554 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34555
34556 @kindex maint print type
34557 @cindex type chain of a data type
34558 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34559 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34560 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34561 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34562 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34563 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34564
34565 @kindex maint selftest
34566 @cindex self tests
34567 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
34568 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34569
34570 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34571 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34572 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34573 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34574 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34575 information.
34576
34577 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34578 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34579 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34580 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34581 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34582 always see the disassembly form.
34583
34584 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34585
34586 @smallexample
34587 (gdb) info addr argc
34588 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34589 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34590 @end smallexample
34591
34592 For more information on these expressions, see
34593 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34594
34595 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34596 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34597 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34598 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34599 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34600
34601 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34602 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34603 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34604 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34605 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34606 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34607 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34608 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34609 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34610
34611 @kindex maint set profile
34612 @kindex maint show profile
34613 @cindex profiling GDB
34614 @item maint set profile
34615 @itemx maint show profile
34616 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34617
34618 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34619 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34620 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34621 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34622 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34623 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34624 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34625
34626 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34627 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34628
34629 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34630 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34631 @cindex hardware debug registers
34632 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34633 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34634 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34635 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34636 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34637 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34638 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34639
34640 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34641 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34642 @item maint set show-all-tib
34643 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34644 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34645 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34646 command.
34647
34648 @kindex maint set target-async
34649 @kindex maint show target-async
34650 @item maint set target-async
34651 @itemx maint show target-async
34652 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34653 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34654 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34655 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34656
34657 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34658 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34659 @item maint set target-non-stop
34660 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34661
34662 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34663 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34664 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34665 if supported by the target.
34666
34667 @table @code
34668 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34669 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34670 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34671
34672 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34673 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34674 does not indicate support.
34675
34676 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34677 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34678 target supports it.
34679 @end table
34680
34681 @kindex maint set per-command
34682 @kindex maint show per-command
34683 @item maint set per-command
34684 @itemx maint show per-command
34685 @cindex resources used by commands
34686
34687 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34688 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34689
34690 @table @code
34691 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34692 @itemx maint show per-command space
34693 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34694 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34695 took, following the command's own output.
34696 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34697 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34698
34699 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34700 @itemx maint show per-command time
34701 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34702 for each command.
34703 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34704 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34705 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34706 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34707 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34708 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34709 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34710 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34711 spent by the program been debugged.
34712 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34713 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34714
34715 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34716 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34717 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34718 for each command.
34719 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34720
34721 @enumerate a
34722 @item
34723 number of symbol tables
34724 @item
34725 number of primary symbol tables
34726 @item
34727 number of blocks in the blockvector
34728 @end enumerate
34729 @end table
34730
34731 @kindex maint space
34732 @cindex memory used by commands
34733 @item maint space @var{value}
34734 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34735 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34736
34737 @kindex maint time
34738 @cindex time of command execution
34739 @item maint time @var{value}
34740 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34741 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34742
34743 @kindex maint translate-address
34744 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34745 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34746 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34747 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34748 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34749 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34750 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34751
34752 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34753 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34754 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34755
34756 @end table
34757
34758 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34759 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34760
34761 @table @code
34762 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34763 @kindex set watchdog
34764 @cindex watchdog timer
34765 @cindex timeout for commands
34766 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34767 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34768 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34769
34770 @item show watchdog
34771 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34772 @end table
34773
34774 @node Remote Protocol
34775 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34776
34777 @menu
34778 * Overview::
34779 * Packets::
34780 * Stop Reply Packets::
34781 * General Query Packets::
34782 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34783 * Tracepoint Packets::
34784 * Host I/O Packets::
34785 * Interrupts::
34786 * Notification Packets::
34787 * Remote Non-Stop::
34788 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34789 * Examples::
34790 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34791 * Library List Format::
34792 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34793 * Memory Map Format::
34794 * Thread List Format::
34795 * Traceframe Info Format::
34796 * Branch Trace Format::
34797 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34798 @end menu
34799
34800 @node Overview
34801 @section Overview
34802
34803 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34804 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34805 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34806 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34807
34808 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34809 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34810
34811 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34812 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34813 @cindex remote serial protocol
34814 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34815 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34816 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34817 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34818 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34819
34820 @smallexample
34821 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34822 @end smallexample
34823 @noindent
34824
34825 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34826 @noindent
34827 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34828 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34829 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34830
34831 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34832 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34833
34834 @smallexample
34835 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34836 @end smallexample
34837
34838 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34839 @noindent
34840 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34841 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34842 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34843
34844 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34845 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34846 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34847 retransmission):
34848
34849 @smallexample
34850 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34851 <- @code{+}
34852 @end smallexample
34853 @noindent
34854
34855 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34856 once a connection is established.
34857 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34858
34859 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34860 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34861 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34862 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34863 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34864 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34865 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34866
34867 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34868 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34869 exceptions).
34870
34871 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34872 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34873 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34874 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34875
34876 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34877 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34878 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34879
34880 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34881 @anchor{Binary Data}
34882 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34883 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34884 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34885 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34886 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34887 binary data.
34888
34889 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34890 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34891 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34892 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34893 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34894 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34895 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34896 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34897 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34898 (described next).
34899
34900 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34901 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34902 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34903 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34904 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34905 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34906 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34907 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34908 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34909 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34910 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34911 3}} more times.
34912
34913 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34914 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34915 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34916 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34917 @samp{0*"00}.
34918
34919 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34920 error number. That number is not well defined.
34921
34922 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34923 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34924 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34925 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34926 on that response.
34927
34928 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34929 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34930 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34931 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34932 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34933 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34934
34935 @node Packets
34936 @section Packets
34937
34938 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34939 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34940 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34941 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34942
34943 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34944 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34945 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34946 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34947 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34948 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34949 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34950 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34951 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34952 @var{baz}.
34953
34954 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34955 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34956 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34957 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34958 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34959 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34960 pick any thread.
34961
34962 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34963 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34964 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34965 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34966 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34967 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34968 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34969 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34970 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34971 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34972 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34973 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34974 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34975
34976 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34977 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34978 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34979 more information.
34980
34981 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34982 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34983
34984 Here are the packet descriptions.
34985
34986 @table @samp
34987
34988 @item !
34989 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34990 @anchor{extended mode}
34991 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34992 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34993 debugged.
34994
34995 Reply:
34996 @table @samp
34997 @item OK
34998 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34999 @end table
35000
35001 @item ?
35002 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35003 @anchor{? packet}
35004 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35005 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35006 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35007
35008 Reply:
35009 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35010
35011 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35012 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35013 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35014 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35015 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35016
35017 Reply:
35018 @table @samp
35019 @item OK
35020 The arguments were set.
35021 @item E @var{NN}
35022 An error occurred.
35023 @end table
35024
35025 @item b @var{baud}
35026 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35027 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35028 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35029
35030 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35031 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35032 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35033
35034 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35035 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35036 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35037 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35038 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35039
35040 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35041 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35042 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35043 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35044
35045 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35046 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35047
35048 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35049 @anchor{bc}
35050 @item bc
35051 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35052 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35053
35054 Reply:
35055 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35056
35057 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35058 @anchor{bs}
35059 @item bs
35060 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35061 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35062
35063 Reply:
35064 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35065
35066 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35067 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35068 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35069 is omitted, resume at current address.
35070
35071 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35072 packet}.
35073
35074 Reply:
35075 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35076
35077 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35078 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35079 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35080 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35081
35082 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35083 packet}.
35084
35085 Reply:
35086 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35087
35088 @item d
35089 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35090 Toggle debug flag.
35091
35092 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35093 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35094
35095 @item D
35096 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35097 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35098 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35099 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35100 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35101
35102 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35103 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35104 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35105 big-endian hex string.
35106
35107 Reply:
35108 @table @samp
35109 @item OK
35110 for success
35111 @item E @var{NN}
35112 for an error
35113 @end table
35114
35115 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35116 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35117 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35118 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35119 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35120
35121 @item g
35122 @anchor{read registers packet}
35123 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35124 Read general registers.
35125
35126 Reply:
35127 @table @samp
35128 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35129 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35130 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35131 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35132 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35133 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
35134 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
35135
35136 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35137 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35138 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35139 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35140 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35141 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35142 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35143 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35144
35145 @smallexample
35146 -> @code{g}
35147 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35148 @end smallexample
35149
35150 @item E @var{NN}
35151 for an error.
35152 @end table
35153
35154 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35155 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35156 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35157 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35158
35159 Reply:
35160 @table @samp
35161 @item OK
35162 for success
35163 @item E @var{NN}
35164 for an error
35165 @end table
35166
35167 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35168 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35169 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35170 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35171 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35172 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35173 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35174 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35175 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35176
35177 Reply:
35178 @table @samp
35179 @item OK
35180 for success
35181 @item E @var{NN}
35182 for an error
35183 @end table
35184
35185 @c FIXME: JTC:
35186 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35187 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35188 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35189 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35190 @c described. For example:
35191 @c
35192 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35193 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35194 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35195 @c
35196 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35197 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35198 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35199
35200 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35201 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35202 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35203 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35204 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35205 step starting at that address.
35206
35207 @item I
35208 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35209 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35210 step packet}.
35211
35212 @item k
35213 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35214 Kill request.
35215
35216 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35217
35218 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35219 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35220
35221 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35222
35223 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35224 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35225 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35226
35227 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35228 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35229 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35230
35231 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35232 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35233 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35234 (@pxref{? packet}).
35235
35236 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35237 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35238 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35239 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35240 any particular boundary.
35241
35242 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35243 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35244 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35245 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35246 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35247 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35248 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35249 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35250
35251 Reply:
35252 @table @samp
35253 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35254 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35255 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35256 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35257 @item E @var{NN}
35258 @var{NN} is errno
35259 @end table
35260
35261 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35262 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35263 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35264 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35265 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35266
35267 Reply:
35268 @table @samp
35269 @item OK
35270 for success
35271 @item E @var{NN}
35272 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35273 written).
35274 @end table
35275
35276 @item p @var{n}
35277 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35278 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35279 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35280 register value is encoded.
35281
35282 Reply:
35283 @table @samp
35284 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35285 the register's value
35286 @item E @var{NN}
35287 for an error
35288 @item @w{}
35289 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35290 @end table
35291
35292 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35293 @anchor{write register packet}
35294 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35295 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35296 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35297 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35298
35299 Reply:
35300 @table @samp
35301 @item OK
35302 for success
35303 @item E @var{NN}
35304 for an error
35305 @end table
35306
35307 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35308 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35309 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35310 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35311 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35312 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35313
35314 @item r
35315 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35316 Reset the entire system.
35317
35318 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35319
35320 @item R @var{XX}
35321 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35322 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35323 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35324
35325 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35326
35327 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35328 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35329 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35330 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35331
35332 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35333 packet}.
35334
35335 Reply:
35336 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35337
35338 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35339 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35340 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35341 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35342 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35343
35344 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35345 packet}.
35346
35347 Reply:
35348 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35349
35350 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35351 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35352 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35353 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35354 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35355
35356 @item T @var{thread-id}
35357 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35358 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35359
35360 Reply:
35361 @table @samp
35362 @item OK
35363 thread is still alive
35364 @item E @var{NN}
35365 thread is dead
35366 @end table
35367
35368 @item v
35369 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35370 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35371
35372 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35373 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35374 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35375 The process ID is a
35376 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35377 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35378 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35379
35380 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35381 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35382 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35383 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35384 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35385 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35386 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35387 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35388
35389 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35390
35391 Reply:
35392 @table @samp
35393 @item E @var{nn}
35394 for an error
35395 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35396 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35397 @item OK
35398 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35399 @end table
35400
35401 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35402 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35403 @anchor{vCont packet}
35404 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35405 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35406 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35407 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35408 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35409 Specifying multiple
35410 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35411 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35412
35413 Currently supported actions are:
35414
35415 @table @samp
35416 @item c
35417 Continue.
35418 @item C @var{sig}
35419 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35420 @item s
35421 Step.
35422 @item S @var{sig}
35423 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35424 @item t
35425 Stop.
35426 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35427 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35428 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35429 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35430 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35431 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35432
35433 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35434 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35435 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35436 jumps to @var{start}).
35437
35438 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35439 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35440 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35441
35442 @end table
35443
35444 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35445 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35446 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35447
35448 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35449 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35450 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35451 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35452 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35453 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35454 as an implementation detail.
35455
35456 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35457 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35458 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35459 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35460 @var{thread-id}.
35461
35462 Reply:
35463 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35464
35465 @item vCont?
35466 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35467 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35468
35469 Reply:
35470 @table @samp
35471 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35472 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35473 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35474 @item @w{}
35475 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35476 @end table
35477
35478 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35479 @item vCtrlC
35480 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35481 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35482 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35483 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35484 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35485 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35486 variant.
35487
35488 Reply:
35489 @table @samp
35490 @item E @var{nn}
35491 for an error
35492 @item OK
35493 for success
35494 @end table
35495
35496 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35497 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35498 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35499 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35500
35501 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35502 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35503 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35504 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35505 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35506 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35507 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35508 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35509 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35510 packet is received.
35511
35512 Reply:
35513 @table @samp
35514 @item OK
35515 for success
35516 @item E @var{NN}
35517 for an error
35518 @end table
35519
35520 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35521 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35522 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35523 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35524 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35525 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35526 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35527 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35528 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35529 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35530 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35531 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35532
35533
35534 Reply:
35535 @table @samp
35536 @item OK
35537 for success
35538 @item E.memtype
35539 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35540 @item E @var{NN}
35541 for an error
35542 @end table
35543
35544 @item vFlashDone
35545 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35546 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35547 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35548 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35549 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35550 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35551 request is completed.
35552
35553 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35554 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35555 @anchor{vKill packet}
35556 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35557 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35558 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35559 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35560
35561 Reply:
35562 @table @samp
35563 @item E @var{nn}
35564 for an error
35565 @item OK
35566 for success
35567 @end table
35568
35569 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35570 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35571 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35572 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35573 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35574 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35575 state.
35576
35577 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35578
35579 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35580
35581 Reply:
35582 @table @samp
35583 @item E @var{nn}
35584 for an error
35585 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35586 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35587 @end table
35588
35589 @item vStopped
35590 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35591 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35592
35593 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35594 @anchor{X packet}
35595 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35596 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35597 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35598 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35599 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35600
35601 Reply:
35602 @table @samp
35603 @item OK
35604 for success
35605 @item E @var{NN}
35606 for an error
35607 @end table
35608
35609 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35610 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35611 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35612 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35613 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35614 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35615 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35616
35617 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35618 separately.
35619
35620 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35621 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35622 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35623 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35624 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35625 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35626
35627 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35628 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35629 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35630 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35631 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35632 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35633
35634 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35635 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35636 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35637 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35638 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35639 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35640 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35641 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35642 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35643 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35644
35645 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35646 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35647
35648 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35649 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35650
35651 @table @samp
35652
35653 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35654 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35655 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35656
35657 @end table
35658
35659 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35660 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35661 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35662 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35663 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35664 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35665 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35666
35667 @table @samp
35668
35669 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35670 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35671 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35672
35673 @end table
35674
35675 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35676
35677 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35678 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35679 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35680 target, is not defined.}
35681
35682 Reply:
35683 @table @samp
35684 @item OK
35685 success
35686 @item @w{}
35687 not supported
35688 @item E @var{NN}
35689 for an error
35690 @end table
35691
35692 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35693 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35694 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35695 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35696 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35697 address @var{addr}.
35698
35699 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35700 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35701 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35702
35703 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35704 movement.}
35705
35706 Reply:
35707 @table @samp
35708 @item OK
35709 success
35710 @item @w{}
35711 not supported
35712 @item E @var{NN}
35713 for an error
35714 @end table
35715
35716 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35717 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35718 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35719 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35720 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35721 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35722
35723 Reply:
35724 @table @samp
35725 @item OK
35726 success
35727 @item @w{}
35728 not supported
35729 @item E @var{NN}
35730 for an error
35731 @end table
35732
35733 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35734 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35735 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35736 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35737 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35738 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35739
35740 Reply:
35741 @table @samp
35742 @item OK
35743 success
35744 @item @w{}
35745 not supported
35746 @item E @var{NN}
35747 for an error
35748 @end table
35749
35750 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35751 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35752 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35753 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35754 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35755 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35756
35757 Reply:
35758 @table @samp
35759 @item OK
35760 success
35761 @item @w{}
35762 not supported
35763 @item E @var{NN}
35764 for an error
35765 @end table
35766
35767 @end table
35768
35769 @node Stop Reply Packets
35770 @section Stop Reply Packets
35771 @cindex stop reply packets
35772
35773 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35774 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35775 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35776 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35777 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35778 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35779 @value{GDBN} source code.
35780
35781 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35782 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35783 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35784 components.
35785
35786 @table @samp
35787
35788 @item S @var{AA}
35789 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35790 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35791 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35792
35793 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35794 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35795 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35796 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35797 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35798 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35799 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35800 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35801
35802 @itemize @bullet
35803 @item
35804 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35805 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35806 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35807 two-digit hex number.
35808
35809 @item
35810 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35811 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35812
35813 @item
35814 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35815 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35816
35817 @item
35818 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35819 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35820 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35821 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35822
35823 @item
35824 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35825 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35826 future.
35827 @end itemize
35828
35829 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35830
35831 @table @samp
35832 @item watch
35833 @itemx rwatch
35834 @itemx awatch
35835 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35836 hex.
35837
35838 @item syscall_entry
35839 @itemx syscall_return
35840 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
35841 syscall number, in hex.
35842
35843 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35844 @item library
35845 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35846 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35847 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35848
35849 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35850 @item replaylog
35851 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35852 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35853 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35854 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35855 for more information.
35856
35857 @item swbreak
35858 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35859 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35860 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35861 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35862 part must be left empty.
35863
35864 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35865 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35866 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35867 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35868 address.
35869
35870 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35871 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35872 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35873 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35874 indicating support.
35875
35876 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35877
35878 @item hwbreak
35879 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35880 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35881
35882 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35883 apply.
35884
35885 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35886 @item fork
35887 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35888 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35889 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35890 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35891 fork events.
35892
35893 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35894 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35895 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35896 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35897 indicating support.
35898
35899 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35900 @item vfork
35901 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35902 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35903 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35904 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35905 vfork events.
35906
35907 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35908 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35909 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35910 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35911 indicating support.
35912
35913 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35914 @item vforkdone
35915 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35916 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35917 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35918 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35919 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35920
35921 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35922 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35923 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35924 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35925 indicating support.
35926
35927 @cindex exec events, remote reply
35928 @item exec
35929 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
35930 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
35931 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
35932
35933 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35934 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35935 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35936 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35937 indicating support.
35938
35939 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
35940 @anchor{thread create event}
35941 @item create
35942 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
35943 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
35944 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
35945 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
35946 also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.
35947
35948 @end table
35949
35950 @item W @var{AA}
35951 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35952 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35953 applicable to certain targets.
35954
35955 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35956 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35957 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35958 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35959
35960 @item X @var{AA}
35961 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35962 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35963
35964 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35965 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35966 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35967 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35968
35969 @anchor{thread exit event}
35970 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
35971 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
35972
35973 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
35974 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
35975 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
35976
35977 @item N
35978 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
35979 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
35980 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
35981 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
35982 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
35983 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
35984 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
35985 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
35986 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
35987 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
35988 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
35989 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
35990 support.
35991
35992 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35993 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35994 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35995 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35996 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35997
35998 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35999 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36000 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36001 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36002 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36003 system calls.
36004
36005 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36006 this very system call.
36007
36008 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36009 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36010 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36011 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36012 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36013 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36014
36015 @end table
36016
36017 @node General Query Packets
36018 @section General Query Packets
36019 @cindex remote query requests
36020
36021 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36022 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36023 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36024 sending information to and from the stub.
36025
36026 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36027 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36028 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36029 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36030 conventions:
36031
36032 @itemize @bullet
36033 @item
36034 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36035 @item
36036 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36037 letter.
36038 @item
36039 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36040 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36041 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36042 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36043 @end itemize
36044
36045 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36046 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36047 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36048 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36049 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36050 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36051 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36052 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36053 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36054 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36055 packet.}.
36056
36057 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36058 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36059 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36060 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36061 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36062
36063 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36064
36065 @table @samp
36066
36067 @item QAgent:1
36068 @itemx QAgent:0
36069 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36070 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36071
36072 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36073 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36074 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36075 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36076 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36077 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36078 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36079 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36080 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36081 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36082 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36083
36084 @item qC
36085 @cindex current thread, remote request
36086 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36087 Return the current thread ID.
36088
36089 Reply:
36090 @table @samp
36091 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36092 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36093 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36094 @item @r{(anything else)}
36095 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36096 @end table
36097
36098 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36099 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36100 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36101 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36102 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36103 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36104 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36105 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36106
36107 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36108 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36109 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36110 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36111 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36112 detect trailing zeros.
36113
36114 Reply:
36115 @table @samp
36116 @item E @var{NN}
36117 An error (such as memory fault)
36118 @item C @var{crc32}
36119 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36120 @end table
36121
36122 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36123 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36124 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36125 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36126 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36127 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36128 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36129 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36130 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36131 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36132 randomization.
36133
36134 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36135
36136 Reply:
36137 @table @samp
36138 @item OK
36139 The request succeeded.
36140
36141 @item E @var{nn}
36142 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36143
36144 @item @w{}
36145 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36146 by the stub.
36147 @end table
36148
36149 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36150 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36151 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36152 address space randomization.
36153
36154 @item qfThreadInfo
36155 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36156 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36157 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36158 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36159 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36160 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36161 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36162 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36163 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36164 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36165
36166 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36167
36168 Reply:
36169 @table @samp
36170 @item m @var{thread-id}
36171 A single thread ID
36172 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36173 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36174 @item l
36175 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36176 @end table
36177
36178 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36179 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36180 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36181 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36182 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36183 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36184 fields.
36185
36186 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36187 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36188 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36189 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36190 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36191
36192 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36193 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36194 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36195 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36196 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36197
36198 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36199 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36200
36201 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36202 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36203 information associated with the variable.)
36204
36205 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36206 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36207 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36208 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36209 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36210 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36211
36212 Reply:
36213 @table @samp
36214 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36215 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36216 local storage requested.
36217
36218 @item E @var{nn}
36219 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36220
36221 @item @w{}
36222 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36223 @end table
36224
36225 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36226 @cindex get thread information block address
36227 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36228 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36229
36230 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36231
36232 Reply:
36233 @table @samp
36234 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36235 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36236 thread information block.
36237
36238 @item E @var{nn}
36239 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36240 address could not be retrieved.
36241
36242 @item @w{}
36243 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36244 @end table
36245
36246 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36247 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36248 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36249 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36250 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36251 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36252 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36253
36254 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36255
36256 Reply:
36257 @table @samp
36258 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36259 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36260 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36261 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36262 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36263 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36264 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36265 @end table
36266
36267 @item qOffsets
36268 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36269 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36270 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36271 image.
36272
36273 Reply:
36274 @table @samp
36275 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36276 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36277 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36278 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36279 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36280 segments by the supplied offsets.
36281
36282 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36283 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36284 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36285
36286 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36287 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36288 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36289 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36290 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36291 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36292 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36293 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36294 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36295 @end table
36296
36297 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36298 @cindex thread information, remote request
36299 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36300 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36301 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36302 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36303
36304 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36305 (see below).
36306
36307 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36308
36309 @item QNonStop:1
36310 @itemx QNonStop:0
36311 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36312 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36313 @anchor{QNonStop}
36314 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36315 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36316
36317 Reply:
36318 @table @samp
36319 @item OK
36320 The request succeeded.
36321
36322 @item E @var{nn}
36323 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36324
36325 @item @w{}
36326 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36327 the stub.
36328 @end table
36329
36330 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36331 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36332 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36333 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36334
36335 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36336 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36337 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36338 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36339 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36340 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36341 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36342
36343 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36344 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36345 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36346
36347 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36348 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36349 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36350 report the requested syscalls.
36351
36352 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36353 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36354
36355 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36356 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36357 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36358 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36359
36360 Reply:
36361 @table @samp
36362 @item OK
36363 The request succeeded.
36364
36365 @item E @var{nn}
36366 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36367
36368 @item @w{}
36369 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36370 the stub.
36371 @end table
36372
36373 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36374 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36375 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36376 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36377
36378 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36379 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36380 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36381 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36382 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36383 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36384 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36385 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36386 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36387 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36388 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36389 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36390 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36391
36392 Reply:
36393 @table @samp
36394 @item OK
36395 The request succeeded.
36396
36397 @item E @var{nn}
36398 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36399
36400 @item @w{}
36401 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36402 the stub.
36403 @end table
36404
36405 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36406 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36407 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36408 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36409
36410 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36411 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36412 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36413 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36414 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36415 Others should be silently discarded.
36416
36417 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36418 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36419 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36420 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36421 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36422 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36423 signals.
36424
36425 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36426 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36427
36428 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36429 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36430 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36431 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36432 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36433
36434 Reply:
36435 @table @samp
36436 @item OK
36437 The request succeeded.
36438
36439 @item E @var{nn}
36440 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36441
36442 @item @w{}
36443 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36444 by the stub.
36445 @end table
36446
36447 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36448 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36449 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36450 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36451
36452 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36453 @item QThreadEvents:1
36454 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36455 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36456 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36457
36458 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36459 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36460 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36461 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36462 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36463 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36464 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36465 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36466 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36467 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36468
36469 Reply:
36470 @table @samp
36471 @item OK
36472 The request succeeded.
36473
36474 @item E @var{nn}
36475 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36476
36477 @item @w{}
36478 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36479 the stub.
36480 @end table
36481
36482 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36483 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36484
36485 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36486 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36487 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36488 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36489 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36490 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36491 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36492 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36493 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36494
36495 Reply:
36496 @table @samp
36497 @item OK
36498 A command response with no output.
36499 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36500 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36501 @item E @var{NN}
36502 Indicate a badly formed request.
36503 @item @w{}
36504 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36505 @end table
36506
36507 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36508 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36509 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36510 packets.)
36511
36512 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36513 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36514 @ifnotinfo
36515 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36516 @end ifnotinfo
36517 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36518 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36519 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36520 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36521 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36522
36523 Reply:
36524 @table @samp
36525 @item 0
36526 The pattern was not found.
36527 @item 1,address
36528 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36529 @item E @var{NN}
36530 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36531 @item @w{}
36532 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36533 @end table
36534
36535 @item QStartNoAckMode
36536 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36537 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36538 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36539 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36540
36541 Reply:
36542 @table @samp
36543 @item OK
36544 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36545 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36546 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36547 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36548 @item @w{}
36549 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36550 @end table
36551
36552 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36553 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36554 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36555 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36556 @anchor{qSupported}
36557 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36558 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36559 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36560 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36561 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36562 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36563 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36564 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36565 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36566 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36567 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36568 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36569 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36570 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36571
36572 Reply:
36573 @table @samp
36574 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36575 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36576 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36577 possible forms).
36578 @item @w{}
36579 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36580 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36581 @end table
36582
36583 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36584 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36585 are:
36586
36587 @table @samp
36588 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36589 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36590 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36591 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36592 @item @var{name}+
36593 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36594 need an associated value.
36595 @item @var{name}-
36596 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36597 @item @var{name}?
36598 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36599 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36600 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36601 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36602 @end table
36603
36604 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36605 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36606 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36607 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36608 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36609
36610 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36611 are defined:
36612
36613 @table @samp
36614 @item multiprocess
36615 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36616 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36617 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36618 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36619 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36620
36621 @item xmlRegisters
36622 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36623 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36624 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36625 description.
36626
36627 @item qRelocInsn
36628 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36629 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36630 instruction reply packet}).
36631
36632 @item swbreak
36633 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36634 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36635
36636 @item hwbreak
36637 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36638 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36639
36640 @item fork-events
36641 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36642 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36643 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36644 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36645
36646 @item vfork-events
36647 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36648 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36649 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36650 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36651
36652 @item exec-events
36653 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36654 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36655 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36656 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36657
36658 @item vContSupported
36659 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36660 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36661 @end table
36662
36663 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36664 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36665 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36666 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36667 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36668 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36669 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36670 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36671 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36672 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36673 all the features it supports.
36674
36675 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36676 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36677
36678 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36679 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36680 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36681 form response.
36682
36683 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36684 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36685 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36686 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36687
36688 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36689 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36690 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36691 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36692 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36693
36694 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36695
36696 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36697 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36698 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36699 @item Feature Name
36700 @tab Value Required
36701 @tab Default
36702 @tab Probe Allowed
36703
36704 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36705 @tab Yes
36706 @tab @samp{-}
36707 @tab No
36708
36709 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36710 @tab No
36711 @tab @samp{-}
36712 @tab Yes
36713
36714 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36715 @tab No
36716 @tab @samp{-}
36717 @tab Yes
36718
36719 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36720 @tab No
36721 @tab @samp{-}
36722 @tab Yes
36723
36724 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36725 @tab No
36726 @tab @samp{-}
36727 @tab Yes
36728
36729 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36730 @tab No
36731 @tab @samp{-}
36732 @tab Yes
36733
36734 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36735 @tab No
36736 @tab @samp{-}
36737 @tab Yes
36738
36739 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36740 @tab No
36741 @tab @samp{-}
36742 @tab Yes
36743
36744 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36745 @tab No
36746 @tab @samp{-}
36747 @tab No
36748
36749 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36750 @tab No
36751 @tab @samp{-}
36752 @tab Yes
36753
36754 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36755 @tab No
36756 @tab @samp{-}
36757 @tab Yes
36758
36759 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36760 @tab No
36761 @tab @samp{-}
36762 @tab Yes
36763
36764 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36765 @tab No
36766 @tab @samp{-}
36767 @tab Yes
36768
36769 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36770 @tab No
36771 @tab @samp{-}
36772 @tab Yes
36773
36774 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36775 @tab No
36776 @tab @samp{-}
36777 @tab Yes
36778
36779 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36780 @tab No
36781 @tab @samp{-}
36782 @tab Yes
36783
36784 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36785 @tab No
36786 @tab @samp{-}
36787 @tab Yes
36788
36789 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36790 @tab No
36791 @tab @samp{-}
36792 @tab Yes
36793
36794 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36795 @tab No
36796 @tab @samp{-}
36797 @tab Yes
36798
36799 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36800 @tab Yes
36801 @tab @samp{-}
36802 @tab Yes
36803
36804 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36805 @tab Yes
36806 @tab @samp{-}
36807 @tab Yes
36808
36809 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36810 @tab Yes
36811 @tab @samp{-}
36812 @tab Yes
36813
36814 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36815 @tab Yes
36816 @tab @samp{-}
36817 @tab Yes
36818
36819 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36820 @tab Yes
36821 @tab @samp{-}
36822 @tab Yes
36823
36824 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36825 @tab No
36826 @tab @samp{-}
36827 @tab Yes
36828
36829 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
36830 @tab No
36831 @tab @samp{-}
36832 @tab Yes
36833
36834 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36835 @tab No
36836 @tab @samp{-}
36837 @tab Yes
36838
36839 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36840 @tab No
36841 @tab @samp{-}
36842 @tab Yes
36843
36844 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36845 @tab No
36846 @tab @samp{-}
36847 @tab No
36848
36849 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36850 @tab No
36851 @tab @samp{-}
36852 @tab No
36853
36854 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36855 @tab No
36856 @tab @samp{-}
36857 @tab No
36858
36859 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36860 @tab No
36861 @tab @samp{-}
36862 @tab No
36863
36864 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36865 @tab No
36866 @tab @samp{-}
36867 @tab No
36868
36869 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36870 @tab No
36871 @tab @samp{-}
36872 @tab No
36873
36874 @item @samp{QAgent}
36875 @tab No
36876 @tab @samp{-}
36877 @tab No
36878
36879 @item @samp{QAllow}
36880 @tab No
36881 @tab @samp{-}
36882 @tab No
36883
36884 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36885 @tab No
36886 @tab @samp{-}
36887 @tab No
36888
36889 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36890 @tab No
36891 @tab @samp{-}
36892 @tab No
36893
36894 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36895 @tab No
36896 @tab @samp{-}
36897 @tab No
36898
36899 @item @samp{tracenz}
36900 @tab No
36901 @tab @samp{-}
36902 @tab No
36903
36904 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36905 @tab No
36906 @tab @samp{-}
36907 @tab No
36908
36909 @item @samp{swbreak}
36910 @tab No
36911 @tab @samp{-}
36912 @tab No
36913
36914 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36915 @tab No
36916 @tab @samp{-}
36917 @tab No
36918
36919 @item @samp{fork-events}
36920 @tab No
36921 @tab @samp{-}
36922 @tab No
36923
36924 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36925 @tab No
36926 @tab @samp{-}
36927 @tab No
36928
36929 @item @samp{exec-events}
36930 @tab No
36931 @tab @samp{-}
36932 @tab No
36933
36934 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
36935 @tab No
36936 @tab @samp{-}
36937 @tab No
36938
36939 @item @samp{no-resumed}
36940 @tab No
36941 @tab @samp{-}
36942 @tab No
36943
36944 @end multitable
36945
36946 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36947
36948 @table @samp
36949 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36950 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36951 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36952 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36953 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36954 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36955 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36956 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36957 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36958 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36959
36960 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36961 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36962 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36963
36964 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36965 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36966 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36967
36968 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36969 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36970 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36971
36972 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36973 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36974 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36975
36976 @item qXfer:features:read
36977 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36978 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36979
36980 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36981 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36982 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36983
36984 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36985 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36986 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36987
36988 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36989 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36990 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36991 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36992
36993 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36994 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36995 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36996
36997 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36998 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36999 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37000
37001 @item qXfer:spu:read
37002 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37003 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37004
37005 @item qXfer:spu:write
37006 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37007 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37008
37009 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37010 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37011 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37012
37013 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37014 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37015 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37016
37017 @item qXfer:threads:read
37018 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37019 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37020
37021 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37022 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37023 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37024
37025 @item qXfer:uib:read
37026 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37027 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37028
37029 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37030 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37031 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37032
37033 @item QNonStop
37034 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37035 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37036
37037 @item QCatchSyscalls
37038 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37039 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37040
37041 @item QPassSignals
37042 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37043 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37044
37045 @item QStartNoAckMode
37046 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37047 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37048
37049 @item multiprocess
37050 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37051 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37052 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37053 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37054 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37055 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37056 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37057 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37058 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37059 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37060 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37061
37062 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37063 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37064 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37065
37066 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37067 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37068 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37069 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37070
37071 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37072 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37073 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37074
37075 @item ReverseContinue
37076 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37077 (@pxref{bc}).
37078
37079 @item ReverseStep
37080 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37081 (@pxref{bs}).
37082
37083 @item TracepointSource
37084 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37085 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37086
37087 @item QAgent
37088 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37089
37090 @item QAllow
37091 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37092
37093 @item QDisableRandomization
37094 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37095
37096 @item StaticTracepoint
37097 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37098 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37099
37100 @item InstallInTrace
37101 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37102 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37103
37104 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37105 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37106 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37107 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37108
37109 @item QTBuffer:size
37110 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37111 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37112
37113 @item tracenz
37114 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37115 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37116 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37117
37118 @item BreakpointCommands
37119 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37120 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37121 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37122
37123 @item Qbtrace:off
37124 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37125
37126 @item Qbtrace:bts
37127 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37128
37129 @item Qbtrace:pt
37130 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37131
37132 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37133 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37134
37135 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37136 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37137
37138 @item swbreak
37139 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37140 breakpoints.
37141
37142 @item hwbreak
37143 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37144 breakpoints.
37145
37146 @item fork-events
37147 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37148
37149 @item vfork-events
37150 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37151 and vforkdone events.
37152
37153 @item exec-events
37154 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37155
37156 @item vContSupported
37157 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37158 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37159
37160 @item QThreadEvents
37161 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37162
37163 @item no-resumed
37164 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37165
37166 @end table
37167
37168 @item qSymbol::
37169 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37170 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37171 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37172 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37173
37174 Reply:
37175 @table @samp
37176 @item OK
37177 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37178 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37179 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37180 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37181 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37182 below.
37183 @end table
37184
37185 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37186 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37187
37188 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37189 target has previously requested.
37190
37191 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37192 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37193 will be empty.
37194
37195 Reply:
37196 @table @samp
37197 @item OK
37198 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37199 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37200 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37201 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37202 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37203 @end table
37204
37205 @item qTBuffer
37206 @itemx QTBuffer
37207 @itemx QTDisconnected
37208 @itemx QTDP
37209 @itemx QTDPsrc
37210 @itemx QTDV
37211 @itemx qTfP
37212 @itemx qTfV
37213 @itemx QTFrame
37214 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37215
37216 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37217
37218 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37219 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37220 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37221 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37222 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37223 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37224 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37225 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37226 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37227 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37228 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37229
37230 Reply:
37231 @table @samp
37232 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37233 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37234 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37235 the thread's attributes.
37236 @end table
37237
37238 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37239 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37240 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37241 packets.)
37242
37243 @item QTNotes
37244 @itemx qTP
37245 @itemx QTSave
37246 @itemx qTsP
37247 @itemx qTsV
37248 @itemx QTStart
37249 @itemx QTStop
37250 @itemx QTEnable
37251 @itemx QTDisable
37252 @itemx QTinit
37253 @itemx QTro
37254 @itemx qTStatus
37255 @itemx qTV
37256 @itemx qTfSTM
37257 @itemx qTsSTM
37258 @itemx qTSTMat
37259 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37260
37261 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37262 @cindex read special object, remote request
37263 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37264 @anchor{qXfer read}
37265 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37266 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37267 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37268 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37269 additional details about what data to access.
37270
37271 Reply:
37272 @table @samp
37273 @item m @var{data}
37274 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37275 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37276 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37277 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37278 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37279 request.
37280
37281 @item l @var{data}
37282 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37283 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37284 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37285
37286 @item l
37287 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37288 There is no more data to be read.
37289
37290 @item E00
37291 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37292
37293 @item E @var{nn}
37294 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37295 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37296
37297 @item @w{}
37298 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37299 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37300 @end table
37301
37302 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37303 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37304 formats, listed above.
37305
37306 @table @samp
37307 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37308 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37309 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37310 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37311
37312 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37313 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37314
37315 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37316 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37317
37318 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37319 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37320 packet may have one of the following values:
37321
37322 @table @code
37323 @item all
37324 Returns all available branch trace.
37325
37326 @item new
37327 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37328 the last read request.
37329
37330 @item delta
37331 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37332 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37333 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37334 used to stitch traces together.
37335
37336 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37337 @end table
37338
37339 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37340 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37341
37342 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37343 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37344
37345 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37346 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37347
37348 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37349 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37350
37351 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37352 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37353 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37354 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37355 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37356 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37357 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37358
37359 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37360 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37361
37362 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37363 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37364 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37365 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37366 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37367
37368 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37369 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37370
37371 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37372 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37373 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37374 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37375 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37376
37377 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37378 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37379 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37380
37381 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37382 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37383
37384 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37385 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37386 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37387 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37388 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37389 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37390 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37391 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37392
37393 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37394 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37395
37396 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37397 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37398
37399 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37400 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37401 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37402 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37403
37404 @table @code
37405 @item start=@var{address}
37406 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37407 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37408 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37409 chosen as the starting point.
37410
37411 @item prev=@var{address}
37412 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37413 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37414 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37415 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37416 exists prior to the starting point.
37417
37418 @end table
37419
37420 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37421 ignored.
37422
37423 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37424 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37425 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37426 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37427 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37428
37429 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37430 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37431
37432 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37433 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37434
37435 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37436 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37437 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37438 Action Lists}.
37439
37440 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37441 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37442 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37443
37444 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37445 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37446 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37447 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37448 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37449
37450 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37451 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37452 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37453
37454 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37455 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37456 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37457 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37458 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37459 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37460 in that context to be accessed.
37461
37462 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37463 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37464 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37465
37466 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37467 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37468 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37469 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37470 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37471
37472 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37473 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37474
37475 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37476 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37477
37478 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37479 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37480 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37481
37482 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37483 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37484
37485 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37486 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37487
37488 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37489 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37490
37491 This packet is not probed by default.
37492
37493 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37494 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37495 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37496 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37497 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37498
37499 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37500 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37501
37502 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37503 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37504 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37505 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37506
37507 @end table
37508
37509 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37510 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37511 @anchor{qXfer write}
37512 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37513 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37514 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37515 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37516 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37517 to access.
37518
37519 Reply:
37520 @table @samp
37521 @item @var{nn}
37522 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37523 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37524
37525 @item E00
37526 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37527
37528 @item E @var{nn}
37529 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37530 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37531
37532 @item @w{}
37533 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37534 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37535 @end table
37536
37537 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37538 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37539 formats, listed above.
37540
37541 @table @samp
37542 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37543 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37544 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37545 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37546 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37547
37548 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37549 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37550 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37551
37552 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37553 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37554 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37555 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37556 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37557 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37558 in that context to be accessed.
37559
37560 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37561 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37562 @end table
37563
37564 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37565 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37566 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37567 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37568 must respond with an empty packet.
37569
37570 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37571 @cindex query attached, remote request
37572 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37573 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37574 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37575 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37576 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37577 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37578 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37579
37580 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37581 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37582 the @code{quit} command.
37583
37584 Reply:
37585 @table @samp
37586 @item 1
37587 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37588 @item 0
37589 The remote server created a new process.
37590 @item E @var{NN}
37591 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37592 @end table
37593
37594 @item Qbtrace:bts
37595 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37596
37597 Reply:
37598 @table @samp
37599 @item OK
37600 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37601 @item E.errtext
37602 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37603 @end table
37604
37605 @item Qbtrace:pt
37606 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37607
37608 Reply:
37609 @table @samp
37610 @item OK
37611 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37612 @item E.errtext
37613 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37614 @end table
37615
37616 @item Qbtrace:off
37617 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37618
37619 Reply:
37620 @table @samp
37621 @item OK
37622 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37623 @item E.errtext
37624 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37625 @end table
37626
37627 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37628 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37629 btrace recording method in bts format.
37630
37631 Reply:
37632 @table @samp
37633 @item OK
37634 The ring buffer size has been set.
37635 @item E.errtext
37636 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37637 @end table
37638
37639 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37640 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37641 btrace recording method in pt format.
37642
37643 Reply:
37644 @table @samp
37645 @item OK
37646 The ring buffer size has been set.
37647 @item E.errtext
37648 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37649 @end table
37650
37651 @end table
37652
37653 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37654 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37655
37656 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37657 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37658 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37659
37660 @menu
37661 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37662 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37663 @end menu
37664
37665 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37666 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37667
37668 @menu
37669 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37670 @end menu
37671
37672 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37673 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37674 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37675
37676 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37677
37678 @table @r
37679
37680 @item 2
37681 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37682
37683 @item 3
37684 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37685
37686 @item 4
37687 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37688
37689 @end table
37690
37691 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37692 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37693
37694 @menu
37695 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37696 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37697 @end menu
37698
37699 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37700 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37701 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37702
37703 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37704 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37705 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37706 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37707 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37708 most-significant -- least-significant.
37709
37710 @table @r
37711
37712 @item MIPS32
37713 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37714 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37715 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37716
37717 @item MIPS64
37718 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37719 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37720 as @code{MIPS32}.
37721
37722 @end table
37723
37724 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37725 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37726 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37727
37728 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37729
37730 @table @r
37731
37732 @item 2
37733 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37734
37735 @item 3
37736 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37737
37738 @item 4
37739 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37740
37741 @item 5
37742 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37743
37744 @end table
37745
37746 @node Tracepoint Packets
37747 @section Tracepoint Packets
37748 @cindex tracepoint packets
37749 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37750
37751 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37752 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37753
37754 @table @samp
37755
37756 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37757 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37758 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37759 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37760 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37761 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37762 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37763 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37764 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37765 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37766 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37767 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37768 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37769 actions.
37770
37771 Replies:
37772 @table @samp
37773 @item OK
37774 The packet was understood and carried out.
37775 @item qRelocInsn
37776 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37777 @item @w{}
37778 The packet was not recognized.
37779 @end table
37780
37781 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37782 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37783 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37784 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37785 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37786 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37787 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37788
37789 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37790 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37791 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37792 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37793 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37794 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37795 tracepoint actions.
37796
37797 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37798 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37799 following forms:
37800
37801 @table @samp
37802
37803 @item R @var{mask}
37804 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37805 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37806 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37807 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37808 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37809
37810 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37811 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37812 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37813 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37814 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37815 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37816 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37817
37818 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37819 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37820 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37821 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37822 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37823 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37824 packet).
37825
37826 @end table
37827
37828 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37829 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37830 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37831 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37832 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37833 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37834 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37835 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37836
37837 Replies:
37838 @table @samp
37839 @item OK
37840 The packet was understood and carried out.
37841 @item qRelocInsn
37842 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37843 @item @w{}
37844 The packet was not recognized.
37845 @end table
37846
37847 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37848 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37849 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37850 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37851 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37852 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37853 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37854 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37855
37856 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37857 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37858 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37859 fit in a single packet.
37860 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37861 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37862
37863 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37864 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37865 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37866 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37867
37868 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37869 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37870 query packets.
37871
37872 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37873 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37874 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37875 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37876 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37877 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37878 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37879 be found.
37880
37881 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37882 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37883 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37884 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37885 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37886 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37887 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37888 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37889 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37890 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37891 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37892 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37893 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37894 variable.
37895
37896 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37897 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37898 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37899 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37900 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37901
37902 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37903 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37904 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37905 one of the following forms:
37906
37907 @table @samp
37908 @item F @var{f}
37909 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37910 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37911 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37912
37913 @item T @var{t}
37914 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37915 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37916
37917 @end table
37918
37919 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37920 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37921 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37922 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37923
37924 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37925 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37926 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37927 is a hexadecimal number.
37928
37929 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37930 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37931 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37932 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37933 numbers.
37934
37935 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37936 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37937 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37938
37939 @item qTMinFTPILen
37940 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37941 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37942 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37943 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37944 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37945 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37946 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37947 arrange for that.
37948
37949 Replies:
37950
37951 @table @samp
37952 @item 0
37953 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37954 @item @var{length}
37955 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37956 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37957 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37958 regardless of size.
37959 @item E
37960 An error has occurred.
37961 @item @w{}
37962 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37963 @end table
37964
37965 @item QTStart
37966 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37967 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37968 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37969 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37970 instruction reply packet}).
37971
37972 @item QTStop
37973 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37974 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37975
37976 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37977 @anchor{QTEnable}
37978 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37979 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37980 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37981 of data from it will resume.
37982
37983 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37984 @anchor{QTDisable}
37985 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37986 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37987 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37988 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37989
37990 @item QTinit
37991 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37992 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37993
37994 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37995 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37996 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37997 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37998 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37999
38000 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38001 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38002 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38003 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38004
38005 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38006 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38007 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38008 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38009 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38010 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38011
38012 @item qTStatus
38013 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38014 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38015
38016 The reply has the form:
38017
38018 @table @samp
38019
38020 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38021 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38022 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38023 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38024
38025 @end table
38026
38027 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38028 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38029
38030 @table @samp
38031
38032 @item tnotrun:0
38033 No trace has been run yet.
38034
38035 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38036 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38037 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38038 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38039 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38040
38041 @item tfull:0
38042 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38043
38044 @item tdisconnected:0
38045 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38046
38047 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38048 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38049
38050 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38051 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38052 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38053 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38054 is hex encoded.
38055
38056 @item tunknown:0
38057 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38058
38059 @end table
38060
38061 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38062 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38063 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38064 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38065 trace.
38066
38067 @table @samp
38068
38069 @item tframes:@var{n}
38070 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38071
38072 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38073 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38074 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38075
38076 @item tsize:@var{n}
38077 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38078
38079 @item tfree:@var{n}
38080 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38081
38082 @item circular:@var{n}
38083 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38084 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38085 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38086 and may fill up.
38087
38088 @item disconn:@var{n}
38089 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38090 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38091 that the trace run will stop.
38092
38093 @end table
38094
38095 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38096 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38097 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38098 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38099 address @var{addr}.
38100
38101 Replies:
38102 @table @samp
38103 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38104 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38105 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38106 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38107 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38108
38109 @end table
38110
38111 @item qTV:@var{var}
38112 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38113 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38114 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38115
38116 Replies:
38117 @table @samp
38118 @item V@var{value}
38119 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38120 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38121 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38122 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38123 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38124 program is running.
38125
38126 @item U
38127 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38128 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38129 was not collected.
38130 @end table
38131
38132 @item qTfP
38133 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38134 @itemx qTsP
38135 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38136 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38137 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38138 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38139 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38140 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38141
38142 @item qTfV
38143 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38144 @itemx qTsV
38145 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38146 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38147 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38148 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38149 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38150 trace state variables.
38151
38152 @item qTfSTM
38153 @itemx qTsSTM
38154 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38155 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38156 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38157 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38158 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38159 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38160 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38161 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38162
38163 Reply:
38164 @table @samp
38165 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38166 A single marker
38167 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38168 a comma-separated list of markers
38169 @item l
38170 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38171 @item E @var{nn}
38172 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38173 @item @w{}
38174 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38175 stub.
38176 @end table
38177
38178 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38179 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38180
38181 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38182 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38183 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38184 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38185 @dfn{last}).
38186
38187 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38188 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38189 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38190 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38191 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38192 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38193 tracepoint markers.
38194
38195 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38196 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38197 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38198 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38199 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38200 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38201
38202 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38203 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38204 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38205 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38206 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38207 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38208 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38209 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38210 available.
38211
38212 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38213 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38214 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38215
38216 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38217 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38218 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38219 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38220 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38221 use whatever size it prefers.
38222
38223 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38224 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38225 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38226 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38227 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38228
38229 @end table
38230
38231 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38232 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38233 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38234 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38235 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38236 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38237 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38238 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38239 it had executed in the original location.
38240
38241 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38242 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38243 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38244 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38245 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38246 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38247 format of the request is:
38248
38249 @table @samp
38250 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38251
38252 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38253 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38254 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38255 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38256 memory starting at @var{to}.
38257 @end table
38258
38259 Replies:
38260 @table @samp
38261 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38262 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38263 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38264 @item E @var{NN}
38265 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38266 relocating the instruction.
38267 @end table
38268
38269 @node Host I/O Packets
38270 @section Host I/O Packets
38271 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38272 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38273
38274 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38275 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38276 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38277 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38278 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38279 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38280 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38281 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38282 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38283 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38284
38285 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38286 its arguments. They have this format:
38287
38288 @table @samp
38289
38290 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38291 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38292 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38293 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38294 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38295 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38296 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38297 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38298 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38299
38300 @end table
38301
38302 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38303
38304 @table @samp
38305
38306 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38307 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38308 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38309 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38310 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38311 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38312 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38313 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38314 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38315 @var{attachment}.
38316
38317 @item @w{}
38318 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38319
38320 @end table
38321
38322 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38323
38324 @table @samp
38325 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38326 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38327 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38328 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38329 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38330 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38331 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38332
38333 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38334 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38335 -1 if an error occurs.
38336
38337 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38338 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38339 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38340 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38341 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38342 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38343 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38344 @var{count} was zero.
38345
38346 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38347 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38348 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38349 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38350 some characters were escaped.
38351
38352 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38353 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38354 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38355 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38356 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38357 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38358 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38359 error occurred.
38360
38361 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38362 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38363 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38364 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38365 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38366 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38367
38368 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38369 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38370 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38371
38372 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38373 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38374 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38375
38376 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38377 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38378 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38379 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38380 some characters were escaped.
38381
38382 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38383 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38384 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38385 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38386 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38387 inferior(s).
38388
38389 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38390 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38391 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38392 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38393 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38394 operation.
38395
38396 @end table
38397
38398 @node Interrupts
38399 @section Interrupts
38400 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38401 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38402
38403 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38404 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38405 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38406 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38407
38408 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38409 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38410 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38411 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38412 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38413
38414 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38415 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38416 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38417 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38418 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38419 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38420 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38421 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38422
38423 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38424 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38425 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38426
38427 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38428 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38429 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38430 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38431 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38432 @code{0x03}.
38433
38434 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38435 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38436 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38437 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38438 currently-executing threads and processes.
38439 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38440 running program, it should send one of the stop
38441 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38442 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38443 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38444 Interrupts received while the
38445 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38446 it is resumed next time.
38447
38448 @node Notification Packets
38449 @section Notification Packets
38450 @cindex notification packets
38451 @cindex packets, notification
38452
38453 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38454 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38455 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38456 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38457 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38458 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38459 is not a problem.
38460
38461 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38462 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38463 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38464 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38465 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38466 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38467 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38468
38469 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38470 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38471
38472 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38473 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38474 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38475 not they understand it.
38476
38477 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38478 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38479 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38480 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38481 recipients.
38482
38483 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38484 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38485 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38486 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38487 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38488
38489 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38490 @table @samp
38491 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38492 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38493 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38494 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38495 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38496 @item @var{ack}
38497 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38498 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38499 @end table
38500
38501 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38502 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38503
38504 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38505 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38506 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38507 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38508 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38509 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38510 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38511 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38512 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38513 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38514
38515 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38516 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38517 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38518 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38519 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38520 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38521
38522 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38523 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38524 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38525 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38526 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38527
38528 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38529 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38530 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38531 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38532 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38533 normally.
38534
38535 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38536 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38537 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38538 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38539 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38540 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38541 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38542 the process shall be repeated.
38543
38544 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38545 following example:
38546 @smallexample
38547 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38548 @code{...}
38549 -> @code{vStopped}
38550 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38551 -> @code{vStopped}
38552 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38553 -> @code{vStopped}
38554 <- @code{OK}
38555 @end smallexample
38556
38557 The following notifications are defined:
38558 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38559
38560 @item Notification
38561 @tab Ack
38562 @tab Event
38563 @tab Description
38564
38565 @item Stop
38566 @tab vStopped
38567 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38568 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38569 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38570 @value{GDBN}.
38571 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38572
38573 @end multitable
38574
38575 @node Remote Non-Stop
38576 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38577
38578 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38579 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38580 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38581 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38582
38583 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38584 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38585 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38586 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38587 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38588 probe the target state after a mode change.
38589
38590 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38591 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38592 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38593 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38594 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38595 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38596 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38597 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38598 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38599 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38600 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38601
38602 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38603 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38604 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38605 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38606 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38607 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38608 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38609 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38610 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38611 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38612 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38613 @samp{OK}.
38614
38615 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38616 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38617 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38618 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38619 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38620 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38621 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38622 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38623 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38624 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38625 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38626 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38627 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38628
38629 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38630 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38631
38632 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38633 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38634 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38635 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38636 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38637 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38638 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38639
38640 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38641 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38642 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38643 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38644 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38645
38646 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38647 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38648 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38649 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38650
38651 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38652 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38653 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38654 @pxref{qSupported}.
38655 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38656 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38657 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38658 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38659 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38660 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38661 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38662
38663 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38664 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38665 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38666 connection.
38667 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38668 new connection is established,
38669 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38670 for the current connection, once disabled.
38671
38672 @node Examples
38673 @section Examples
38674
38675 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38676 does not get any direct output:
38677
38678 @smallexample
38679 -> @code{R00}
38680 <- @code{+}
38681 @emph{target restarts}
38682 -> @code{?}
38683 <- @code{+}
38684 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38685 -> @code{+}
38686 @end smallexample
38687
38688 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38689
38690 @smallexample
38691 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38692 <- @code{+}
38693 -> @code{s}
38694 <- @code{+}
38695 @emph{time passes}
38696 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38697 -> @code{+}
38698 -> @code{g}
38699 <- @code{+}
38700 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38701 -> @code{+}
38702 @end smallexample
38703
38704 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38705 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38706 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38707
38708 @menu
38709 * File-I/O Overview::
38710 * Protocol Basics::
38711 * The F Request Packet::
38712 * The F Reply Packet::
38713 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38714 * Console I/O::
38715 * List of Supported Calls::
38716 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38717 * Constants::
38718 * File-I/O Examples::
38719 @end menu
38720
38721 @node File-I/O Overview
38722 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38723 @cindex file-i/o overview
38724
38725 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38726 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38727 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38728 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38729 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38730 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38731
38732 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38733 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38734 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38735 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38736 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38737
38738 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38739 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38740 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38741 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38742 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38743 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38744 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38745
38746 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38747 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38748 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38749 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38750 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38751
38752 @smallexample
38753 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38754 <- target requests 'system call X'
38755 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38756 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38757 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38758 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38759 @end smallexample
38760
38761 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38762 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38763 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38764 system are not supported by this protocol.
38765
38766 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38767
38768 @node Protocol Basics
38769 @subsection Protocol Basics
38770 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38771
38772 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38773 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38774 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38775 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38776 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38777 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38778 to call the appropriate host system call:
38779
38780 @itemize @bullet
38781 @item
38782 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38783
38784 @item
38785 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38786 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38787 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38788 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38789
38790 @end itemize
38791
38792 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38793
38794 @itemize @bullet
38795 @item
38796 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38797 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38798 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38799 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38800 packet.
38801
38802 @item
38803 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38804 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38805
38806 @item
38807 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38808
38809 @item
38810 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38811
38812 @item
38813 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38814 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38815 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38816 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38817 packet.
38818
38819 @end itemize
38820
38821 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38822 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38823
38824 @itemize @bullet
38825 @item
38826 Return value.
38827
38828 @item
38829 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38830
38831 @item
38832 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38833
38834 @end itemize
38835
38836 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38837 the latest continue or step action.
38838
38839 @node The F Request Packet
38840 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38841 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38842 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38843
38844 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38845
38846 @table @samp
38847 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38848
38849 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38850 This is just the name of the function.
38851
38852 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38853 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38854 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38855 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38856 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38857 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38858 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38859
38860 @end table
38861
38862
38863
38864 @node The F Reply Packet
38865 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38866 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38867 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38868
38869 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38870
38871 @table @samp
38872
38873 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38874
38875 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38876
38877 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38878 representation.
38879 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38880
38881 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38882 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38883 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38884
38885 @smallexample
38886 F0,0,C
38887 @end smallexample
38888
38889 @noindent
38890 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38891
38892 @smallexample
38893 F-1,4,C
38894 @end smallexample
38895
38896 @noindent
38897 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38898
38899 @end table
38900
38901
38902 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38903 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38904 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38905
38906 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38907 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38908 the target should behave as if it had
38909 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38910 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38911 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38912 packet.
38913
38914 It's important for the target to know in which
38915 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38916
38917 @itemize @bullet
38918 @item
38919 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38920
38921 @item
38922 The system call on the host has been finished.
38923
38924 @end itemize
38925
38926 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38927 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38928 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38929 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38930 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38931 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38932
38933 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38934 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38935 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38936 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38937 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38938 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38939 or the full action has been completed.
38940
38941 @node Console I/O
38942 @subsection Console I/O
38943 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38944
38945 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38946 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38947 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38948 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38949 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38950 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38951 conditions is met:
38952
38953 @itemize @bullet
38954 @item
38955 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38956 @code{read}
38957 system call is treated as finished.
38958
38959 @item
38960 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38961 newline.
38962
38963 @item
38964 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38965 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38966
38967 @end itemize
38968
38969 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38970 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38971 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38972 is stopped at the user's request.
38973
38974
38975 @node List of Supported Calls
38976 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38977 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38978
38979 @menu
38980 * open::
38981 * close::
38982 * read::
38983 * write::
38984 * lseek::
38985 * rename::
38986 * unlink::
38987 * stat/fstat::
38988 * gettimeofday::
38989 * isatty::
38990 * system::
38991 @end menu
38992
38993 @node open
38994 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38995 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38996
38997 @table @asis
38998 @item Synopsis:
38999 @smallexample
39000 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39001 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39002 @end smallexample
39003
39004 @item Request:
39005 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39006
39007 @noindent
39008 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39009
39010 @table @code
39011 @item O_CREAT
39012 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39013 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39014 are concerned.
39015
39016 @item O_EXCL
39017 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39018 an error and open() fails.
39019
39020 @item O_TRUNC
39021 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39022 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39023 truncated to zero length.
39024
39025 @item O_APPEND
39026 The file is opened in append mode.
39027
39028 @item O_RDONLY
39029 The file is opened for reading only.
39030
39031 @item O_WRONLY
39032 The file is opened for writing only.
39033
39034 @item O_RDWR
39035 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39036 @end table
39037
39038 @noindent
39039 Other bits are silently ignored.
39040
39041
39042 @noindent
39043 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39044
39045 @table @code
39046 @item S_IRUSR
39047 User has read permission.
39048
39049 @item S_IWUSR
39050 User has write permission.
39051
39052 @item S_IRGRP
39053 Group has read permission.
39054
39055 @item S_IWGRP
39056 Group has write permission.
39057
39058 @item S_IROTH
39059 Others have read permission.
39060
39061 @item S_IWOTH
39062 Others have write permission.
39063 @end table
39064
39065 @noindent
39066 Other bits are silently ignored.
39067
39068
39069 @item Return value:
39070 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39071 occurred.
39072
39073 @item Errors:
39074
39075 @table @code
39076 @item EEXIST
39077 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39078
39079 @item EISDIR
39080 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39081
39082 @item EACCES
39083 The requested access is not allowed.
39084
39085 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39086 @var{pathname} was too long.
39087
39088 @item ENOENT
39089 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39090
39091 @item ENODEV
39092 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39093
39094 @item EROFS
39095 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39096 write access was requested.
39097
39098 @item EFAULT
39099 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39100
39101 @item ENOSPC
39102 No space on device to create the file.
39103
39104 @item EMFILE
39105 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39106
39107 @item ENFILE
39108 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39109 has been reached.
39110
39111 @item EINTR
39112 The call was interrupted by the user.
39113 @end table
39114
39115 @end table
39116
39117 @node close
39118 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39119 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39120
39121 @table @asis
39122 @item Synopsis:
39123 @smallexample
39124 int close(int fd);
39125 @end smallexample
39126
39127 @item Request:
39128 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39129
39130 @item Return value:
39131 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39132
39133 @item Errors:
39134
39135 @table @code
39136 @item EBADF
39137 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39138
39139 @item EINTR
39140 The call was interrupted by the user.
39141 @end table
39142
39143 @end table
39144
39145 @node read
39146 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39147 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39148
39149 @table @asis
39150 @item Synopsis:
39151 @smallexample
39152 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39153 @end smallexample
39154
39155 @item Request:
39156 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39157
39158 @item Return value:
39159 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39160 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39161 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39162
39163 @item Errors:
39164
39165 @table @code
39166 @item EBADF
39167 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39168 reading.
39169
39170 @item EFAULT
39171 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39172
39173 @item EINTR
39174 The call was interrupted by the user.
39175 @end table
39176
39177 @end table
39178
39179 @node write
39180 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39181 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39182
39183 @table @asis
39184 @item Synopsis:
39185 @smallexample
39186 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39187 @end smallexample
39188
39189 @item Request:
39190 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39191
39192 @item Return value:
39193 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39194 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39195 is returned.
39196
39197 @item Errors:
39198
39199 @table @code
39200 @item EBADF
39201 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39202 writing.
39203
39204 @item EFAULT
39205 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39206
39207 @item EFBIG
39208 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39209 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39210
39211 @item ENOSPC
39212 No space on device to write the data.
39213
39214 @item EINTR
39215 The call was interrupted by the user.
39216 @end table
39217
39218 @end table
39219
39220 @node lseek
39221 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39222 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39223
39224 @table @asis
39225 @item Synopsis:
39226 @smallexample
39227 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39228 @end smallexample
39229
39230 @item Request:
39231 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39232
39233 @var{flag} is one of:
39234
39235 @table @code
39236 @item SEEK_SET
39237 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39238
39239 @item SEEK_CUR
39240 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39241 bytes.
39242
39243 @item SEEK_END
39244 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39245 bytes.
39246 @end table
39247
39248 @item Return value:
39249 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39250 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39251 value of -1 is returned.
39252
39253 @item Errors:
39254
39255 @table @code
39256 @item EBADF
39257 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39258
39259 @item ESPIPE
39260 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39261
39262 @item EINVAL
39263 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39264
39265 @item EINTR
39266 The call was interrupted by the user.
39267 @end table
39268
39269 @end table
39270
39271 @node rename
39272 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39273 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39274
39275 @table @asis
39276 @item Synopsis:
39277 @smallexample
39278 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39279 @end smallexample
39280
39281 @item Request:
39282 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39283
39284 @item Return value:
39285 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39286
39287 @item Errors:
39288
39289 @table @code
39290 @item EISDIR
39291 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39292 directory.
39293
39294 @item EEXIST
39295 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39296
39297 @item EBUSY
39298 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39299 process.
39300
39301 @item EINVAL
39302 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39303 of itself.
39304
39305 @item ENOTDIR
39306 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39307 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39308 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39309
39310 @item EFAULT
39311 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39312
39313 @item EACCES
39314 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39315
39316 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39317
39318 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39319
39320 @item ENOENT
39321 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39322
39323 @item EROFS
39324 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39325
39326 @item ENOSPC
39327 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39328 directory entry.
39329
39330 @item EINTR
39331 The call was interrupted by the user.
39332 @end table
39333
39334 @end table
39335
39336 @node unlink
39337 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39338 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39339
39340 @table @asis
39341 @item Synopsis:
39342 @smallexample
39343 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39344 @end smallexample
39345
39346 @item Request:
39347 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39348
39349 @item Return value:
39350 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39351
39352 @item Errors:
39353
39354 @table @code
39355 @item EACCES
39356 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39357
39358 @item EPERM
39359 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39360
39361 @item EBUSY
39362 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39363 being used by another process.
39364
39365 @item EFAULT
39366 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39367
39368 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39369 @var{pathname} was too long.
39370
39371 @item ENOENT
39372 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39373
39374 @item ENOTDIR
39375 A component of the path is not a directory.
39376
39377 @item EROFS
39378 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39379
39380 @item EINTR
39381 The call was interrupted by the user.
39382 @end table
39383
39384 @end table
39385
39386 @node stat/fstat
39387 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39388 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39389 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39390
39391 @table @asis
39392 @item Synopsis:
39393 @smallexample
39394 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39395 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39396 @end smallexample
39397
39398 @item Request:
39399 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39400 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39401
39402 @item Return value:
39403 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39404
39405 @item Errors:
39406
39407 @table @code
39408 @item EBADF
39409 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39410
39411 @item ENOENT
39412 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39413 path is an empty string.
39414
39415 @item ENOTDIR
39416 A component of the path is not a directory.
39417
39418 @item EFAULT
39419 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39420
39421 @item EACCES
39422 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39423
39424 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39425 @var{pathname} was too long.
39426
39427 @item EINTR
39428 The call was interrupted by the user.
39429 @end table
39430
39431 @end table
39432
39433 @node gettimeofday
39434 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39435 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39436
39437 @table @asis
39438 @item Synopsis:
39439 @smallexample
39440 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39441 @end smallexample
39442
39443 @item Request:
39444 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39445
39446 @item Return value:
39447 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39448
39449 @item Errors:
39450
39451 @table @code
39452 @item EINVAL
39453 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39454
39455 @item EFAULT
39456 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39457 @end table
39458
39459 @end table
39460
39461 @node isatty
39462 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39463 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39464
39465 @table @asis
39466 @item Synopsis:
39467 @smallexample
39468 int isatty(int fd);
39469 @end smallexample
39470
39471 @item Request:
39472 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39473
39474 @item Return value:
39475 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39476
39477 @item Errors:
39478
39479 @table @code
39480 @item EINTR
39481 The call was interrupted by the user.
39482 @end table
39483
39484 @end table
39485
39486 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39487 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39488 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39489 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39490 needed.
39491
39492
39493 @node system
39494 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39495 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39496
39497 @table @asis
39498 @item Synopsis:
39499 @smallexample
39500 int system(const char *command);
39501 @end smallexample
39502
39503 @item Request:
39504 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39505
39506 @item Return value:
39507 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39508 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39509 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39510 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39511 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39512 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39513 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39514
39515 @item Errors:
39516
39517 @table @code
39518 @item EINTR
39519 The call was interrupted by the user.
39520 @end table
39521
39522 @end table
39523
39524 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39525 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39526 the host is simplified before it's returned
39527 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39528 is discarded, and the return value consists
39529 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39530
39531 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39532 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39533 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39534
39535 @table @code
39536 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39537 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39538 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39539 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39540
39541 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39542 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39543 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39544 protocol.
39545 @end table
39546
39547 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39548 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39549 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39550
39551 @menu
39552 * Integral Datatypes::
39553 * Pointer Values::
39554 * Memory Transfer::
39555 * struct stat::
39556 * struct timeval::
39557 @end menu
39558
39559 @node Integral Datatypes
39560 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39561 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39562
39563 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39564 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39565 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39566
39567 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39568 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39569
39570 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39571
39572 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39573 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39574
39575 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39576
39577 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39578 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39579 byte order.
39580
39581 @node Pointer Values
39582 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39583 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39584
39585 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39586 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39587 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39588 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39589
39590 @smallexample
39591 @code{1aaf/12}
39592 @end smallexample
39593
39594 @noindent
39595 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39596 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39597 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39598 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39599
39600 @smallexample
39601 @code{123456/d}
39602 @end smallexample
39603
39604 @node Memory Transfer
39605 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39606 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39607
39608 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39609 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39610 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39611 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39612 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39613 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39614 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39615
39616
39617 @node struct stat
39618 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39619 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39620
39621 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39622 is defined as follows:
39623
39624 @smallexample
39625 struct stat @{
39626 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39627 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39628 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39629 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39630 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39631 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39632 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39633 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39634 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39635 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39636 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39637 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39638 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39639 @};
39640 @end smallexample
39641
39642 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39643 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39644 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39645
39646 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39647 range of values.
39648
39649 @table @code
39650
39651 @item st_dev
39652 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39653
39654 @item st_ino
39655 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39656
39657 @item st_mode
39658 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39659 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39660
39661 @item st_uid
39662 @itemx st_gid
39663 @itemx st_rdev
39664 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39665
39666 @item st_atime
39667 @itemx st_mtime
39668 @itemx st_ctime
39669 These values have a host and file system dependent
39670 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39671 support exact timing values.
39672 @end table
39673
39674 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39675 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39676 continuing.
39677
39678 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39679 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39680 get truncated on the target.
39681
39682 @node struct timeval
39683 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39684 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39685
39686 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39687 is defined as follows:
39688
39689 @smallexample
39690 struct timeval @{
39691 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39692 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39693 @};
39694 @end smallexample
39695
39696 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39697 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39698 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39699
39700 @node Constants
39701 @subsection Constants
39702 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39703
39704 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39705 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39706 values before and after the call as needed.
39707
39708 @menu
39709 * Open Flags::
39710 * mode_t Values::
39711 * Errno Values::
39712 * Lseek Flags::
39713 * Limits::
39714 @end menu
39715
39716 @node Open Flags
39717 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39718 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39719
39720 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39721
39722 @smallexample
39723 O_RDONLY 0x0
39724 O_WRONLY 0x1
39725 O_RDWR 0x2
39726 O_APPEND 0x8
39727 O_CREAT 0x200
39728 O_TRUNC 0x400
39729 O_EXCL 0x800
39730 @end smallexample
39731
39732 @node mode_t Values
39733 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39734 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39735
39736 All values are given in octal representation.
39737
39738 @smallexample
39739 S_IFREG 0100000
39740 S_IFDIR 040000
39741 S_IRUSR 0400
39742 S_IWUSR 0200
39743 S_IXUSR 0100
39744 S_IRGRP 040
39745 S_IWGRP 020
39746 S_IXGRP 010
39747 S_IROTH 04
39748 S_IWOTH 02
39749 S_IXOTH 01
39750 @end smallexample
39751
39752 @node Errno Values
39753 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39754 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39755
39756 All values are given in decimal representation.
39757
39758 @smallexample
39759 EPERM 1
39760 ENOENT 2
39761 EINTR 4
39762 EBADF 9
39763 EACCES 13
39764 EFAULT 14
39765 EBUSY 16
39766 EEXIST 17
39767 ENODEV 19
39768 ENOTDIR 20
39769 EISDIR 21
39770 EINVAL 22
39771 ENFILE 23
39772 EMFILE 24
39773 EFBIG 27
39774 ENOSPC 28
39775 ESPIPE 29
39776 EROFS 30
39777 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39778 EUNKNOWN 9999
39779 @end smallexample
39780
39781 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39782 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39783
39784 @node Lseek Flags
39785 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39786 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39787
39788 @smallexample
39789 SEEK_SET 0
39790 SEEK_CUR 1
39791 SEEK_END 2
39792 @end smallexample
39793
39794 @node Limits
39795 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39796 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39797
39798 All values are given in decimal representation.
39799
39800 @smallexample
39801 INT_MIN -2147483648
39802 INT_MAX 2147483647
39803 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39804 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39805 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39806 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39807 @end smallexample
39808
39809 @node File-I/O Examples
39810 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39811 @cindex file-i/o examples
39812
39813 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39814 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39815
39816 @smallexample
39817 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39818 @emph{request memory read from target}
39819 -> @code{m1234,6}
39820 <- XXXXXX
39821 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39822 -> @code{F6}
39823 @end smallexample
39824
39825 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39826 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39827
39828 @smallexample
39829 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39830 @emph{request memory write to target}
39831 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39832 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39833 -> @code{F6}
39834 @end smallexample
39835
39836 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39837 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39838
39839 @smallexample
39840 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39841 -> @code{F-1,9}
39842 @end smallexample
39843
39844 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39845 host is called:
39846
39847 @smallexample
39848 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39849 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39850 <- @code{T02}
39851 @end smallexample
39852
39853 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39854 host is called:
39855
39856 @smallexample
39857 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39858 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39859 <- @code{T02}
39860 @end smallexample
39861
39862 @node Library List Format
39863 @section Library List Format
39864 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39865
39866 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39867 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39868 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39869 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39870 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39871 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39872 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39873 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39874 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39875 are loaded.
39876
39877 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39878 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39879 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39880 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39881
39882 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39883 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39884 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39885 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39886 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39887 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39888
39889 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39890 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39891
39892 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39893 offset, looks like this:
39894
39895 @smallexample
39896 <library-list>
39897 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39898 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39899 </library>
39900 </library-list>
39901 @end smallexample
39902
39903 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39904 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39905
39906 @smallexample
39907 <library-list>
39908 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39909 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39910 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39911 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39912 </library>
39913 </library-list>
39914 @end smallexample
39915
39916 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39917
39918 @smallexample
39919 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39920 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39921 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39922 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39923 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39924 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39925 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39926 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39927 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39928 @end smallexample
39929
39930 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39931 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39932 section for each library.
39933
39934 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39935 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39936 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39937
39938 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39939 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39940 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39941 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39942
39943 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39944 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39945 target, the following parameters are reported:
39946
39947 @itemize @minus
39948 @item
39949 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39950 @code{struct link_map}.
39951 @item
39952 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39953 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39954 @item
39955 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39956 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39957 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39958 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39959 @item
39960 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39961 @end itemize
39962
39963 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39964 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39965 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39966
39967 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39968 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39969
39970 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39971 looks like this:
39972
39973 @smallexample
39974 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39975 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39976 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39977 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39978 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39979 </library-list-svr>
39980 @end smallexample
39981
39982 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39983
39984 @smallexample
39985 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39986 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39987 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39988 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39989 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39990 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39991 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39992 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39993 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39994 @end smallexample
39995
39996 @node Memory Map Format
39997 @section Memory Map Format
39998 @cindex memory map format
39999
40000 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40001 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40002 memory map.
40003
40004 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40005 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40006 lists memory regions.
40007
40008 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40009 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40010
40011 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40012
40013 @smallexample
40014 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40015 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40016 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40017 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40018 <memory-map>
40019 region...
40020 </memory-map>
40021 @end smallexample
40022
40023 Each region can be either:
40024
40025 @itemize
40026
40027 @item
40028 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40029 bytes from there:
40030
40031 @smallexample
40032 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40033 @end smallexample
40034
40035
40036 @item
40037 A region of read-only memory:
40038
40039 @smallexample
40040 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40041 @end smallexample
40042
40043
40044 @item
40045 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40046 bytes in length:
40047
40048 @smallexample
40049 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40050 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40051 </memory>
40052 @end smallexample
40053
40054 @end itemize
40055
40056 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40057 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40058 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40059
40060 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40061
40062 @smallexample
40063 <!-- ................................................... -->
40064 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40065 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40066 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40067 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40068 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40069 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40070 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40071 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40072 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40073 and its type, or device. -->
40074 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40075 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40076 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40077 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40078 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40079 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40080 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40081 @end smallexample
40082
40083 @node Thread List Format
40084 @section Thread List Format
40085 @cindex thread list format
40086
40087 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40088 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40089 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40090 the following structure:
40091
40092 @smallexample
40093 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40094 <threads>
40095 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40096 ... description ...
40097 </thread>
40098 </threads>
40099 @end smallexample
40100
40101 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40102 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40103 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40104 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40105 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40106 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40107 auxiliary information.
40108
40109 @node Traceframe Info Format
40110 @section Traceframe Info Format
40111 @cindex traceframe info format
40112
40113 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40114 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40115 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40116 collected in a traceframe.
40117
40118 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40119 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40120
40121 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40122 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40123
40124 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40125
40126 @smallexample
40127 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40128 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40129 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40130 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40131 <traceframe-info>
40132 block...
40133 </traceframe-info>
40134 @end smallexample
40135
40136 Each traceframe block can be either:
40137
40138 @itemize
40139
40140 @item
40141 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40142 @var{length} bytes from there:
40143
40144 @smallexample
40145 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40146 @end smallexample
40147
40148 @item
40149 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40150 collected:
40151
40152 @smallexample
40153 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40154 @end smallexample
40155
40156 @end itemize
40157
40158 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40159
40160 @smallexample
40161 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40162 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40163
40164 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40165 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40166 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40167 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40168 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40169 @end smallexample
40170
40171 @node Branch Trace Format
40172 @section Branch Trace Format
40173 @cindex branch trace format
40174
40175 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40176 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40177 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40178 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40179
40180 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40181 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40182
40183 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40184 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40185
40186 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40187
40188 @smallexample
40189 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40190 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40191 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40192 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40193 <btrace>
40194 block...
40195 </btrace>
40196 @end smallexample
40197
40198 @itemize
40199
40200 @item
40201 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40202 and ending at @var{end}:
40203
40204 @smallexample
40205 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40206 @end smallexample
40207
40208 @end itemize
40209
40210 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40211
40212 @smallexample
40213 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40214 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40215
40216 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40217 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40218 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40219
40220 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40221
40222 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40223
40224 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40225 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40226 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40227 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40228 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40229
40230 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40231 @end smallexample
40232
40233 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40234 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40235 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40236
40237 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40238 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40239 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40240
40241 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40242 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40243
40244 @table @code
40245 @item bts
40246 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40247 @table @code
40248 @item size
40249 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40250 @end table
40251 @item pt
40252 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40253 PT}) format.
40254 @table @code
40255 @item size
40256 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40257 @end table
40258 @end table
40259
40260 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40261 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40262
40263 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40264
40265 @smallexample
40266 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40267 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40268
40269 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40270 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40271
40272 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40273 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40274 @end smallexample
40275
40276 @include agentexpr.texi
40277
40278 @node Target Descriptions
40279 @appendix Target Descriptions
40280 @cindex target descriptions
40281
40282 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40283 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40284 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40285 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40286 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40287 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40288 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40289
40290 @itemize @bullet
40291 @item
40292 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40293 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40294 @item
40295 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40296 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40297 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40298 @item
40299 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40300 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40301 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40302 @end itemize
40303
40304 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40305 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40306 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40307 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40308 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40309
40310 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40311 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40312
40313 @menu
40314 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40315 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40316 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40317 descriptions.
40318 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40319 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40320 @end menu
40321
40322 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40323 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40324
40325 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40326 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40327 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40328 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40329 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40330 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40331 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40332 Format}.
40333
40334 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40335 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40336 specify a file are:
40337
40338 @table @code
40339 @cindex set tdesc filename
40340 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40341 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40342
40343 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40344 @item unset tdesc filename
40345 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40346 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40347
40348 @cindex show tdesc filename
40349 @item show tdesc filename
40350 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40351 @end table
40352
40353
40354 @node Target Description Format
40355 @section Target Description Format
40356 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40357
40358 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40359 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40360 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40361 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40362 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40363 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40364 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40365
40366 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40367 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40368 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40369 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40370 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40371
40372 Here is a simple target description:
40373
40374 @smallexample
40375 <target version="1.0">
40376 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40377 </target>
40378 @end smallexample
40379
40380 @noindent
40381 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40382 the x86-64 architecture.
40383
40384 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40385 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40386 are explained further below.
40387
40388 @smallexample
40389 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40390 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40391 <target version="1.0">
40392 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40393 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40394 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40395 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40396 </target>
40397 @end smallexample
40398
40399 @noindent
40400 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40401 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40402 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40403 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40404 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40405 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40406 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40407 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40408 the version mismatch.
40409
40410 @subsection Inclusion
40411 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40412 @cindex XInclude
40413 @ifnotinfo
40414 @cindex <xi:include>
40415 @end ifnotinfo
40416
40417 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40418 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40419 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40420 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40421 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40422
40423 @smallexample
40424 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40425 @end smallexample
40426
40427 @noindent
40428 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40429 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40430 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40431 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40432 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40433 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40434 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40435 original description.
40436
40437 @subsection Architecture
40438 @cindex <architecture>
40439
40440 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40441
40442 @smallexample
40443 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40444 @end smallexample
40445
40446 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40447 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40448
40449 @subsection OS ABI
40450 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40451
40452 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40453 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40454
40455 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40456
40457 @smallexample
40458 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40459 @end smallexample
40460
40461 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40462 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40463
40464 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40465 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40466
40467 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40468 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40469
40470 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40471
40472 @smallexample
40473 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40474 @end smallexample
40475
40476 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40477 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40478
40479 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40480 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40481 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40482 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40483 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40484 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40485 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40486
40487 @smallexample
40488 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40489 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40490 @end smallexample
40491
40492 @subsection Features
40493 @cindex <feature>
40494
40495 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40496 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40497 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40498 has this form:
40499
40500 @smallexample
40501 <feature name="@var{name}">
40502 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40503 @var{reg}@dots{}
40504 </feature>
40505 @end smallexample
40506
40507 @noindent
40508 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40509 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40510 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40511 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40512
40513 @subsection Types
40514
40515 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40516 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40517 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40518 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40519 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40520 and enum types.
40521
40522 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40523 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40524 Types must be defined before they are used.
40525
40526 @cindex <vector>
40527 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40528 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40529 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40530 @var{count}:
40531
40532 @smallexample
40533 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40534 @end smallexample
40535
40536 @cindex <union>
40537 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40538 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40539 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40540 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40541
40542 @smallexample
40543 <union id="@var{id}">
40544 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40545 @dots{}
40546 </union>
40547 @end smallexample
40548
40549 @cindex <struct>
40550 @cindex <flags>
40551 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40552 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40553 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40554 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40555 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40556 specified.
40557
40558 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40559
40560 @smallexample
40561 <struct id="@var{id}">
40562 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40563 @dots{}
40564 </struct>
40565 @end smallexample
40566
40567 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40568 No implicit padding is added.
40569
40570 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
40571
40572 @smallexample
40573 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40574 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40575 @dots{}
40576 </struct>
40577 @end smallexample
40578
40579 @smallexample
40580 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40581 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40582 @dots{}
40583 </flags>
40584 @end smallexample
40585
40586 The @var{name} value is required.
40587 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
40588 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
40589 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
40590
40591 The @var{start} value is required, and @var{end} and @var{type}
40592 are optional.
40593 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
40594 and zero represents the least significant bit.
40595 The default value of @var{end} is @var{start}, a single bit field.
40596
40597 The default value of @var{type} depends on whether the
40598 @var{end} was specified. If @var{end} is specified then the default
40599 value of @var{type} is an unsigned integer. If @var{end} is unspecified
40600 then the default value of @var{type} is @code{bool}.
40601
40602 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
40603
40604 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
40605 defining them with @samp{struct}:
40606
40607 @itemize @bullet
40608 @item
40609 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
40610 @item
40611 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
40612 @end itemize
40613
40614 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
40615 defining them with @samp{flags}:
40616
40617 @itemize @bullet
40618 @item
40619 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
40620
40621 @smallexample
40622 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
40623 $1 = 42
40624 @end smallexample
40625
40626 @end itemize
40627
40628 @subsection Registers
40629 @cindex <reg>
40630
40631 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40632
40633 @smallexample
40634 <reg name="@var{name}"
40635 bitsize="@var{size}"
40636 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40637 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40638 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40639 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40640 @end smallexample
40641
40642 @noindent
40643 The components are as follows:
40644
40645 @table @var
40646
40647 @item name
40648 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40649
40650 @item bitsize
40651 The register's size, in bits.
40652
40653 @item regnum
40654 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40655 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40656 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40657 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40658 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40659 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40660 in order of increasing register number.
40661
40662 @item save-restore
40663 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40664 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40665 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40666 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40667 ABI.
40668
40669 @item type
40670 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40671 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40672 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40673 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40674 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40675 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40676
40677 @item group
40678 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40679 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40680 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40681 in @code{info registers}.
40682
40683 @end table
40684
40685 @node Predefined Target Types
40686 @section Predefined Target Types
40687 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40688
40689 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40690 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40691 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40692 types. The currently supported types are:
40693
40694 @table @code
40695
40696 @item bool
40697 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
40698
40699 @item int8
40700 @itemx int16
40701 @itemx int32
40702 @itemx int64
40703 @itemx int128
40704 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40705
40706 @item uint8
40707 @itemx uint16
40708 @itemx uint32
40709 @itemx uint64
40710 @itemx uint128
40711 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40712
40713 @item code_ptr
40714 @itemx data_ptr
40715 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40716 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40717 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40718 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40719 may be marked as data pointers.
40720
40721 @item ieee_single
40722 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40723
40724 @item ieee_double
40725 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40726
40727 @item arm_fpa_ext
40728 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40729
40730 @item i387_ext
40731 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40732
40733 @item i386_eflags
40734 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40735
40736 @item i386_mxcsr
40737 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40738
40739 @end table
40740
40741 @node Enum Target Types
40742 @section Enum Target Types
40743 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
40744
40745 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
40746 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
40747
40748 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
40749
40750 @smallexample
40751 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40752 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
40753 @dots{}
40754 </enum>
40755 @end smallexample
40756
40757 Enums must be defined before they are used.
40758
40759 @smallexample
40760 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
40761 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
40762 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
40763 </enum>
40764 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
40765 <field name="X" start="0"/>
40766 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
40767 </flags>
40768 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
40769 @end smallexample
40770
40771 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
40772 would be printed as:
40773
40774 @smallexample
40775 (gdb) info register flags
40776 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
40777 @end smallexample
40778
40779 @node Standard Target Features
40780 @section Standard Target Features
40781 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40782
40783 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40784 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40785 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40786 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40787 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40788 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40789 can recognize them.
40790
40791 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40792 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40793 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40794 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40795 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40796 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40797 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40798 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40799
40800 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40801 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40802 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40803
40804 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40805 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40806 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40807 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40808
40809 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40810 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40811 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40812
40813 @menu
40814 * AArch64 Features::
40815 * ARM Features::
40816 * i386 Features::
40817 * MicroBlaze Features::
40818 * MIPS Features::
40819 * M68K Features::
40820 * NDS32 Features::
40821 * Nios II Features::
40822 * PowerPC Features::
40823 * S/390 and System z Features::
40824 * TIC6x Features::
40825 @end menu
40826
40827
40828 @node AArch64 Features
40829 @subsection AArch64 Features
40830 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40831
40832 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40833 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40834 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40835
40836 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40837 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40838 and @samp{fpcr}.
40839
40840 @node ARM Features
40841 @subsection ARM Features
40842 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40843
40844 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40845 ARM targets.
40846 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40847 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40848
40849 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40850 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40851 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40852 and @samp{xpsr}.
40853
40854 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40855 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40856
40857 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40858 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40859 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40860 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40861
40862 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40863 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40864 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40865 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40866 halves of the double-precision registers.
40867
40868 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40869 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40870 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40871 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40872 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40873 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40874
40875 @node i386 Features
40876 @subsection i386 Features
40877 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40878
40879 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40880 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40881
40882 @itemize @minus
40883 @item
40884 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40885 @item
40886 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40887 @item
40888 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40889 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40890 @item
40891 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40892 @item
40893 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40894 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40895 @end itemize
40896
40897 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40898
40899 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40900 describe registers:
40901
40902 @itemize @minus
40903 @item
40904 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40905 @item
40906 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40907 @item
40908 @samp{mxcsr}
40909 @end itemize
40910
40911 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40912 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40913 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40914
40915 @itemize @minus
40916 @item
40917 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40918 @item
40919 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40920 @end itemize
40921
40922 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
40923 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40924
40925 @itemize @minus
40926 @item
40927 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40928 @item
40929 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40930 @end itemize
40931
40932 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40933 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40934
40935 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40936 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40937 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40938
40939 @itemize @minus
40940 @item
40941 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40942 @end itemize
40943
40944 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40945
40946 @itemize @minus
40947 @item
40948 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40949 @end itemize
40950
40951 It should
40952 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40953
40954 @itemize @minus
40955 @item
40956 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40957 @item
40958 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40959 @end itemize
40960
40961 It should
40962 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40963
40964 @itemize @minus
40965 @item
40966 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40967 @end itemize
40968
40969 @node MicroBlaze Features
40970 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40971 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40972
40973 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40974 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40975 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40976 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40977 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40978
40979 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40980 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40981
40982 @node MIPS Features
40983 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40984 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40985
40986 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40987 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40988 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40989 on the target.
40990
40991 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40992 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40993 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40994
40995 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40996 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40997 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40998 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40999
41000 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41001 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41002 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41003 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41004
41005 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41006 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41007 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41008
41009 @node M68K Features
41010 @subsection M68K Features
41011 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41012
41013 @table @code
41014 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41015 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41016 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41017 One of those features must be always present.
41018 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41019 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41020 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41021 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41022
41023 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41024 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41025 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41026 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41027 @end table
41028
41029 @node NDS32 Features
41030 @subsection NDS32 Features
41031 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41032
41033 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41034 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41035 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41036 and @samp{pc}.
41037
41038 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41039 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41040 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41041 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41042
41043 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41044 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41045 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41046 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41047 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41048 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41049 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41050
41051 @node Nios II Features
41052 @subsection Nios II Features
41053 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41054
41055 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41056 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41057 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41058 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41059 @samp{mpuacc}).
41060
41061 @node PowerPC Features
41062 @subsection PowerPC Features
41063 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41064
41065 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41066 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41067 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41068 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41069
41070 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41071 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41072
41073 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41074 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41075 and @samp{vrsave}.
41076
41077 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41078 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41079 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41080 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41081 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41082 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41083
41084 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41085 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41086 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41087 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41088 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41089 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41090 user.
41091
41092 @node S/390 and System z Features
41093 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41094 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41095 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41096
41097 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41098 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41099 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41100 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41101 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41102 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41103 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41104 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41105 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41106
41107 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41108 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41109 @samp{fpc}.
41110
41111 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41112 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41113
41114 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41115 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41116 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41117 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41118 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41119 32-bit wide.
41120
41121 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41122 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41123 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41124
41125 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41126 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41127 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41128 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41129 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41130 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41131 @samp{v31}.
41132
41133 @node TIC6x Features
41134 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41135 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41136 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41137 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41138 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41139 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41140
41141 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41142 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41143 through @samp{B31}.
41144
41145 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41146 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41147
41148 @node Operating System Information
41149 @appendix Operating System Information
41150 @cindex operating system information
41151
41152 @menu
41153 * Process list::
41154 @end menu
41155
41156 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41157 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41158 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41159 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41160 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41161 on a different aspect of target.
41162
41163 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41164 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41165 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41166 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41167
41168 @node Process list
41169 @appendixsection Process list
41170 @cindex operating system information, process list
41171
41172 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41173 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41174 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41175 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41176
41177 An example document is:
41178
41179 @smallexample
41180 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41181 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41182 <osdata type="processes">
41183 <item>
41184 <column name="pid">1</column>
41185 <column name="user">root</column>
41186 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41187 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41188 </item>
41189 </osdata>
41190 @end smallexample
41191
41192 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41193 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41194 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41195 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41196 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41197 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41198 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41199
41200 @node Trace File Format
41201 @appendix Trace File Format
41202 @cindex trace file format
41203
41204 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41205 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41206
41207 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41208 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41209 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41210 in the future.
41211
41212 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41213 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41214 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41215 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41216 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41217 of this section.
41218
41219 @table @code
41220 @item R @var{size}
41221 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41222 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41223 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41224 a single trace file.
41225
41226 @item status @var{status}
41227 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41228 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41229 file.
41230
41231 @item tp @var{payload}
41232 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41233 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41234 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41235 reply packets.
41236
41237 @item tsv @var{payload}
41238 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41239 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41240 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41241 reply packets.
41242
41243 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41244 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41245 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41246 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41247 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41248 file. Includes are not allowed.
41249
41250 @end table
41251
41252 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41253 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41254 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41255 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41256 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41257 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41258 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41259 endianness.
41260
41261 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41262
41263 @table @code
41264 @item R @var{bytes}
41265 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41266 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41267 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41268
41269 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41270 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41271 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41272 @var{length} bytes.
41273
41274 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41275 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41276 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41277
41278 @end table
41279
41280 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41281 of blocks.
41282
41283 @node Index Section Format
41284 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41285 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41286 @cindex index section format
41287
41288 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41289 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41290 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41291 description.
41292
41293 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41294 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41295 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41296 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41297 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41298 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41299
41300 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41301
41302 @enumerate
41303 @item
41304 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41305 unless otherwise noted:
41306
41307 @enumerate
41308 @item
41309 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41310 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41311 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41312 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41313 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41314 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41315 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41316
41317 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41318 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41319 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41320 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41321
41322 @item
41323 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41324
41325 @item
41326 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41327 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41328 to the next offset.
41329
41330 @item
41331 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41332
41333 @item
41334 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41335
41336 @item
41337 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41338 @end enumerate
41339
41340 @item
41341 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41342 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41343 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41344 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41345 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41346 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41347 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41348 CU indices.
41349
41350 @item
41351 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41352 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41353 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41354 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41355
41356 @item
41357 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41358 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41359
41360 @enumerate
41361 @item
41362 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41363
41364 @item
41365 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41366 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41367
41368 @item
41369 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41370 @end enumerate
41371
41372 @item
41373 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41374 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41375
41376 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41377 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41378 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41379 constant pool.
41380
41381 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41382 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41383 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41384
41385 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41386 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41387 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41388 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41389 index version:
41390
41391 @table @asis
41392 @item Version 4
41393 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41394
41395 @item Versions 5 to 7
41396 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41397 @end table
41398
41399 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41400
41401 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41402 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41403 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41404 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41405 collision.
41406
41407 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41408 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41409 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41410 the code.
41411
41412 @item
41413 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41414 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41415 strings.
41416
41417 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41418 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41419 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41420 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41421 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41422 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41423
41424 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41425 @end enumerate
41426
41427 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41428 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41429 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41430
41431 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41432 (bit 0 = LSB):
41433
41434 @table @asis
41435
41436 @item Bits 0-23
41437 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41438 @item Bits 24-27
41439 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41440 @item Bits 28-30
41441 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41442
41443 @table @asis
41444 @item 0
41445 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41446 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41447 with previous versions of the index.
41448 @item 1
41449 The symbol is a type.
41450 @item 2
41451 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41452 @item 3
41453 The symbol is a function.
41454 @item 4
41455 Any other kind of symbol.
41456 @item 5,6,7
41457 These values are reserved.
41458 @end table
41459
41460 @item Bit 31
41461 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41462
41463 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41464 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41465 @value{GDBN} sources.
41466
41467 @end table
41468
41469 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41470 global/static attributes in the index.
41471
41472 @smallexample
41473 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41474 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41475 switch (die->tag)
41476 @{
41477 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41478 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41479 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41480 kind = TYPE;
41481 is_static = 1;
41482 break;
41483 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41484 kind = VARIABLE;
41485 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41486 break;
41487 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41488 kind = FUNCTION;
41489 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41490 break;
41491 case DW_TAG_constant:
41492 kind = VARIABLE;
41493 is_static = ! is_external;
41494 break;
41495 case DW_TAG_variable:
41496 kind = VARIABLE;
41497 is_static = ! is_external;
41498 break;
41499 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41500 kind = TYPE;
41501 is_static = 0;
41502 break;
41503 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41504 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41505 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41506 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41507 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41508 kind = TYPE;
41509 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41510 break;
41511 default:
41512 assert (0);
41513 @}
41514 @end smallexample
41515
41516 @node Man Pages
41517 @appendix Manual pages
41518 @cindex Man pages
41519
41520 @menu
41521 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41522 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41523 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41524 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41525 @end menu
41526
41527 @node gdb man
41528 @heading gdb man
41529
41530 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41531
41532 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41533 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41534 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41535 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41536 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41537 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41538 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41539 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41540 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41541 @c man end
41542
41543 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41544 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41545 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41546 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41547
41548 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41549 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41550
41551 @itemize @bullet
41552 @item
41553 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41554
41555 @item
41556 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41557
41558 @item
41559 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41560
41561 @item
41562 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41563 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41564 @end itemize
41565
41566 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41567 Modula-2.
41568
41569 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41570 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41571 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41572 by using the command @code{help}.
41573
41574 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41575 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41576 executable program as the argument:
41577
41578 @smallexample
41579 gdb program
41580 @end smallexample
41581
41582 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41583
41584 @smallexample
41585 gdb program core
41586 @end smallexample
41587
41588 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41589 to debug a running process:
41590
41591 @smallexample
41592 gdb program 1234
41593 gdb -p 1234
41594 @end smallexample
41595
41596 @noindent
41597 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41598 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41599 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41600
41601 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41602
41603 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41604 @table @env
41605 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41606 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41607
41608 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41609 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41610
41611 @item bt
41612 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41613
41614 @item print @var{expr}
41615 Display the value of an expression.
41616
41617 @item c
41618 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41619
41620 @item next
41621 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41622 function calls in the line.
41623
41624 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41625 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41626
41627 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41628 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41629
41630 @item step
41631 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41632 function calls in the line.
41633
41634 @item help [@var{name}]
41635 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41636 about using @value{GDBN}.
41637
41638 @item quit
41639 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41640 @end table
41641
41642 @ifset man
41643 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41644 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41645 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41646 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41647 @end ifset
41648 @c man end
41649
41650 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41651 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41652 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41653 encountered with no
41654 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41655 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41656 Many options have
41657 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41658 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41659 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41660 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41661 more usual convention.)
41662
41663 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41664 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41665 option is used.
41666
41667 @table @env
41668 @item -help
41669 @itemx -h
41670 List all options, with brief explanations.
41671
41672 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41673 @itemx -s @var{file}
41674 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41675
41676 @item -write
41677 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41678
41679 @item -exec=@var{file}
41680 @itemx -e @var{file}
41681 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41682 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41683 dump.
41684
41685 @item -se=@var{file}
41686 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41687 file.
41688
41689 @item -core=@var{file}
41690 @itemx -c @var{file}
41691 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41692
41693 @item -command=@var{file}
41694 @itemx -x @var{file}
41695 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41696
41697 @item -ex @var{command}
41698 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41699
41700 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41701 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41702 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41703
41704 @item -nh
41705 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41706
41707 @item -nx
41708 @itemx -n
41709 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41710
41711 @item -quiet
41712 @itemx -q
41713 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41714 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41715
41716 @item -batch
41717 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41718 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41719 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41720 commands in the command files.
41721
41722 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41723 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41724 more useful, the message
41725
41726 @smallexample
41727 Program exited normally.
41728 @end smallexample
41729
41730 @noindent
41731 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41732 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41733
41734 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41735 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41736 instead of the current directory.
41737
41738 @item -fullname
41739 @itemx -f
41740 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41741 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41742 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41743 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41744 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41745 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41746 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41747 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41748
41749 @item -b @var{bps}
41750 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41751 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41752
41753 @item -tty=@var{device}
41754 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41755 @end table
41756 @c man end
41757
41758 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41759 @ifset man
41760 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41761 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41762 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41763
41764 @smallexample
41765 info gdb
41766 @end smallexample
41767
41768 @noindent
41769 should give you access to the complete manual.
41770
41771 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41772 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41773 @end ifset
41774 @c man end
41775
41776 @node gdbserver man
41777 @heading gdbserver man
41778
41779 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41780 @format
41781 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41782 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41783
41784 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41785
41786 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41787 @c man end
41788 @end format
41789
41790 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41791 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41792 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41793
41794 @ifclear man
41795 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41796 @end ifclear
41797 @ifset man
41798 Usage (server (target) side):
41799 @end ifset
41800
41801 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41802 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41803 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41804 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41805
41806 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41807 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41808 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41809
41810 @smallexample
41811 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41812 @end smallexample
41813
41814 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41815
41816 @smallexample
41817 @ifset man
41818 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41819 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41820 @end ifset
41821 @ifclear man
41822 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41823 @end ifclear
41824 @end smallexample
41825
41826 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41827 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41828 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41829
41830 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41831
41832 @smallexample
41833 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41834 @end smallexample
41835
41836 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41837 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41838 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41839 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41840 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41841 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41842 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41843 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41844 print an error message and exit.
41845
41846 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41847 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41848
41849 @smallexample
41850 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41851 @end smallexample
41852
41853 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41854 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41855
41856 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41857 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41858 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41859 the program you want to debug.
41860
41861 @smallexample
41862 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41863 @end smallexample
41864
41865 @ifclear man
41866 @subheading Usage (host side)
41867 @end ifclear
41868 @ifset man
41869 Usage (host side):
41870 @end ifset
41871
41872 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41873 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41874 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41875 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41876 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41877 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41878 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41879 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41880 descriptor. For example:
41881
41882 @smallexample
41883 @ifset man
41884 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41885 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41886 @end ifset
41887 @ifclear man
41888 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41889 @end ifclear
41890 @end smallexample
41891
41892 @noindent
41893 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41894
41895 @smallexample
41896 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41897 @end smallexample
41898
41899 @noindent
41900 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41901 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41902 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41903 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41904 `Connection refused'.
41905
41906 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41907 described in
41908 @ifset man
41909 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41910 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41911 @end ifset
41912 @ifclear man
41913 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41914 @end ifclear
41915 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41916
41917 @smallexample
41918 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41919 @end smallexample
41920
41921 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41922 case.
41923 @c man end
41924
41925 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41926 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41927
41928 @itemize @bullet
41929
41930 @item
41931 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41932
41933 @smallexample
41934 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41935 @end smallexample
41936
41937 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41938 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41939 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41940 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41941 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41942 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41943 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41944
41945 @item
41946 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41947 program:
41948
41949 @smallexample
41950 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41951 @end smallexample
41952
41953 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41954 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41955 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41956 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41957
41958 @item
41959 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41960
41961 @smallexample
41962 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41963 @end smallexample
41964
41965 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41966 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41967 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41968 debug several processes in the same session.
41969 @end itemize
41970
41971 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41972
41973 @table @env
41974
41975 @item --help
41976 List all options, with brief explanations.
41977
41978 @item --version
41979 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41980
41981 @item --attach
41982 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41983
41984 @smallexample
41985 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41986 @end smallexample
41987
41988 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41989 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41990
41991 @item --multi
41992 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41993 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41994 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41995 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41996
41997 @smallexample
41998 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41999 @end smallexample
42000
42001 @item --debug
42002 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42003 process.
42004 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42005 the developers.
42006
42007 @item --remote-debug
42008 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42009 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42010 the developers.
42011
42012 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42013 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42014 of debugging output.
42015 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42016
42017 @item --wrapper
42018 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42019 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42020 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42021 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42022
42023 @item --once
42024 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42025 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42026 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42027 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42028
42029 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42030
42031 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42032 @c QDisableRandomization.
42033
42034 @end table
42035 @c man end
42036
42037 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42038 @ifset man
42039 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42040 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42041 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42042
42043 @smallexample
42044 info gdb
42045 @end smallexample
42046
42047 should give you access to the complete manual.
42048
42049 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42050 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42051 @end ifset
42052 @c man end
42053
42054 @node gcore man
42055 @heading gcore
42056
42057 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42058
42059 @format
42060 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42061 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42062 @c man end
42063 @end format
42064
42065 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42066 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42067 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42068 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42069 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42070 running without any change.
42071 @c man end
42072
42073 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42074 @table @env
42075 @item -o @var{filename}
42076 The optional argument
42077 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42078 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42079 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42080 @end table
42081 @c man end
42082
42083 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42084 @ifset man
42085 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42086 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42087 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42088
42089 @smallexample
42090 info gdb
42091 @end smallexample
42092
42093 @noindent
42094 should give you access to the complete manual.
42095
42096 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42097 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42098 @end ifset
42099 @c man end
42100
42101 @node gdbinit man
42102 @heading gdbinit
42103
42104 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42105
42106 @format
42107 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42108 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42109 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42110 @end ifset
42111
42112 ~/.gdbinit
42113
42114 ./.gdbinit
42115 @c man end
42116 @end format
42117
42118 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42119 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42120 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42121 described in
42122 @ifset man
42123 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42124 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42125 @end ifset
42126 @ifclear man
42127 @ref{Sequences}.
42128 @end ifclear
42129
42130 Please read more in
42131 @ifset man
42132 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42133 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42134 @end ifset
42135 @ifclear man
42136 @ref{Startup}.
42137 @end ifclear
42138
42139 @table @env
42140 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42141 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42142 @end ifset
42143 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42144 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42145 @end ifclear
42146 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42147 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42148 See more in
42149 @ifset man
42150 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42151 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42152 @end ifset
42153 @ifclear man
42154 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42155 @end ifclear
42156
42157 @item ~/.gdbinit
42158 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42159 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42160
42161 @item ./.gdbinit
42162 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42163 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42164 See more in
42165 @ifset man
42166 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42167 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42168 @end ifset
42169 @ifclear man
42170 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42171 @end ifclear
42172 @end table
42173 @c man end
42174
42175 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42176 @ifset man
42177 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42178
42179 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42180 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42181 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42182
42183 @smallexample
42184 info gdb
42185 @end smallexample
42186
42187 should give you access to the complete manual.
42188
42189 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42190 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42191 @end ifset
42192 @c man end
42193
42194 @include gpl.texi
42195
42196 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42197 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42198 @include fdl.texi
42199
42200 @node Concept Index
42201 @unnumbered Concept Index
42202
42203 @printindex cp
42204
42205 @node Command and Variable Index
42206 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42207
42208 @printindex fn
42209
42210 @tex
42211 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42212 % meantime:
42213 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42214 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42215 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42216 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42217 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42218 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42219 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42220 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42221 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42222 \page\colophon
42223 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42224 @end tex
42225
42226 @bye